xref: /netbsd-src/external/gpl3/gdb/dist/gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo (revision bdc22b2e01993381dcefeff2bc9b56ca75a4235c)
1\input texinfo      @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3@c
4@c %**start of header
5@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6@c of @set vars.  However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7@setfilename gdb.info
8@c
9@c man begin INCLUDE
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c man end
12@c
13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24@c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25@c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26@c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27@syncodeindex ky fn
28@syncodeindex tp fn
29
30@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32@syncodeindex vr fn
33
34@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35@c This is updated by GNU Press.
36@set EDITION Tenth
37
38@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39@set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44@c manuals to an info tree.
45@dircategory Software development
46@direntry
47* Gdb: (gdb).                     The GNU debugger.
48* gdbserver: (gdb) Server.        The GNU debugging server.
49@end direntry
50
51@copying
52@c man begin COPYRIGHT
53Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63this GNU Manual.  Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65@c man end
66@end copying
67
68@ifnottex
69This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75@end ifset
76Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78@insertcopying
79@end ifnottex
80
81@titlepage
82@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84@sp 1
85@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87@sp 1
88@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89@end ifset
90@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91@page
92@tex
93{\parskip=0pt
94\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97}
98@end tex
99
100@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
10251 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106@insertcopying
107@end titlepage
108@page
109
110@ifnottex
111@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120@end ifset
121Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126Fish.  Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127software in general.  We will miss him.
128
129@menu
130* Summary::                     Summary of @value{GDBN}
131* Sample Session::              A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133* Invocation::                  Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134* Commands::                    @value{GDBN} commands
135* Running::                     Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136* Stopping::                    Stopping and continuing
137* Reverse Execution::           Running programs backward
138* Process Record and Replay::   Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139* Stack::                       Examining the stack
140* Source::                      Examining source files
141* Data::                        Examining data
142* Optimized Code::              Debugging optimized code
143* Macros::                      Preprocessor Macros
144* Tracepoints::                 Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145* Overlays::                    Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147* Languages::                   Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149* Symbols::                     Examining the symbol table
150* Altering::                    Altering execution
151* GDB Files::                   @value{GDBN} files
152* Targets::                     Specifying a debugging target
153* Remote Debugging::            Debugging remote programs
154* Configurations::              Configuration-specific information
155* Controlling GDB::             Controlling @value{GDBN}
156* Extending GDB::               Extending @value{GDBN}
157* Interpreters::		Command Interpreters
158* TUI::                         @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159* Emacs::                       Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160* GDB/MI::                      @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161* Annotations::                 @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162* JIT Interface::               Using the JIT debugging interface.
163* In-Process Agent::            In-Process Agent
164
165* GDB Bugs::                    Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168* Command Line Editing: (rluserman).         Command Line Editing
169* Using History Interactively: (history).    Using History Interactively
170@end ifset
171@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172* Command Line Editing::        Command Line Editing
173* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174@end ifclear
175* In Memoriam::                 In Memoriam
176* Formatting Documentation::    How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177* Installing GDB::              Installing GDB
178* Maintenance Commands::        Maintenance Commands
179* Remote Protocol::             GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180* Agent Expressions::           The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181* Target Descriptions::         How targets can describe themselves to
182                                @value{GDBN}
183* Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184                                 the operating system
185* Trace File Format::		GDB trace file format
186* Index Section Format::        .gdb_index section format
187* Man Pages::			Manual pages
188* Copying::			GNU General Public License says
189                                how you can copy and share GDB
190* GNU Free Documentation License::  The license for this documentation
191* Concept Index::               Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192* Command and Variable Index::  Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193                                  functions, and Python data types
194@end menu
195
196@end ifnottex
197
198@contents
199
200@node Summary
201@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210@itemize @bullet
211@item
212Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214@item
215Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217@item
218Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220@item
221Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223@end itemize
224
225You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229Support for D is partial.  For information on D, see
230@ref{D,,D}.
231
232@cindex Modula-2
233Support for Modula-2 is partial.  For information on Modula-2, see
234@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236Support for OpenCL C is partial.  For information on OpenCL C, see
237@ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239@cindex Pascal
240Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241nested functions does not currently work.  @value{GDBN} does not support
242entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243syntax.
244
245@cindex Fortran
246@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248underscore.
249
250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253@menu
254* Free Software::               Freely redistributable software
255* Free Documentation::          Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256* Contributors::                Contributors to GDB
257@end menu
258
259@node Free Software
260@unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263General Public License
264(GPL).  The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273from anyone else.
274
275@node Free Documentation
276@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280include with the free software.  Many of our most important
281programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282texts.  Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283when an important free software package does not come with a free
284manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap.  We have many such
285gaps today.
286
287Consider Perl, for instance.  The tutorial manuals that people
288normally use are non-free.  How did this come about?  Because the
289authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291them from the free software world.
292
293That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294from the last.  Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297contract to make it non-free.
298
299Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300price.  The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine.  (The Free
302Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.)  The
303problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual.  Free manuals
304are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305modify.  Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308free software.  Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program.  A
316manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318community.
319
320Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321acceptable.  For example, requirements to preserve the original
322author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323authors, are ok.  It is also no problem to require modified versions
324to include notice that they were modified.  Even entire sections that
325may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326with nontechnical topics (like this one).  These kinds of restrictions
327are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328of the manual.
329
330However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332media, through all the usual channels.  Otherwise, the restrictions
333obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334manual to replace it.
335
336Please spread the word about this issue.  Our community continues to
337lose manuals to proprietary publishing.  If we spread the word that
338free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341the free software community.
342
343If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345license.  Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346don't have to let the publisher decide.  Some commercial publishers
347will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349what you want.  If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350try other publishers.  If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356improvements.  Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357at all.  Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363published by other publishers, at
364@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366@node Contributors
367@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370other @sc{gnu} programs.  Many others have contributed to its
371development.  This section attempts to credit major contributors.  One
372of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here.  The
374file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375blow-by-blow account.
376
377Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379@quotation
380@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome.  If you
381or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383@end quotation
384
385So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387releases:
388Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403Bothner and Daniel Berlin.  James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404demangler.  Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418support.
419Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439libraries.
440
441Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442about several machine instruction sets.
443
444Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445remote debugging.  Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450command-line editing and command history.
451
452Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457symbols.
458
459Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465processors.
466
467Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474watchpoints.
475
476Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni.  Kim Haase
489provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495development since 1991.  Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni.  In
501addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514Hat.
515
516Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector.  Many
517people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame.  Mark
526Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528trad unwinders.  The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534Weigand.
535
536Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors.  Others
538who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549@node Sample Session
550@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554debugger.  This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556@iftex
557In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559@end iftex
560
561@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567definition within another stop working.  In the following short @code{m4}
568session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570same thing.  However, when we change the open quote string to
571@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574@smallexample
575$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576$ @b{./m4}
577@b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579@b{foo}
5800000
581@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583@b{bar}
5840000
585@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588@b{baz}
589@b{Ctrl-d}
590m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591@end smallexample
592
593@noindent
594Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596@smallexample
597$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599@c FIXME... format to come out better.
600@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607(@value{GDBP})
608@end smallexample
609
610@noindent
611@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614that examples fit in this manual.
615
616@smallexample
617(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618@end smallexample
619
620@noindent
621We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624@code{break} command.
625
626@smallexample
627(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629@end smallexample
630
631@noindent
632Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636@smallexample
637(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639@b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641@b{foo}
6420000
643@end smallexample
644
645@noindent
646To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}.  @value{GDBN}
647suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648context where it stops.
649
650@smallexample
651@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654    at builtin.c:879
655879         if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656@end smallexample
657
658@noindent
659Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660the next line of the current function.
661
662@smallexample
663(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664882         set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666@end smallexample
667
668@noindent
669@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine.  We can go into it
670by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674@smallexample
675(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677    at input.c:530
678530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
679@end smallexample
680
681@noindent
682The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display.  It
684shows a summary of the stack.  We can use the @code{backtrace}
685command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689@smallexample
690(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691#0  set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692    at input.c:530
693#1  0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694    at builtin.c:882
695#2  0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696#3  0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697    at macro.c:71
698#4  0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699#5  0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700@end smallexample
701
702@noindent
703We step through a few more lines to see what happens.  The first two
704times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707@smallexample
708(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
7090x3b5c  532         if (rquote != def_rquote)
710(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
7110x3b80  535         lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ?  \
712def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714536         rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717538         len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718@end smallexample
719
720@noindent
721The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723and right quotes we specified.  We use the command @code{p}
724(@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726@smallexample
727(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731@end smallexample
732
733@noindent
734@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738@smallexample
739(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740533             xfree(rquote);
741534
742535         lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744536         rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746537
747538         len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748539         len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749540     @}
750541
751542     void
752@end smallexample
753
754@noindent
755Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758@smallexample
759(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760539         len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762540     @}
763(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764$3 = 9
765(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766$4 = 7
767@end smallexample
768
769@noindent
770That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772@code{rquote} respectively.  We can set them to better values using
773the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775assignments.
776
777@smallexample
778(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779$5 = 7
780(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781$6 = 9
782@end smallexample
783
784@noindent
785Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}?  We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788example that caused trouble initially:
789
790@smallexample
791(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792Continuing.
793
794@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796baz
7970000
798@end smallexample
799
800@noindent
801Success!  The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones.  The
802problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803lengths.  We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805@smallexample
806@b{Ctrl-d}
807Program exited normally.
808@end smallexample
809
810@noindent
811The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812indicates @code{m4} has finished executing.  We can end our @value{GDBN}
813session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815@smallexample
816(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817@end smallexample
818
819@node Invocation
820@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823The essentials are:
824@itemize @bullet
825@item
826type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827@item
828type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829@end itemize
830
831@menu
832* Invoking GDB::                How to start @value{GDBN}
833* Quitting GDB::                How to quit @value{GDBN}
834* Shell Commands::              How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835* Logging Output::              How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836@end menu
837
838@node Invoking GDB
839@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}.  Once started,
842@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847The command-line options described here are designed
848to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852specifying an executable program:
853
854@smallexample
855@value{GDBP} @var{program}
856@end smallexample
857
858@noindent
859You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860specified:
861
862@smallexample
863@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864@end smallexample
865
866You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867to debug a running process:
868
869@smallexample
870@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871@end smallexample
872
873@noindent
874would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump.  @value{GDBN}
881will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}.  This option stops
885option processing.
886@smallexample
887@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888@end smallexample
889This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894(or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896@smallexample
897@value{GDBP} --silent
898@end smallexample
899
900@noindent
901You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902options.  @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904@noindent
905Type
906
907@smallexample
908@value{GDBP} -help
909@end smallexample
910
911@noindent
912to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916in sequential order.  The order makes a difference when the
917@samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920@menu
921* File Options::                Choosing files
922* Mode Options::                Choosing modes
923* Startup::                     What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924@end menu
925
926@node File Options
927@subsection Choosing Files
928
929When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID).  This is
931the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively.  (@value{GDBN} reads the
933first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939to open it as a corefile.  If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945argument and ignore it.
946
947Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948following list.  @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE.  This
954@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955@c it.
956
957@table @code
958@item -symbols @var{file}
959@itemx -s @var{file}
960@cindex @code{--symbols}
961@cindex @code{-s}
962Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964@item -exec @var{file}
965@itemx -e @var{file}
966@cindex @code{--exec}
967@cindex @code{-e}
968Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971@item -se @var{file}
972@cindex @code{--se}
973Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974file.
975
976@item -core @var{file}
977@itemx -c @var{file}
978@cindex @code{--core}
979@cindex @code{-c}
980Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982@item -pid @var{number}
983@itemx -p @var{number}
984@cindex @code{--pid}
985@cindex @code{-p}
986Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988@item -command @var{file}
989@itemx -x @var{file}
990@cindex @code{--command}
991@cindex @code{-x}
992Execute commands from file @var{file}.  The contents of this file is
993evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994@xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996@item -eval-command @var{command}
997@itemx -ex @var{command}
998@cindex @code{--eval-command}
999@cindex @code{-ex}
1000Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands.  It may
1003also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005@smallexample
1006@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007   -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008@end smallexample
1009
1010@item -init-command @var{file}
1011@itemx -ix @var{file}
1012@cindex @code{--init-command}
1013@cindex @code{-ix}
1014Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015after loading gdbinit files).
1016@xref{Startup}.
1017
1018@item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019@itemx -iex @var{command}
1020@cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021@cindex @code{-iex}
1022Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023after loading gdbinit files).
1024@xref{Startup}.
1025
1026@item -directory @var{directory}
1027@itemx -d @var{directory}
1028@cindex @code{--directory}
1029@cindex @code{-d}
1030Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032@item -r
1033@itemx -readnow
1034@cindex @code{--readnow}
1035@cindex @code{-r}
1036Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040@end table
1041
1042@node Mode Options
1043@subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048@table @code
1049@anchor{-nx}
1050@item -nx
1051@itemx -n
1052@cindex @code{--nx}
1053@cindex @code{-n}
1054Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057@table @code
1058@item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059This is the system-wide init file.
1060Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063have been processed.
1064@item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065This is the init file in your home directory.
1066It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067command options have been processed.
1068@item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069This is the init file in the current directory.
1070It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071@code{-ex} have been processed.  Command line options @code{-x} and
1072@code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073@end table
1074
1075For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076For documentation on how to write command files,
1077@xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079@anchor{-nh}
1080@item -nh
1081@cindex @code{--nh}
1082Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083in your home directory.
1084@xref{Startup}.
1085
1086@item -quiet
1087@itemx -silent
1088@itemx -q
1089@cindex @code{--quiet}
1090@cindex @code{--silent}
1091@cindex @code{-q}
1092``Quiet''.  Do not print the introductory and copyright messages.  These
1093messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095@item -batch
1096@cindex @code{--batch}
1097Run in batch mode.  Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}).  Exit with
1100nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101in the command files.  Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107make this more useful, the message
1108
1109@smallexample
1110Program exited normally.
1111@end smallexample
1112
1113@noindent
1114(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116mode.
1117
1118@item -batch-silent
1119@cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently.  All
1121@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122unaffected).  This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123for an interactive session.
1124
1125This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126messages, for example.
1127
1128Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131@item -return-child-result
1132@cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136@itemize @bullet
1137@item
1138@value{GDBN} exits abnormally.  E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139internal error.  In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141@item
1142The user quits with an explicit value.  E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143@item
1144The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145the exit code will be -1.
1146@end itemize
1147
1148This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150interface.
1151
1152@item -nowindows
1153@itemx -nw
1154@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155@cindex @code{-nw}
1156``No windows''.  If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158interface.  If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160@item -windows
1161@itemx -w
1162@cindex @code{--windows}
1163@cindex @code{-w}
1164If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165used if possible.
1166
1167@item -cd @var{directory}
1168@cindex @code{--cd}
1169Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170instead of the current directory.
1171
1172@item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173@itemx -D @var{directory}
1174@cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175@cindex @code{-D}
1176Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178auxiliary files.  @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180@item -fullname
1181@itemx -f
1182@cindex @code{--fullname}
1183@cindex @code{-f}
1184@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185subprocess.  It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187displayed (which includes each time your program stops).  This
1188recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190and a newline.  The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192frame.
1193
1194@item -annotate @var{level}
1195@cindex @code{--annotate}
1196This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}.  Its
1197effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198(@pxref{Annotations}).  The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200expressions, source lines, and other types of output.  Level 0 is the
1201normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208@item --args
1209@cindex @code{--args}
1210Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212This option stops option processing.
1213
1214@item -baud @var{bps}
1215@itemx -b @var{bps}
1216@cindex @code{--baud}
1217@cindex @code{-b}
1218Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221@item -l @var{timeout}
1222@cindex @code{-l}
1223Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224for remote debugging.
1225
1226@item -tty @var{device}
1227@itemx -t @var{device}
1228@cindex @code{--tty}
1229@cindex @code{-t}
1230Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty.  Investigate.
1232
1233@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234@item -tui
1235@cindex @code{--tui}
1236Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting.  The Text User
1237Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).  Do not use this
1240option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246program or device.  This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0.  The
1253previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated.  Earlier
1255@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257@item -write
1258@cindex @code{--write}
1259Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing.  This
1260is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261(@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263@item -statistics
1264@cindex @code{--statistics}
1265This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268@item -version
1269@cindex @code{--version}
1270This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273@item -configuration
1274@cindex @code{--configuration}
1275This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276configuration parameters, and then exit.  These details can be
1277important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279@end table
1280
1281@node Startup
1282@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283@cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287@enumerate
1288@item
1289Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292@item
1293@cindex init file
1294Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297that file.
1298
1299@anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300@item
1301Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304that file.
1305
1306@anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307@item
1308Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309@samp{-ix} options in their specified order.  Usually you should use the
1310@samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312gets loaded.
1313
1314@item
1315Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317@anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318@item
1319Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321@samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322This is only done if the current directory is
1323different from your home directory.  Thus, you can have more than one
1324init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326@value{GDBN}.
1327
1328@item
1329If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332@xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335you must do something like the following:
1336
1337@smallexample
1338$ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339@end smallexample
1340
1341Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342off too late.
1343
1344@item
1345Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346@samp{-x} options in their specified order.  @xref{Command Files}, for
1347more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349@item
1350Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353@end enumerate
1354
1355Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way.  The init
1357file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359and operands.  Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365@cindex init file name
1366@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.  The Windows
1371port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372@file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376@node Quitting GDB
1377@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381@table @code
1382@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385@itemx q
1386To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}).  If you
1388do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390error code.
1391@end table
1392
1393@cindex interrupt
1394An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396returns to @value{GDBN} command level.  It is safe to type the interrupt
1397character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404@node Shell Commands
1405@section Shell Commands
1406
1407If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411@table @code
1412@kindex shell
1413@kindex !
1414@cindex shell escape
1415@item shell @var{command-string}
1416@itemx !@var{command-string}
1417Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420shell to run.  Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422@end table
1423
1424The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426@value{GDBN}:
1427
1428@table @code
1429@kindex make
1430@cindex calling make
1431@item make @var{make-args}
1432Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433arguments.  This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434@end table
1435
1436@node Logging Output
1437@section Logging Output
1438@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444@table @code
1445@kindex set logging
1446@item set logging on
1447Enable logging.
1448@item set logging off
1449Disable logging.
1450@cindex logging file name
1451@item set logging file @var{file}
1452Change the name of the current logfile.  The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453@item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile.  Set @code{overwrite} if
1455you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456@item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459@kindex show logging
1460@item show logging
1461Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462@end table
1463
1464@node Commands
1465@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}.  You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473@menu
1474* Command Syntax::              How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475* Completion::                  Command completion
1476* Help::                        How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477@end menu
1478
1479@node Command Syntax
1480@section Command Syntax
1481
1482A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input.  There is no limit on
1483how long it can be.  It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484arguments whose meaning depends on the command name.  For example, the
1485command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486step, as in @samp{step 5}.  You can also use the @code{step} command
1487with no arguments.  Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489@cindex abbreviation
1490@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491unambiguous.  Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492documentation for individual commands.  In some cases, even ambiguous
1493abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495names start with @code{s}.  You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498@cindex repeating commands
1499@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501repeat the previous command.  Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504repeat.  User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505@ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509exactly as typed.  This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}).  Since it is easy to press one
1514@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518@cindex comment
1519Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520nothing.  This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523@cindex repeating command sequences
1524@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526commands.  This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528for editing.
1529
1530@node Completion
1531@section Command Completion
1532
1533@cindex completion
1534@cindex word completion
1535@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537are for the next word in a command, at any time.  This works for @value{GDBN}
1538commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541of a word.  If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543enter it).  For example, if you type
1544
1545@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549@smallexample
1550(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551@end smallexample
1552
1553@noindent
1554@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557@smallexample
1558(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559@end smallexample
1560
1561@noindent
1562You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected.  (If you
1565were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell.  You can either supply more
1571characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word.  For
1573example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575just sounds the bell.  Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577example:
1578
1579@smallexample
1580(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582make_a_section_from_file     make_environ
1583make_abs_section             make_function_type
1584make_blockvector             make_pointer_type
1585make_cleanup                 make_reference_type
1586make_command                 make_symbol_completion_list
1587(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588@end smallexample
1589
1590@noindent
1591After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593command.
1594
1595If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice.  @kbd{M-?}
1597means @kbd{@key{META} ?}.  You can type this either by holding down a
1598key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605@smallexample
1606(@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607main
1608<... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609*** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610(@value{GDBP}) b m
1611@end smallexample
1612
1613@noindent
1614This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616@table @code
1617@kindex set max-completions
1618@item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619@itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620Set the maximum number of completion candidates.  @value{GDBN} will
1621stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624The default value is 200.  A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626completion slow.
1627@kindex show max-completions
1628@item show max-completions
1629Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630during completion.
1631@end table
1632
1633@cindex quotes in commands
1634@cindex completion of quoted strings
1635Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637its notion of a word.  To permit word completion to work in this
1638situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639@value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1642name of a C@t{++} function.  This is because C@t{++} allows function
1643overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1644by argument type).  For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1645may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1646that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1647that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.  To use the
1648word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1649@code{'} at the beginning of the function name.  This alerts
1650@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1651when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1652
1653@smallexample
1654(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1655bubble(double,double)    bubble(int,int)
1656(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1657@end smallexample
1658
1659In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1660quotes.  When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1661completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1662place:
1663
1664@smallexample
1665(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1666@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1667(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1668@end smallexample
1669
1670@noindent
1671In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1672you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1673completion on an overloaded symbol.
1674
1675For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1676Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}.  You can use the command @code{set
1677overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1678see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1679
1680@cindex completion of structure field names
1681@cindex structure field name completion
1682@cindex completion of union field names
1683@cindex union field name completion
1684When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1685structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1686confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions.  Also, it only
1687examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1688limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1689left-hand-side:
1690
1691@smallexample
1692(@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1693magic                to_fputs             to_rewind
1694to_data              to_isatty            to_write
1695to_delete            to_put               to_write_async_safe
1696to_flush             to_read
1697@end smallexample
1698
1699@noindent
1700This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1701@code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1702follows:
1703
1704@smallexample
1705struct ui_file
1706@{
1707   int *magic;
1708   ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1709   ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1710   ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1711   ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1712   ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1713   ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1714   ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1715   ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1716   ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1717   void *to_data;
1718@}
1719@end smallexample
1720
1721
1722@node Help
1723@section Getting Help
1724@cindex online documentation
1725@kindex help
1726
1727You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1728using the command @code{help}.
1729
1730@table @code
1731@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1732@item help
1733@itemx h
1734You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1735display a short list of named classes of commands:
1736
1737@smallexample
1738(@value{GDBP}) help
1739List of classes of commands:
1740
1741aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1742breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1743data -- Examining data
1744files -- Specifying and examining files
1745internals -- Maintenance commands
1746obscure -- Obscure features
1747running -- Running the program
1748stack -- Examining the stack
1749status -- Status inquiries
1750support -- Support facilities
1751tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1752               stopping the program
1753user-defined -- User-defined commands
1754
1755Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1756commands in that class.
1757Type "help" followed by command name for full
1758documentation.
1759Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1760(@value{GDBP})
1761@end smallexample
1762@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1763
1764@item help @var{class}
1765Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1766list of the individual commands in that class.  For example, here is the
1767help display for the class @code{status}:
1768
1769@smallexample
1770(@value{GDBP}) help status
1771Status inquiries.
1772
1773List of commands:
1774
1775@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1776@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1777info -- Generic command for showing things
1778        about the program being debugged
1779show -- Generic command for showing things
1780        about the debugger
1781
1782Type "help" followed by command name for full
1783documentation.
1784Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1785(@value{GDBP})
1786@end smallexample
1787
1788@item help @var{command}
1789With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1790short paragraph on how to use that command.
1791
1792@kindex apropos
1793@item apropos @var{args}
1794The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1795commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1796@var{args}.  It prints out all matches found.  For example:
1797
1798@smallexample
1799apropos alias
1800@end smallexample
1801
1802@noindent
1803results in:
1804
1805@smallexample
1806@c @group
1807alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1808aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1809d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1810del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1811delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812@c @end group
1813@end smallexample
1814
1815@kindex complete
1816@item complete @var{args}
1817The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1818for the beginning of a command.  Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1819command you want completed.  For example:
1820
1821@smallexample
1822complete i
1823@end smallexample
1824
1825@noindent results in:
1826
1827@smallexample
1828@group
1829if
1830ignore
1831info
1832inspect
1833@end group
1834@end smallexample
1835
1836@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1837@end table
1838
1839In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1840and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1841of @value{GDBN} itself.  Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1842manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context.  The listings
1843under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1844Function Index point to all the sub-commands.  @xref{Command and Variable
1845Index}.
1846
1847@c @group
1848@table @code
1849@kindex info
1850@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1851@item info
1852This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1853program.  For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1854with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1855registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1856You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1857@w{@code{help info}}.
1858
1859@kindex set
1860@item set
1861You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1862@code{set}.  For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1863@code{set prompt $}.
1864
1865@kindex show
1866@item show
1867In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1868@value{GDBN} itself.
1869You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1870related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1871system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1872which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1873
1874@kindex info set
1875To display all the settable parameters and their current
1876values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1877@code{info set}.  Both commands produce the same display.
1878@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1879@c FIXME...program.  Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1880@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1881@end table
1882@c @end group
1883
1884Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1885exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1886
1887@table @code
1888@kindex show version
1889@cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1890@item show version
1891Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running.  You should include this
1892information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports.  If multiple versions of
1893@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1894version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1895commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away.  Also, many
1896system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1897variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1898The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1899@value{GDBN}.
1900
1901@kindex show copying
1902@kindex info copying
1903@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1904@item show copying
1905@itemx info copying
1906Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1907
1908@kindex show warranty
1909@kindex info warranty
1910@item show warranty
1911@itemx info warranty
1912Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1913if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1914
1915@kindex show configuration
1916@item show configuration
1917Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1918when it was built.  This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1919@file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1920automatically by @command{configure}.  When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1921bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1922your report.
1923
1924@end table
1925
1926@node Running
1927@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1928
1929When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1930debugging information when you compile it.
1931
1932You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1933of your choice.  If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1934your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1935kill a child process.
1936
1937@menu
1938* Compilation::                 Compiling for debugging
1939* Starting::                    Starting your program
1940* Arguments::                   Your program's arguments
1941* Environment::                 Your program's environment
1942
1943* Working Directory::           Your program's working directory
1944* Input/Output::                Your program's input and output
1945* Attach::                      Debugging an already-running process
1946* Kill Process::                Killing the child process
1947
1948* Inferiors and Programs::      Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1949* Threads::                     Debugging programs with multiple threads
1950* Forks::                       Debugging forks
1951* Checkpoint/Restart::          Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1952@end menu
1953
1954@node Compilation
1955@section Compiling for Debugging
1956
1957In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1958debugging information when you compile it.  This debugging information
1959is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1960variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1961and addresses in the executable code.
1962
1963To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1964the compiler.
1965
1966Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1967optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option.  However, some
1968compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1969together.  Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1970executables containing debugging information.
1971
1972@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1973without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code.  We
1974recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1975program.  You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1976in pushing your luck.  For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1977
1978Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1979@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information.  @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1980format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1981
1982@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1983expansion (@pxref{Macros}).  Most compilers do not include information
1984about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1985the @option{-g} flag alone.  Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1986the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1987the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1988
1989@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1990gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1991information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1992
1993You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1994version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1995DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1996format in @value{GDBN}.
1997
1998@need 2000
1999@node Starting
2000@section Starting your Program
2001@cindex starting
2002@cindex running
2003
2004@table @code
2005@kindex run
2006@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2007@item run
2008@itemx r
2009Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2010You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2011@value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2012@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2013command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2014
2015@end table
2016
2017If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2018supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2019that process run your program.  In some environments without processes,
2020@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.  Other targets,
2021like @samp{remote}, are always running.  If you get an error
2022message like this one:
2023
2024@smallexample
2025The "remote" target does not support "run".
2026Try "help target" or "continue".
2027@end smallexample
2028
2029@noindent
2030then use @code{continue} to run your program.  You may need @code{load}
2031first (@pxref{load}).
2032
2033The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2034receives from its superior.  @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2035information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program.  (You
2036can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2037your program the next time you start it.)  This information may be
2038divided into four categories:
2039
2040@table @asis
2041@item The @emph{arguments.}
2042Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2043@code{run} command.  If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2044is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2045(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2046the arguments.
2047In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2048@code{SHELL} environment variable.  If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2049@value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}).  You can disable
2050use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2051below for details).
2052
2053@item The @emph{environment.}
2054Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2055use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2056environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2057your program.  @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2058
2059@item The @emph{working directory.}
2060Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}.  You can set
2061the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2062@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2063
2064@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2065Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2066standard output as @value{GDBN} is using.  You can redirect input and output
2067in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2068set a different device for your program.
2069@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2070
2071@cindex pipes
2072@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2073pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2074program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2075wrong program.
2076@end table
2077
2078When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2079immediately.  @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2080of how to arrange for your program to stop.  Once your program has
2081stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2082or @code{call} commands.  @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2083
2084If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2085time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2086table, and reads it again.  When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2087your current breakpoints.
2088
2089@table @code
2090@kindex start
2091@item start
2092@cindex run to main procedure
2093The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2094With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2095other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2096main procedure.  The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2097execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2098procedure, depending on the language used.
2099
2100The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2101breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2102the @samp{run} command.
2103
2104@cindex elaboration phase
2105Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2106executed before the main procedure is called.  This depends on the
2107languages used to write your program.  In C@t{++}, for instance,
2108constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2109@code{main} is called.  It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2110before reaching the main procedure.  However, the temporary breakpoint
2111will remain to halt execution.
2112
2113Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2114@samp{start} command.  These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2115underlying @samp{run} command.  Note that the same arguments will be
2116reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2117@samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2118
2119It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration.  In
2120these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2121your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2122elaboration phase.  Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2123elaboration code before running your program.
2124
2125@anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2126@kindex set exec-wrapper
2127@item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2128@itemx show exec-wrapper
2129@itemx unset exec-wrapper
2130When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2131launch programs for debugging.  @value{GDBN} starts your program
2132with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2133@var{program}}.  Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2134arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2135appropriate for your shell.  The wrapper runs until it executes
2136your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2137
2138You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2139its arguments as a wrapper.  Several standard Unix utilities do
2140this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}.  Any Unix shell script ending
2141with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2142
2143For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2144the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2145environment:
2146
2147@smallexample
2148(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2149(@value{GDBP}) run
2150@end smallexample
2151
2152This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2153@sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2154
2155@kindex set startup-with-shell
2156@item set startup-with-shell
2157@itemx set startup-with-shell on
2158@itemx set startup-with-shell off
2159@itemx show set startup-with-shell
2160On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2161@value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program.  Arguments of the
2162@code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2163substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2164I/O.  In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2165shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2166startup failures such as:
2167
2168@smallexample
2169(@value{GDBP}) run
2170Starting program: ./a.out
2171During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2172@end smallexample
2173
2174@noindent
2175which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2176@samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program.  Most often, this is
2177caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2178initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2179$@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2180@samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2181
2182@anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2183@kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2184@item set auto-connect-native-target
2185@itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2186@itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2187@itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2188
2189By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2190@code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2191native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine.  If you're
2192sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2193tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2194with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2195
2196If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2197connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2198connects to the native target, if one is available.
2199
2200If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2201already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2202
2203@smallexample
2204(@value{GDBP}) run
2205Don't know how to run.  Try "help target".
2206@end smallexample
2207
2208If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2209uses it with the @code{run} command.
2210
2211In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2212@code{target native} command.  For example,
2213
2214@smallexample
2215(@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2216(@value{GDBP}) run
2217Don't know how to run.  Try "help target".
2218(@value{GDBP}) target native
2219(@value{GDBP}) run
2220Starting program: ./a.out
2221[Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2222@end smallexample
2223
2224In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2225@value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2226the next @code{run} command.  Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2227disconnect.
2228
2229Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2230@code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2231proc}, @code{info os}.
2232
2233@kindex set disable-randomization
2234@item set disable-randomization
2235@itemx set disable-randomization on
2236This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2237randomization of the virtual address space of the started program.  This option
2238is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2239reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2240
2241This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2242On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2243
2244@smallexample
2245(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2246@end smallexample
2247
2248@item set disable-randomization off
2249Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged.  Some bugs rear their
2250ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses.  If your bug
2251disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2252@value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2253as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs.  Use @kbd{set
2254disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2255
2256On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2257protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks.  In these
2258cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2259code.  Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2260a code at its expected addresses.
2261
2262Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2263makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2264having just unprivileged access at the target system.  Reading the shared
2265library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2266misusing it.  Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2267random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2268startup.  Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2269a randomly chosen address.
2270
2271Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2272similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2273a randomly chosen address upon startup.  PIE executables always load even
2274already prelinked shared libraries at a random address.  You can build such
2275executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2276
2277Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2278(as long as the randomization is enabled).
2279
2280@item show disable-randomization
2281Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2282the virtual address space of the started program.
2283
2284@end table
2285
2286@node Arguments
2287@section Your Program's Arguments
2288
2289@cindex arguments (to your program)
2290The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2291@code{run} command.
2292They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2293performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program.  Your
2294@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2295@value{GDBN} uses.  If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2296the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2297
2298On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2299@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2300calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2301the program, not by the shell.
2302
2303@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2304@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2305
2306@table @code
2307@kindex set args
2308@item set args
2309Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run.  If
2310@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2311with no arguments.  Once you have run your program with arguments,
2312using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2313it again without arguments.
2314
2315@kindex show args
2316@item show args
2317Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2318@end table
2319
2320@node Environment
2321@section Your Program's Environment
2322
2323@cindex environment (of your program)
2324The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2325their values.  Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2326your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2327path for programs to run.  Usually you set up environment variables with
2328the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run.  When
2329debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2330environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2331
2332@table @code
2333@kindex path
2334@item path @var{directory}
2335Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2336(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2337The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2338You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2339system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2340MS-DOS and MS-Windows).  If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2341is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2342
2343You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2344working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path.  If you
2345use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2346@code{path} command.  @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2347@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2348@var{directory} to the search path.
2349@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2350@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2351
2352@kindex show paths
2353@item show paths
2354Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2355environment variable).
2356
2357@kindex show environment
2358@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2359Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2360your program when it starts.  If you do not supply @var{varname},
2361print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2362your program.  You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2363
2364@kindex set environment
2365@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2366Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}.  The value
2367changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2368it), not for @value{GDBN} itself.  The @var{value} may be any string; the
2369values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2370interpretation is supplied by your program itself.  The @var{value}
2371parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2372null value.
2373@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2374@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2375
2376For example, this command:
2377
2378@smallexample
2379set env USER = foo
2380@end smallexample
2381
2382@noindent
2383tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2384@samp{foo}.  (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2385are not actually required.)
2386
2387Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2388which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2389If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2390wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}.  @xref{set
2391exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2392
2393@kindex unset environment
2394@item unset environment @var{varname}
2395Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2396program.  This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2397@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2398rather than assigning it an empty value.
2399@end table
2400
2401@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2402the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2403exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not).  If your @code{SHELL} variable
2404names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2405non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2406for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2407environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2408affect your program.  You may wish to move setting of environment
2409variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2410@file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2411
2412@node Working Directory
2413@section Your Program's Working Directory
2414
2415@cindex working directory (of your program)
2416Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2417working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2418The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2419from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2420working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2421
2422The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2423that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.  @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2424Specify Files}.
2425
2426@table @code
2427@kindex cd
2428@cindex change working directory
2429@item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2430Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.  If not
2431given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2432
2433@kindex pwd
2434@item pwd
2435Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2436@end table
2437
2438It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2439the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2440during its run).  If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2441configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2442proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2443current working directory of the debuggee.
2444
2445@node Input/Output
2446@section Your Program's Input and Output
2447
2448@cindex redirection
2449@cindex i/o
2450@cindex terminal
2451By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2452the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses.  @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2453to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2454modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2455running your program.
2456
2457@table @code
2458@kindex info terminal
2459@item info terminal
2460Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2461program is using.
2462@end table
2463
2464You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2465redirection with the @code{run} command.  For example,
2466
2467@smallexample
2468run > outfile
2469@end smallexample
2470
2471@noindent
2472starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2473
2474@kindex tty
2475@cindex controlling terminal
2476Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2477with the @code{tty} command.  This command accepts a file name as
2478argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2479commands.  It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2480process, for future @code{run} commands.  For example,
2481
2482@smallexample
2483tty /dev/ttyb
2484@end smallexample
2485
2486@noindent
2487directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2488default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2489that as their controlling terminal.
2490
2491An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2492effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2493terminal.
2494
2495When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2496command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected.  The input
2497for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.  @code{tty} is an alias
2498for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2499
2500@cindex inferior tty
2501@cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2502You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2503display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2504program.
2505
2506@table @code
2507@item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2508@kindex set inferior-tty
2509Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}.  Omitting @var{tty}
2510restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2511@value{GDBN}.
2512
2513@item show inferior-tty
2514@kindex show inferior-tty
2515Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2516@end table
2517
2518@node Attach
2519@section Debugging an Already-running Process
2520@kindex attach
2521@cindex attach
2522
2523@table @code
2524@item attach @var{process-id}
2525This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2526outside @value{GDBN}.  (@code{info files} shows your active
2527targets.)  The command takes as argument a process ID.  The usual way to
2528find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2529or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2530
2531@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2532executing the command.
2533@end table
2534
2535To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2536which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2537programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system.  You must
2538also have permission to send the process a signal.
2539
2540When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2541the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2542the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2543(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}).  You can also use
2544the @code{file} command to load the program.  @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2545Specify Files}.
2546
2547The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2548process is to stop it.  You can examine and modify an attached process
2549with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2550you start processes with @code{run}.  You can insert breakpoints; you
2551can step and continue; you can modify storage.  If you would rather the
2552process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2553attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2554
2555@table @code
2556@kindex detach
2557@item detach
2558When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2559@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.  Detaching
2560the process continues its execution.  After the @code{detach} command,
2561that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2562are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2563@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2564executing the command.
2565@end table
2566
2567If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2568that process.  If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2569By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2570things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2571@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2572Messages}).
2573
2574@node Kill Process
2575@section Killing the Child Process
2576
2577@table @code
2578@kindex kill
2579@item kill
2580Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2581@end table
2582
2583This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2584running process.  @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2585is running.
2586
2587On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2588while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}.  You can use the
2589@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2590outside the debugger.
2591
2592The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2593relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2594executable file while it is running in a process.  In this case, when you
2595next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2596reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2597breakpoint settings).
2598
2599@node Inferiors and Programs
2600@section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2601
2602@value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2603session.  In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2604several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2605before starting another).  In the most general case, you can have
2606multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2607from multiple executables.
2608
2609@cindex inferior
2610@value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2611object called an @dfn{inferior}.  An inferior typically corresponds to
2612a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2613have processes.  Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2614may be retained after a process exits.  Inferiors have unique
2615identifiers that are different from process ids.  Usually each
2616inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2617embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2618of a single address space.  Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2619threads running in it.
2620
2621To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2622inferiors}}:
2623
2624@table @code
2625@kindex info inferiors
2626@item info inferiors
2627Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2628
2629@value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2630
2631@enumerate
2632@item
2633the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2634
2635@item
2636the target system's inferior identifier
2637
2638@item
2639the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2640
2641@end enumerate
2642
2643@noindent
2644An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2645indicates the current inferior.
2646
2647For example,
2648@end table
2649@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2650
2651@smallexample
2652(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2653  Num  Description       Executable
2654  2    process 2307      hello
2655* 1    process 3401      goodbye
2656@end smallexample
2657
2658To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2659
2660@table @code
2661@kindex inferior @var{infno}
2662@item inferior @var{infno}
2663Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior.  The argument
2664@var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2665in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2666@end table
2667
2668@vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2669The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2670number of the current inferior.  You may find this useful in writing
2671breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2672@xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2673information on convenience variables.
2674
2675You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2676@code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands.  On some
2677systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2678automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}.  To
2679remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2680@w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2681
2682@table @code
2683@kindex add-inferior
2684@item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2685Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2686executable; @var{n} defaults to 1.  If no executable is specified,
2687the inferiors begins empty, with no program.  You can still assign or
2688change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2689@code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2690
2691@kindex clone-inferior
2692@item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2693Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2694@var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2695number of the current inferior.  This is a convenient command when you
2696want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2697
2698@smallexample
2699(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2700  Num  Description       Executable
2701* 1    process 29964     helloworld
2702(@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2703Added inferior 2.
27041 inferiors added.
2705(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2706  Num  Description       Executable
2707  2    <null>            helloworld
2708* 1    process 29964     helloworld
2709@end smallexample
2710
2711You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2712
2713@kindex remove-inferiors
2714@item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}.  It is not
2716possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command.  For
2717those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2718
2719@end table
2720
2721To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2722inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2723inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2724using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2725
2726@table @code
2727@kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2728@item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2729Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2730inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}.  Note that the inferior's entry
2731still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2732but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2733
2734@kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2735@item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2736Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2737number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}.  Note that the inferior's entry still
2738stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2739Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2740@end table
2741
2742After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2743@code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2744a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2745@code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2746
2747
2748To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2749control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2750
2751@table @code
2752@kindex set print inferior-events
2753@cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2754@item set print inferior-events
2755@itemx set print inferior-events on
2756@itemx set print inferior-events off
2757The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2758disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2759inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2760detached.  By default, these messages will not be printed.
2761
2762@kindex show print inferior-events
2763@item show print inferior-events
2764Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2765inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2766@end table
2767
2768Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2769single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2770value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2771
2772
2773Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2774get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2775spaces in a debug session.  You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2776info program-spaces}} command.
2777
2778@table @code
2779@kindex maint info program-spaces
2780@item maint info program-spaces
2781Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2782@value{GDBN}.
2783
2784@value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2785
2786@enumerate
2787@item
2788the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2789
2790@item
2791the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2792the @code{file} command.
2793
2794@end enumerate
2795
2796@noindent
2797An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2798indicates the current program space.
2799
2800In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2801information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form.  For
2802example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2803
2804@smallexample
2805(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2806  Id   Executable
2807* 1    hello
2808  2    goodbye
2809        Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2810@end smallexample
2811
2812Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2813while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}.  On
2814some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2815same program space.  The most common example is that of debugging both
2816the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call.  For example,
2817
2818@smallexample
2819(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2820  Id   Executable
2821* 1    vfork-test
2822        Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2823@end smallexample
2824
2825Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2826space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2827@end table
2828
2829@node Threads
2830@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2831
2832@cindex threads of execution
2833@cindex multiple threads
2834@cindex switching threads
2835In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2836may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution.  The precise semantics
2837of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2838the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2839that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2840modify the same variables).  On the other hand, each thread has its own
2841registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2842
2843@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2844programs:
2845
2846@itemize @bullet
2847@item automatic notification of new threads
2848@item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2849@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2850@item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2851a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2852@item thread-specific breakpoints
2853@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2854messages on thread start and exit.
2855@item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2856the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2857isn't compatible with the program.
2858@end itemize
2859
2860@cindex focus of debugging
2861@cindex current thread
2862The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2863threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2864control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2865This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}.  Debugging commands show
2866program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2867
2868@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2869@cindex thread identifier (system)
2870@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2871@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2872@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2873Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2874the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2875form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2876whose form varies depending on the particular system.  For example, on
2877@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2878
2879@smallexample
2880[New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2881@end smallexample
2882
2883@noindent
2884when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.  In contrast, on other systems,
2885the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2886further qualifier.
2887
2888@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2889@c         thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2890@c         second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2891@c         program?
2892@c         (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always?  Or do some
2893@c         multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2894@c         threads ab initio?
2895
2896@anchor{thread numbers}
2897@cindex thread number, per inferior
2898@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2899For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2900---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior.  This
2901number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2902between threads of different inferiors.
2903
2904@cindex qualified thread ID
2905You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2906@var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2907@dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2908number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2909inferior.  For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2910inferior 2.  If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2911then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2912inferior.
2913
2914Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2915@var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2916the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2917of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2918
2919@anchor{thread ID lists}
2920@cindex thread ID lists
2921Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2922argument.  A list element can be:
2923
2924@enumerate
2925@item
2926A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2927display, with or without an inferior qualifier.  E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2928@samp{1}.
2929
2930@item
2931A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2932qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2933@var{thr1}-@var{thr2}.  E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2934
2935@item
2936All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2937without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2938@samp{1.*}) or @code{*}.  The former refers to all threads of the
2939given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2940refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2941
2942@end enumerate
2943
2944For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2945thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2946includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
29477 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7.  That is, in
2948expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
29497.1}.
2950
2951
2952@anchor{global thread numbers}
2953@cindex global thread number
2954@cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2955In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2956assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2957thread ID}, a single integer.  Unlike the thread number component of
2958the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2959you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2960
2961From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2962thread.  In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2963program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2964
2965@vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2966@vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2967The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2968@samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2969and the global thread number of the current thread.  You may find this
2970useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2971and so forth.  @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2972general information on convenience variables.
2973
2974If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2975usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2976the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2977
2978@smallexample
2979Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2980@end smallexample
2981
2982Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2983
2984@smallexample
2985Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2986@end smallexample
2987
2988@table @code
2989@kindex info threads
2990@item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2991
2992Display information about one or more threads.  With no arguments
2993displays information about all threads.  You can specify the list of
2994threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2995(@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2996
2997@value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2998
2999@enumerate
3000@item
3001the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3002
3003@item
3004the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3005option was specified
3006
3007@item
3008the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3009
3010@item
3011the thread's name, if one is known.  A thread can either be named by
3012the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3013program itself.
3014
3015@item
3016the current stack frame summary for that thread
3017@end enumerate
3018
3019@noindent
3020An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3021indicates the current thread.
3022
3023For example,
3024@end table
3025@c end table here to get a little more width for example
3026
3027@smallexample
3028(@value{GDBP}) info threads
3029  Id   Target Id         Frame
3030* 1    process 35 thread 13  main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3031  2    process 35 thread 23  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3032  3    process 35 thread 27  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3033    at threadtest.c:68
3034@end smallexample
3035
3036If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3037IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3038Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3039
3040If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3041indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3042
3043@smallexample
3044(@value{GDBP}) info threads
3045  Id   GId  Target Id             Frame
3046  1.1  1    process 35 thread 13  main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3047  1.2  3    process 35 thread 23  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3048  1.3  4    process 35 thread 27  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3049* 2.1  2    process 65 thread 1   main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3050@end smallexample
3051
3052On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3053Solaris-specific command:
3054
3055@table @code
3056@item maint info sol-threads
3057@kindex maint info sol-threads
3058@cindex thread info (Solaris)
3059Display info on Solaris user threads.
3060@end table
3061
3062@table @code
3063@kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3064@item thread @var{thread-id}
3065Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread.  The command
3066argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3067the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3068inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3069
3070@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3071thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3072
3073@smallexample
3074(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3075[Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3076#0  some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
30778	    printf ("hello\n");
3078@end smallexample
3079
3080@noindent
3081As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3082@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3083threads.
3084
3085@kindex thread apply
3086@cindex apply command to several threads
3087@item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3088The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3089@var{command} to one or more threads.  Specify the threads that you
3090want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3091lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads.  To apply a
3092command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3093@var{command}}.  To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3094type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3095
3096
3097@kindex thread name
3098@cindex name a thread
3099@item thread name [@var{name}]
3100This command assigns a name to the current thread.  If no argument is
3101given, any existing user-specified name is removed.  The thread name
3102appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3103
3104On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3105determine the name of the thread as given by the OS.  On these
3106systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3107system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3108@value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3109
3110@kindex thread find
3111@cindex search for a thread
3112@item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3113Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3114matches the supplied regular expression.
3115
3116As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3117this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3118@var{systag}.  For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3119is the LWP id.
3120
3121@smallexample
3122(@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3123Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3124(@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3125  Id   Target Id         Frame
3126  4    Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3127@end smallexample
3128
3129@kindex set print thread-events
3130@cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3131@item set print thread-events
3132@itemx set print thread-events on
3133@itemx set print thread-events off
3134The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3135disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3136started or that threads have exited.  By default, these messages will
3137be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3138Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3139
3140@kindex show print thread-events
3141@item show print thread-events
3142Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3143have started and exited.
3144@end table
3145
3146@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3147more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3148programs with multiple threads.
3149
3150@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3151watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3152
3153@anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3154@table @code
3155@kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3156@cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3157@item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3158If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3159directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3160If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3161its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3162Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3163macro.
3164
3165On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3166@code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3167inferior process.  @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3168to find @code{libthread_db}.  @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3169specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3170by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3171
3172A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3173refers to the default system directories that are
3174normally searched for loading shared libraries.  The @samp{$sdir} entry
3175is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3176(@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3177
3178A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3179refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3180was loaded in the inferior process.
3181
3182For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3183@value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3184If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3185mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3186will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3187If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3188@value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3189
3190Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3191only on some platforms.
3192
3193@kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3194@item show libthread-db-search-path
3195Display current libthread_db search path.
3196
3197@kindex set debug libthread-db
3198@kindex show debug libthread-db
3199@cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3200@item set debug libthread-db
3201@itemx show debug libthread-db
3202Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3203Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3204@end table
3205
3206@node Forks
3207@section Debugging Forks
3208
3209@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3210@cindex multiple processes
3211@cindex processes, multiple
3212On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3213programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3214function.  When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3215parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.  If you have
3216set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3217will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3218will cause it to terminate.
3219
3220However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3221which isn't too painful.  Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3222the child process executes after the fork.  It may be useful to sleep
3223only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3224so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3225on the child.  While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3226get its process ID.  Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3227@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3228the child process (@pxref{Attach}).  From that point on you can debug
3229the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3230
3231On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3232that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3233functions.  On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3234with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3235
3236The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3237connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3238@code{target extended-remote} mode.
3239
3240By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3241the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3242
3243If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3244use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3245
3246@table @code
3247@kindex set follow-fork-mode
3248@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3249Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3250@code{vfork}.  A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3251process.  The @var{mode} argument can be:
3252
3253@table @code
3254@item parent
3255The original process is debugged after a fork.  The child process runs
3256unimpeded.  This is the default.
3257
3258@item child
3259The new process is debugged after a fork.  The parent process runs
3260unimpeded.
3261
3262@end table
3263
3264@kindex show follow-fork-mode
3265@item show follow-fork-mode
3266Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3267@end table
3268
3269@cindex debugging multiple processes
3270On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3271command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3272
3273@table @code
3274@kindex set detach-on-fork
3275@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3276Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3277retain debugger control over them both.
3278
3279@table @code
3280@item on
3281The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3282@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3283independently.  This is the default.
3284
3285@item off
3286Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3287One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3288@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3289is held suspended.
3290
3291@end table
3292
3293@kindex show detach-on-fork
3294@item show detach-on-fork
3295Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3296@end table
3297
3298If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3299will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3300You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3301using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3302to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3303Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3304
3305To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3306from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3307to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3308command.  @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3309and Programs}.
3310
3311If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3312@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3313breakpoint in the new target.  If you have a breakpoint set on
3314@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3315the child process's @code{main}.
3316
3317On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3318cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3319
3320If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3321call executes, the new target restarts.  To restart the parent
3322process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3323as its argument.  By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3324@value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3325You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3326command.
3327
3328@table @code
3329@kindex set follow-exec-mode
3330@item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3331
3332Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}.  An
3333@code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3334
3335@code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3336
3337@table @code
3338@item new
3339@value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3340new inferior.  The program the process was running before the
3341@code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3342original inferior.
3343
3344For example:
3345
3346@smallexample
3347(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3348(gdb) info inferior
3349  Id   Description   Executable
3350* 1    <null>        prog1
3351(@value{GDBP}) run
3352process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3353Program exited normally.
3354(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3355  Id   Description   Executable
3356  1    <null>        prog1
3357* 2    <null>        prog2
3358@end smallexample
3359
3360@item same
3361@value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior.  The new
3362executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3363inferior.  Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3364e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3365running after the @code{exec} call.  This is the default mode.
3366
3367For example:
3368
3369@smallexample
3370(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3371  Id   Description   Executable
3372* 1    <null>        prog1
3373(@value{GDBP}) run
3374process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3375Program exited normally.
3376(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3377  Id   Description   Executable
3378* 1    <null>        prog2
3379@end smallexample
3380
3381@end table
3382@end table
3383
3384@code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3385@code{target extended-remote} mode.
3386
3387You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3388a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made.  @xref{Set
3389Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3390
3391@node Checkpoint/Restart
3392@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3393
3394@cindex checkpoint
3395@cindex restart
3396@cindex bookmark
3397@cindex snapshot of a process
3398@cindex rewind program state
3399
3400On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3401@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3402program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3403later.
3404
3405Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3406happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved.  This
3407includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3408system state.  Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3409moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3410
3411Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3412getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3413a checkpoint.  Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3414the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3415from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3416start again from there.
3417
3418This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3419steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3420
3421To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3422
3423@table @code
3424@kindex checkpoint
3425@item checkpoint
3426Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3427The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3428is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3429
3430@kindex info checkpoints
3431@item info checkpoints
3432List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3433session.  For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3434listed:
3435
3436@table @code
3437@item Checkpoint ID
3438@item Process ID
3439@item Code Address
3440@item Source line, or label
3441@end table
3442
3443@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3444@item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3445Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3446@var{checkpoint-id}.  All program variables, registers, stack frames
3447etc.@:  will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3448was saved.  In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3449in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3450
3451Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3452are not affected by restoring a checkpoint.  In general, a checkpoint
3453only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3454the debugger.
3455
3456@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3457@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3458Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3459
3460@end table
3461
3462Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3463of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3464(OS) state, including file pointers.  It won't ``un-write'' data from
3465a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3466so that the previously written data can be overwritten.  For files
3467opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3468previously read data can be read again.
3469
3470Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3471external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3472from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3473but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3474be received again.  Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3475been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3476
3477However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3478program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3479again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3480different execution path this time.
3481
3482@cindex checkpoints and process id
3483Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3484different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3485id.  Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3486and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3487If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3488potentially pose a problem.
3489
3490@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3491
3492On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3493is performed on new processes for security reasons.  This makes it
3494difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3495absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3496absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3497next.
3498
3499A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3500Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3501and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3502process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3503your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3504
3505@node Stopping
3506@chapter Stopping and Continuing
3507
3508The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3509program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3510trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3511
3512Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3513such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3514@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}.  You may then examine and
3515change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3516continue execution.  Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3517ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3518explicitly request this information at any time.
3519
3520@table @code
3521@kindex info program
3522@item info program
3523Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3524running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3525@end table
3526
3527@menu
3528* Breakpoints::                 Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3529* Continuing and Stepping::     Resuming execution
3530* Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3531                                Skipping over functions and files
3532* Signals::                     Signals
3533* Thread Stops::                Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3534@end menu
3535
3536@node Breakpoints
3537@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3538
3539@cindex breakpoints
3540A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3541the program is reached.  For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3542control in finer detail whether your program stops.  You can set
3543breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3544Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3545should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3546program.
3547
3548On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3549the executable is run.
3550
3551@cindex watchpoints
3552@cindex data breakpoints
3553@cindex memory tracing
3554@cindex breakpoint on memory address
3555@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3556A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3557when the value of an expression changes.  The expression may be a value
3558of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3559combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}.  This is sometimes called
3560@dfn{data breakpoints}.  You must use a different command to set
3561watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3562from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3563enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3564same commands.
3565
3566You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3567whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint.  @xref{Auto Display,,
3568Automatic Display}.
3569
3570@cindex catchpoints
3571@cindex breakpoint on events
3572A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3573when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3574exception or the loading of a library.  As with watchpoints, you use a
3575different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3576Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3577other breakpoint.  (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3578@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3579
3580@cindex breakpoint numbers
3581@cindex numbers for breakpoints
3582@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3583catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3584starting with one.  In many of the commands for controlling various
3585features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3586breakpoint you want to change.  Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3587@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3588enable it again.
3589
3590@cindex breakpoint ranges
3591@cindex breakpoint lists
3592@cindex ranges of breakpoints
3593@cindex lists of breakpoints
3594Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3595on which to operate.  A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3596like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3597When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3598are operated on.
3599
3600@menu
3601* Set Breaks::                  Setting breakpoints
3602* Set Watchpoints::             Setting watchpoints
3603* Set Catchpoints::             Setting catchpoints
3604* Delete Breaks::               Deleting breakpoints
3605* Disabling::                   Disabling breakpoints
3606* Conditions::                  Break conditions
3607* Break Commands::              Breakpoint command lists
3608* Dynamic Printf::              Dynamic printf
3609* Save Breakpoints::            How to save breakpoints in a file
3610* Static Probe Points::         Listing static probe points
3611* Error in Breakpoints::        ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3612* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3613@end menu
3614
3615@node Set Breaks
3616@subsection Setting Breakpoints
3617
3618@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3619@c       consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3620@c
3621@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3622
3623@kindex break
3624@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3625@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3626@cindex latest breakpoint
3627Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3628@code{b}).  The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3629number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3630Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3631convenience variables.
3632
3633@table @code
3634@item break @var{location}
3635Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3636function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3637(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3638specify a @var{location}.)  The breakpoint will stop your program just
3639before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3640
3641When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3642C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3643@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3644that situation.
3645
3646It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3647only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3648or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3649
3650@item break
3651When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3652the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3653(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}).  In any selected frame but the
3654innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3655returns to that frame.  This is similar to the effect of a
3656@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3657that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint.  If you use
3658@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3659the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3660inside loops.
3661
3662@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3663least one instruction has been executed.  If it did not do this, you
3664would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3665breakpoint.  This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3666existed when your program stopped.
3667
3668@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3669Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3670@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3671value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3672@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3673above (or no argument) specifying where to break.  @xref{Conditions,
3674,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3675
3676@kindex tbreak
3677@item tbreak @var{args}
3678Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop.  The @var{args} are the
3679same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3680way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3681program stops there.  @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3682
3683@kindex hbreak
3684@cindex hardware breakpoints
3685@item hbreak @var{args}
3686Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint.  The @var{args} are the same as for the
3687@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3688breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3689have this support.  The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3690debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3691changing the instruction.  This can be used with the new trap-generation
3692provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets.  These targets
3693will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3694address that is assigned to the debug registers.  However the hardware
3695breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints.  For
3696example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3697@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used.  Delete
3698or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3699(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3700@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3701For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3702breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3703hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3704
3705@kindex thbreak
3706@item thbreak @var{args}
3707Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop.  The @var{args}
3708are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3709the same way.  However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3710the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3711first time your program stops there.  Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3712command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3713may not have this support.  @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3714See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3715
3716@kindex rbreak
3717@cindex regular expression
3718@cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3719@cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3720@item rbreak @var{regex}
3721Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3722@var{regex}.  This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3723matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set.  Once these
3724breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3725the @code{break} command.  You can delete them, disable them, or make
3726them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3727
3728The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3729like @file{grep}.  Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3730shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3731an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s.  There is an implicit
3732@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3733match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3734
3735@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3736When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3737breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3738classes.
3739
3740@cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3741The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3742@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3743
3744@smallexample
3745(@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3746@end smallexample
3747
3748@item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3749If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3750the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3751specified @var{file}.  This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3752every function in a given file:
3753
3754@smallexample
3755(@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3756@end smallexample
3757
3758The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3759optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3760
3761@kindex info breakpoints
3762@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3763@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3764@itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3765Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3766not deleted.  Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3767about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3768For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3769
3770@table @emph
3771@item Breakpoint Numbers
3772@item Type
3773Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3774@item Disposition
3775Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3776@item Enabled or Disabled
3777Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}.  @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3778that are not enabled.
3779@item Address
3780Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.  For a
3781pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3782contain @samp{<PENDING>}.  Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3783library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3784See below for details.  A breakpoint with several locations will
3785have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3786@item What
3787Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3788line number.  For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3789the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3790the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3791@end table
3792
3793@noindent
3794If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3795``target''.  If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3796@value{GDBN} on the host's side.  If it is ``target'', then the condition
3797is evaluated by the target.  The @code{info break} command shows
3798the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3799its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3800
3801Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that.  A pending breakpoint is
3802allowed to have a condition specified for it.  The condition is not parsed for
3803validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3804breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3805
3806@noindent
3807@code{info break} with a breakpoint
3808number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint.  The
3809convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3810the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3811listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3812
3813@noindent
3814@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3815has been hit.  This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3816@code{ignore} command.  You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3817hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3818was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number.  This
3819will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3820
3821@noindent
3822For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3823@code{info break} also displays that count.
3824
3825@end table
3826
3827@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3828your program.  There is nothing silly or meaningless about this.  When
3829the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3830(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3831
3832@cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3833@cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3834It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3835in your program.  Examples of this situation are:
3836
3837@itemize @bullet
3838@item
3839Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3840
3841@item
3842For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3843instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3844
3845@item
3846For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3847correspond to any number of instantiations.
3848
3849@item
3850For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3851several places where that function is inlined.
3852@end itemize
3853
3854In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3855the relevant locations.
3856
3857A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3858table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3859each breakpoint location.  The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3860address column.  The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3861addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3862locations belong.  The number column for a location is of the form
3863@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3864
3865For example:
3866
3867@smallexample
3868Num     Type           Disp Enb  Address    What
38691       breakpoint     keep y    <MULTIPLE>
3870        stop only if i==1
3871        breakpoint already hit 1 time
38721.1                         y    0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
38731.2                         y    0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3874@end smallexample
3875
3876Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3877@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3878@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands.  Note that you cannot
3879delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3880entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3881the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3882the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example).  Disabling or enabling
3883the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3884that belong to that breakpoint.
3885
3886@cindex pending breakpoints
3887It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3888Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3889and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed.  To support
3890this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3891any shared library is loaded or unloaded.  Typically, you would
3892set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3893debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3894symbols from the library are not available.  When you try to set
3895breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3896a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3897is not yet resolved.
3898
3899After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3900@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints.  When a newly loaded
3901shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3902pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3903ordinary breakpoint.  When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3904that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3905
3906This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too.  For
3907example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3908a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3909a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3910
3911Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3912differ from regular breakpoints.  You can set conditions or commands,
3913enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3914
3915@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3916happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3917address specification to an address:
3918
3919@kindex set breakpoint pending
3920@kindex show breakpoint pending
3921@table @code
3922@item set breakpoint pending auto
3923This is the default behavior.  When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3924location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3925
3926@item set breakpoint pending on
3927This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3928result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3929
3930@item set breakpoint pending off
3931This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created.  Any
3932unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error.  This setting does
3933not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3934
3935@item show breakpoint pending
3936Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3937@end table
3938
3939The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3940variants.  Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3941as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3942
3943@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3944For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3945software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3946breakpoint address is read-only or read-write.  This applies to
3947breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3948breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}.  For
3949breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3950breakpoints.
3951
3952You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
3953
3954@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3955@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3956@table @code
3957@item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3958This is the default behavior.  When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3959will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3960breakpoint must be used.
3961
3962@item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3963This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3964type.  If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3965trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3966@end table
3967
3968@value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3969at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3970executed, given control to the debugger.  By default, the program
3971code is so modified only when the program is resumed.  As soon as
3972the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions.  This
3973behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3974target should gdb abrubptly disconnect.  However, with slow remote
3975targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3976This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3977
3978@kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3979@kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3980@table @code
3981@item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3982All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3983the target only when the target is resumed.  All breakpoints are
3984removed from the target when it stops.  This is the default mode.
3985
3986@item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3987Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times.  If
3988the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3989breakpoints in the target are updated immediately.  A breakpoint is
3990removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3991@end table
3992
3993@value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3994when a breakpoint breaks.  If the condition is true, then the process being
3995debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3996
3997If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3998download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3999
4000This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4001
4002@kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4003@kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4004@table @code
4005@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4006This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4007conditions on the host's side.  Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4008the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4009for condition evaluation.  This is the standard evaluation mode.
4010
4011@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4012This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4013to the target at the moment of their insertion.  The target
4014is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4015breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4016is true.  Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4017cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4018that is only known to the host.  Examples include
4019conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4020that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4021that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4022target is a remote system.  In these cases, the conditions will be
4023evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4024
4025@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4026This is the default mode.  If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4027conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4028the target (limitations mentioned previously apply).  If the target does
4029not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4030to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4031@end table
4032
4033
4034@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4035@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4036@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4037special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4038programs).  These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4039starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4040You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4041@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4042
4043
4044@node Set Watchpoints
4045@subsection Setting Watchpoints
4046
4047@cindex setting watchpoints
4048You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4049expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4050this may happen.  (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4051The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4052as complex as many variables combined by operators.  Examples include:
4053
4054@itemize @bullet
4055@item
4056A reference to the value of a single variable.
4057
4058@item
4059An address cast to an appropriate data type.  For example,
4060@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4061address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4062
4063@item
4064An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}.  The
4065expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4066language (@pxref{Languages}).
4067@end itemize
4068
4069You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4070not be evaluated yet.  For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4071@samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4072@value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4073the expression produces a valid value.  If the expression becomes
4074valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4075pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4076@code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4077the expression changes.
4078
4079@cindex software watchpoints
4080@cindex hardware watchpoints
4081Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4082hardware.  @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4083program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4084times slower than normal execution.  (But this may still be worth it, to
4085catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4086culprit.)
4087
4088On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4089@value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4090slow down the running of your program.
4091
4092@table @code
4093@kindex watch
4094@item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4095Set a watchpoint for an expression.  @value{GDBN} will break when the
4096expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4097changes.  The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4098to watch the value of a single variable:
4099
4100@smallexample
4101(@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4102@end smallexample
4103
4104If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4105argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4106@var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}.  If any other threads
4107change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break.  Note
4108that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4109with Hardware Watchpoints.
4110
4111Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4112(see below).  The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4113instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}.  In this case,
4114@value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4115and watch the memory at that address.  The type of the result is used
4116to determine the size of the watched memory.  If the expression's
4117result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4118error.
4119
4120The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4121of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4122feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4123Embedded}.)  A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4124to an address to watch.  The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4125(the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4126the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4127Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4128addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4129watchpoint address.  The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4130Examples:
4131
4132@smallexample
4133(@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4134(@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4135@end smallexample
4136
4137@kindex rwatch
4138@item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4139Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4140by the program.
4141
4142@kindex awatch
4143@item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4144Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4145or written into by the program.
4146
4147@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4148@item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4149This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4150@code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4151@end table
4152
4153If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4154dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4155never change.  @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4156a never-changing value:
4157
4158@smallexample
4159(@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4160Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4161(@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4162Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4163@end smallexample
4164
4165@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible.  Hardware
4166watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4167value at the exact instruction where the change occurs.  If @value{GDBN}
4168cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4169executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4170@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4171
4172@cindex use only software watchpoints
4173You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4174@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command.  With this variable set to
4175zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4176the underlying system supports them.  (Note that hardware-assisted
4177watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4178@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4179mechanism of watching expression values.)
4180
4181@table @code
4182@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4183@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4184Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4185
4186@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4187@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4188Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4189@end table
4190
4191For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4192watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4193hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4194
4195When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4196
4197@smallexample
4198Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4199@end smallexample
4200
4201@noindent
4202if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4203
4204Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4205hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4206value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4207every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4208that currently.  If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4209hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4210will print a message like this:
4211
4212@smallexample
4213Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4214@end smallexample
4215
4216Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4217data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4218watchpoint on the target machine can handle.  For example, some systems
4219can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4220cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4221double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4222wide).  As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4223into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4224
4225If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4226to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4227Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4228time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4229able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4230warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4231
4232@smallexample
4233Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4234@end smallexample
4235
4236@noindent
4237If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4238
4239Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4240exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4241That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4242expression with separately allocated resources.
4243
4244If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4245any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4246kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4247
4248@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4249(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4250they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4251which these variables were defined.  In particular, when the program
4252being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4253and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set.  If you
4254rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again.  One
4255way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4256@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4257
4258@cindex watchpoints and threads
4259@cindex threads and watchpoints
4260In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4261watched expression from every thread.
4262
4263@quotation
4264@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4265have only limited usefulness.  If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4266watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4267single thread}.  If you are confident that the expression can only
4268change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4269confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4270software watchpoints as usual.  However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4271when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression.  (Hardware
4272watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4273@end quotation
4274
4275@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4276
4277@node Set Catchpoints
4278@subsection Setting Catchpoints
4279@cindex catchpoints, setting
4280@cindex exception handlers
4281@cindex event handling
4282
4283You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4284kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4285shared library.  Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4286
4287@table @code
4288@kindex catch
4289@item catch @var{event}
4290Stop when @var{event} occurs.  The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4291
4292@table @code
4293@item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4294@itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4295@itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4296@kindex catch throw
4297@kindex catch rethrow
4298@kindex catch catch
4299@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4300The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4301
4302If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4303regular expression will be caught.
4304
4305@vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4306The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4307exception-related catchpoint, on some systems.  This holds the
4308exception being thrown.
4309
4310There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4311@value{GDBN}:
4312
4313@itemize @bullet
4314@item
4315The support for these commands is system-dependent.  Currently, only
4316systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4317supported.
4318
4319@item
4320The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4321variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4322If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4323These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4324or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4325built.
4326
4327@item
4328The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4329instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4330
4331@item
4332When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4333location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4334support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}.  You can use @code{up}
4335(@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4336
4337@item
4338If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4339control to you when the function has finished executing.  If the call
4340raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4341returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4342simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4343that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits.  This is the case even if
4344you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4345disabled within interactive calls.  @xref{Calling}, for information on
4346controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4347
4348@item
4349You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4350
4351@item
4352You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4353@end itemize
4354
4355@item exception
4356@kindex catch exception
4357@cindex Ada exception catching
4358@cindex catch Ada exceptions
4359An Ada exception being raised.  If an exception name is specified
4360at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4361the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4362Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4363
4364When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4365name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4366fully qualified name must be used as the exception name.  Otherwise,
4367@value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4368rather than the user-defined one.  For instance, assuming an exception
4369called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4370the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4371Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4372
4373@item exception unhandled
4374@kindex catch exception unhandled
4375An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4376
4377@item assert
4378@kindex catch assert
4379A failed Ada assertion.
4380
4381@item exec
4382@kindex catch exec
4383@cindex break on fork/exec
4384A call to @code{exec}.
4385
4386@item syscall
4387@itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4388@kindex catch syscall
4389@cindex break on a system call.
4390A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}.  A
4391syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4392from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4393@value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4394debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall.  If no
4395argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4396will be caught.
4397
4398@var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4399underlying OS.  Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS.  On
4400GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4401names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4402
4403@c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4404@c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4405@c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4406@c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4407
4408Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4409each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4410facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4411available choices.
4412
4413You may also specify the system call numerically.  A syscall's
4414number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4415identify the requested service.  When you specify the syscall by its
4416name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4417into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4418may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4419list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4420behind the OS upgrades).
4421
4422You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4423the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent).  For
4424instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4425network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4426to @code{catch syscall}.  Note that not all syscall groups are
4427available in every system.  You can use the command completion
4428facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4429syscall groups available on your environment.
4430
4431The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4432arguments to it:
4433
4434@smallexample
4435(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4436Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4437(@value{GDBP}) r
4438Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4439
4440Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4441	   0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4442(@value{GDBP}) c
4443Continuing.
4444
4445Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4446	0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4447(@value{GDBP})
4448@end smallexample
4449
4450Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4451
4452@smallexample
4453(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4454Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4455(@value{GDBP}) r
4456Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4457
4458Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4459		   0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4460(@value{GDBP}) c
4461Continuing.
4462
4463Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4464	0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4465(@value{GDBP})
4466@end smallexample
4467
4468An example of specifying a system call numerically.  In the case
4469below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4470file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4471
4472@smallexample
4473(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4474Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4475(@value{GDBP}) r
4476Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4477
4478Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4479		   0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4480(@value{GDBP}) c
4481Continuing.
4482
4483Program exited normally.
4484(@value{GDBP})
4485@end smallexample
4486
4487Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4488
4489@smallexample
4490(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4491Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4492'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4493'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4494(@value{GDBP}) r
4495Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4496
4497Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4498   from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4499
4500(@value{GDBP}) c
4501Continuing.
4502@end smallexample
4503
4504However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4505in XML file for that syscall number.  In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4506a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4507but the catchpoint will be set anyway.  See the example below:
4508
4509@smallexample
4510(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4511warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4512Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4513(@value{GDBP})
4514@end smallexample
4515
4516If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4517it will not be able to display syscall names.  Also, if your
4518architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4519you will not be able to see the syscall names.  It is important to
4520notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4521name database.  In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4522
4523@smallexample
4524(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4525warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4526warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4527GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4528Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4529(@value{GDBP})
4530@end smallexample
4531
4532Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4533
4534Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4535number.  In this case, you would see something like:
4536
4537@smallexample
4538(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4539Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4540@end smallexample
4541
4542Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4543
4544@item fork
4545@kindex catch fork
4546A call to @code{fork}.
4547
4548@item vfork
4549@kindex catch vfork
4550A call to @code{vfork}.
4551
4552@item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4553@itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4554@kindex catch load
4555@kindex catch unload
4556The loading or unloading of a shared library.  If @var{regexp} is
4557given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4558matches one of the affected libraries.
4559
4560@item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4561@kindex catch signal
4562The delivery of a signal.
4563
4564With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4565used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4566@samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4567
4568With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4569@value{GDBN}, will be caught.  This argument cannot be used with other
4570signal names.
4571
4572Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4573@code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}).  Only signals specified in this list
4574will be caught.
4575
4576One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4577@code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4578catchpoint.
4579
4580When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4581@code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4582However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4583on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4584commands.
4585
4586@end table
4587
4588@item tcatch @var{event}
4589@kindex tcatch
4590Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop.  The catchpoint is
4591automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4592
4593@end table
4594
4595Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4596
4597
4598@node Delete Breaks
4599@subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4600
4601@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4602@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4603It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4604catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4605to stop there.  This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint.  A
4606breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4607
4608With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4609where they are in your program.  With the @code{delete} command you can
4610delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4611their breakpoint numbers.
4612
4613It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it.  @value{GDBN}
4614automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4615when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4616
4617@table @code
4618@kindex clear
4619@item clear
4620Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4621selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}).  When
4622the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4623breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4624
4625@item clear @var{location}
4626Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4627@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4628most useful ones are listed below:
4629
4630@table @code
4631@item clear @var{function}
4632@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4633Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4634
4635@item clear @var{linenum}
4636@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4637Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4638@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4639@end table
4640
4641@cindex delete breakpoints
4642@kindex delete
4643@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4644@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4645Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4646list specified as argument.  If no argument is specified, delete all
4647breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4648confirm off}).  You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4649@end table
4650
4651@node Disabling
4652@subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4653
4654@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4655Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4656prefer to @dfn{disable} it.  This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4657it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4658that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4659
4660You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4661the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4662one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments.  Use @code{info break} to
4663print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4664do not know which numbers to use.
4665
4666Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4667affects all of its locations.
4668
4669A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4670different states of enablement:
4671
4672@itemize @bullet
4673@item
4674Enabled.  The breakpoint stops your program.  A breakpoint set
4675with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4676@item
4677Disabled.  The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4678@item
4679Enabled once.  The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4680disabled.
4681@item
4682Enabled for a count.  The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4683N times, then becomes disabled.
4684@item
4685Enabled for deletion.  The breakpoint stops your program, but
4686immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently.  A breakpoint
4687set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4688@end itemize
4689
4690You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4691watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4692
4693@table @code
4694@kindex disable
4695@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4696@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4697Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4698listed.  A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten.  All
4699options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4700case the breakpoint is enabled again later.  You may abbreviate
4701@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4702
4703@kindex enable
4704@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4705Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints).  They
4706become effective once again in stopping your program.
4707
4708@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4709Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily.  @value{GDBN} disables any
4710of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4711
4712@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4713Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily.  @value{GDBN} records
4714@var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4715breakpoint's count when it is hit.  When any count reaches 0,
4716@value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint.  If a breakpoint has an ignore
4717count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4718decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4719
4720@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4721Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die.  @value{GDBN}
4722deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4723Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4724@end table
4725
4726@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4727@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4728Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4729,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4730subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4731the commands above.  (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4732breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4733breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4734Stepping}.)
4735
4736@node Conditions
4737@subsection Break Conditions
4738@cindex conditional breakpoints
4739@cindex breakpoint conditions
4740
4741@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr?  Context where wanted?
4742@c      in particular for a watchpoint?
4743The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4744specified place.  You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4745breakpoint.  A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4746programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  A breakpoint with
4747a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4748and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4749
4750This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4751situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4752when the condition is false.  In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4753by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4754@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4755
4756Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4757since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4758it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4759and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4760one.
4761
4762Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4763your program.  This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4764that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4765format special data structures.  The effects are completely predictable
4766unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address.  (In
4767that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4768program without checking the condition of this one.)  Note that
4769breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4770conditions for the
4771purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4772(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4773
4774Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4775the target supports it.  Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4776@value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4777(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4778independently of @value{GDBN}.  Global variables become raw memory
4779locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4780
4781In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4782when its condition evaluates to true.  This mechanism may provide faster
4783response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4784since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4785every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4786
4787Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4788@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command.  @xref{Set
4789Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.  They can also be changed at any time
4790with the @code{condition} command.
4791
4792You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4793The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4794@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4795catchpoint.
4796
4797@table @code
4798@kindex condition
4799@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4800Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4801watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}.  After you set a condition,
4802breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4803@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C).  When you use
4804@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4805syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4806referents in the context of your breakpoint.  If @var{expression} uses
4807symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4808prints an error message:
4809
4810@smallexample
4811No symbol "foo" in current context.
4812@end smallexample
4813
4814@noindent
4815@value{GDBN} does
4816not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4817command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4818@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4819
4820@item condition @var{bnum}
4821Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}.  It becomes
4822an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4823@end table
4824
4825@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4826A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4827breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times.  This is so
4828useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4829count} of the breakpoint.  Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4830is an integer.  Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4831therefore has no effect.  But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4832ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4833the ignore count by one and continues.  As a result, if the ignore count
4834value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4835your program reaches it.
4836
4837@table @code
4838@kindex ignore
4839@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4840Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4841The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4842execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4843takes no action.
4844
4845To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4846a count of zero.
4847
4848When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4849breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4850@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}.  @xref{Continuing and
4851Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4852
4853If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4854condition is not checked.  Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4855@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4856
4857You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4858as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4859is decremented each time.  @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4860Variables}.
4861@end table
4862
4863Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4864
4865
4866@node Break Commands
4867@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4868
4869@cindex breakpoint commands
4870You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4871commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint.  For
4872example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4873enable other breakpoints.
4874
4875@table @code
4876@kindex commands
4877@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4878@item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4879@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4880@itemx end
4881Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints.  The commands
4882themselves appear on the following lines.  Type a line containing just
4883@code{end} to terminate the commands.
4884
4885To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4886follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4887
4888With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4889watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4890encountered).  If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4891command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4892set by that command.  This applies to breakpoints set by
4893@code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4894creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4895Expressions}).
4896@end table
4897
4898Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4899disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4900
4901You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again.  Simply
4902use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4903that resumes execution.
4904
4905Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4906execution, are ignored.  This is because any time you resume execution
4907(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4908another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4909ambiguities about which list to execute.
4910
4911@kindex silent
4912If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4913usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed.  This may
4914be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4915then continue.  If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4916see no sign that the breakpoint was reached.  @code{silent} is
4917meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4918
4919The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4920print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4921breakpoints.  @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4922
4923For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4924value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4925
4926@smallexample
4927break foo if x>0
4928commands
4929silent
4930printf "x is %d\n",x
4931cont
4932end
4933@end smallexample
4934
4935One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4936you can test for another.  Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4937of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4938erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4939to any variables that need them.  End with the @code{continue} command
4940so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4941command so that no output is produced.  Here is an example:
4942
4943@smallexample
4944break 403
4945commands
4946silent
4947set x = y + 4
4948cont
4949end
4950@end smallexample
4951
4952@node Dynamic Printf
4953@subsection Dynamic Printf
4954
4955@cindex dynamic printf
4956@cindex dprintf
4957The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4958formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4959inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4960having to recompile it.
4961
4962In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console.  However,
4963you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4964For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4965program's @code{printf} function.  This has the advantage that the
4966characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4967redirects to files and so forth.
4968
4969If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4970ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent.  In addition to
4971ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4972with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4973the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4974target.  Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4975everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4976
4977@table @code
4978@kindex dprintf
4979@item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4980Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4981more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4982To print several values, separate them with commas.
4983
4984@item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4985Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4986styles enumerated below.  A change of style affects all existing
4987dynamic printfs immediately.  (If you need individual control over the
4988print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4989explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4990
4991@table @code
4992@item gdb
4993@kindex dprintf-style gdb
4994Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4995
4996@item call
4997@kindex dprintf-style call
4998Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4999@code{printf}).
5000
5001@item agent
5002@kindex dprintf-style agent
5003Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5004the output itself.  This style is only available for agents that
5005support running commands on the target.
5006@end table
5007
5008@item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5009Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}.  By
5010default its value is @code{printf}.  You may set it to any expression.
5011that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5012command.
5013
5014@item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5015Set a ``channel'' for dprintf.  If set to a non-empty value,
5016@value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5017a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5018@code{fprintf} and similar functions.  Otherwise, the dprintf format
5019string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5020
5021As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5022that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5023you could do the following:
5024
5025@example
5026(gdb) set dprintf-style call
5027(gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5028(gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5029(gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5030Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5031(gdb) info break
50321       dprintf        keep y   0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5033        call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5034        continue
5035(gdb)
5036@end example
5037
5038Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5039as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5040the variable settings.
5041
5042@item set disconnected-dprintf on
5043@itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5044@kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5045Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5046@value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target.  This only applies
5047if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5048
5049@item show disconnected-dprintf off
5050@kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5051Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5052
5053@end table
5054
5055@value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5056relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5057in which they are being used.  For instance, the function and channel
5058may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5059all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5060those locals.  If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5061
5062@node Save Breakpoints
5063@subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5064
5065To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5066breakpoints}} command.
5067
5068@table @code
5069@kindex save breakpoints
5070@cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5071@item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5072This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5073their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5074suitable for use in a later debugging session.  This includes all
5075types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5076tracepoints).  To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5077@code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}).  Note that watchpoints
5078with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5079because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5080watchpoint is valid anymore.  Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5081are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5082breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5083and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5084that can no longer be recreated.
5085@end table
5086
5087@node Static Probe Points
5088@subsection Static Probe Points
5089
5090@cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5091@cindex static probe point, DTrace
5092@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code.  @acronym{SDT} stands
5093for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5094runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5095
5096Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5097ELF-compatible systems:
5098
5099@itemize @bullet
5100
5101@item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5102@acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5103@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5104for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5105probes in your applications.}.  @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5106from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5107@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5108for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5109
5110@item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5111@acronym{USDT} probes.  @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5112C@t{++} languages.
5113@end itemize
5114
5115@cindex semaphores on static probe points
5116Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5117for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5118using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file.  If your probe has a semaphore,
5119@value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5120breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation.  But, if you put a
5121breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5122@code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5123the semaphore.  @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5124
5125You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5126probes}, with optional arguments:
5127
5128@table @code
5129@kindex info probes
5130@item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5131If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5132@code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5133probes.  If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5134
5135If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5136names when selecting which probes to list.  If omitted, probes by all
5137probes from all providers are listed.
5138
5139If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5140when selecting which probes to list.  If omitted, probe names are not
5141considered when deciding whether to display them.
5142
5143If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5144object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine.  If not
5145given, all object files are considered.
5146
5147@item info probes all
5148List the available static probes, from all types.
5149@end table
5150
5151@cindex enabling and disabling probes
5152Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled.  The effect of
5153enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5154handled.  Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5155disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5156
5157You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5158commands, with optional arguments:
5159
5160@table @code
5161@kindex enable probes
5162@item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5163If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5164provider names when selecting which probes to enable.  If omitted,
5165all probes from all providers are enabled.
5166
5167If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5168names when selecting which probes to enable.  If omitted, probe names
5169are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5170
5171If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5172object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine.  If not
5173given, all object files are considered.
5174
5175@kindex disable probes
5176@item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5177See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5178optional arguments accepted by this command.
5179@end table
5180
5181@vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5182A probe may specify up to twelve arguments.  These are available at the
5183point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5184at the probe's location.  The arguments are available using the
5185convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5186@code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}.  In @code{SystemTap}
5187probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5188types are not preserved.  In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5189provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5190the value of the probe argument will be a long integer.  The
5191convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5192at the current probe point.
5193
5194These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5195any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5196an error message.
5197
5198
5199@c  @ifclear BARETARGET
5200@node Error in Breakpoints
5201@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5202
5203If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5204watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5205
5206@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5207@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5208@smallexample
5209Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5210You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5211@end smallexample
5212
5213@noindent
5214This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5215only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5216watchpoints it needs to insert.
5217
5218When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5219hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5220
5221@node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5222@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5223@cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5224
5225Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5226which breakpoints may be placed.  For architectures thus constrained,
5227@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5228with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5229
5230One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V.  The FR-V is
5231a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5232bundled together for parallel execution.  The FR-V architecture
5233constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5234bundle to the instruction with the lowest address.  @value{GDBN}
5235honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5236first in the bundle.
5237
5238It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5239instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5240a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5241another.  Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5242breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5243printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5244is hit.
5245
5246A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5247that's been subject to address adjustment:
5248
5249@smallexample
5250warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5251@end smallexample
5252
5253Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5254internal breakpoints.  If you see one of these warnings, you should
5255verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5256desired affect.  If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5257other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5258E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5259instruction.  A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5260cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5261
5262@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5263adjusted breakpoints:
5264
5265@smallexample
5266warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5267to 0x00010410.
5268@end smallexample
5269
5270When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5271action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5272frequently than expected.
5273
5274@node Continuing and Stepping
5275@section Continuing and Stepping
5276
5277@cindex stepping
5278@cindex continuing
5279@cindex resuming execution
5280@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5281completes normally.  In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5282one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5283line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5284particular command you use).  Either when continuing or when stepping,
5285your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal.  (If
5286it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5287@samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5288or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5289handlers}).)
5290
5291@table @code
5292@kindex continue
5293@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5294@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5295@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5296@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5297@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5298Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5299any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed.  The optional argument
5300@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5301ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5302@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5303
5304The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5305stopped due to a breakpoint.  At other times, the argument to
5306@code{continue} is ignored.
5307
5308The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5309debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5310purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5311@code{continue}.
5312@end table
5313
5314To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5315(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5316calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5317Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5318
5319A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5320(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5321beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5322is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5323and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5324interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5325
5326@table @code
5327@kindex step
5328@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5329@item step
5330Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5331line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}.  This command is
5332abbreviated @code{s}.
5333
5334@quotation
5335@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5336@c numbers in the debugging information".  (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5337@c not line numbers).  But it seems complex to try to make that
5338@c distinction here.
5339@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5340within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5341execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5342debugging information.  Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5343is compiled without debugging information.  To step through functions
5344without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5345below.
5346@end quotation
5347
5348The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5349line.  This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5350@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.  @code{step} continues
5351to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5352the line.  In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5353called within the line.
5354
5355Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5356number information for the function.  Otherwise it acts like the
5357@code{next} command.  This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5358on @acronym{MIPS} machines.  Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5359was any debugging information about the routine.
5360
5361@item step @var{count}
5362Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times.  If a
5363breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5364@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5365
5366@kindex next
5367@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5368@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5369Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5370This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5371the line of code are executed without stopping.  Execution stops when
5372control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5373that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command.  This command
5374is abbreviated @code{n}.
5375
5376An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5377
5378
5379@c  FIX ME!!  Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5380@c  the following paragraph?   ---  Vctoria
5381@c
5382@c  @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5383@c  @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5384@c  function are executed without stopping.
5385
5386The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5387source line.  This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5388@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5389
5390@kindex set step-mode
5391@item set step-mode
5392@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5393@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5394@itemx set step-mode on
5395The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5396stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5397information rather than stepping over it.
5398
5399This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5400machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5401want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5402
5403@item set step-mode off
5404Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5405debug information.  This is the default.
5406
5407@item show step-mode
5408Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5409source line debug information.
5410
5411@kindex finish
5412@kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5413@item finish
5414Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5415returns.  Print the returned value (if any).  This command can be
5416abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5417
5418Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5419,Returning from a Function}).
5420
5421@kindex until
5422@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5423@cindex run until specified location
5424@item until
5425@itemx u
5426Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5427current stack frame, is reached.  This command is used to avoid single
5428stepping through a loop more than once.  It is like the @code{next}
5429command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5430automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5431than the address of the jump.
5432
5433This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5434though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5435exits the loop.  In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5436simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5437through the next iteration.
5438
5439@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5440stack frame.
5441
5442@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5443of machine code does not match the order of the source lines.  For
5444example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5445(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5446@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5447
5448@smallexample
5449(@value{GDBP}) f
5450#0  main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5451206                 expand_input();
5452(@value{GDBP}) until
5453195             for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5454@end smallexample
5455
5456This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5457generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5458start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5459written before the body of the loop.  The @code{until} command appeared
5460to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5461expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5462statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5463
5464@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5465instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5466argument.
5467
5468@item until @var{location}
5469@itemx u @var{location}
5470Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5471reached, or the current stack frame returns.  The location is any of
5472the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5473This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5474hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.  The specified
5475location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame.  This
5476implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5477invocations.  For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5478line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5479line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5480invocations have returned.
5481
5482@smallexample
548394	int factorial (int value)
548495	@{
548596	    if (value > 1) @{
548697            value *= factorial (value - 1);
548798	    @}
548899	    return (value);
5489100     @}
5490@end smallexample
5491
5492
5493@kindex advance @var{location}
5494@item advance @var{location}
5495Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}.  An argument is
5496required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5497@ref{Specify Location}.
5498Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5499frame.  This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5500not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5501have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5502
5503
5504@kindex stepi
5505@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5506@item stepi
5507@itemx stepi @var{arg}
5508@itemx si
5509Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5510
5511It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5512instructions.  This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5513instruction to be executed, each time your program stops.  @xref{Auto
5514Display,, Automatic Display}.
5515
5516An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5517
5518@need 750
5519@kindex nexti
5520@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5521@item nexti
5522@itemx nexti @var{arg}
5523@itemx ni
5524Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5525proceed until the function returns.
5526
5527An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5528
5529@end table
5530
5531@anchor{range stepping}
5532@cindex range stepping
5533@cindex target-assisted range stepping
5534By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5535target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}.  In other words, whenever you
5536use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5537tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5538addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps.  This speeds up
5539line stepping, particularly for remote targets.  Ideally, there should
5540be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off.  However, it's
5541possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5542remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5543stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5544enabled.  You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5545if necessary:
5546
5547@table @code
5548@kindex set range-stepping
5549@kindex show range-stepping
5550@item set range-stepping
5551@itemx show range-stepping
5552Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5553
5554If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5555target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5556multiple single-steps.  If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5557single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target.  The
5558default is @code{on}.
5559
5560@end table
5561
5562@node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5563@section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5564@cindex skipping over functions and files
5565
5566The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5567uninteresting to debug.  The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5568skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5569a particular file when stepping.
5570
5571For example, consider the following C function:
5572
5573@smallexample
5574101     int func()
5575102     @{
5576103         foo(boring());
5577104         bar(boring());
5578105     @}
5579@end smallexample
5580
5581@noindent
5582Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5583are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}.  If you run @code{step}
5584at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5585step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5586
5587One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5588command to immediately exit it.  But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5589is called from many places.
5590
5591A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}.  This instructs
5592@value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}.  Now when you execute
5593@code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5594@code{foo}.
5595
5596Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5597(@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5598name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5599
5600On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5601``Extended Regular Expressions''.  See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5602on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems.  On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5603expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5604the underlying system.
5605See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5606description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5607
5608@table @code
5609@kindex skip
5610@item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5611The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5612that specify what to skip.
5613The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5614
5615@table @code
5616@item -file @var{file}
5617@itemx -fi @var{file}
5618Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5619
5620@item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5621@itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5622@cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5623Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5624over when stepping.
5625
5626@smallexample
5627(gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5628@end smallexample
5629
5630@item -function @var{linespec}
5631@itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5632Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5633named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5634@xref{Specify Location}.
5635
5636@item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5637@itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5638@cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5639Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5640
5641This form is useful for complex function names.
5642For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5643constructors or destructors.  Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5644write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5645the template arguments are.  Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5646regular expression makes this easier.
5647
5648@smallexample
5649(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5650@end smallexample
5651
5652If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5653in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5654
5655@smallexample
5656(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5657@end smallexample
5658@end table
5659
5660If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5661will be skipped.
5662
5663@kindex skip function
5664@item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5665After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5666function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5667stepping.  @xref{Specify Location}.
5668
5669If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5670will be skipped.
5671
5672(If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5673@kbd{skip function file}.)
5674
5675@kindex skip file
5676@item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5677After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5678will be skipped over when stepping.
5679
5680@smallexample
5681(gdb) skip file boring.c
5682File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5683@end smallexample
5684
5685If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5686you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5687@end table
5688
5689Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5690These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5691
5692@table @code
5693@kindex info skip
5694@item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5695Print details about the specified skip(s).  If @var{range} is not specified,
5696print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5697@code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5698
5699@table @emph
5700@item Identifier
5701A number identifying this skip.
5702@item Enabled or Disabled
5703Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5704Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5705@item Glob
5706If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5707Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5708@item File
5709The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5710If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5711@item RE
5712If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5713Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5714@item Function
5715The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5716If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5717@end table
5718
5719@kindex skip delete
5720@item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5721Delete the specified skip(s).  If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5722skips.
5723
5724@kindex skip enable
5725@item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5726Enable the specified skip(s).  If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5727skips.
5728
5729@kindex skip disable
5730@item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5731Disable the specified skip(s).  If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5732skips.
5733
5734@end table
5735
5736@node Signals
5737@section Signals
5738@cindex signals
5739
5740A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program.  The
5741operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5742kind a name and a number.  For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5743signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5744@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5745memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5746the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5747requested an alarm).
5748
5749@cindex fatal signals
5750Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5751functioning of your program.  Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5752errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5753program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5754@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5755fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5756
5757@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5758program.  You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5759signal.
5760
5761@cindex handling signals
5762Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5763@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5764(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5765but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5766You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5767
5768@table @code
5769@kindex info signals
5770@kindex info handle
5771@item info signals
5772@itemx info handle
5773Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5774handle each one.  You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5775the defined types of signals.
5776
5777@item info signals @var{sig}
5778Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5779
5780@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5781
5782@item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5783Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals.  @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5784for details about this command.
5785
5786@kindex handle
5787@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5788Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}.  The @var{signal}
5789can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5790@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5791@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5792known signals.  Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5793say what change to make.
5794@end table
5795
5796@c @group
5797The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5798Their full names are:
5799
5800@table @code
5801@item nostop
5802@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens.  It may
5803still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5804
5805@item stop
5806@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens.  This implies
5807the @code{print} keyword as well.
5808
5809@item print
5810@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5811
5812@item noprint
5813@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all.  This
5814implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5815
5816@item pass
5817@itemx noignore
5818@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5819can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5820and not handled.  @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5821
5822@item nopass
5823@itemx ignore
5824@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5825@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5826@end table
5827@c @end group
5828
5829When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5830program until you
5831continue.  Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5832effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}.  In other words,
5833after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5834command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5835program sees that signal when you continue.
5836
5837The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5838non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5839@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5840erroneous signals.
5841
5842You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5843seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5844or to give it any signal at any time.  For example, if your program stopped
5845due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5846values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5847execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5848a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal.  To prevent this,
5849you can continue with @samp{signal 0}.  @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5850Program a Signal}.
5851
5852@cindex stepping and signal handlers
5853@anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5854
5855@value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code.  If a signal
5856that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5857a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5858in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5859stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns.  In other
5860words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler.  This prevents
5861signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5862nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly.  Note that
5863the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5864signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5865that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner.  Also
5866note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5867signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5868
5869@anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5870
5871If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5872handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5873or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5874step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5875
5876Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5877to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5878resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5879stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5880
5881Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5882of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5883
5884@smallexample
5885(@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5886Signal        Stop      Print   Pass to program Description
5887SIGUSR1       Yes       Yes     Yes             User defined signal 1
5888(@value{GDBP}) c
5889Continuing.
5890
5891Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5892main () sigusr1.c:28
589328        p = 0;
5894(@value{GDBP}) si
5895sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
58969       @{
5897@end smallexample
5898
5899The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5900program to receive the signal first:
5901
5902@smallexample
5903(@value{GDBP}) n
590428        p = 0;
5905(@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5906(@value{GDBP}) si
5907sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
59089       @{
5909(@value{GDBP})
5910@end smallexample
5911
5912@cindex extra signal information
5913@anchor{extra signal information}
5914
5915On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5916associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5917delivered to the program being debugged.  This information is exported
5918by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5919that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5920receipt of a signal.  The data type of the information itself is
5921target dependent.  You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5922$_siginfo} command.  On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5923standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5924system header.
5925
5926Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5927referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5928
5929@smallexample
5930@group
5931(@value{GDBP}) continue
5932Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
59330x0000000000400766 in main ()
593469        *(int *)p = 0;
5935(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5936type = struct @{
5937    int si_signo;
5938    int si_errno;
5939    int si_code;
5940    union @{
5941        int _pad[28];
5942        struct @{...@} _kill;
5943        struct @{...@} _timer;
5944        struct @{...@} _rt;
5945        struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5946        struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5947        struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5948    @} _sifields;
5949@}
5950(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5951type = struct @{
5952    void *si_addr;
5953@}
5954(@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5955$1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5956@end group
5957@end smallexample
5958
5959Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5960
5961@cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5962@cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5963On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5964violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5965In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5966depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5967With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5968kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5969bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5970information is displayed.
5971
5972The usual output of a segfault is:
5973@smallexample
5974Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
59750x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
597668        value = *(p + len);
5977@end smallexample
5978
5979While a bound violation is presented as:
5980@smallexample
5981Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5982Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5983Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
59840x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
598568        value = *(p + len);
5986@end smallexample
5987
5988@node Thread Stops
5989@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5990
5991@cindex stopped threads
5992@cindex threads, stopped
5993
5994@cindex continuing threads
5995@cindex threads, continuing
5996
5997@value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5998(@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}).  There
5999are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6000debugger.  In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6001when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6002or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6003@value{GDBN}.  On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6004@dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6005you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6006
6007@menu
6008* All-Stop Mode::		All threads stop when GDB takes control
6009* Non-Stop Mode::		Other threads continue to execute
6010* Background Execution::	Running your program asynchronously
6011* Thread-Specific Breakpoints::	Controlling breakpoints
6012* Interrupted System Calls::	GDB may interfere with system calls
6013* Observer Mode::               GDB does not alter program behavior
6014@end menu
6015
6016@node All-Stop Mode
6017@subsection All-Stop Mode
6018
6019@cindex all-stop mode
6020
6021In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6022@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread.  This
6023allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6024switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6025underfoot.
6026
6027Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6028executing.  @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6029like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6030
6031In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6032Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6033system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6034execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6035single step.  Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6036statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6037stops.
6038
6039You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6040continuing or even single-stepping.  This happens whenever some other
6041thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6042first thread completes whatever you requested.
6043
6044@cindex automatic thread selection
6045@cindex switching threads automatically
6046@cindex threads, automatic switching
6047Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6048signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6049signal happened.  @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6050message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6051thread.
6052
6053On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6054locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6055
6056@table @code
6057@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6058@cindex scheduler locking mode
6059@cindex lock scheduler
6060Set the scheduler locking mode.  It applies to normal execution,
6061record mode, and replay mode.  If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6062locking and any thread may run at any time.  If @code{on}, then only
6063the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed.  The
6064@code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6065threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6066that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.  Other
6067threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6068completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6069@samp{until}, or @samp{finish}.  However, unless another thread hits a
6070breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6071current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.  The
6072@code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6073@code{on} in replay mode.
6074
6075@item show scheduler-locking
6076Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6077@end table
6078
6079@cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6080By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6081@code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6082threads of the current inferior to run.  For example, if @value{GDBN}
6083is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6084@code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6085inferior.  This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6086forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6087it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child.  In other
6088situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6089of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6090to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit.  In the latter case,
6091you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6092inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6093
6094@table @code
6095@kindex set schedule-multiple
6096@item set schedule-multiple
6097Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6098when an execution command is issued.  When @code{on}, all threads of
6099all processes are allowed to run.  When @code{off}, only the threads
6100of the current process are resumed.  The default is @code{off}.  The
6101@code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6102or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6103
6104@item show schedule-multiple
6105Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6106multiple processes.
6107@end table
6108
6109@node Non-Stop Mode
6110@subsection Non-Stop Mode
6111
6112@cindex non-stop mode
6113
6114@c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6115@c with more details.
6116
6117For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6118mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6119the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely.  This
6120minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6121where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6122respond to external events.  This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6123
6124In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6125@emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6126threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior.  Additionally,
6127execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6128only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6129in all-stop mode.  This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6130ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6131one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6132one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6133independently and simultaneously.
6134
6135To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6136or attach to your program:
6137
6138@smallexample
6139# If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6140set pagination off
6141
6142# Finally, turn it on!
6143set non-stop on
6144@end smallexample
6145
6146You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6147
6148@table @code
6149@kindex set non-stop
6150@item set non-stop on
6151Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6152@item set non-stop off
6153Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6154@kindex show non-stop
6155@item show non-stop
6156Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6157@end table
6158
6159Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6160not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6161In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6162@value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6163not possible to switch modes once debugging has started.  Furthermore,
6164since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6165non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6166default.
6167
6168In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6169by default.  That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6170To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6171
6172You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6173(@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6174while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6175The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6176always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6177
6178Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6179running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6180In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6181but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6182To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6183
6184Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6185
6186In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6187that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode.  This is because the
6188thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6189command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6190changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6191previously current thread.
6192
6193@node Background Execution
6194@subsection Background Execution
6195
6196@cindex foreground execution
6197@cindex background execution
6198@cindex asynchronous execution
6199@cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6200
6201@value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants:  the normal
6202foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6203(asynchronous) behavior.  In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6204the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6205another command.  In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6206a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6207
6208If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6209message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6210
6211To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command.  For example,
6212the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6213just @code{c&}.  The execution commands that accept background execution
6214are:
6215
6216@table @code
6217@kindex run&
6218@item run
6219@xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6220
6221@item attach
6222@kindex attach&
6223@xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6224
6225@item step
6226@kindex step&
6227@xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6228
6229@item stepi
6230@kindex stepi&
6231@xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6232
6233@item next
6234@kindex next&
6235@xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6236
6237@item nexti
6238@kindex nexti&
6239@xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6240
6241@item continue
6242@kindex continue&
6243@xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6244
6245@item finish
6246@kindex finish&
6247@xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6248
6249@item until
6250@kindex until&
6251@xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6252
6253@end table
6254
6255Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6256mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6257However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6258the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6259previous one finishes.  Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6260mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6261
6262You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6263using the @code{interrupt} command.
6264
6265@table @code
6266@kindex interrupt
6267@item interrupt
6268@itemx interrupt -a
6269
6270Suspend execution of the running program.  In all-stop mode,
6271@code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6272only the current thread.  To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6273use @code{interrupt -a}.
6274@end table
6275
6276@node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6277@subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6278
6279When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6280Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6281breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6282
6283@table @code
6284@cindex breakpoints and threads
6285@cindex thread breakpoints
6286@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6287@item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6288@itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6289@var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6290writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6291specify some source line.
6292
6293Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6294to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6295particular thread reaches this breakpoint.  The @var{thread-id} specifier
6296is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6297in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6298
6299If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6300breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6301program.
6302
6303You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6304well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6305after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6306
6307@smallexample
6308(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6309@end smallexample
6310
6311@end table
6312
6313Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6314@value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6315thread list.  For example:
6316
6317@smallexample
6318(@value{GDBP}) c
6319Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6320@end smallexample
6321
6322There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6323thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6324@code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6325Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6326(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc.  Note that with some targets,
6327@value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6328explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6329command.
6330
6331@node Interrupted System Calls
6332@subsection Interrupted System Calls
6333
6334@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6335@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6336@cindex premature return from system calls
6337There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6338multi-threaded programs.  If one thread stops for a
6339breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6340system call, then the system call may return prematurely.  This is a
6341consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6342that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6343stop execution.
6344
6345To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6346each system call and react appropriately.  This is good programming
6347style anyways.
6348
6349For example, do not write code like this:
6350
6351@smallexample
6352  sleep (10);
6353@end smallexample
6354
6355The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6356at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6357
6358Instead, write this:
6359
6360@smallexample
6361  int unslept = 10;
6362  while (unslept > 0)
6363    unslept = sleep (unslept);
6364@end smallexample
6365
6366A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6367conforming to its specification.  But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6368multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6369@value{GDBN}.
6370
6371Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6372monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6373When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6374prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6375
6376@node Observer Mode
6377@subsection Observer Mode
6378
6379If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6380without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6381variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6382whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc.  These operate
6383at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6384
6385When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6386be @dfn{observer mode}.  As a convenience, the variable
6387@code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6388mode.
6389
6390Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6391combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6392@code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6393then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6394stream will still not be able to be placed.
6395
6396@table @code
6397
6398@kindex observer
6399@item set observer on
6400@itemx set observer off
6401When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6402below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6403non-stop debugging.  Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6404normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6405
6406@item show observer
6407Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6408
6409@kindex may-write-registers
6410@item set may-write-registers on
6411@itemx set may-write-registers off
6412This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6413registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6414@code{jump} command.  It defaults to @code{on}.
6415
6416@item show may-write-registers
6417Show the current permission to write registers.
6418
6419@kindex may-write-memory
6420@item set may-write-memory on
6421@itemx set may-write-memory off
6422This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6423of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}.  It
6424defaults to @code{on}.
6425
6426@item show may-write-memory
6427Show the current permission to write memory.
6428
6429@kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6430@item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6431@itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6432This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6433This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6434by @value{GDBN}.  It defaults to @code{on}.
6435
6436@item show may-insert-breakpoints
6437Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6438
6439@kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6440@item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6441@itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6442This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6443tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment.  It affects only
6444non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6445@code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}.  It defaults to @code{on}.
6446
6447@item show may-insert-tracepoints
6448Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6449
6450@kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6451@item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6452@itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6453This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6454tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment.  It affects only
6455fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6456control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}.  It defaults to @code{on}.
6457
6458@item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6459Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6460
6461@kindex may-interrupt
6462@item set may-interrupt on
6463@itemx set may-interrupt off
6464This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6465program execution.  When this variable is @code{off}, the
6466@code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6467@kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6468
6469@item show may-interrupt
6470Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6471
6472@end table
6473
6474@node Reverse Execution
6475@chapter Running programs backward
6476@cindex reverse execution
6477@cindex running programs backward
6478
6479When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6480you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6481If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6482``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6483
6484A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6485to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6486program was executing normally.  Variables, registers etc.@: should
6487revert to their previous values.  Obviously this requires a great
6488deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6489all target environments can support reverse execution.
6490
6491When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6492have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6493order.  The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6494thread of execution in reverse.  As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6495the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6496instruction are reverted to their previous states.  After executing
6497a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6498should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6499prior values@footnote{
6500Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others.  For instance,
6501memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard.  Some
6502targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6503
6504The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6505requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6506@value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6507results back to @value{GDBN}.  Whatever the target reports back to
6508@value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user.  @value{GDBN}
6509assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6510consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6511}.
6512
6513If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6514reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6515
6516@table @code
6517@kindex reverse-continue
6518@kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6519@item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6520@itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6521Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6522in reverse.  Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6523exceptions (signals), just like normal execution.  Behavior of
6524asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6525
6526@kindex reverse-step
6527@kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6528@item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6529Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6530different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6531
6532Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6533at the beginning of a source line.  It ``un-executes'' the previously
6534executed source line.  If the previous source line included calls to
6535debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6536the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6537statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6538
6539Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6540called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6541
6542@kindex reverse-stepi
6543@kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6544@item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6545Reverse-execute one machine instruction.  Note that the instruction
6546to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6547counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one.  For instance,
6548if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6549back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6550
6551@kindex reverse-next
6552@kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6553@item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6554Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6555the current (innermost) stack frame.  If the line contains function
6556calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping.  Starting from
6557the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6558to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6559just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6560line of a function back to its return to its caller
6561@footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6562
6563@kindex reverse-nexti
6564@kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6565@item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6566Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6567in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6568That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6569another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6570in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6571frame) is reached.
6572
6573@kindex reverse-finish
6574@item reverse-finish
6575Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6576current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6577where it was called.  Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6578function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6579
6580@kindex set exec-direction
6581@item set exec-direction
6582Set the direction of target execution.
6583@item set exec-direction reverse
6584@cindex execute forward or backward in time
6585@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6586exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''.  Affected commands include
6587@code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}.  The @code{return}
6588command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6589@item set exec-direction forward
6590@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6591This is the default.
6592@end table
6593
6594
6595@node Process Record and Replay
6596@chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6597@cindex process record and replay
6598@cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6599
6600On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6601and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6602replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6603
6604@cindex replay mode
6605When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6606for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6607mode}.  In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6608instructions.  Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6609code execution are taken from the execution log.  While code is not
6610really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6611program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6612changed as they normally would.  Their contents are taken from the
6613execution log.
6614
6615@cindex record mode
6616If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6617@value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}.  In this mode, the
6618inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6619for future replay.
6620
6621The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6622(@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6623inferior runs does not.  However, the reverse execution is limited in
6624this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6625log.  In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6626support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6627
6628When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6629replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6630previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6631platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6632
6633For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6634@value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6635
6636@table @code
6637@kindex target record
6638@kindex target record-full
6639@kindex target record-btrace
6640@kindex record
6641@kindex record full
6642@kindex record btrace
6643@kindex record btrace bts
6644@kindex record btrace pt
6645@kindex record bts
6646@kindex record pt
6647@kindex rec
6648@kindex rec full
6649@kindex rec btrace
6650@kindex rec btrace bts
6651@kindex rec btrace pt
6652@kindex rec bts
6653@kindex rec pt
6654@item record @var{method}
6655This command starts the process record and replay target.  The
6656recording method can be specified as parameter.  Without a parameter
6657the command uses the @code{full} recording method.  The following
6658recording methods are available:
6659
6660@table @code
6661@item full
6662Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6663replay implementation.  This method allows replaying and reverse
6664execution.
6665
6666@item btrace @var{format}
6667Hardware-supported instruction recording.  This method does not record
6668data.  Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6669be overwritten when the buffer is full.  It allows limited reverse
6670execution.  Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6671execution.  In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6672Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting.  The recording may
6673be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6674
6675The recording format can be specified as parameter.  Without a parameter
6676the command chooses the recording format.  The following recording
6677formats are available:
6678
6679@table @code
6680@item bts
6681@cindex branch trace store
6682Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format.  In
6683this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6684branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6685
6686@item pt
6687@cindex Intel Processor Trace
6688Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format.  In this
6689format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6690that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6691
6692The trace can be recorded with very low overhead.  The compressed
6693trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6694number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6695
6696Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6697expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace.  This is mostly due to the
6698increased number of instructions to process.  You should increase the
6699buffer-size with care.
6700@end table
6701
6702Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6703@end table
6704
6705The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6706already running.  Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6707the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6708with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6709
6710@cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6711Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6712will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6713is started.  That's because the process record and replay target
6714doesn't support displaced stepping.
6715
6716@cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6717@cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6718If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6719the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6720all recording methods are available.  The @code{full} recording method
6721does not support these two modes.
6722
6723@kindex record stop
6724@kindex rec s
6725@item record stop
6726Stop the process record and replay target.  When process record and
6727replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6728inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6729
6730When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6731the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6732next instruction that would have been recorded.  In other words, if
6733you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6734will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6735
6736On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6737while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6738but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6739at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6740usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6741
6742When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6743process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6744
6745@kindex record goto
6746@item record goto
6747Go to a specific location in the execution log.  There are several
6748ways to specify the location to go to:
6749
6750@table @code
6751@item record goto begin
6752@itemx record goto start
6753Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6754
6755@item record goto end
6756Go to the end of the execution log.
6757
6758@item record goto @var{n}
6759Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6760@end table
6761
6762@kindex record save
6763@item record save @var{filename}
6764Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6765Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6766@var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6767
6768This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6769
6770@kindex record restore
6771@item record restore @var{filename}
6772Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6773File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6774
6775@kindex set record full
6776@item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6777@itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6778Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6779recording method.  Default value is 200000.
6780
6781If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6782deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6783instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}.  For every new recorded
6784instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6785instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6786(Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6787lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6788the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6789
6790If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6791delete recorded instructions from the execution log.  The number of
6792recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6793
6794@kindex show record full
6795@item show record full insn-number-max
6796Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6797recording method.
6798
6799@item set record full stop-at-limit
6800Control the behavior of the  @code{full} recording method when the
6801number of recorded instructions reaches the limit.  If ON (the
6802default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6803first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6804continue running it and recording the execution log.  If you decide
6805to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6806oldest one to be deleted.
6807
6808If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6809oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6810
6811@item show record full stop-at-limit
6812Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6813
6814@item set record full memory-query
6815Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6816changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6817If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6818case.
6819
6820If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6821ignore the effect of such instructions on memory.  Later, when
6822@value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6823instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6824results.
6825
6826@item show record full memory-query
6827Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6828
6829@kindex set record btrace
6830The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data.  As a
6831convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6832the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6833read-only areas don't change.  This for example makes it possible to
6834disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6835In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6836You can use the following command for that:
6837
6838@item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6839Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6840accessing memory during replay.  If @code{read-only} (the default),
6841@value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6842If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6843and to read-write memory.  Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6844to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6845position.
6846
6847@kindex show record btrace
6848@item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6849Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6850
6851@kindex set record btrace bts
6852@item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6853@itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6854Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6855format.  Default is 64KB.
6856
6857If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6858allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6859that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6860The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6861@var{size}.  Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6862buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6863the @acronym{BTS} format.
6864
6865If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6866allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6867
6868Bigger buffers mean longer traces.  On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6869also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6870
6871@item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6872Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6873tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6874
6875@kindex set record btrace pt
6876@item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6877@itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6878Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6879Processor Trace format.  Default is 16KB.
6880
6881If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6882allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6883that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6884format.  The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6885requested @var{size}.  Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6886actual buffer size for each thread.
6887
6888If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6889allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6890
6891Bigger buffers mean longer traces.  On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6892also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6893
6894@item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6895Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6896tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6897
6898@kindex info record
6899@item info record
6900Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6901method:
6902
6903@table @code
6904@item full
6905For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6906record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6907
6908@itemize @bullet
6909@item
6910Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6911@item
6912Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6913@item
6914Highest recorded instruction number.
6915@item
6916Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6917@item
6918Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6919@item
6920Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6921@end itemize
6922
6923@item btrace
6924For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6925
6926@itemize @bullet
6927@item
6928Recording format.
6929@item
6930Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6931@item
6932Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6933instructions.
6934@item
6935Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6936@end itemize
6937
6938For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6939@itemize @bullet
6940@item
6941Size of the perf ring buffer.
6942@end itemize
6943
6944For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6945@itemize @bullet
6946@item
6947Size of the perf ring buffer.
6948@end itemize
6949@end table
6950
6951@kindex record delete
6952@kindex rec del
6953@item record delete
6954When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6955subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6956from the current address.  This means you will abandon the previously
6957recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6958
6959@kindex record instruction-history
6960@kindex rec instruction-history
6961@item record instruction-history
6962Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log.  By
6963default, ten instructions are disassembled.  This can be changed using
6964the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command.  Instructions
6965are printed in execution order.
6966
6967It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6968@code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6969as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6970
6971The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6972current program counter value.  This instruction can appear multiple
6973times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6974every time.  To omit the current position marker, specify the
6975@code{/p} modifier.
6976
6977To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6978instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6979omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6980
6981Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}.  This
6982feature is not available for all recording formats.
6983
6984There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6985disassemble:
6986
6987@table @code
6988@item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6989Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6990@var{insn}.
6991
6992@item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6993Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6994@var{insn}.  If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6995@var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}.  If
6996@var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6997instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6998
6999@item record instruction-history
7000Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7001
7002@item record instruction-history -
7003Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7004
7005@item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7006Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7007@var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}.  The instruction
7008number @var{end} is included.
7009@end table
7010
7011This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7012
7013@kindex set record
7014@item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7015@itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7016Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7017instruction-history} command.  The default value is 10.
7018A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7019
7020@kindex show record
7021@item show record instruction-history-size
7022Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7023instruction-history} command.
7024
7025@kindex record function-call-history
7026@kindex rec function-call-history
7027@item record function-call-history
7028Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7029line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7030function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7031for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7032specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7033the @code{/i} modifier is specified).  The function names are indented
7034to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7035specified.  The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7036given together.
7037
7038@smallexample
7039(@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
70401   void foo (void)
70412   @{
70423   @}
70434
70445   void bar (void)
70456   @{
70467     ...
70478     foo ();
70489     ...
704910  @}
7050(@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
70511  bar     inst 1,4     at foo.c:6,8
70522    foo   inst 5,10    at foo.c:2,3
70533  bar     inst 11,13   at foo.c:9,10
7054@end smallexample
7055
7056By default, ten lines are printed.  This can be changed using the
7057@code{set record function-call-history-size} command.  Functions are
7058printed in execution order.  There are several ways to specify what
7059to print:
7060
7061@table @code
7062@item record function-call-history @var{func}
7063Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7064
7065@item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7066Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}.  If
7067@var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7068function number @var{func}.  If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7069prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7070
7071@item record function-call-history
7072Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7073
7074@item record function-call-history -
7075Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7076
7077@item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7078Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7079function number @var{end}.  The function number @var{end} is included.
7080@end table
7081
7082This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7083
7084@item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7085@itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7086Define how many lines to print in the
7087@code{record function-call-history} command.  The default value is 10.
7088A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7089
7090@item show record function-call-history-size
7091Show how many lines to print in the
7092@code{record function-call-history} command.
7093@end table
7094
7095
7096@node Stack
7097@chapter Examining the Stack
7098
7099When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7100stopped and how it got there.
7101
7102@cindex call stack
7103Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7104is generated.
7105That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7106the arguments of the call,
7107and the local variables of the function being called.
7108The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7109The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7110stack}.
7111
7112When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7113stack allow you to see all of this information.
7114
7115@cindex selected frame
7116One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7117@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame.  In
7118particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7119your program, the value is found in the selected frame.  There are
7120special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7121interested in.  @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7122
7123When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7124currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7125@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7126
7127@menu
7128* Frames::                      Stack frames
7129* Backtrace::                   Backtraces
7130* Selection::                   Selecting a frame
7131* Frame Info::                  Information on a frame
7132* Frame Filter Management::     Managing frame filters
7133
7134@end menu
7135
7136@node Frames
7137@section Stack Frames
7138
7139@cindex frame, definition
7140@cindex stack frame
7141The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7142frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7143with one call to one function.  The frame contains the arguments given
7144to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7145which the function is executing.
7146
7147@cindex initial frame
7148@cindex outermost frame
7149@cindex innermost frame
7150When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7151function @code{main}.  This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7152@dfn{outermost} frame.  Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7153made.  Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7154is eliminated.  If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7155the same function.  The frame for the function in which execution is
7156actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame.  This is the most
7157recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7158
7159@cindex frame pointer
7160Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses.  A
7161stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7162kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7163address serves as the address of the frame.  Usually this address is kept
7164in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7165(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7166
7167@cindex frame number
7168@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7169zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7170and so on upward.  These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7171they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7172frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7173
7174@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7175@c underflow problems.
7176@cindex frameless execution
7177Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7178without stack frames.  (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7179@smallexample
7180@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7181@end smallexample
7182generates functions without a frame.)
7183This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7184the frame setup time.  @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7185with these function invocations.  If the innermost function invocation
7186has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7187it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7188correct tracing of the function call chain.  However, @value{GDBN} has
7189no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7190
7191@node Backtrace
7192@section Backtraces
7193
7194@cindex traceback
7195@cindex call stack traces
7196A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is.  It shows one
7197line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7198frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7199stack.
7200
7201@anchor{backtrace-command}
7202@table @code
7203@kindex backtrace
7204@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7205@item backtrace
7206@itemx bt
7207Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7208frames in the stack.
7209
7210You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7211character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7212
7213@item backtrace @var{n}
7214@itemx bt @var{n}
7215Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7216
7217@item backtrace -@var{n}
7218@itemx bt -@var{n}
7219Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7220
7221@item backtrace full
7222@itemx bt full
7223@itemx bt full @var{n}
7224@itemx bt full -@var{n}
7225Print the values of the local variables also.  As described above,
7226@var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7227
7228@item backtrace no-filters
7229@itemx bt no-filters
7230@itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7231@itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7232@itemx bt no-filters full
7233@itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7234@itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7235Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace.  @xref{Frame
7236Filter API}, for more information.  Additionally use @ref{disable
7237frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters.  This is only
7238relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7239support.
7240@end table
7241
7242@kindex where
7243@kindex info stack
7244The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7245are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7246
7247@cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7248In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7249backtrace only for the current thread.  To display the backtrace for
7250several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7251(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}).  For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7252apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7253the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7254multi-threaded program.
7255
7256Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7257The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7258print address off}.  The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7259line number, as well as the arguments to the function.  The program
7260counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7261line number.
7262
7263Here is an example of a backtrace.  It was made with the command
7264@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7265
7266@smallexample
7267@group
7268#0  m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7269    at builtin.c:993
7270#1  0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7271#2  0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7272    at macro.c:71
7273(More stack frames follow...)
7274@end group
7275@end smallexample
7276
7277@noindent
7278The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7279value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7280code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7281
7282@noindent
7283The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7284@code{@dots{}}.  By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7285only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc).  See command
7286@kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7287on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7288
7289@cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7290@cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7291If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7292optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7293never used after the call.  Such optimizations generate code that
7294passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7295in the stack frame.  @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7296arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one.  Here's what
7297such a backtrace might look like:
7298
7299@smallexample
7300@group
7301#0  m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7302    at builtin.c:993
7303#1  0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7304#2  0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7305    at macro.c:71
7306(More stack frames follow...)
7307@end group
7308@end smallexample
7309
7310@noindent
7311The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7312shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7313
7314If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7315either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7316you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7317
7318@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7319@cindex program entry point
7320@cindex startup code, and backtrace
7321Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7322libraries and startup code transition into user code.  For C this is
7323@code{main}@footnote{
7324Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7325environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7326entry point.  They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7327When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7328it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7329system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7330
7331If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7332in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7333
7334@table @code
7335@item set backtrace past-main
7336@itemx set backtrace past-main on
7337@kindex set backtrace
7338Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7339
7340@item set backtrace past-main off
7341Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point.  This is the
7342default.
7343
7344@item show backtrace past-main
7345@kindex show backtrace
7346Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7347
7348@item set backtrace past-entry
7349@itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7350Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7351This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7352and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7353
7354@item set backtrace past-entry off
7355Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7356application.  This is the default.
7357
7358@item show backtrace past-entry
7359Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7360
7361@item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7362@itemx set backtrace limit 0
7363@itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7364@cindex backtrace limit
7365Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels.  A value of @code{unlimited}
7366or zero means unlimited levels.
7367
7368@item show backtrace limit
7369Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7370@end table
7371
7372You can control how file names are displayed.
7373
7374@table @code
7375@item set filename-display
7376@itemx set filename-display relative
7377@cindex filename-display
7378Display file names relative to the compilation directory.  This is the default.
7379
7380@item set filename-display basename
7381Display only basename of a filename.
7382
7383@item set filename-display absolute
7384Display an absolute filename.
7385
7386@item show filename-display
7387Show the current way to display filenames.
7388@end table
7389
7390@node Selection
7391@section Selecting a Frame
7392
7393Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7394whichever stack frame is selected at the moment.  Here are the commands for
7395selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7396of the stack frame just selected.
7397
7398@table @code
7399@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7400@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7401@item frame @var{n}
7402@itemx f @var{n}
7403Select frame number @var{n}.  Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7404(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7405innermost one, and so on.  The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7406@code{main}.
7407
7408@item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7409@itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7410Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}.  This is useful mainly if the
7411chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7412impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames.  In
7413addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7414switches between them.  The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7415specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7416
7417@kindex up
7418@item up @var{n}
7419Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1.  For positive
7420numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7421frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7422
7423@kindex down
7424@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7425@item down @var{n}
7426Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1.  For
7427positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7428lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7429You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7430@end table
7431
7432All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7433frame.  The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7434arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7435frame.  The second line shows the text of that source line.
7436
7437@need 1000
7438For example:
7439
7440@smallexample
7441@group
7442(@value{GDBP}) up
7443#1  0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7444    at env.c:10
744510              read_input_file (argv[i]);
7446@end group
7447@end smallexample
7448
7449After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7450prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7451You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7452editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7453@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7454for details.
7455
7456@table @code
7457@kindex select-frame
7458@item select-frame
7459The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7460not display the new frame after selecting it.  This command is
7461intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7462output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7463
7464@kindex down-silently
7465@kindex up-silently
7466@item up-silently @var{n}
7467@itemx down-silently @var{n}
7468These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7469respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7470causing display of the new frame.  They are intended primarily for use
7471in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7472distracting.
7473@end table
7474
7475@node Frame Info
7476@section Information About a Frame
7477
7478There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7479stack frame.
7480
7481@table @code
7482@item frame
7483@itemx f
7484When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7485frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7486selected stack frame.  It can be abbreviated @code{f}.  With an
7487argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7488@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7489
7490@kindex info frame
7491@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7492@item info frame
7493@itemx info f
7494This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7495including:
7496
7497@itemize @bullet
7498@item
7499the address of the frame
7500@item
7501the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7502@item
7503the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7504@item
7505the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7506@item
7507the address of the frame's arguments
7508@item
7509the address of the frame's local variables
7510@item
7511the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7512@item
7513which registers were saved in the frame
7514@end itemize
7515
7516@noindent The verbose description is useful when
7517something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7518the usual conventions.
7519
7520@item info frame @var{addr}
7521@itemx info f @var{addr}
7522Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7523selecting that frame.  The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7524command.  This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7525architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7526@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7527
7528@kindex info args
7529@item info args
7530Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7531
7532@item info locals
7533@kindex info locals
7534Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7535line.  These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7536accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7537
7538@end table
7539
7540@node Frame Filter Management
7541@section Management of Frame Filters.
7542@cindex managing frame filters
7543
7544Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7545output of frames.  @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7546
7547Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7548within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7549
7550@table @code
7551@kindex info frame-filter
7552@item info frame-filter
7553Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7554their name, priority and enabled status.
7555
7556@kindex disable frame-filter
7557@anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7558@item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7559Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7560@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}.  The
7561@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7562@code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7563dictionary resides.  When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7564across all dictionaries are disabled.  The @var{filter-name} is the name
7565of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7566@var{filter-dictionary}.  A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7567may be enabled again later.
7568
7569@kindex enable frame-filter
7570@item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7571Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7572@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}.  The
7573@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7574@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7575dictionary resides.  When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7576all dictionaries are enabled.  The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7577filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7578@var{filter-dictionary}.
7579
7580Example:
7581
7582@smallexample
7583(gdb) info frame-filter
7584
7585global frame-filters:
7586  Priority  Enabled  Name
7587  1000      No       PrimaryFunctionFilter
7588  100       Yes      Reverse
7589
7590progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7591  Priority  Enabled  Name
7592  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7593
7594objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7595  Priority  Enabled  Name
7596  999       Yes      BuildProgra Filter
7597
7598(gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7599(gdb) info frame-filter
7600
7601global frame-filters:
7602  Priority  Enabled  Name
7603  1000      No       PrimaryFunctionFilter
7604  100       Yes      Reverse
7605
7606progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7607  Priority  Enabled  Name
7608  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7609
7610objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7611  Priority  Enabled  Name
7612  999       No       BuildProgramFilter
7613
7614(gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7615(gdb) info frame-filter
7616
7617global frame-filters:
7618  Priority  Enabled  Name
7619  1000      Yes      PrimaryFunctionFilter
7620  100       Yes      Reverse
7621
7622progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7623  Priority  Enabled  Name
7624  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7625
7626objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7627  Priority  Enabled  Name
7628  999       No       BuildProgramFilter
7629@end smallexample
7630
7631@kindex set frame-filter priority
7632@item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7633Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7634@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7635@var{filter-name}.  The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7636@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7637dictionary resides.  The @var{priority} is an integer.
7638
7639@kindex show frame-filter priority
7640@item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7641Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7642@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7643@var{filter-name}.  The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7644@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7645dictionary resides.
7646
7647Example:
7648
7649@smallexample
7650(gdb) info frame-filter
7651
7652global frame-filters:
7653  Priority  Enabled  Name
7654  1000      Yes      PrimaryFunctionFilter
7655  100       Yes      Reverse
7656
7657progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7658  Priority  Enabled  Name
7659  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7660
7661objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7662  Priority  Enabled  Name
7663  999       No       BuildProgramFilter
7664
7665(gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7666(gdb) info frame-filter
7667
7668global frame-filters:
7669  Priority  Enabled  Name
7670  1000      Yes      PrimaryFunctionFilter
7671  50        Yes      Reverse
7672
7673progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7674  Priority  Enabled  Name
7675  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7676
7677objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7678  Priority  Enabled  Name
7679  999       No       BuildProgramFilter
7680@end smallexample
7681@end table
7682
7683@node Source
7684@chapter Examining Source Files
7685
7686@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7687information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7688used to build it.  When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7689the line where it stopped.  Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7690(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7691execution in that frame has stopped.  You can print other portions of
7692source files by explicit command.
7693
7694If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7695prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7696@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7697
7698@menu
7699* List::                        Printing source lines
7700* Specify Location::            How to specify code locations
7701* Edit::                        Editing source files
7702* Search::                      Searching source files
7703* Source Path::                 Specifying source directories
7704* Machine Code::                Source and machine code
7705@end menu
7706
7707@node List
7708@section Printing Source Lines
7709
7710@kindex list
7711@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7712To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7713(abbreviated @code{l}).  By default, ten lines are printed.
7714There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7715print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7716
7717Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7718
7719@table @code
7720@item list @var{linenum}
7721Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7722current source file.
7723
7724@item list @var{function}
7725Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7726@var{function}.
7727
7728@item list
7729Print more lines.  If the last lines printed were printed with a
7730@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7731printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7732as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7733Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7734
7735@item list -
7736Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7737@end table
7738
7739@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7740By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7741the @code{list} command.  You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7742
7743@table @code
7744@kindex set listsize
7745@item set listsize @var{count}
7746@itemx set listsize unlimited
7747Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7748the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7749Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7750
7751@kindex show listsize
7752@item show listsize
7753Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7754@end table
7755
7756Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7757so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}.  This is more useful
7758than listing the same lines again.  An exception is made for an
7759argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7760each repetition moves up in the source file.
7761
7762In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7763@dfn{locations}.  Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7764of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7765to specify some source line.
7766
7767Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7768
7769@table @code
7770@item list @var{location}
7771Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7772
7773@item list @var{first},@var{last}
7774Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}.  Both arguments are
7775locations.  When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7776source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7777the same source file as the first location.
7778
7779@item list ,@var{last}
7780Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7781
7782@item list @var{first},
7783Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7784
7785@item list +
7786Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7787
7788@item list -
7789Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7790
7791@item list
7792As described in the preceding table.
7793@end table
7794
7795@node Specify Location
7796@section Specifying a Location
7797@cindex specifying location
7798@cindex location
7799@cindex source location
7800
7801@menu
7802* Linespec Locations::                Linespec locations
7803* Explicit Locations::                Explicit locations
7804* Address Locations::                 Address locations
7805@end menu
7806
7807Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7808of your program's code.  Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7809debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7810Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7811linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7812
7813@node Linespec Locations
7814@subsection Linespec Locations
7815@cindex linespec locations
7816
7817A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7818as file name, function name, etc.  Here are all the different ways of
7819specifying a linespec:
7820
7821@table @code
7822@item @var{linenum}
7823Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7824
7825@item -@var{offset}
7826@itemx +@var{offset}
7827Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7828line}.  For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7829printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7830execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7831(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)  When
7832used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7833this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7834linespec.
7835
7836@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7837Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7838If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7839source file name with the same trailing components.  For example, if
7840@var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7841name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7842@file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7843
7844@item @var{function}
7845Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7846For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7847
7848@item @var{function}:@var{label}
7849Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7850
7851@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7852Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7853in the file @var{filename}.  You only need the file name with a
7854function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7855functions in different source files.
7856
7857@item @var{label}
7858Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7859in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7860If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7861is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7862
7863@cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7864@item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7865The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7866applications to embed static probes.  @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7867information on finding and using static probes.  This form of linespec
7868specifies the location of such a static probe.
7869
7870If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7871or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7872If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7873If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7874each one of those probes.
7875@end table
7876
7877@node Explicit Locations
7878@subsection Explicit Locations
7879@cindex explicit locations
7880
7881@dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7882location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7883
7884Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7885file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7886sources.  In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7887line you meant more accurately and unambiguously.  Also, using
7888explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7889
7890For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7891defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7892named @code{foo}.  @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7893the symbol table to know.
7894
7895The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7896following table:
7897
7898@table @code
7899@item -source @var{filename}
7900The value specifies the source file name.  To differentiate between
7901files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7902to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}.  Otherwise
7903@value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7904name.   This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7905
7906@item -function @var{function}
7907The value specifies the name of a function.  Operations
7908on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7909or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7910In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7911
7912@item -label @var{label}
7913The value specifies the name of a label.  When the function
7914name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7915selected stack frame.
7916
7917@item -line @var{number}
7918The value specifies a line offset for the location.  The offset may either
7919be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7920the command.  When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7921relative to the current line.
7922@end table
7923
7924Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7925trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7926
7927@node Address Locations
7928@subsection Address Locations
7929@cindex address locations
7930
7931@dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address.  They have
7932the generalized form *@var{address}.
7933
7934For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7935specifies a source line that contains @var{address}.  For @code{break} and
7936other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7937parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7938source files.
7939
7940Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7941language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7942address.  In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7943semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7944that frequently occur during debugging.  Here are the various forms
7945of @var{address}:
7946
7947@table @code
7948@item @var{expression}
7949Any expression valid in the current working language.
7950
7951@item @var{funcaddr}
7952An address of a function or procedure derived from its name.  In C,
7953C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7954simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7955of a valid expression).  In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7956@code{&@var{function}}.  In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7957(although the Pascal form also works).
7958
7959This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7960before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7961
7962@item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7963Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7964file explicitly.  This is useful if the name of the function does not
7965specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7966functions with identical names in different source files.
7967@end table
7968
7969@node Edit
7970@section Editing Source Files
7971@cindex editing source files
7972
7973@kindex edit
7974@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7975To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7976The editing program of your choice
7977is invoked with the current line set to
7978the active line in the program.
7979Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7980want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7981
7982@table @code
7983@item edit @var{location}
7984Edit the source file specified by @code{location}.  Editing starts at
7985that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7986specified file.  @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7987of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7988command most commonly used:
7989
7990@table @code
7991@item edit @var{number}
7992Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7993
7994@item edit @var{function}
7995Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7996@end table
7997
7998@end table
7999
8000@subsection Choosing your Editor
8001You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8002@footnote{
8003The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8004following command-line syntax:
8005@smallexample
8006ex +@var{number} file
8007@end smallexample
8008The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8009the file where to start editing.}.
8010By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8011by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8012@value{GDBN}.  For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8013@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8014@smallexample
8015EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8016export EDITOR
8017gdb @dots{}
8018@end smallexample
8019or in the @code{csh} shell,
8020@smallexample
8021setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8022gdb @dots{}
8023@end smallexample
8024
8025@node Search
8026@section Searching Source Files
8027@cindex searching source files
8028
8029There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8030regular expression.
8031
8032@table @code
8033@kindex search
8034@kindex forward-search
8035@kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8036@item forward-search @var{regexp}
8037@itemx search @var{regexp}
8038The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8039starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8040@var{regexp}.  It lists the line that is found.  You can use the
8041synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8042@code{fo}.
8043
8044@kindex reverse-search
8045@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8046The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8047with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8048for @var{regexp}.  It lists the line that is found.  You can abbreviate
8049this command as @code{rev}.
8050@end table
8051
8052@node Source Path
8053@section Specifying Source Directories
8054
8055@cindex source path
8056@cindex directories for source files
8057Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8058files from which they were compiled, just the names.  Even when they do,
8059the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8060session.  @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8061this is called the @dfn{source path}.  Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8062it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8063in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8064
8065For example, suppose an executable references the file
8066@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8067@file{/mnt/cross}.  The file is first looked up literally; if this
8068fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8069fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8070message is printed.  @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8071source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8072Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8073the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8074@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8075@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8076
8077Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8078names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8079instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8080is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8081@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8082that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8083
8084Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8085source files.
8086
8087Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8088any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8089each line is in the file.
8090
8091@kindex directory
8092@kindex dir
8093When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8094and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8095To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8096
8097The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8098script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8099
8100In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8101that manage a list of source path substitution rules.  A @dfn{substitution
8102rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8103debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8104directory between compilation and debugging.  A rule is made of
8105two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8106the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8107In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8108@var{to} respectively.  @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8109of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8110source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8111name to look up the sources.
8112
8113Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8114moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8115@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8116@file{/mnt/cross}.  The first lookup will then be
8117@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8118of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.  To define a source path
8119substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8120(@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8121
8122To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8123@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8124For instance, a rule substituting  @file{/usr/source} into
8125@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8126not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}.  And because the substitution
8127is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8128not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8129
8130In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8131command.  However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8132the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8133subdirectories.  With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8134subdirectory of your project.  If you moved the entire tree while
8135preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8136allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8137command.
8138
8139@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8140The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8141longer exists.  On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8142the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead.  So, if
8143for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8144located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8145method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8146
8147@cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8148@cindex default source path substitution
8149You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8150configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8151@samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option.  The @var{dir}
8152should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8153prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8154directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8155automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8156location.  This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8157with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8158together.
8159
8160@table @code
8161@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8162@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8163Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path.  Several
8164directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8165(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8166part of absolute file names) or
8167whitespace.  You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8168path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8169
8170@kindex cdir
8171@kindex cwd
8172@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8173@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8174@cindex compilation directory
8175@cindex current directory
8176@cindex working directory
8177@cindex directory, current
8178@cindex directory, compilation
8179You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8180directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8181working directory.  @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8182tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8183session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8184directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8185
8186@item directory
8187Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems).  This requires confirmation.
8188
8189@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8190@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that.  (thanks to RMS)
8191
8192@item set directories @var{path-list}
8193@kindex set directories
8194Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8195@samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8196
8197@item show directories
8198@kindex show directories
8199Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8200
8201@anchor{set substitute-path}
8202@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8203@kindex set substitute-path
8204Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8205current list of existing substitution rules.  If a rule with the same
8206@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8207
8208For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8209@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8210
8211@smallexample
8212(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8213@end smallexample
8214
8215@noindent
8216will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8217@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8218@file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8219
8220In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8221the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8222defined.  The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8223the substitution.
8224
8225For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8226
8227@smallexample
8228(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8229(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8230@end smallexample
8231
8232@noindent
8233@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8234@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule.  However, it would
8235use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8236@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8237
8238
8239@item unset substitute-path [path]
8240@kindex unset substitute-path
8241If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8242for a rule that would rewrite that path.  Delete that rule if found.
8243A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8244
8245If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8246
8247@item show substitute-path [path]
8248@kindex show substitute-path
8249If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8250which would rewrite that path, if any.
8251
8252If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8253rules.
8254
8255@end table
8256
8257If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8258interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8259versions of source.  You can correct the situation as follows:
8260
8261@enumerate
8262@item
8263Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8264
8265@item
8266Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8267directories you want in the source path.  You can add all the
8268directories in one command.
8269@end enumerate
8270
8271@node Machine Code
8272@section Source and Machine Code
8273@cindex source line and its code address
8274
8275You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8276addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8277a range of addresses as machine instructions.  You can use the command
8278@code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8279source line when execution stops.  When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8280mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8281line specified.  Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8282well as hex.
8283
8284@table @code
8285@kindex info line
8286@item info line @var{location}
8287Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8288source line @var{location}.  You can specify source lines in any of
8289the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8290@end table
8291
8292For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8293the object code for the first line of function
8294@code{m4_changequote}:
8295
8296@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8297@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8298@smallexample
8299(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8300Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8301@end smallexample
8302
8303@noindent
8304@cindex code address and its source line
8305We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8306@var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8307@smallexample
8308(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8309Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8310@end smallexample
8311
8312@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8313@cindex @code{x} command, default address
8314@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8315After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8316is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8317sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8318,Examining Memory}).  Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8319convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8320Variables}).
8321
8322@table @code
8323@kindex disassemble
8324@cindex assembly instructions
8325@cindex instructions, assembly
8326@cindex machine instructions
8327@cindex listing machine instructions
8328@item disassemble
8329@itemx disassemble /m
8330@itemx disassemble /s
8331@itemx disassemble /r
8332This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8333instructions.  It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8334the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8335as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8336The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8337program counter of the selected frame.  A single argument to this
8338command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8339surrounding this value.  When two arguments are given, they should
8340be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace.  The
8341arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8342
8343@table @code
8344@item @var{start},@var{end}
8345the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8346@item @var{start},+@var{length}
8347the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8348@code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8349@end table
8350
8351@noindent
8352When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8353printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8354
8355The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8356@samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8357
8358If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8359the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8360@end table
8361
8362The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8363HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8364
8365@smallexample
8366(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8367Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8368   0x32c4 <main+204>:      addil 0,dp
8369   0x32c8 <main+208>:      ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8370   0x32cc <main+212>:      ldil 0x3000,r31
8371   0x32d0 <main+216>:      ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8372   0x32d4 <main+220>:      ldo 0(r31),rp
8373   0x32d8 <main+224>:      addil -0x800,dp
8374   0x32dc <main+228>:      ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8375   0x32e0 <main+232>:      ldil 0x3000,r31
8376End of assembler dump.
8377@end smallexample
8378
8379Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8380with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8381function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8382
8383@smallexample
8384(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8385Dump of assembler code for function main:
83865       @{
8387   0x08048330 <+0>:    push   %ebp
8388   0x08048331 <+1>:    mov    %esp,%ebp
8389   0x08048333 <+3>:    sub    $0x8,%esp
8390   0x08048336 <+6>:    and    $0xfffffff0,%esp
8391   0x08048339 <+9>:    sub    $0x10,%esp
8392
83936         printf ("Hello.\n");
8394=> 0x0804833c <+12>:   movl   $0x8048440,(%esp)
8395   0x08048343 <+19>:   call   0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8396
83977         return 0;
83988       @}
8399   0x08048348 <+24>:   mov    $0x0,%eax
8400   0x0804834d <+29>:   leave
8401   0x0804834e <+30>:   ret
8402
8403End of assembler dump.
8404@end smallexample
8405
8406The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8407there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8408The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8409Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8410@code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8411This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8412and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8413Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8414several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8415
8416@file{foo.h}:
8417
8418@smallexample
8419int
8420foo (int a)
8421@{
8422  if (a < 0)
8423    return a * 2;
8424  if (a == 0)
8425    return 1;
8426  return a + 10;
8427@}
8428@end smallexample
8429
8430@file{foo.c}:
8431
8432@smallexample
8433#include "foo.h"
8434volatile int x, y;
8435int
8436main ()
8437@{
8438  x = foo (y);
8439  return 0;
8440@}
8441@end smallexample
8442
8443@smallexample
8444(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8445Dump of assembler code for function main:
84465	@{
8447
84486	  x = foo (y);
8449   0x0000000000400400 <+0>:	mov    0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8450   0x0000000000400417 <+23>:	mov    %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8451
84527	  return 0;
84538	@}
8454   0x000000000040041d <+29>:	xor    %eax,%eax
8455   0x000000000040041f <+31>:	retq
8456   0x0000000000400420 <+32>:	add    %eax,%eax
8457   0x0000000000400422 <+34>:	jmp    0x400417 <main+23>
8458
8459End of assembler dump.
8460(@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8461Dump of assembler code for function main:
8462foo.c:
84635	@{
84646	  x = foo (y);
8465   0x0000000000400400 <+0>:	mov    0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8466
8467foo.h:
84684	  if (a < 0)
8469   0x0000000000400406 <+6>:	test   %eax,%eax
8470   0x0000000000400408 <+8>:	js     0x400420 <main+32>
8471
84726	  if (a == 0)
84737	    return 1;
84748	  return a + 10;
8475   0x000000000040040a <+10>:	lea    0xa(%rax),%edx
8476   0x000000000040040d <+13>:	test   %eax,%eax
8477   0x000000000040040f <+15>:	mov    $0x1,%eax
8478   0x0000000000400414 <+20>:	cmovne %edx,%eax
8479
8480foo.c:
84816	  x = foo (y);
8482   0x0000000000400417 <+23>:	mov    %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8483
84847	  return 0;
84858	@}
8486   0x000000000040041d <+29>:	xor    %eax,%eax
8487   0x000000000040041f <+31>:	retq
8488
8489foo.h:
84905	    return a * 2;
8491   0x0000000000400420 <+32>:	add    %eax,%eax
8492   0x0000000000400422 <+34>:	jmp    0x400417 <main+23>
8493End of assembler dump.
8494@end smallexample
8495
8496Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8497
8498@smallexample
8499(gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8500Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8501   0x0000000000400281:  38 36  cmp    %dh,(%rsi)
8502   0x0000000000400283:  2d 36 34 2e 73 sub    $0x732e3436,%eax
8503   0x0000000000400288:  6f     outsl  %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8504   0x0000000000400289:  2e 32 00       xor    %cs:(%rax),%al
8505End of assembler dump.
8506@end smallexample
8507
8508Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8509So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8510in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8511and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8512
8513Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8514mnemonics or other syntax.
8515
8516For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8517instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8518libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8519location of the relocation table.  On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8520might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8521
8522@table @code
8523@kindex set disassembler-options
8524@cindex disassembler options
8525@item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8526This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8527the disassembler.  For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8528@code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8529manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8530(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8531The default value is the empty string.
8532
8533If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8534multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8535Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8536and S/390.
8537
8538@kindex show disassembler-options
8539@item show disassembler-options
8540Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8541@end table
8542
8543@table @code
8544@kindex set disassembly-flavor
8545@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8546@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8547@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8548Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8549program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8550
8551Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family.  You
8552can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8553The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8554assemblers for x86-based targets.
8555
8556@kindex show disassembly-flavor
8557@item show disassembly-flavor
8558Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8559@end table
8560
8561@table @code
8562@kindex set disassemble-next-line
8563@kindex show disassemble-next-line
8564@item set disassemble-next-line
8565@itemx show disassemble-next-line
8566Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8567line or instruction when execution stops.  If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8568display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8569program being debugged stops.  This is @emph{in addition} to
8570displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8571possible.  If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8572(e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8573info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8574next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line.  If
8575AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8576if the source line cannot be displayed.  This setting causes
8577@value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8578with no line info or whose source file is unavailable.  The default is
8579OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8580instruction.
8581@end table
8582
8583
8584@node Data
8585@chapter Examining Data
8586
8587@cindex printing data
8588@cindex examining data
8589@kindex print
8590@kindex inspect
8591The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8592command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}.  It
8593evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8594program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8595Different Languages}).  It may also print the expression using a
8596Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8597
8598@table @code
8599@item print @var{expr}
8600@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8601@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language).  By default the
8602value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8603you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8604@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8605Formats}.
8606
8607@item print
8608@itemx print /@var{f}
8609@cindex reprint the last value
8610If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8611@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}).  This allows you to
8612conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8613@end table
8614
8615A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8616It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8617specified format.  @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8618
8619If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8620fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8621command rather than @code{print}.  @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8622Table}.
8623
8624@cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8625@kindex explore
8626Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8627through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8628the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}).  It
8629offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8630abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8631itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8632embedded in the higher level data types.
8633
8634@table @code
8635@item explore @var{arg}
8636@var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8637visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8638@end table
8639
8640The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8641example.  If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8642C program as
8643
8644@smallexample
8645struct SimpleStruct
8646@{
8647  int i;
8648  double d;
8649@};
8650
8651struct ComplexStruct
8652@{
8653  struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8654  int arr[10];
8655@};
8656@end smallexample
8657
8658@noindent
8659followed by variable declarations as
8660
8661@smallexample
8662struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8663struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8664@end smallexample
8665
8666@noindent
8667then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8668@code{explore} command as follows.
8669
8670@smallexample
8671(gdb) explore cs
8672The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8673the following fields:
8674
8675  ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8676   arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8677
8678Enter the field number of choice:
8679@end smallexample
8680
8681@noindent
8682Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8683prompted to chose the field you want to explore.  Let's say you choose
8684the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}.  Then, since this field is a
8685pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value.  From
8686the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8687value, hence you enter @code{y}.  If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8688be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8689field will be explored as if it were an array.
8690
8691@smallexample
8692`cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8693Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8694The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8695SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8696
8697  i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8698  d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8699
8700Press enter to return to parent value:
8701@end smallexample
8702
8703@noindent
8704If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8705entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8706prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8707to explore.
8708
8709@smallexample
8710`cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8711Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8712
8713`(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8714
8715(cs.arr)[5] = 4
8716
8717Press enter to return to parent value:
8718@end smallexample
8719
8720In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8721leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8722return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8723level data structure).
8724
8725Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8726explore types.  Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8727variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8728program being debugged), you specify a type name.  If you consider the
8729same example as above, your can explore the type
8730@code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8731@code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8732
8733@smallexample
8734(gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8735@end smallexample
8736
8737@noindent
8738By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8739session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8740manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8741example.
8742
8743The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8744@code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8745a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8746being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8747exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8748
8749@table @code
8750@item explore value @var{expr}
8751@cindex explore value
8752This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8753expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8754current context of the program being debugged).  The behavior of this
8755command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8756command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8757
8758@item explore type @var{arg}
8759@cindex explore type
8760This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8761@var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8762debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8763is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8764debugged).  If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8765identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8766argument @var{arg}.  If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8767this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8768being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8769@end table
8770
8771@menu
8772* Expressions::                 Expressions
8773* Ambiguous Expressions::       Ambiguous Expressions
8774* Variables::                   Program variables
8775* Arrays::                      Artificial arrays
8776* Output Formats::              Output formats
8777* Memory::                      Examining memory
8778* Auto Display::                Automatic display
8779* Print Settings::              Print settings
8780* Pretty Printing::             Python pretty printing
8781* Value History::               Value history
8782* Convenience Vars::            Convenience variables
8783* Convenience Funs::            Convenience functions
8784* Registers::                   Registers
8785* Floating Point Hardware::     Floating point hardware
8786* Vector Unit::                 Vector Unit
8787* OS Information::              Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8788* Memory Region Attributes::    Memory region attributes
8789* Dump/Restore Files::          Copy between memory and a file
8790* Core File Generation::        Cause a program dump its core
8791* Character Sets::              Debugging programs that use a different
8792                                character set than GDB does
8793* Caching Target Data::         Data caching for targets
8794* Searching Memory::            Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8795* Value Sizes::                 Managing memory allocated for values
8796@end menu
8797
8798@node Expressions
8799@section Expressions
8800
8801@cindex expressions
8802@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8803compute its value.  Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8804by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8805@value{GDBN}.  This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8806casts, and string constants.  It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8807you compiled your program to include this information; see
8808@ref{Compilation}.
8809
8810@cindex arrays in expressions
8811@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8812the user.  The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}.  For example,
8813you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8814of three integers.  If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8815to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8816is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8817
8818Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8819this manual are in C.  @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8820Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8821languages.
8822
8823In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8824expressions regardless of your programming language.
8825
8826@cindex casts, in expressions
8827Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8828useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8829at that address in memory.
8830@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8831
8832@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8833to programming languages:
8834
8835@table @code
8836@item @@
8837@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8838@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8839
8840@item ::
8841@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8842function where it is defined.  @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8843
8844@cindex @{@var{type}@}
8845@cindex type casting memory
8846@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8847@cindex casts, to view memory
8848@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8849Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8850memory.  The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8851an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8852operators, just as in a cast).  This construct is allowed regardless
8853of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8854@end table
8855
8856@node Ambiguous Expressions
8857@section Ambiguous Expressions
8858@cindex ambiguous expressions
8859
8860Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements.  For instance,
8861some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8862a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8863different contexts.  This is called @dfn{overloading}.  Another example
8864involving Ada is generics.  A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8865templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8866the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8867
8868In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8869the expression to remove the ambiguity.  For instance in C@t{++}, you
8870can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8871@kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}.  In Ada, using the fully
8872qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8873as well.
8874
8875When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8876has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8877possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8878The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8879aborts the current command.  If the command in which the expression was
8880used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8881menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8882choices.
8883
8884For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8885breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8886We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8887
8888@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8889@smallexample
8890@group
8891(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8892[0] cancel
8893[1] all
8894[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8895[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8896[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8897[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8898[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8899[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8900> 2 4 6
8901Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8902Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8903Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8904Multiple breakpoints were set.
8905Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8906 breakpoints.
8907(@value{GDBP})
8908@end group
8909@end smallexample
8910
8911@table @code
8912@kindex set multiple-symbols
8913@item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8914@cindex multiple-symbols menu
8915
8916This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8917is ambiguous.
8918
8919By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}.  If the command with which
8920the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8921automatically selects all possible choices.  For instance, inserting
8922a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8923inserted on each possible match.  However, if a unique choice must be made,
8924then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8925For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8926in the use of the menu.
8927
8928When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8929when an ambiguity is detected.
8930
8931Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8932an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8933
8934@kindex show multiple-symbols
8935@item show multiple-symbols
8936Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8937@end table
8938
8939@node Variables
8940@section Program Variables
8941
8942The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8943in your program.
8944
8945Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8946(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8947
8948@itemize @bullet
8949@item
8950global (or file-static)
8951@end itemize
8952
8953@noindent or
8954
8955@itemize @bullet
8956@item
8957visible according to the scope rules of the
8958programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8959@end itemize
8960
8961@noindent This means that in the function
8962
8963@smallexample
8964foo (a)
8965     int a;
8966@{
8967  bar (a);
8968  @{
8969    int b = test ();
8970    bar (b);
8971  @}
8972@}
8973@end smallexample
8974
8975@noindent
8976you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8977executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8978examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8979the block where @code{b} is declared.
8980
8981@cindex variable name conflict
8982There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8983scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8984in this file.  But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8985function with the same name (in different source files).  If that
8986happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects.  If you wish,
8987you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8988using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8989
8990@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8991@ifnotinfo
8992@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8993@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8994@end ifnotinfo
8995@smallexample
8996@var{file}::@var{variable}
8997@var{function}::@var{variable}
8998@end smallexample
8999
9000@noindent
9001Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9002static @var{variable}.  In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9003make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9004to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9005
9006@smallexample
9007(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9008@end smallexample
9009
9010The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9011static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9012in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9013simple name of the variable.  However, you may also use this notation
9014to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9015
9016@smallexample
9017void
9018foo (int a)
9019@{
9020  if (a < 10)
9021    bar (a);
9022  else
9023    process (a);    /* Stop here */
9024@}
9025
9026int
9027bar (int a)
9028@{
9029  foo (a + 5);
9030@}
9031@end smallexample
9032
9033@noindent
9034For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9035here is what you might see
9036when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9037
9038@smallexample
9039(@value{GDBP}) p a
9040$1 = 10
9041(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9042$2 = 5
9043(@value{GDBP}) up 2
9044#2  0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9045(@value{GDBP}) p a
9046$3 = 5
9047(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9048$4 = 0
9049@end smallexample
9050
9051@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9052These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9053similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}.  When they are in
9054conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9055overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9056
9057For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9058that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9059include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9060@code{some_global}.
9061
9062@smallexample
9063(@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9064$1 = 23
9065(@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9066A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9067(@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9068$2 = 27
9069@end smallexample
9070
9071@cindex wrong values
9072@cindex variable values, wrong
9073@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9074@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9075@quotation
9076@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9077wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9078scope, and just before exit.
9079@end quotation
9080You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9081This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9082set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9083stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9084values until the stack frame is completely built.  On exit, it usually
9085also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9086after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9087variable definitions may be gone.
9088
9089This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9090To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9091when compiling.
9092
9093@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9094Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9095unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9096opposed to memory addresses).  Depending on the support for such cases
9097offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9098might not be able to display values for such local variables.  If that
9099happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9100
9101@smallexample
9102No symbol "foo" in current context.
9103@end smallexample
9104
9105To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9106different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9107formats.  @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9108options.  @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9109info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9110
9111If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9112@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9113by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9114type>}.  @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9115
9116If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9117value at the time the function got called.  If the value is not available an
9118error message is printed.  Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9119Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9120to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9121
9122@smallexample
9123Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
912429	  i++;
9125(gdb) next
912630	  e (i);
9127(gdb) print i
9128$1 = 31
9129(gdb) print i@@entry
9130$2 = 30
9131@end smallexample
9132
9133Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9134signedness.  Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9135printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers.  @code{-fsigned-char} or
9136@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9137defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9138For program code
9139
9140@smallexample
9141char var0[] = "A";
9142signed char var1[] = "A";
9143@end smallexample
9144
9145You get during debugging
9146@smallexample
9147(gdb) print var0
9148$1 = "A"
9149(gdb) print var1
9150$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9151@end smallexample
9152
9153@node Arrays
9154@section Artificial Arrays
9155
9156@cindex artificial array
9157@cindex arrays
9158@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9159It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9160same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9161dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9162program.
9163
9164You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9165@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}.  The left
9166operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9167and be an individual object.  The right operand should be the desired length
9168of the array.  The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9169the type of the left argument.  The first element is actually the left
9170argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9171following those that hold the first element, and so on.  Here is an
9172example.  If a program says
9173
9174@smallexample
9175int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9176@end smallexample
9177
9178@noindent
9179you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9180
9181@smallexample
9182p *array@@len
9183@end smallexample
9184
9185The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory.  Array values made
9186with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9187subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9188Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9189(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9190
9191Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9192This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9193The value need not be in memory:
9194@smallexample
9195(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9196$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9197@end smallexample
9198
9199As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9200@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9201the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9202@smallexample
9203(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9204$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9205@end smallexample
9206
9207Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9208moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9209actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9210of pointers in an array.  One useful work-around in this situation is
9211to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9212Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9213interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}.  For
9214instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9215structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9216in each structure.  Here is an example of what you might type:
9217
9218@smallexample
9219set $i = 0
9220p dtab[$i++]->fv
9221@key{RET}
9222@key{RET}
9223@dots{}
9224@end smallexample
9225
9226@node Output Formats
9227@section Output Formats
9228
9229@cindex formatted output
9230@cindex output formats
9231By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type.  Sometimes
9232this is not what you want.  For example, you might want to print a number
9233in hex, or a pointer in decimal.  Or you might want to view data in memory
9234at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction.  To do
9235these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9236
9237The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9238already computed.  This is done by starting the arguments of the
9239@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter.  The format
9240letters supported are:
9241
9242@table @code
9243@item x
9244Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9245hexadecimal.
9246
9247@item d
9248Print as integer in signed decimal.
9249
9250@item u
9251Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9252
9253@item o
9254Print as integer in octal.
9255
9256@item t
9257Print as integer in binary.  The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9258@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9259used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9260see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9261
9262@item a
9263@cindex unknown address, locating
9264@cindex locate address
9265Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9266the nearest preceding symbol.  You can use this format used to discover
9267where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9268
9269@smallexample
9270(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9271$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9272@end smallexample
9273
9274@noindent
9275The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9276@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9277
9278@item c
9279Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.  This
9280prints both the numerical value and its character representation.  The
9281character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9282for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9283
9284Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9285@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9286constants.  Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9287data.
9288
9289@item f
9290Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9291using typical floating point syntax.
9292
9293@item s
9294@cindex printing strings
9295@cindex printing byte arrays
9296Regard as a string, if possible.  With this format, pointers to single-byte
9297data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9298are displayed as fixed-length strings.  Other values are displayed in their
9299natural types.
9300
9301Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9302@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9303strings.  Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9304array.
9305
9306@item z
9307Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9308printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9309to the size of the integer type.
9310
9311@item r
9312@cindex raw printing
9313Print using the @samp{raw} formatting.  By default, @value{GDBN} will
9314use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9315Printing}).  This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9316value's contents.  The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9317pretty-printer which might exist.
9318@end table
9319
9320For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9321
9322@smallexample
9323p/x $pc
9324@end smallexample
9325
9326@noindent
9327Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9328names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9329
9330To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9331you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9332expression.  For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9333
9334@node Memory
9335@section Examining Memory
9336
9337You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9338any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9339
9340@cindex examining memory
9341@table @code
9342@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9343@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9344@itemx x @var{addr}
9345@itemx x
9346Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9347@end table
9348
9349@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9350much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9351expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9352If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9353Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9354
9355@table @r
9356@item @var{n}, the repeat count
9357The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1.  It specifies
9358how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.  If a negative
9359number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9360@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9361@c 4.1.2.
9362
9363@item @var{f}, the display format
9364The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9365(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9366@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9367The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.  The default changes
9368each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9369
9370@item @var{u}, the unit size
9371The unit size is any of
9372
9373@table @code
9374@item b
9375Bytes.
9376@item h
9377Halfwords (two bytes).
9378@item w
9379Words (four bytes).  This is the initial default.
9380@item g
9381Giant words (eight bytes).
9382@end table
9383
9384Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9385default unit the next time you use @code{x}.  For the @samp{i} format,
9386the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.  For the @samp{s} format,
9387the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9388Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
938932-bit strings.  The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9390Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9391current compilation unit.  If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9392modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9393UTF-32.  The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9394be altered.
9395
9396@item @var{addr}, starting display address
9397@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9398memory.  The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9399it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9400@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions.  The default for
9401@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9402other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9403the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9404starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9405a value from memory).
9406@end table
9407
9408For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9409(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9410starting at address @code{0x54320}.  @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9411words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9412@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9413
9414You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9415from the given address.  For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9416halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9417
9418Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9419letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9420unit size or format comes first; either order works.  The output
9421specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9422(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9423
9424Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9425and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9426@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9427including any operands.  For convenience, especially when used with
9428the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9429slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9430follow the last instruction that is within the count.  The command
9431@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9432instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9433
9434If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9435the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9436address as many as the absolute value of the given number.  For the @samp{i}
9437format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9438instruction boundaries while disassembling backward.  If line info is not
9439available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9440
9441All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9442easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9443you use @code{x}.  For example, after you have inspected three machine
9444instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9445with just @samp{x/7}.  If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9446the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9447for successive uses of @code{x}.
9448
9449When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9450counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9451
9452@smallexample
9453(@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9454   0x804837f <main+11>: mov    %esp,%ebp
9455   0x8048381 <main+13>: push   %ecx
9456   0x8048382 <main+14>: sub    $0x4,%esp
9457=> 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl   $0x8048460,(%esp)
9458   0x804838c <main+24>: call   0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9459@end smallexample
9460
9461@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9462The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9463in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9464would get in the way.  Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9465subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9466@code{$_} and @code{$__}.  After an @code{x} command, the last address
9467examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9468@code{$_}.  The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9469the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9470
9471If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9472are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9473address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9474
9475@anchor{addressable memory unit}
9476@cindex addressable memory unit
9477Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits.  This means
9478that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data.  Some
9479targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9480Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9481@dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9482when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size.  The word
9483@dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9484the addressable memory unit size of the target.  For most systems,
9485addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9486
9487@cindex remote memory comparison
9488@cindex target memory comparison
9489@cindex verify remote memory image
9490@cindex verify target memory image
9491When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9492(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9493in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9494downloaded to the target.  Or, on any target, you may want to check
9495whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections.  The
9496@code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9497
9498@table @code
9499@kindex compare-sections
9500@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9501Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9502executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9503the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches.  With no
9504arguments, compares all loadable sections.  With an argument of
9505@code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9506
9507Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9508target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9509(@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9510@end table
9511
9512@node Auto Display
9513@section Automatic Display
9514@cindex automatic display
9515@cindex display of expressions
9516
9517If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9518(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9519display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9520Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9521to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9522The automatic display looks like this:
9523
9524@smallexample
95252: foo = 38
95263: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9527@end smallexample
9528
9529@noindent
9530This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values.  As with
9531displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9532specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9533whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9534specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9535or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9536
9537@table @code
9538@kindex display
9539@item display @var{expr}
9540Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9541each time your program stops.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9542
9543@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9544
9545@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9546For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9547count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9548arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9549@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9550
9551@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9552For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9553number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9554be examined each time your program stops.  Examining means in effect
9555doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}.  @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9556@end table
9557
9558For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9559instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9560is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9561
9562@table @code
9563@kindex delete display
9564@kindex undisplay
9565@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9566@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9567Remove items from the list of expressions to display.  Specify the
9568numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9569argument @var{dnums}.  It can be a single display number, one of the
9570numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9571or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9572
9573@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9574(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9575
9576@kindex disable display
9577@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9578Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}.  A disabled display
9579item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten.  It may be
9580enabled again later.  Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9581want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}.  It can be a
9582single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9583the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9584numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9585
9586@kindex enable display
9587@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9588Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}.  It becomes effective once
9589again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9590Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9591command argument @var{dnums}.  It can be a single display number, one
9592of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9593display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9594
9595@item display
9596Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9597done when your program stops.
9598
9599@kindex info display
9600@item info display
9601Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9602automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9603values.  This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9604It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9605because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9606@end table
9607
9608@cindex display disabled out of scope
9609If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9610sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up.  Such an
9611expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9612variables is not defined.  For example, if you give the command
9613@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9614@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9615continues to stop inside that function.  When it stops elsewhere---where
9616there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9617automatically.  The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9618is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9619
9620@node Print Settings
9621@section Print Settings
9622
9623@cindex format options
9624@cindex print settings
9625@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9626and symbols are printed.
9627
9628@noindent
9629These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9630
9631@table @code
9632@kindex set print
9633@item set print address
9634@itemx set print address on
9635@cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9636@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9637traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9638even when it also displays the contents of those addresses.  The default
9639is @code{on}.  For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9640@code{set print address on}:
9641
9642@smallexample
9643@group
9644(@value{GDBP}) f
9645#0  set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9646    at input.c:530
9647530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
9648@end group
9649@end smallexample
9650
9651@item set print address off
9652Do not print addresses when displaying their contents.  For example,
9653this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9654
9655@smallexample
9656@group
9657(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9658(@value{GDBP}) f
9659#0  set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9660530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
9661@end group
9662@end smallexample
9663
9664You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9665dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface.  For example, with
9666@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9667all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9668
9669@kindex show print
9670@item show print address
9671Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9672@end table
9673
9674When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9675closest earlier symbol plus an offset.  If that symbol does not uniquely
9676identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9677source file), you may need to clarify.  One way to do this is with
9678@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}.  Alternately,
9679you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9680it prints a symbolic address:
9681
9682@table @code
9683@item set print symbol-filename on
9684@cindex source file and line of a symbol
9685@cindex symbol, source file and line
9686Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9687symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9688
9689@item set print symbol-filename off
9690Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol.  This is the
9691default.
9692
9693@item show print symbol-filename
9694Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9695line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9696@end table
9697
9698Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9699numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9700number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9701
9702Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9703printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9704
9705@table @code
9706@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9707@itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9708@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9709Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9710offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9711@var{max-offset}.  The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9712to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9713it.  Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9714
9715@item show print max-symbolic-offset
9716Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9717symbolic address.
9718@end table
9719
9720@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9721@cindex pointer, finding referent
9722If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9723@samp{set print symbol-filename on}.  Then you can determine the name
9724and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9725@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}.  This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9726For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9727at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9728
9729@smallexample
9730(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9731(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9732$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9733@end smallexample
9734
9735@quotation
9736@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9737does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9738the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9739@end quotation
9740
9741You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9742@samp{set print symbol on}:
9743
9744@table @code
9745@item set print symbol on
9746Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9747one exists.
9748
9749@item set print symbol off
9750Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9751address.  In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9752corresponding to pointers to functions.  This is the default.
9753
9754@item show print symbol
9755Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9756address.
9757@end table
9758
9759Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9760
9761@table @code
9762@item set print array
9763@itemx set print array on
9764@cindex pretty print arrays
9765Pretty print arrays.  This format is more convenient to read,
9766but uses more space.  The default is off.
9767
9768@item set print array off
9769Return to compressed format for arrays.
9770
9771@item show print array
9772Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9773arrays.
9774
9775@cindex print array indexes
9776@item set print array-indexes
9777@itemx set print array-indexes on
9778Print the index of each element when displaying arrays.  May be more
9779convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9780index of a given element in that printed array.  The default is off.
9781
9782@item set print array-indexes off
9783Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9784
9785@item show print array-indexes
9786Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9787arrays.
9788
9789@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9790@itemx set print elements unlimited
9791@cindex number of array elements to print
9792@cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9793Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9794If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9795printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9796This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9797When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9798Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9799that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9800
9801@item show print elements
9802Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9803If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9804
9805@item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9806@kindex set print frame-arguments
9807@cindex printing frame argument values
9808@cindex print all frame argument values
9809@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9810@cindex do not print frame argument values
9811This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9812when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}).  The possible
9813values are:
9814
9815@table @code
9816@item all
9817The values of all arguments are printed.
9818
9819@item scalars
9820Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar.  The value of more
9821complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9822by @code{@dots{}}.  This is the default.  Here is an example where
9823only scalar arguments are shown:
9824
9825@smallexample
9826#1  0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9827  at frame-args.c:23
9828@end smallexample
9829
9830@item none
9831None of the argument values are printed.  Instead, the value of each argument
9832is replaced by @code{@dots{}}.  In this case, the example above now becomes:
9833
9834@smallexample
9835#1  0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9836  at frame-args.c:23
9837@end smallexample
9838@end table
9839
9840By default, only scalar arguments are printed.  This command can be used
9841to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9842of their type.  However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9843of more complex parameters.  For instance, it reduces the amount of
9844information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9845Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9846the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9847especially in large applications.  Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9848to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9849thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9850
9851@item show print frame-arguments
9852Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9853
9854@item set print raw frame-arguments on
9855Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9856
9857@item set print raw frame-arguments off
9858Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9859for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9860otherwise print the value in raw form.
9861This is the default.
9862
9863@item show print raw frame-arguments
9864Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9865
9866@anchor{set print entry-values}
9867@item set print entry-values @var{value}
9868@kindex set print entry-values
9869Set printing of frame argument values at function entry.  In some cases
9870@value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9871the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9872and therefore is different.  With optimized code, the current value could be
9873unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9874
9875The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description).  Older
9876@value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}.  Compilers not supporting
9877this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9878@code{no} setting.
9879
9880This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9881the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags.  With
9882@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9883this information.
9884
9885The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9886
9887@table @code
9888@item no
9889Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9890point.
9891@smallexample
9892#0  equal (val=5)
9893#0  different (val=6)
9894#0  lost (val=<optimized out>)
9895#0  born (val=10)
9896#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9897@end smallexample
9898
9899@item only
9900Print only parameter values from function entry point.  The actual parameter
9901values are never printed.
9902@smallexample
9903#0  equal (val@@entry=5)
9904#0  different (val@@entry=5)
9905#0  lost (val@@entry=5)
9906#0  born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9907#0  invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9908@end smallexample
9909
9910@item preferred
9911Print only parameter values from function entry point.  If value from function
9912entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9913value for such parameter.
9914@smallexample
9915#0  equal (val@@entry=5)
9916#0  different (val@@entry=5)
9917#0  lost (val@@entry=5)
9918#0  born (val=10)
9919#0  invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9920@end smallexample
9921
9922@item if-needed
9923Print actual parameter values.  If actual parameter value is not known while
9924value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9925parameter.
9926@smallexample
9927#0  equal (val=5)
9928#0  different (val=6)
9929#0  lost (val@@entry=5)
9930#0  born (val=10)
9931#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9932@end smallexample
9933
9934@item both
9935Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9936point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9937optimizations.
9938@smallexample
9939#0  equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9940#0  different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9941#0  lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9942#0  born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9943#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9944@end smallexample
9945
9946@item compact
9947Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9948function entry point if it is known.  If neither is known, print for the actual
9949value @code{<optimized out>}.  If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9950values are known and identical, print the shortened
9951@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9952@smallexample
9953#0  equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9954#0  different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9955#0  lost (val@@entry=5)
9956#0  born (val=10)
9957#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9958@end smallexample
9959
9960@item default
9961Always print the actual parameter value.  Print also its value from function
9962entry point, but only if it is known.  If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9963if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9964@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9965@smallexample
9966#0  equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9967#0  different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9968#0  lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9969#0  born (val=10)
9970#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9971@end smallexample
9972@end table
9973
9974For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9975entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9976
9977@item show print entry-values
9978Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9979entry.
9980
9981@item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9982@itemx set print repeats unlimited
9983@cindex repeated array elements
9984Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9985elements.  When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9986array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9987@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9988identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9989themselves.  Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9990cause all elements to be individually printed.  The default threshold
9991is 10.
9992
9993@item show print repeats
9994Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9995elements.
9996
9997@item set print null-stop
9998@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9999Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10000@sc{null} is encountered.  This is useful when large arrays actually
10001contain only short strings.
10002The default is off.
10003
10004@item show print null-stop
10005Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10006@sc{null} character.
10007
10008@item set print pretty on
10009@cindex print structures in indented form
10010@cindex indentation in structure display
10011Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10012per line, like this:
10013
10014@smallexample
10015@group
10016$1 = @{
10017  next = 0x0,
10018  flags = @{
10019    sweet = 1,
10020    sour = 1
10021  @},
10022  meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10023@}
10024@end group
10025@end smallexample
10026
10027@item set print pretty off
10028Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10029
10030@smallexample
10031@group
10032$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10033meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10034@end group
10035@end smallexample
10036
10037@noindent
10038This is the default format.
10039
10040@item show print pretty
10041Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10042
10043@item set print sevenbit-strings on
10044@cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10045@cindex octal escapes in strings
10046Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10047@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10048character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}.  This setting is
10049best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10050high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10051
10052@item set print sevenbit-strings off
10053Print full eight-bit characters.  This allows the use of more
10054international character sets, and is the default.
10055
10056@item show print sevenbit-strings
10057Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10058
10059@item set print union on
10060@cindex unions in structures, printing
10061Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10062and other unions.  This is the default setting.
10063
10064@item set print union off
10065Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10066structures and other unions.  @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10067instead.
10068
10069@item show print union
10070Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10071structures and other unions.
10072
10073For example, given the declarations
10074
10075@smallexample
10076typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10077typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10078typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10079              Bug_forms;
10080
10081struct thing @{
10082  Species it;
10083  union @{
10084    Tree_forms tree;
10085    Bug_forms bug;
10086  @} form;
10087@};
10088
10089struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10090@end smallexample
10091
10092@noindent
10093with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10094
10095@smallexample
10096$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10097@end smallexample
10098
10099@noindent
10100and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10101
10102@smallexample
10103$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10104@end smallexample
10105
10106@noindent
10107@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10108and in Pascal.
10109@end table
10110
10111@need 1000
10112@noindent
10113These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10114
10115@table @code
10116@cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10117@item set print demangle
10118@itemx set print demangle on
10119Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10120(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10121linkage.  The default is on.
10122
10123@item show print demangle
10124Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10125
10126@item set print asm-demangle
10127@itemx set print asm-demangle on
10128Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10129in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10130The default is off.
10131
10132@item show print asm-demangle
10133Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10134or demangled form.
10135
10136@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10137@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10138@kindex set demangle-style
10139@item set demangle-style @var{style}
10140Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10141represent C@t{++} names.  The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10142
10143@table @code
10144@item auto
10145Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10146This is the default.
10147
10148@item gnu
10149Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10150
10151@item hp
10152Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10153
10154@item lucid
10155Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10156
10157@item arm
10158Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10159@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10160debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables.  @value{GDBN} would
10161require further enhancement to permit that.
10162
10163@end table
10164If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10165
10166@item show demangle-style
10167Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10168
10169@item set print object
10170@itemx set print object on
10171@cindex derived type of an object, printing
10172@cindex display derived types
10173When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10174(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10175the virtual function table.  Note that the virtual function table is
10176required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10177type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10178type is sufficient.  Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10179working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10180
10181@item set print object off
10182Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10183virtual function table.  This is the default setting.
10184
10185@item show print object
10186Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10187
10188@item set print static-members
10189@itemx set print static-members on
10190@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10191Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.  The default is on.
10192
10193@item set print static-members off
10194Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10195
10196@item show print static-members
10197Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10198
10199@item set print pascal_static-members
10200@itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10201@cindex static members of Pascal objects
10202@cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10203Print static members when displaying a Pascal object.  The default is on.
10204
10205@item set print pascal_static-members off
10206Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10207
10208@item show print pascal_static-members
10209Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10210
10211@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10212@item set print vtbl
10213@itemx set print vtbl on
10214@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10215@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10216@cindex VTBL display
10217Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.  The default is off.
10218(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10219ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10220
10221@item set print vtbl off
10222Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10223
10224@item show print vtbl
10225Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10226@end table
10227
10228@node Pretty Printing
10229@section Pretty Printing
10230
10231@value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10232Python code.  It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects.  This
10233mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10234
10235@menu
10236* Pretty-Printer Introduction::  Introduction to pretty-printers
10237* Pretty-Printer Example::       An example pretty-printer
10238* Pretty-Printer Commands::      Pretty-printer commands
10239@end menu
10240
10241@node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10242@subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10243
10244When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10245registered for the value.  If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10246pretty-printer to print the value.  Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10247
10248Pretty-printers are normally named.  This makes them easy to manage.
10249The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10250pretty-printers with their names.
10251If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10252@dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10253Each such subprinter has its own name.
10254The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10255
10256Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10257Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10258debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10259do anything special.
10260
10261There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10262
10263@itemize @bullet
10264@item
10265Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10266all inferiors.
10267
10268@item
10269Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10270when debugging that program.
10271@xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10272
10273@item
10274Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10275with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10276@xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10277@end itemize
10278
10279@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10280pretty-printers are selected,
10281
10282@xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10283for new types.
10284
10285@node Pretty-Printer Example
10286@subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10287
10288Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10289
10290@smallexample
10291(@value{GDBP}) print s
10292$1 = @{
10293  static npos = 4294967295,
10294  _M_dataplus = @{
10295    <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10296      <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10297        <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10298      @},
10299    members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10300      std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10301    _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10302  @}
10303@}
10304@end smallexample
10305
10306With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10307
10308@smallexample
10309(@value{GDBP}) print s
10310$2 = "abcd"
10311@end smallexample
10312
10313@node Pretty-Printer Commands
10314@subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10315@cindex pretty-printer commands
10316
10317@table @code
10318@kindex info pretty-printer
10319@item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10320Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10321This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10322
10323@var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10324whose pretty-printers to list.
10325Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10326(@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10327and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10328@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10329looks up a printer from these three objects.
10330
10331@var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10332to list.
10333
10334@kindex disable pretty-printer
10335@item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10336Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10337A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10338
10339@kindex enable pretty-printer
10340@item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10341Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10342@end table
10343
10344Example:
10345
10346Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10347named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10348another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10349@code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10350
10351@smallexample
10352(gdb) info pretty-printer
10353library1.so:
10354  foo
10355library2.so:
10356  bar
10357    bar1
10358    bar2
10359(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10360library2.so:
10361  bar
10362    bar1
10363    bar2
10364(gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
103651 printer disabled
103662 of 3 printers enabled
10367(gdb) info pretty-printer
10368library1.so:
10369  foo [disabled]
10370library2.so:
10371  bar
10372    bar1
10373    bar2
10374(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
103751 printer disabled
103761 of 3 printers enabled
10377(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10378library1.so:
10379  foo [disabled]
10380library2.so:
10381  bar
10382    bar1 [disabled]
10383    bar2
10384(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
103851 printer disabled
103860 of 3 printers enabled
10387(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10388library1.so:
10389  foo [disabled]
10390library2.so:
10391  bar [disabled]
10392    bar1 [disabled]
10393    bar2
10394@end smallexample
10395
10396Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10397as can each individual subprinter.
10398
10399@node Value History
10400@section Value History
10401
10402@cindex value history
10403@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10404Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10405@dfn{value history}.  This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10406Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10407(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10408When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10409since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10410symbol table.
10411
10412@cindex @code{$}
10413@cindex @code{$$}
10414@cindex history number
10415The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10416refer to them.  These are successive integers starting with one.
10417@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10418printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10419history number.
10420
10421To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10422history number.  The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10423remind you of this.  Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10424the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10425@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10426is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10427@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10428
10429For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10430want to see the contents of the structure.  It suffices to type
10431
10432@smallexample
10433p *$
10434@end smallexample
10435
10436If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10437to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10438
10439@smallexample
10440p *$.next
10441@end smallexample
10442
10443@noindent
10444You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10445command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10446
10447Note that the history records values, not expressions.  If the value of
10448@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10449
10450@smallexample
10451print x
10452set x=5
10453@end smallexample
10454
10455@noindent
10456then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10457remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10458
10459@table @code
10460@kindex show values
10461@item show values
10462Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10463This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10464values} does not change the history.
10465
10466@item show values @var{n}
10467Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10468
10469@item show values +
10470Print ten history values just after the values last printed.  If no more
10471values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10472@end table
10473
10474Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10475same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10476
10477@node Convenience Vars
10478@section Convenience Variables
10479
10480@cindex convenience variables
10481@cindex user-defined variables
10482@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10483@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later.  These variables
10484exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10485setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10486of your program.  That is why you can use them freely.
10487
10488Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}.  Any name preceded by
10489@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10490the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10491(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10492by @samp{$}.  @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10493
10494You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10495expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10496For example:
10497
10498@smallexample
10499set $foo = *object_ptr
10500@end smallexample
10501
10502@noindent
10503would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10504@code{object_ptr}.
10505
10506Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10507value is @code{void} until you assign a new value.  You can alter the
10508value with another assignment at any time.
10509
10510Convenience variables have no fixed types.  You can assign a convenience
10511variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10512that variable already has a value of a different type.  The convenience
10513variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10514
10515@table @code
10516@kindex show convenience
10517@cindex show all user variables and functions
10518@item show convenience
10519Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10520as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10521Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10522
10523@kindex init-if-undefined
10524@cindex convenience variables, initializing
10525@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10526Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set.  This is useful
10527for user-defined commands that keep some state.  It is similar, in concept,
10528to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10529convenience variables are global).  It can also be used to allow users to
10530override default values used in a command script.
10531
10532If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10533any side-effects do not occur.
10534@end table
10535
10536One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10537incremented or a pointer to be advanced.  For example, to print
10538a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10539
10540@smallexample
10541set $i = 0
10542print bar[$i++]->contents
10543@end smallexample
10544
10545@noindent
10546Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10547
10548Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10549values likely to be useful.
10550
10551@table @code
10552@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10553@item $_
10554The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10555the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).  Other
10556commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10557set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10558and @code{info breakpoint}.  The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10559except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10560to the type of @code{$__}.
10561
10562@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10563@item $__
10564The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10565to the value found in the last address examined.  Its type is chosen
10566to match the format in which the data was printed.
10567
10568@item $_exitcode
10569@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10570When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10571automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10572resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10573
10574@item $_exitsignal
10575@vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10576When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10577@value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10578and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10579
10580To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10581(i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10582@code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10583@code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10584Functions}).  For example, considering the following source code:
10585
10586@smallexample
10587#include <signal.h>
10588
10589int
10590main (int argc, char *argv[])
10591@{
10592  raise (SIGALRM);
10593  return 0;
10594@}
10595@end smallexample
10596
10597A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10598or signalled would be:
10599
10600@smallexample
10601(@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10602Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10603End with a line saying just ``end''.
10604>if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10605 >echo The program has exited\n
10606 >else
10607 >echo The program has signalled\n
10608 >end
10609>end
10610(@value{GDBP}) run
10611Starting program:
10612
10613Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10614The program no longer exists.
10615(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10616The program has signalled
10617@end smallexample
10618
10619As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10620debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10621@code{SIGALRM} signal.  If the program being debugged had not called
10622@code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10623
10624@smallexample
10625(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10626The program has exited
10627@end smallexample
10628
10629@item $_exception
10630The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10631thrown at an exception-related catchpoint.  @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10632
10633@item $_probe_argc
10634@itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10635Arguments to a static probe.  @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10636
10637@item $_sdata
10638@vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10639The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10640data.  @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.  Note that
10641@code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10642if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10643
10644@item $_siginfo
10645@vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10646The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10647(@pxref{extra signal information}).  Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10648could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10649For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10650
10651@item $_tlb
10652@vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10653The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10654applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10655gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10656@xref{General Query Packets}.
10657This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10658
10659@item $_inferior
10660The number of the current inferior.  @xref{Inferiors and
10661Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10662
10663@item $_thread
10664The thread number of the current thread.  @xref{thread numbers}.
10665
10666@item $_gthread
10667The global number of the current thread.  @xref{global thread numbers}.
10668
10669@end table
10670
10671@node Convenience Funs
10672@section Convenience Functions
10673
10674@cindex convenience functions
10675@value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}.  These
10676have a syntax similar to convenience variables.  A convenience
10677function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10678however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10679@value{GDBN}.
10680
10681These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10682@code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10683
10684@table @code
10685
10686@item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10687@findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10688Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}.  Otherwise it
10689returns zero.
10690
10691A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10692is @code{void}.  For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10693(see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10694it is @code{void}:
10695
10696@smallexample
10697(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10698$1 = void
10699(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10700$2 = 1
10701(@value{GDBP}) run
10702Starting program: ./a.out
10703[Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10704(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10705$3 = 0
10706(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10707$4 = 0
10708@end smallexample
10709
10710In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10711@code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10712program being debugged.  Before the execution there is no exit code to
10713be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}.  After the
10714execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10715@code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10716anymore.
10717
10718The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10719program being debugged.  For example, given the following function:
10720
10721@smallexample
10722void
10723foo (void)
10724@{
10725@}
10726@end smallexample
10727
10728The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10729
10730@smallexample
10731(@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10732$1 = void
10733(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10734$2 = 1
10735(@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10736(@value{GDBP}) print $v
10737$3 = void
10738(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10739$4 = 1
10740@end smallexample
10741
10742@end table
10743
10744These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10745@code{Python} support.
10746
10747@table @code
10748
10749@item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10750@findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10751Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10752@var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10753Otherwise it returns zero.
10754
10755@item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10756@findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10757Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10758@var{regex}.  Otherwise it returns zero.
10759The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10760regular expression support.
10761
10762@item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10763@findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10764Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10765Otherwise it returns zero.
10766
10767@item $_strlen(@var{str})
10768@findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10769Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10770
10771@item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10772@findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10773Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10774Otherwise it returns zero.
10775
10776If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10777it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10778The default is 1.
10779
10780Example:
10781
10782@smallexample
10783(gdb) backtrace
10784#0  bottom_func ()
10785    at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10786#1  0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10787    at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10788#2  0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10789    at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10790#3  0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10791    at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10792(gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10793$1 = 1
10794(gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10795$1 = 1
10796@end smallexample
10797
10798@item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10799@findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10800Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10801@var{regexp}.  Otherwise it returns zero.
10802
10803If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10804it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10805The default is 1.
10806
10807@item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10808@findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10809Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10810Otherwise it returns zero.
10811
10812If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10813it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10814The default is 1.
10815
10816This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10817checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10818by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10819frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10820
10821@item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10822@findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10823Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10824@var{regexp}.  Otherwise it returns zero.
10825
10826If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10827it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10828The default is 1.
10829
10830This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10831checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10832by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10833frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10834
10835@item $_as_string(@var{value})
10836@findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10837Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10838
10839This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10840enumeration value.  For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10841an enumerated type:
10842
10843@smallexample
10844(gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10845Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10846@end smallexample
10847
10848@end table
10849
10850@value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10851convenience functions.
10852
10853@table @code
10854@item help function
10855@kindex help function
10856@cindex show all convenience functions
10857Print a list of all convenience functions.
10858@end table
10859
10860@node Registers
10861@section Registers
10862
10863@cindex registers
10864You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10865with names starting with @samp{$}.  The names of registers are different
10866for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10867your machine.
10868
10869@table @code
10870@kindex info registers
10871@item info registers
10872Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10873and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10874
10875@kindex info all-registers
10876@cindex floating point registers
10877@item info all-registers
10878Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10879and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10880
10881@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10882Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10883As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10884the selected stack frame.  The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10885the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10886@end table
10887
10888@anchor{standard registers}
10889@cindex stack pointer register
10890@cindex program counter register
10891@cindex process status register
10892@cindex frame pointer register
10893@cindex standard registers
10894@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10895expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10896architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers.  The register names
10897@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10898the stack pointer.  @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10899pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10900register that contains the processor status.  For example,
10901you could print the program counter in hex with
10902
10903@smallexample
10904p/x $pc
10905@end smallexample
10906
10907@noindent
10908or print the instruction to be executed next with
10909
10910@smallexample
10911x/i $pc
10912@end smallexample
10913
10914@noindent
10915or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10916one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10917memory (most machines, nowadays).  This assumes that the innermost
10918stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10919stack frames are selected.  To pop entire frames off the stack,
10920regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10921see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10922
10923@smallexample
10924set $sp += 4
10925@end smallexample
10926
10927Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10928your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10929so long as there is no conflict.  The @code{info registers} command
10930shows the canonical names.  For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10931registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10932can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10933is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10934
10935@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10936integer when the register is examined in this way.  Some machines have
10937special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10938registers are considered to have floating point values.  There is no way
10939to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10940(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10941@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10942
10943Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats.  This
10944means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10945the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10946sees.  For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10947coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10948programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format.  In such
10949cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10950that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10951prints the data in both formats.
10952
10953@cindex SSE registers (x86)
10954@cindex MMX registers (x86)
10955Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10956in several different ways.  For example, modern x86-based machines
10957have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10958together in several different formats.  @value{GDBN} refers to such
10959registers in @code{struct} notation:
10960
10961@smallexample
10962(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10963$1 = @{
10964  v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10965  v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10966  v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10967  v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10968  v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10969  v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10970  uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10971@}
10972@end smallexample
10973
10974@noindent
10975To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10976view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10977value to a @code{struct} member:
10978
10979@smallexample
10980 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10981@end smallexample
10982
10983Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10984(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}).  This means that you get the
10985value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10986were exited and their saved registers restored.  In order to see the
10987true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10988frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10989
10990@cindex caller-saved registers
10991@cindex call-clobbered registers
10992@cindex volatile registers
10993@cindex <not saved> values
10994Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10995callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10996registers).  It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10997the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10998frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10999@value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11000(``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11001machine code generated by your compiler.  If some register is not
11002saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11003its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11004explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11005displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value.  With targets
11006that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11007if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11008in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11009This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11010the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11011call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about.  Note,
11012however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11013may also be affecting the inner frame.  Also, the more ``outer'' the
11014frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11015register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11016represent the value the register had just before the call.
11017
11018@node Floating Point Hardware
11019@section Floating Point Hardware
11020@cindex floating point
11021
11022Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11023you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11024
11025@table @code
11026@kindex info float
11027@item info float
11028Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11029point unit.  The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11030floating point chip.  Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11031the ARM and x86 machines.
11032@end table
11033
11034@node Vector Unit
11035@section Vector Unit
11036@cindex vector unit
11037
11038Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11039more information about the status of the vector unit.
11040
11041@table @code
11042@kindex info vector
11043@item info vector
11044Display information about the vector unit.  The exact contents and
11045layout vary depending on the hardware.
11046@end table
11047
11048@node OS Information
11049@section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11050@cindex OS information
11051
11052@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11053you debug your program.
11054
11055@cindex auxiliary vector
11056@cindex vector, auxiliary
11057Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11058startup.  This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11059specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11060binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11061hardware, operating system, and process.  Each value's purpose is
11062identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11063Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11064@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information.  For remote
11065targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11066support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11067@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11068
11069@table @code
11070@kindex info auxv
11071@item info auxv
11072Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11073live process or a core dump file.  @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11074numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11075tags.  Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11076pointers to strings or other data.  @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11077most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11078an unrecognized tag.
11079@end table
11080
11081On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11082information and show it to you.  The types of information available
11083will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11084target.  The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11085@ref{Operating System Information}.  For remote targets, this
11086functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11087@samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11088
11089@table @code
11090@kindex info os
11091@item info os @var{infotype}
11092
11093Display OS information of the requested type.
11094
11095On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11096
11097@anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11098@table @code
11099@kindex info os cpus
11100@item cpus
11101Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11102the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11103different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11104CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11105kernel initialization.
11106
11107@kindex info os files
11108@item files
11109Display the list of open file descriptors on the target.  For each
11110file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11111owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11112of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11113
11114@kindex info os modules
11115@item modules
11116Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target.  For each
11117module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11118bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11119module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11120in memory.
11121
11122@kindex info os msg
11123@item msg
11124Display the list of all System V message queues on the target.  For each
11125message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11126queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11127on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11128that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11129of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11130message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11131the message queue was last changed.
11132
11133@kindex info os processes
11134@item processes
11135Display the list of processes on the target.  For each process,
11136@value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11137command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11138that the process is currently running on.  (To understand what these
11139properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11140the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11141
11142@kindex info os procgroups
11143@item procgroups
11144Display the list of process groups on the target.  For each process,
11145@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11146to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11147identifier, and the command line of the process.  The list is sorted
11148first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11149so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11150and the process group leader is listed first.
11151
11152@kindex info os semaphores
11153@item semaphores
11154Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target.  For each
11155semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11156set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11157set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11158and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11159
11160@kindex info os shm
11161@item shm
11162Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11163For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11164the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11165region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11166attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11167attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11168attached to, detach from, and changed.
11169
11170@kindex info os sockets
11171@item sockets
11172Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target.  For each
11173socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11174remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11175the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11176connection.
11177
11178@kindex info os threads
11179@item threads
11180Display the list of threads running on the target.  For each thread,
11181@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11182belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11183processor core that it is currently running on.  The main thread of a
11184process is not listed.
11185@end table
11186
11187@item info os
11188If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11189@var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11190@var{infotype}.  If the target does not return a list of possible
11191types, this command will report an error.
11192@end table
11193
11194@node Memory Region Attributes
11195@section Memory Region Attributes
11196@cindex memory region attributes
11197
11198@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11199required by regions of your target's memory.  @value{GDBN} uses
11200attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11201accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11202target memory.  By default the description of memory regions is
11203fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11204user can override the fetched regions.
11205
11206Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled.  When a
11207memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11208accessing memory in that region.  Similarly, if no memory regions have
11209been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11210all memory.
11211
11212When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11213to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11214
11215@table @code
11216@kindex mem
11217@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11218Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11219attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11220monitored by @value{GDBN}.  Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11221case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11222(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11223
11224@item mem auto
11225Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11226regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11227
11228@kindex delete mem
11229@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11230Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11231monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11232
11233@kindex disable mem
11234@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11235Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11236A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11237It may be enabled again later.
11238
11239@kindex enable mem
11240@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11241Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11242
11243@kindex info mem
11244@item info mem
11245Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11246for each region:
11247
11248@table @emph
11249@item Memory Region Number
11250@item Enabled or Disabled.
11251Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11252Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11253
11254@item Lo Address
11255The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11256
11257@item Hi Address
11258The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11259
11260@item Attributes
11261The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11262@end table
11263@end table
11264
11265
11266@subsection Attributes
11267
11268@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11269The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11270write accesses to a memory region.
11271
11272While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11273memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11274etc.@: from accessing memory.
11275
11276@table @code
11277@item ro
11278Memory is read only.
11279@item wo
11280Memory is write only.
11281@item rw
11282Memory is read/write.  This is the default.
11283@end table
11284
11285@subsubsection Memory Access Size
11286The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11287accesses in the memory region.  Often memory mapped device registers
11288require specific sized accesses.  If no access size attribute is
11289specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11290
11291@table @code
11292@item 8
11293Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11294@item 16
11295Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11296@item 32
11297Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11298@item 64
11299Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11300@end table
11301
11302@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11303@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11304@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11305@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11306@c
11307@c @table @code
11308@c @item hwbreak
11309@c Always use hardware breakpoints
11310@c @item swbreak (default)
11311@c @end table
11312
11313@subsubsection Data Cache
11314The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11315memory.  While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11316protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11317does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11318registers.
11319
11320@table @code
11321@item cache
11322Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11323@item nocache
11324Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.  This is the default.
11325@end table
11326
11327@subsection Memory Access Checking
11328@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11329not explicitly described.  This can be useful if accessing such
11330regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11331better error checking.  The following commands control this behaviour.
11332
11333@table @code
11334@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11335@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11336If @code{on} is specified, make  @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11337explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11338to such memory.  The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11339memory range defined.  If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11340treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11341The default value is @code{on}.
11342@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11343@item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11344Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11345@end table
11346
11347
11348@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11349@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11350@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11351@c
11352@c @table @code
11353@c @item verify
11354@c @item noverify (default)
11355@c @end table
11356
11357@node Dump/Restore Files
11358@section Copy Between Memory and a File
11359@cindex dump/restore files
11360@cindex append data to a file
11361@cindex dump data to a file
11362@cindex restore data from a file
11363
11364You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11365@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file.  The
11366@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11367@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11368memory.  Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11369Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11370append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11371
11372@table @code
11373
11374@kindex dump
11375@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11376@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11377Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11378or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11379
11380The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11381@table @code
11382@item binary
11383Raw binary form.
11384@item ihex
11385Intel hex format.
11386@item srec
11387Motorola S-record format.
11388@item tekhex
11389Tektronix Hex format.
11390@item verilog
11391Verilog Hex format.
11392@end table
11393
11394@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11395@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}.  If
11396@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11397form.
11398
11399@kindex append
11400@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11401@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11402Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11403or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11404(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11405
11406@kindex restore
11407@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11408Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory.  The
11409@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11410file format, except for raw binary.  To restore a raw binary file you
11411must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11412
11413If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11414contained in the file.  Binary files always start at address zero, so
11415they will be restored at address @var{bias}.  Other bfd files have
11416a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11417from that location.
11418
11419If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11420file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11421These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11422the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11423
11424@end table
11425
11426@node Core File Generation
11427@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11428@cindex dump core from inferior
11429
11430A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11431image of a running process and its process status (register values
11432etc.).  Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11433crashed while it ran outside a debugger.  A program that crashes
11434automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11435the user.  @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11436the post-mortem debugging mode.
11437
11438Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11439are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11440@value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11441
11442@table @code
11443@kindex gcore
11444@kindex generate-core-file
11445@item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11446@itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11447Produce a core dump of the inferior process.  The optional argument
11448@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.  If not
11449specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11450@var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11451
11452Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11453this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11454
11455On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11456file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11457dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11458
11459@kindex set use-coredump-filter
11460@anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11461@item set use-coredump-filter on
11462@itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11463Enable or disable the use of the file
11464@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11465files.  This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11466memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11467file.  @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11468
11469To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11470@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11471which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types.  If a bit
11472is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11473types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored.  This
11474configuration is inherited by child processes.  For more information
11475about the bits that can be set in the
11476@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11477manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11478
11479By default, this option is @code{on}.  If this option is turned
11480@code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11481and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11482to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file.  This
11483value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11484(anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11485@code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11486This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11487@end table
11488
11489@node Character Sets
11490@section Character Sets
11491@cindex character sets
11492@cindex charset
11493@cindex translating between character sets
11494@cindex host character set
11495@cindex target character set
11496
11497If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11498represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11499@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11500you.  The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11501character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11502@dfn{target character set}.
11503
11504For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11505uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11506remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11507running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11508then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11509@sc{ebcdic}.  If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11510target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11511@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11512character and string literals in expressions.
11513
11514@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11515the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11516target-charset} command, described below.
11517
11518Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11519support:
11520
11521@table @code
11522@item set target-charset @var{charset}
11523@kindex set target-charset
11524Set the current target character set to @var{charset}.  To display the
11525list of supported target character sets, type
11526@kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11527
11528@item set host-charset @var{charset}
11529@kindex set host-charset
11530Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11531
11532By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11533system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11534@code{set host-charset} command.  On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11535automatically determine the appropriate host character set.  In this
11536case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11537
11538@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11539set.  If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11540@value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11541
11542@item set charset @var{charset}
11543@kindex set charset
11544Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}.  As
11545above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11546@value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11547for both host and target.
11548
11549@item show charset
11550@kindex show charset
11551Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11552
11553@item show host-charset
11554@kindex show host-charset
11555Show the name of the current host character set.
11556
11557@item show target-charset
11558@kindex show target-charset
11559Show the name of the current target character set.
11560
11561@item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11562@kindex set target-wide-charset
11563Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}.  This is
11564the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type.  To
11565display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11566@kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11567
11568@item show target-wide-charset
11569@kindex show target-wide-charset
11570Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11571@end table
11572
11573Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11574Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11575@file{charset-test.c}:
11576
11577@smallexample
11578#include <stdio.h>
11579
11580char ascii_hello[]
11581  = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11582     111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11583char ibm1047_hello[]
11584  = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11585     150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11586
11587main ()
11588@{
11589  printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11590@}
11591@end smallexample
11592
11593In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11594containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11595encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11596
11597We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11598
11599@smallexample
11600$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11601$ gdb -nw charset-test
11602GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11603Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11604@dots{}
11605(@value{GDBP})
11606@end smallexample
11607
11608We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11609@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11610strings:
11611
11612@smallexample
11613(@value{GDBP}) show charset
11614The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11615(@value{GDBP})
11616@end smallexample
11617
11618For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11619initial character set:
11620@smallexample
11621(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11622(@value{GDBP}) show charset
11623The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11624(@value{GDBP})
11625@end smallexample
11626
11627Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11628host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11629characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11630them properly.  Since our current target character set is also
11631@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11632
11633@smallexample
11634(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11635$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11636(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11637$2 = 72 'H'
11638(@value{GDBP})
11639@end smallexample
11640
11641@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11642literals you use in expressions:
11643
11644@smallexample
11645(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11646$3 = 43 '+'
11647(@value{GDBP})
11648@end smallexample
11649
11650The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11651character.
11652
11653@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11654target program uses.  If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11655character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11656
11657@smallexample
11658(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11659$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11660(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11661$5 = 200 '\310'
11662(@value{GDBP})
11663@end smallexample
11664
11665If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11666@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11667
11668@smallexample
11669(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11670ASCII       EBCDIC-US   IBM1047     ISO-8859-1
11671(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11672@end smallexample
11673
11674We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11675program's strings again.  Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11676@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11677target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11678@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11679
11680@smallexample
11681(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11682(@value{GDBP}) show charset
11683The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11684The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11685(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11686$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11687(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11688$7 = 72 '\110'
11689(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11690$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11691(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11692$9 = 200 'H'
11693(@value{GDBP})
11694@end smallexample
11695
11696As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11697string literals you use in expressions:
11698
11699@smallexample
11700(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11701$10 = 78 '+'
11702(@value{GDBP})
11703@end smallexample
11704
11705The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11706character.
11707
11708@node Caching Target Data
11709@section Caching Data of Targets
11710@cindex caching data of targets
11711
11712@value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11713Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11714@xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11715Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11716(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11717remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11718Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11719since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11720values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc.  Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11721(@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11722is executing.
11723Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11724known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11725rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11726in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11727stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11728in the code segment.
11729Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11730cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11731
11732@table @code
11733@kindex set remotecache
11734@item set remotecache on
11735@itemx set remotecache off
11736This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11737with old scripts.
11738
11739@kindex show remotecache
11740@item show remotecache
11741Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11742
11743@kindex set stack-cache
11744@item set stack-cache on
11745@itemx set stack-cache off
11746Enable or disable caching of stack accesses.  When @code{on}, use
11747caching.  By default, this option is @code{on}.
11748
11749@kindex show stack-cache
11750@item show stack-cache
11751Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11752
11753@kindex set code-cache
11754@item set code-cache on
11755@itemx set code-cache off
11756Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses.  When @code{on},
11757use caching.  By default, this option is @code{on}.  This improves
11758performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11759
11760@kindex show code-cache
11761@item show code-cache
11762Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11763accesses.
11764
11765@kindex info dcache
11766@item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11767Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11768current inferior's address space.  The information displayed
11769includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11770number, address, and how many times it was referenced.  This
11771command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11772
11773If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11774printed in hex.
11775
11776@item set dcache size @var{size}
11777@cindex dcache size
11778@kindex set dcache size
11779Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11780
11781@item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11782@cindex dcache line-size
11783@kindex set dcache line-size
11784Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11785Must be a power of 2.
11786
11787@item show dcache size
11788@kindex show dcache size
11789Show maximum number of dcache entries.  @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11790
11791@item show dcache line-size
11792@kindex show dcache line-size
11793Show default size of dcache lines.
11794
11795@end table
11796
11797@node Searching Memory
11798@section Search Memory
11799@cindex searching memory
11800
11801Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11802@code{find} command.
11803
11804@table @code
11805@kindex find
11806@item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11807@itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11808Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11809etc.  The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11810@var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11811@end table
11812
11813@var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11814They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11815
11816@table @r
11817@item @var{s}, search query size
11818The size of each search query value.
11819
11820@table @code
11821@item b
11822bytes
11823@item h
11824halfwords (two bytes)
11825@item w
11826words (four bytes)
11827@item g
11828giant words (eight bytes)
11829@end table
11830
11831All values are interpreted in the current language.
11832This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11833then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11834
11835If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11836value's type in the current language.
11837This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11838pattern as a mixture of types.
11839Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11840a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11841which is typically four bytes.
11842
11843@item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11844The maximum number of matches to print.  The default is to print all finds.
11845@end table
11846
11847You can use strings as search values.  Quote them with double-quotes
11848 (@code{"}).
11849The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11850regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11851
11852The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11853number of matches found.
11854
11855The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11856@samp{$_}.
11857A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11858
11859For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11860
11861@smallexample
11862void
11863hello ()
11864@{
11865  static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11866  static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11867    __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11868    = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11869  printf ("%s\n", hello);
11870@}
11871@end smallexample
11872
11873@noindent
11874you get during debugging:
11875
11876@smallexample
11877(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
118780x804956d <hello.1620+6>
118791 pattern found
11880(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
118810x8049567 <hello.1620>
118820x804956d <hello.1620+6>
118832 patterns found
11884(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
118850x8049567 <hello.1620>
118861 pattern found
11887(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
118880x8049560 <mixed.1625>
118891 pattern found
11890(gdb) print $numfound
11891$1 = 1
11892(gdb) print $_
11893$2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11894@end smallexample
11895
11896@node Value Sizes
11897@section Value Sizes
11898
11899Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11900@value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value.  It is possible in
11901some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11902may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11903@value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11904
11905@table @code
11906@kindex set max-value-size
11907@item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11908@itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11909Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11910contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11911requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11912
11913Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11914allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11915
11916There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11917order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11918currently 16 bytes.
11919
11920The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11921complete expressions.  For example, an expression denoting a simple
11922integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11923@var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}.  On the other hand,
11924@value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11925@var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11926succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11927size is less than @var{bytes}.
11928
11929The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11930
11931@kindex show max-value-size
11932@item show max-value-size
11933Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11934allocate for the contents of a value.
11935@end table
11936
11937@node Optimized Code
11938@chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11939@cindex optimized code, debugging
11940@cindex debugging optimized code
11941
11942Almost all compilers support optimization.  With optimization
11943disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11944directly to your source code, in a simplistic way.  As the compiler
11945applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11946diverges from your original source code.  With help from debugging
11947information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11948the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11949
11950@value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled.  If you
11951can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11952progress of your program during debugging.  But, there are many cases
11953where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11954
11955When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11956optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11957really there.  Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11958exactly match your source file!  An extreme example: if you define a
11959variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11960variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11961
11962Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11963@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling.  If in
11964doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11965please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11966@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11967
11968@menu
11969* Inline Functions::            How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11970* Tail Call Frames::            @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11971@end menu
11972
11973@node Inline Functions
11974@section Inline Functions
11975@cindex inline functions, debugging
11976
11977@dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11978body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11979routine.  @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11980non-inlined functions.  They appear in backtraces.  You can view their
11981arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11982them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11983You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11984@code{info frame} command.
11985
11986For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11987record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11988@value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11989other compilers do also.  @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11990when using @sc{dwarf 2}.  Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11991do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11992@samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11993function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}.  It instead
11994displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11995local variables in the caller.
11996
11997The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11998unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11999the call.  @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12000start of the inlined function are different instructions.  Stepping to
12001the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12002the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12003instructions are executed.
12004
12005This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12006context of the call and then the effect of the call.  Only stepping by
12007a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12008this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12009
12010There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12011function calls are the same as normal calls:
12012
12013@itemize @bullet
12014@item
12015Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12016work, because the call site does not contain any code.  @value{GDBN}
12017may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12018function, after the call.  This limitation will be removed in a future
12019version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12020or inside the inlined function instead.
12021
12022@item
12023@value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12024using the @code{finish} command.  This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12025debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12026and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12027
12028@end itemize
12029
12030@node Tail Call Frames
12031@section Tail Call Frames
12032@cindex tail call frames, debugging
12033
12034Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement.  In
12035unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12036instruction at the end of @code{B} code.  Optimizing compiler may replace the
12037call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12038instead.  Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12039
12040During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12041function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}.  If function
12042@code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12043then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}.  However, in
12044some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12045@code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12046return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12047
12048This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12049the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags.  With
12050@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12051this information.
12052
12053@kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12054kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12055
12056@smallexample
12057(gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12058   0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12059(gdb) info frame
12060Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12061 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12062 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12063 source language c++.
12064 Arglist at unknown address.
12065 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12066@end smallexample
12067
12068The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12069There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12070used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12071callee by multiple different jump sequences.  In such case @value{GDBN} still
12072tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12073unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12074
12075@table @code
12076@anchor{set debug entry-values}
12077@item set debug entry-values
12078@kindex set debug entry-values
12079When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12080values at function entry and tail calls.  It will show all the possible valid
12081tail calls code paths it has considered.  It will also print the intersection
12082of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12083result.
12084
12085@item show debug entry-values
12086@kindex show debug entry-values
12087Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12088values at function entry and tail calls.
12089@end table
12090
12091The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12092call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12093reference by variable @code{x}):
12094
12095@smallexample
12096static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12097void (*x) (void) = c;
12098static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12099static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12100int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12101
12102Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12103DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12104a () at t.c:3
121053	static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12106(gdb) bt
12107#0  a () at t.c:3
12108#1  0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12109@end smallexample
12110
12111Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12112
12113@smallexample
12114int i;
12115static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12116static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12117static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12118static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12119static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12120@{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12121static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12122int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12123
12124tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12125tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12126tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12127(gdb) bt
12128#0  f () at t.c:2
12129#1  0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12130#2  0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12131@end smallexample
12132
12133@set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12134@set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12135
12136@c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12137@ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12138@set ARROW @click{}
12139@set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12140@set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12141@end ifset
12142@ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12143@set ARROW ->
12144@set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12145@set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12146@end ifclear
12147
12148Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12149The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12150@value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12151
12152@code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12153has found.  It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12154prefixed by @code{compare:}.  The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12155printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence.  That one could have many
12156futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12157any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12158
12159For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12160@code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12161also ambigous.  The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12162therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12163omitted.
12164
12165There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12166entry may fail:
12167
12168@smallexample
12169int v;
12170static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12171static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12172static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12173static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12174@{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12175int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12176
12177(gdb) bt
12178#0  c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12179#1  0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12180function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12181i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12182#2  0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12183@end smallexample
12184
12185@value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12186function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12187tail calls.  Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12188@value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12189prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12190
12191@node Macros
12192@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12193
12194Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12195``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12196@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12197the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12198where it was defined.
12199
12200You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12201with information about preprocessor macros.  Most compilers do not
12202include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12203with the @option{-g} flag.  @xref{Compilation}.
12204
12205A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12206and then provide a different definition after that.  Thus, at different
12207points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12208no definition at all.  If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12209uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line.  Otherwise,
12210@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12211see @ref{List}.
12212
12213Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12214macro invocations present in the expression.  @value{GDBN} also provides
12215the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12216
12217@table @code
12218
12219@kindex macro expand
12220@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12221@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12222@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12223@item macro expand @var{expression}
12224@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12225Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12226@var{expression}.  Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12227not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12228it can be any string of tokens.
12229
12230@kindex macro exp1
12231@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12232@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12233@cindex expand macro once
12234@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)}  Show the results of
12235expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12236@var{expression}.  Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12237left unchanged.  This command allows you to see the effect of a
12238particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12239expansions.  Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12240parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12241can be any string of tokens.
12242
12243@kindex info macro
12244@cindex macro definition, showing
12245@cindex definition of a macro, showing
12246@cindex macros, from debug info
12247@item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12248Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12249and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12250definition was established.  The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12251argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12252the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12253
12254@kindex info macros
12255@item info macros @var{location}
12256Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12257by @var{location},  and describe the source location or compiler
12258command-line where those definitions were established.
12259
12260@kindex macro define
12261@cindex user-defined macros
12262@cindex defining macros interactively
12263@cindex macros, user-defined
12264@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12265@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12266Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12267invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12268@var{replacement-list}.  The first form of this command defines an
12269``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12270defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12271@var{arglist}.
12272
12273A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12274expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12275@code{macro undef} command, described below.  The definition overrides
12276all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12277as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12278
12279@kindex macro undef
12280@item macro undef @var{macro}
12281Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12282This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12283define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12284in the program being debugged.
12285
12286@kindex macro list
12287@item macro list
12288List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12289@end table
12290
12291@cindex macros, example of debugging with
12292Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action.  First, we
12293show our source files:
12294
12295@smallexample
12296$ cat sample.c
12297#include <stdio.h>
12298#include "sample.h"
12299
12300#define M 42
12301#define ADD(x) (M + x)
12302
12303main ()
12304@{
12305#define N 28
12306  printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12307#undef N
12308  printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12309#define N 1729
12310  printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12311@}
12312$ cat sample.h
12313#define Q <
12314$
12315@end smallexample
12316
12317Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12318@value{NGCC}.  We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12319minimum.  Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12320and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12321version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12322includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12323information.
12324
12325@smallexample
12326$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12327$
12328@end smallexample
12329
12330Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12331
12332@smallexample
12333$ gdb -nw sample
12334GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12335Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12336GDB is free software, @dots{}
12337(@value{GDBP})
12338@end smallexample
12339
12340We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12341program is not running.  @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12342to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12343
12344@smallexample
12345(@value{GDBP}) list main
123463
123474       #define M 42
123485       #define ADD(x) (M + x)
123496
123507       main ()
123518       @{
123529       #define N 28
1235310        printf ("Hello, world!\n");
1235411      #undef N
1235512        printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12356(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12357Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12358#define ADD(x) (M + x)
12359(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12360Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12361  included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12362#define Q <
12363(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12364expands to: (42 + 1)
12365(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12366expands to: once (M + 1)
12367(@value{GDBP})
12368@end smallexample
12369
12370In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12371the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12372@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12373which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12374
12375Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12376force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12377
12378@smallexample
12379(@value{GDBP}) break main
12380Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12381(@value{GDBP}) run
12382Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12383
12384Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
1238510        printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12386(@value{GDBP})
12387@end smallexample
12388
12389At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12390
12391@smallexample
12392(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12393Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12394#define N 28
12395(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12396expands to: 28 < 42
12397(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12398$1 = 1
12399(@value{GDBP})
12400@end smallexample
12401
12402As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12403give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12404thereof) in force at each point:
12405
12406@smallexample
12407(@value{GDBP}) next
12408Hello, world!
1240912        printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12410(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12411The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12412at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12413(@value{GDBP}) next
12414We're so creative.
1241514        printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12416(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12417Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12418#define N 1729
12419(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12420expands to: 1729 < 42
12421(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12422$2 = 0
12423(@value{GDBP})
12424@end smallexample
12425
12426In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12427line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax.  For macros defined in
12428such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12429of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12430
12431@smallexample
12432(@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12433Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12434-D__STDC__=1
12435(@value{GDBP})
12436@end smallexample
12437
12438
12439@node Tracepoints
12440@chapter Tracepoints
12441@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12442@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12443
12444@cindex tracepoints
12445In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12446the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12447anything helpful about its behavior.  If the program's correctness
12448depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12449might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12450fail, even when the code itself is correct.  It is useful to be able
12451to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12452
12453Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12454specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12455arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12456Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12457those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints.  The
12458expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12459for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12460a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12461in memory at that moment.  However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12462values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12463unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12464
12465The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12466targets.  @xref{Targets}.  In addition, your remote target must know
12467how to collect trace data.  This functionality is implemented in the
12468remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12469support tracepoints as of this writing.  The format of the remote
12470packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12471Packets}.
12472
12473It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12474of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12475through the file.  @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12476
12477This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12478
12479@menu
12480* Set Tracepoints::
12481* Analyze Collected Data::
12482* Tracepoint Variables::
12483* Trace Files::
12484@end menu
12485
12486@node Set Tracepoints
12487@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12488
12489Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12490tracepoints can be set.  A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12491breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12492standard breakpoint commands.  For instance, as with breakpoints,
12493tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12494of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12495as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12496
12497For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12498of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12499it hits that tracepoint.  The collected data can include registers,
12500local variables, or global data.  Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12501commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12502tracepoint was hit.
12503
12504Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature.  Ignore counts on
12505tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12506commands when they are hit.  Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12507either.
12508
12509@cindex fast tracepoints
12510Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12511a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12512faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12513
12514@cindex static tracepoints
12515@cindex markers, static tracepoints
12516@cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12517Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12518that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12519in the target.  Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12520tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}.  With static tracing, a set of
12521instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12522the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12523address.  These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12524investigating what the target is actually doing.  @value{GDBN}'s
12525support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12526points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12527tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12528@value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support.  Namely, support for collecting
12529registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12530point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12531The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12532instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12533static tracepoint marker.
12534
12535@code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12536@xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12537
12538This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12539conditions and actions.
12540
12541@menu
12542* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12543* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12544* Tracepoint Passcounts::
12545* Tracepoint Conditions::
12546* Trace State Variables::
12547* Tracepoint Actions::
12548* Listing Tracepoints::
12549* Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12550* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12551* Tracepoint Restrictions::
12552@end menu
12553
12554@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12555@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12556
12557@table @code
12558@cindex set tracepoint
12559@kindex trace
12560@item trace @var{location}
12561The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12562Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12563@xref{Specify Location}.  The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12564which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12565collect some data, and then allow the program to continue.  Setting a tracepoint
12566or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12567supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12568in tracing}).
12569If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12570these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12571command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12572not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.  In addition,
12573@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12574address is not yet resolved.  (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12575Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12576until they are resolved.  The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12577@value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12578@value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12579tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12580the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12581
12582Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12583
12584@smallexample
12585(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121}    // a source file and line number
12586
12587(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2}           // 2 lines forward
12588
12589(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function}  // first source line of function
12590
12591(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12592
12593(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4}    // an address
12594@end smallexample
12595
12596@noindent
12597You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12598
12599@item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12600Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12601@var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12602if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12603@xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12604information on tracepoint conditions.
12605
12606@item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12607@cindex set fast tracepoint
12608@cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12609@kindex ftrace
12610The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint.  For targets that
12611support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12612less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12613instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support.  It
12614may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12615location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12616message.
12617
12618@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12619@code{trace}.
12620
12621On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12622be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12623placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12624program is available to install trampolines.  Some Unix-type systems,
12625such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12626address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12627to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12628to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12629
12630@example
12631sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12632@end example
12633
12634@noindent
12635which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12636trampolines.  The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12637
12638@item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12639@cindex set static tracepoint
12640@cindex static tracepoints, setting
12641@cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12642@kindex strace
12643The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint.  For targets that
12644support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12645instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}.  It may not
12646be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12647which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12648
12649@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12650@code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12651@code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}.  This probes the marker
12652identified by the @var{marker} string identifier.  This identifier
12653depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12654using.  You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12655of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12656@xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12657Markers}.  For example, in the following small program using the UST
12658tracing engine:
12659
12660@smallexample
12661main ()
12662@{
12663  trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12664@}
12665@end smallexample
12666
12667@noindent
12668the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12669@code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12670
12671@smallexample
12672(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12673Cnt Enb ID         Address            What
126741   n   ust/bar33  0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12675         Data: "str %s"
12676[etc...]
12677@end smallexample
12678
12679@noindent
12680so you may probe the marker above with:
12681
12682@smallexample
12683(@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12684@end smallexample
12685
12686Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12687$_sdata}.  This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12688call to the tracing library.  In the UST example above, you'll see
12689that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12690string.  The user data is then the result of running that formating
12691string against the following arguments.  Note that @code{info
12692static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12693the @samp{Data:} field.
12694
12695You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12696the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12697@value{GDBN}.  @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12698
12699@vindex $tpnum
12700@cindex last tracepoint number
12701@cindex recent tracepoint number
12702@cindex tracepoint number
12703The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12704of the most recently set tracepoint.
12705
12706@kindex delete tracepoint
12707@cindex tracepoint deletion
12708@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12709Permanently delete one or more tracepoints.  With no argument, the
12710default is to delete all tracepoints.  Note that the regular
12711@code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12712
12713Examples:
12714
12715@smallexample
12716(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12717
12718(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace}       // remove all tracepoints
12719@end smallexample
12720
12721@noindent
12722You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12723@end table
12724
12725@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12726@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12727
12728These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12729
12730@table @code
12731@kindex disable tracepoint
12732@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12733Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12734@var{num} is given.  A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12735a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten.  You can re-enable
12736a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12737If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12738has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12739change will be effective immediately.  Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12740next trace experiment.
12741
12742@kindex enable tracepoint
12743@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12744Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints.  If this command is
12745issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12746tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12747become effective immediately.  Otherwise, they will become effective the
12748next time a trace experiment is run.
12749@end table
12750
12751@node Tracepoint Passcounts
12752@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12753
12754@table @code
12755@kindex passcount
12756@cindex tracepoint pass count
12757@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12758Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint.  The passcount is a way to
12759automatically stop a trace experiment.  If a tracepoint's passcount is
12760@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12761the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit.  If the tracepoint number
12762@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12763passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint.  If no passcount is
12764given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12765user.
12766
12767Examples:
12768
12769@smallexample
12770(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12771@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12772
12773(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12}  // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12774@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12775(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12776(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12777(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12778(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12779(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12780(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1}        // Stop tracing when foo has been
12781@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12782@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12783@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12784@end smallexample
12785@end table
12786
12787@node Tracepoint Conditions
12788@subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12789@cindex conditional tracepoints
12790@cindex tracepoint conditions
12791
12792The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12793reaches a specified place.  You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12794a tracepoint.  A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12795programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  A
12796tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12797program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12798is true.
12799
12800Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12801using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12802@xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}.  They can
12803also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12804just as with breakpoints.
12805
12806Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12807the conditional expression itself.  Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12808expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12809suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12810Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12811accesses, and so forth.
12812
12813For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12814frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred.  You
12815could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12816of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12817through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12818collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12819search through.
12820
12821@smallexample
12822(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12823@end smallexample
12824
12825@node Trace State Variables
12826@subsection Trace State Variables
12827@cindex trace state variables
12828
12829A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12830created and managed by target-side code.  The syntax is the same as
12831that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12832but they are stored on the target.  They must be created explicitly,
12833using a @code{tvariable} command.  They are always 64-bit signed
12834integers.
12835
12836Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12837to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12838experiment starts.  There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12839trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12840
12841@cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12842Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12843them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12844variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12845while the trace experiment is running.  Trace state variables share
12846the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12847cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12848@code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12849variable with the same name.
12850
12851@table @code
12852
12853@item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12854@kindex tvariable
12855The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12856@code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12857@var{expression}.  The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12858entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12859otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12860@code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12861variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12862existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12863value. The default initial value is 0.
12864
12865@item info tvariables
12866@kindex info tvariables
12867List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12868Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12869currently running.
12870
12871@item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12872@kindex delete tvariable
12873Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12874are specified.
12875
12876@end table
12877
12878@node Tracepoint Actions
12879@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12880
12881@table @code
12882@kindex actions
12883@cindex tracepoint actions
12884@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12885This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12886tracepoint is hit.  If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12887specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12888recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12889@code{actions} without bothering about its number).  You specify the
12890actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12891terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}.  So
12892far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12893@code{while-stepping}.
12894
12895@code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12896Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12897actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12898
12899@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12900To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12901and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12902
12903@smallexample
12904(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12905
12906(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12907
12908(@value{GDBP}) @b{end}              // signals the end of actions.
12909@end smallexample
12910
12911In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12912commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12913hit.  Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12914following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12915followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12916sequence of single steps.  The @code{while-stepping} command is
12917terminated by its own separate @code{end} command.  Lastly, the action
12918list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12919
12920@smallexample
12921(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12922(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12923Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12924> collect bar,baz
12925> collect $regs
12926> while-stepping 12
12927  > collect $pc, arr[i]
12928  > end
12929end
12930@end smallexample
12931
12932@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12933@item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12934Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12935This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12936In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12937special arguments are supported:
12938
12939@table @code
12940@item $regs
12941Collect all registers.
12942
12943@item $args
12944Collect all function arguments.
12945
12946@item $locals
12947Collect all local variables.
12948
12949@item $_ret
12950Collect the return address.  This is helpful if you want to see more
12951of a backtrace.
12952
12953@emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12954determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12955collected instead.  On some architectures the reliability is higher
12956for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12957When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12958found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12959
12960@item $_probe_argc
12961Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12962tracepoint is located.
12963@xref{Static Probe Points}.
12964
12965@item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12966@var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11.  Collects the @var{n}th argument
12967from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12968@xref{Static Probe Points}.
12969
12970@item $_sdata
12971@vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12972Collect static tracepoint marker specific data.  Only available for
12973static tracepoints.  @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12974Lists}.  On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12975instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call.  The
12976tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12977character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12978instrumented the program.  Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12979Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12980
12981@smallexample
12982 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12983 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12984@end smallexample
12985
12986In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12987@samp{hello $yourname}.  When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12988inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12989@value{GDBN}.
12990@end table
12991
12992You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12993with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12994arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12995
12996The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12997@code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12998particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12999to the first zero.  The upper bound is by default the value of the
13000@code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13001number, that is the upper bound instead.  So for instance
13002@samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13003@samp{mystr}.
13004
13005The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13006particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13007
13008@kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13009@item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13010Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.  This
13011command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions.  The results
13012are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13013state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13014values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13015action were used.
13016
13017@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13018@item while-stepping @var{n}
13019Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13020collecting new data after each step.  The @code{while-stepping}
13021command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13022(followed by its own @code{end} command):
13023
13024@smallexample
13025> while-stepping 12
13026  > collect $regs, myglobal
13027  > end
13028>
13029@end smallexample
13030
13031@noindent
13032Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13033@code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13034you need it.  You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13035@code{stepping}.
13036
13037@item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13038@kindex set default-collect
13039@cindex default collection action
13040This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13041hit.  It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13042to every tracepoint action list.  The expressions are parsed
13043individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13044@code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13045local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13046
13047@item show default-collect
13048@kindex show default-collect
13049Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13050tracepoint hit.
13051
13052@end table
13053
13054@node Listing Tracepoints
13055@subsection Listing Tracepoints
13056
13057@table @code
13058@kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13059@kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13060@cindex information about tracepoints
13061@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13062Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}.  If you don't
13063specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13064tracepoints defined so far.  The format is similar to that used for
13065@code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13066command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13067
13068A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13069tracing:
13070
13071@itemize @bullet
13072@item
13073its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13074
13075@item
13076the state about installed on target of each location
13077@end itemize
13078
13079@smallexample
13080(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13081Num     Type           Disp Enb Address    What
130821       tracepoint     keep y   0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13083        while-stepping 20
13084          collect globfoo, $regs
13085        end
13086        collect globfoo2
13087        end
13088        pass count 1200
130892       tracepoint     keep y   <MULTIPLE>
13090        collect $eip
130912.1                         y     0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13092        installed on target
130932.2                         y     0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13094        installed on target
130952.3                         y     <PENDING>  set_tracepoint
130963       tracepoint     keep y   0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13097        not installed on target
13098(@value{GDBP})
13099@end smallexample
13100
13101@noindent
13102This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13103@end table
13104
13105@node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13106@subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13107
13108@table @code
13109@kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13110@cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13111@item info static-tracepoint-markers
13112Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13113program.
13114
13115For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13116
13117@table @emph
13118@item Count
13119An incrementing counter, output to help readability.  This is not a
13120stable identifier.
13121@item ID
13122The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13123@item Enabled or Disabled
13124Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}.  @samp{n} identifies marks
13125that are not enabled.
13126@item Address
13127Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13128@item What
13129Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13130number.  If the debug information included in the program does not
13131allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13132will be left blank.
13133@end table
13134
13135@noindent
13136In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13137
13138@table @emph
13139@item Data
13140User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call.  In the
13141UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13142marker call.
13143@item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13144The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13145@end table
13146
13147@smallexample
13148(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13149Cnt ID         Enb Address            What
131501   ust/bar2   y   0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13151     Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13152     Probed by static tracepoints: #2
131532   ust/bar33  n   0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13154     Data: str %s
13155(@value{GDBP})
13156@end smallexample
13157@end table
13158
13159@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13160@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13161
13162@table @code
13163@kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13164@cindex start a new trace experiment
13165@cindex collected data discarded
13166@item tstart
13167This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13168It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13169trace buffer during the previous trace experiment.  If any arguments
13170are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13171experiment's state.  The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13172especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13173the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13174information, and so forth.
13175
13176@kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13177@cindex stop a running trace experiment
13178@item tstop
13179This command stops the trace experiment.  If any arguments are
13180supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note.  This is
13181useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13182instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13183needs to be stopped quickly.
13184
13185@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13186automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13187(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13188
13189@kindex tstatus
13190@cindex status of trace data collection
13191@cindex trace experiment, status of
13192@item tstatus
13193This command displays the status of the current trace data
13194collection.
13195@end table
13196
13197Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13198
13199@smallexample
13200(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13201(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13202Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13203> collect $regs,$locals,$args
13204> while-stepping 11
13205  > collect $regs
13206  > end
13207> end
13208(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13209	[time passes @dots{}]
13210(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13211@end smallexample
13212
13213@anchor{disconnected tracing}
13214@cindex disconnected tracing
13215You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13216@value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13217involuntarily.  For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13218ask what you want to do with the trace.  But for unexpected
13219terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13220unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13221@code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13222continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13223
13224@table @code
13225@item set disconnected-tracing on
13226@itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13227@kindex set disconnected-tracing
13228Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13229has disconnected from the target.  Note that @code{detach} or
13230@code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13231matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13232for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13233
13234@item show disconnected-tracing
13235@kindex show disconnected-tracing
13236Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13237
13238@end table
13239
13240When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13241still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13242meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons.  If it is running,
13243it will continue after reconnection.
13244
13245Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13246tracepoints in effect.  @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13247information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13248to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13249have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime.  If one of
13250the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13251debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13252which to specify that tracepoint.  This matching-up process is
13253necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13254created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13255
13256@cindex circular trace buffer
13257If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13258can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13259buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13260frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13261collecting.  This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13262hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13263buffer is full.  To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13264@samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on.  You can set this at any time,
13265including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13266buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13267the next run.
13268
13269@table @code
13270@item set circular-trace-buffer on
13271@itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13272@kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13273Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13274for trace data.  A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13275fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13276data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13277
13278@item show circular-trace-buffer
13279@kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13280Show the current choice for the trace buffer.  Note that this may not
13281match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13282match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13283for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13284
13285@end table
13286
13287@table @code
13288@item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13289@itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13290@kindex set trace-buffer-size
13291Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes.  Not all
13292targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13293the trace buffer, or some other limitation.  Set to a value of
13294@code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13295likes.  This is also the default.
13296
13297@item show trace-buffer-size
13298@kindex show trace-buffer-size
13299Show the current requested size for the trace buffer.  Note that this
13300will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13301and was able to handle the requested size.  For instance, if the
13302target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13303not reflect the change until the next run starts.  Use @code{tstatus}
13304to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13305@end table
13306
13307@table @code
13308@item set trace-user @var{text}
13309@kindex set trace-user
13310
13311@item show trace-user
13312@kindex show trace-user
13313
13314@item set trace-notes @var{text}
13315@kindex set trace-notes
13316Set the trace run's notes.
13317
13318@item show trace-notes
13319@kindex show trace-notes
13320Show the trace run's notes.
13321
13322@item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13323@kindex set trace-stop-notes
13324Set the trace run's stop notes.  The handling of the note is as for
13325@code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13326stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13327
13328@item show trace-stop-notes
13329@kindex show trace-stop-notes
13330Show the trace run's stop notes.
13331
13332@end table
13333
13334@node Tracepoint Restrictions
13335@subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13336
13337@cindex tracepoint restrictions
13338There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints.  As
13339described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13340without interaction from @value{GDBN}.  Thus the full capabilities of
13341the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13342examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13343collected.  The following items describe some common problems, but it
13344is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13345mentioned here.
13346
13347@itemize @bullet
13348
13349@item
13350Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues).  Thus
13351the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13352You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13353convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13354state variables).  Some language features may implicitly call
13355functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13356cannot be collected either.
13357
13358@item
13359Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13360@code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13361behave erratically.  The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13362instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13363may change (for instance it is loaded into a register).  The
13364tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13365variables that is correct for the tracepoint location.  When the
13366tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13367where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13368program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13369
13370@item
13371Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13372may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13373in a misleading way.
13374
13375@item
13376When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13377dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13378being pointed to.  However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13379not automatically collect the string.  You need to explicitly
13380dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13381collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to.  For example,
13382@code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13383by @code{ptr}.
13384
13385@item
13386It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13387tracepoint.  Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13388bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13389(adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13390target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13391Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13392using a trace frame.  The number of stack frames that can be examined
13393depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack.  Note that
13394if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13395stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13396invalid address.
13397
13398@item
13399If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13400infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13401the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13402for that tracepoint.  However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13403multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13404inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop.  In those cases
13405@value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13406it to zero.
13407
13408@end itemize
13409
13410@node Analyze Collected Data
13411@section Using the Collected Data
13412
13413After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13414for examining the trace data.  The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13415collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13416snapshot every time it single-steps.  All these snapshots are
13417consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13418examine them later.  The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13419specific trace snapshot.  When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13420snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13421registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13422rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13423debugged.  This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13424(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13425behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13426when the tracepoint occurred.  Any requests for data that are not in
13427the buffer will fail.
13428
13429@menu
13430* tfind::                       How to select a trace snapshot
13431* tdump::                       How to display all data for a snapshot
13432* save tracepoints::            How to save tracepoints for a future run
13433@end menu
13434
13435@node tfind
13436@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13437
13438@kindex tfind
13439@cindex select trace snapshot
13440@cindex find trace snapshot
13441The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13442@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13443counting from zero.  If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13444snapshot is selected.
13445
13446Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13447
13448@table @code
13449@item tfind start
13450Find the first snapshot in the buffer.  This is a synonym for
13451@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13452
13453@item tfind none
13454Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13455
13456@item tfind end
13457Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13458
13459@item tfind
13460No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13461one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13462
13463@item tfind -
13464Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one.  This permits
13465retracing earlier steps.
13466
13467@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13468Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}.  Search
13469proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot.  If no
13470argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13471for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13472
13473@item tfind pc @var{addr}
13474Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13475program counter.  Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13476snapshot.  If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13477snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13478
13479@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13480Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13481addresses (exclusive).
13482
13483@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13484Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13485@var{addr2} (inclusive).
13486
13487@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13488Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}.  If
13489the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13490that source file.  Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13491trace snapshot.  If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13492next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13493@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13494stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13495@end table
13496
13497The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13498designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer.  For
13499instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13500snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13501trace snapshot.  So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13502simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13503snapshots in order.  Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13504@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13505The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13506for the next source line executed.  The @code{tfind pc} command with
13507no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13508(PC) as the current frame.  The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13509no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13510tracepoint as the current one.
13511
13512In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13513these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13514scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13515you are interested in.  Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13516registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13517
13518@smallexample
13519(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13520(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13521> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13522          $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13523> tfind
13524> end
13525
13526Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13527Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13528Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13529Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13530Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13531Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13532Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13533Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13534Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13535Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13536Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13537@end smallexample
13538
13539Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13540the buffer:
13541
13542@smallexample
13543(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13544(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13545> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13546> tfind line
13547> end
13548
13549Frame 0, X = 1
13550Frame 7, X = 2
13551Frame 13, X = 255
13552@end smallexample
13553
13554@node tdump
13555@subsection @code{tdump}
13556@kindex tdump
13557@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13558@cindex tracepoint data, display
13559
13560This command takes no arguments.  It prints all the data collected at
13561the current trace snapshot.
13562
13563@smallexample
13564(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13565(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13566Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13567> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13568> end
13569
13570(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13571
13572(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13573#0  gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13574at gdb_test.c:444
13575444        printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13576
13577(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13578Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13579d0             0xc4aa0085       -995491707
13580d1             0x18     24
13581d2             0x80     128
13582d3             0x33     51
13583d4             0x71aea3d        119204413
13584d5             0x22     34
13585d6             0xe0     224
13586d7             0x380035 3670069
13587a0             0x19e24a 1696330
13588a1             0x3000668        50333288
13589a2             0x100    256
13590a3             0x322000 3284992
13591a4             0x3000698        50333336
13592a5             0x1ad3cc 1758156
13593fp             0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13594sp             0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13595ps             0x0      0
13596pc             0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13597fpcontrol      0x0      0
13598fpstatus       0x0      0
13599fpiaddr        0x0      0
13600p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13601p1 = (void *) 0x11
13602p2 = (void *) 0x22
13603p3 = (void *) 0x33
13604p4 = (void *) 0x44
13605p5 = (void *) 0x55
13606p6 = (void *) 0x66
13607gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13608
13609(@value{GDBP})
13610@end smallexample
13611
13612@code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13613actions and printing the value of each expression listed.  So
13614@code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13615actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13616
13617Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13618uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13619frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13620collected while stepping.  This allows it to correctly choose whether
13621to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13622body of the while-stepping loop.  However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13623then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13624list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13625same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13626@c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13627
13628@node save tracepoints
13629@subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13630@kindex save tracepoints
13631@kindex save-tracepoints
13632@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13633
13634This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13635their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13636suitable for use in a later debugging session.  To read the saved
13637tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13638Files}).  The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13639alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13640
13641@node Tracepoint Variables
13642@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13643@cindex tracepoint variables
13644@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13645
13646@table @code
13647@vindex $trace_frame
13648@item (int) $trace_frame
13649The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13650snapshot is selected.
13651
13652@vindex $tracepoint
13653@item (int) $tracepoint
13654The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13655
13656@vindex $trace_line
13657@item (int) $trace_line
13658The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13659
13660@vindex $trace_file
13661@item (char []) $trace_file
13662The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13663
13664@vindex $trace_func
13665@item (char []) $trace_func
13666The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13667@end table
13668
13669Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13670use @code{output} instead.
13671
13672Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13673stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13674data.  Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13675which are managed by the target.
13676
13677@smallexample
13678(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13679
13680(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13681> output $trace_file
13682> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13683> tfind
13684> end
13685@end smallexample
13686
13687@node Trace Files
13688@section Using Trace Files
13689@cindex trace files
13690
13691In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13692longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13693for a different activity.  To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13694dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13695of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13696
13697@table @code
13698
13699@kindex tsave
13700@item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13701@itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13702Save the trace data to @var{filename}.  By default, this command
13703assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13704necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13705then save it.  If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13706optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13707the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13708more efficient if the trace buffer is very large.  (Note, however, that
13709@code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13710By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13711You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13712format.  The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13713that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools.  Please go to
13714@indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13715
13716@kindex target tfile
13717@kindex tfile
13718@kindex target ctf
13719@kindex ctf
13720@item target tfile @var{filename}
13721@itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13722Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13723a source of trace data.  Commands that examine data work as they do with
13724a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13725@code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13726the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13727Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13728the host.
13729
13730@smallexample
13731(@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13732(@value{GDBP}) tfind
13733Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
1373439            ++a;  /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13735(@value{GDBP}) tdump
13736Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13737i = 0
13738a = 0
13739b = 1 '\001'
13740c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13741d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13742(@value{GDBP}) p b
13743$1 = 1
13744@end smallexample
13745
13746@end table
13747
13748@node Overlays
13749@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13750@cindex overlays
13751
13752If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13753memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13754problem.  @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13755use overlays.
13756
13757@menu
13758* How Overlays Work::              A general explanation of overlays.
13759* Overlay Commands::               Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13760* Automatic Overlay Debugging::    @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13761                                   mapped by asking the inferior.
13762* Overlay Sample Program::         A sample program using overlays.
13763@end menu
13764
13765@node How Overlays Work
13766@section How Overlays Work
13767@cindex mapped overlays
13768@cindex unmapped overlays
13769@cindex load address, overlay's
13770@cindex mapped address
13771@cindex overlay area
13772
13773Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13774kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13775other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13776management hardware, for example.  Suppose further that you want to
13777adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13778
13779One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13780independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13781@dfn{overlays}.  Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13782their machine code in the larger memory.  Place your main program in
13783instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13784largest overlay as well.
13785
13786Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13787overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13788for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13789there.
13790
13791@c NB:  In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13792@c size of all overlays.  This is intentional to remind the developer
13793@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13794
13795@smallexample
13796@group
13797    Data             Instruction            Larger
13798Address Space       Address Space        Address Space
13799+-----------+       +-----------+        +-----------+
13800|           |       |           |        |           |
13801+-----------+       +-----------+        +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13802| program   |       |   main    |   .----| overlay 1 | load address
13803| variables |       |  program  |   |    +-----------+
13804| and heap  |       |           |   |    |           |
13805+-----------+       |           |   |    +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13806|           |       +-----------+   |    |           | load address
13807+-----------+       |           |   |  .-| overlay 2 |
13808                    |           |   |  | |           |
13809         mapped --->+-----------+   |  | +-----------+
13810         address    |           |   |  | |           |
13811                    |  overlay  | <-'  | |           |
13812                    |   area    |  <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13813                    |           | <---.  |           | load address
13814                    +-----------+     `--| overlay 3 |
13815                    |           |        |           |
13816                    +-----------+        |           |
13817                                         +-----------+
13818                                         |           |
13819                                         +-----------+
13820
13821                    @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13822@end group
13823@end smallexample
13824
13825The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13826and instruction address spaces.  To map an overlay, the program copies
13827its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13828Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13829may be mapped at a time.  For a system with a single address space for
13830data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13831program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13832program and the overlay area.
13833
13834An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13835@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13836instruction memory.  An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13837in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13838is its address in the larger memory.  The mapped address is also called
13839the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13840called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13841
13842Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13843program to limited instruction memory.  They introduce a new set of
13844global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13845
13846@itemize @bullet
13847
13848@item
13849Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13850must make sure that overlay is actually mapped.  Otherwise, the call or
13851return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13852overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13853
13854@item
13855If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13856will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13857your program's performance.
13858
13859@item
13860The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13861overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13862mapped address.  However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13863and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13864You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13865addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13866ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13867
13868@item
13869The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13870to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13871instruction and data spaces.
13872
13873@end itemize
13874
13875The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13876improved in many ways:
13877
13878@itemize @bullet
13879
13880@item
13881If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13882hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13883contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13884This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13885area in the usual way.
13886
13887@item
13888If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13889overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13890
13891@item
13892You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions.  In
13893general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13894code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13895return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13896the data.  Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13897must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13898different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13899
13900@end itemize
13901
13902
13903@node Overlay Commands
13904@section Overlay Commands
13905
13906To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13907correspond to a separate section of the executable file.  The section's
13908virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13909mapped and load addresses.  Identifying overlays with sections allows
13910@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13911variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13912
13913@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13914you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}.  The commands are:
13915
13916@table @code
13917@item overlay off
13918@kindex overlay
13919Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.  When overlay support is
13920disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13921always present at their mapped addresses.  By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13922overlay support is disabled.
13923
13924@item overlay manual
13925@cindex manual overlay debugging
13926Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging.  In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13927relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13928using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13929commands described below.
13930
13931@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13932@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13933@cindex map an overlay
13934Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13935be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.  When an
13936overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13937functions and variables at their mapped addresses.  @value{GDBN} assumes
13938that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13939@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13940
13941@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13942@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13943@cindex unmap an overlay
13944Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13945must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13946When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13947overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13948
13949@item overlay auto
13950Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging.  In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13951consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13952to see which overlays are mapped.  For details, see @ref{Automatic
13953Overlay Debugging}.
13954
13955@item overlay load-target
13956@itemx overlay load
13957@cindex reloading the overlay table
13958Re-read the overlay table from the inferior.  Normally, @value{GDBN}
13959re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13960stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13961overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}.  This command is only
13962useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13963
13964@item overlay list-overlays
13965@itemx overlay list
13966@cindex listing mapped overlays
13967Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13968addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13969
13970@end table
13971
13972Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13973of the function the address falls in:
13974
13975@smallexample
13976(@value{GDBP}) print main
13977$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13978@end smallexample
13979@noindent
13980When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13981unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13982asterisks around them.  For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13983unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13984
13985@smallexample
13986(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13987No sections are mapped.
13988(@value{GDBP}) print foo
13989$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13990@end smallexample
13991@noindent
13992When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13993name normally:
13994
13995@smallexample
13996(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13997Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13998        mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13999(@value{GDBP}) print foo
14000$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14001@end smallexample
14002
14003When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14004address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14005overlay is mapped.  This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14006@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14007code.  However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14008
14009@itemize @bullet
14010@item
14011@cindex breakpoints in overlays
14012@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14013You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14014@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14015@item
14016@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14017unmapped overlays.  However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14018overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14019you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14020breakpoints properly.
14021@end itemize
14022
14023
14024@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14025@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14026@cindex automatic overlay debugging
14027
14028@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14029are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14030inferior.  If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14031@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14032looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14033current state of the overlays.
14034
14035Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14036@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14037
14038@table @asis
14039
14040@item @code{_ovly_table}:
14041This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14042
14043@smallexample
14044struct
14045@{
14046  /* The overlay's mapped address.  */
14047  unsigned long vma;
14048
14049  /* The size of the overlay, in bytes.  */
14050  unsigned long size;
14051
14052  /* The overlay's load address.  */
14053  unsigned long lma;
14054
14055  /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14056     zero otherwise.  */
14057  unsigned long mapped;
14058@}
14059@end smallexample
14060
14061@item @code{_novlys}:
14062This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14063number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14064
14065@end table
14066
14067To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14068looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14069@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14070executable file.  When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14071the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14072currently mapped.
14073
14074In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14075@code{_ovly_debug_event}.  If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14076will silently set a breakpoint there.  If the overlay manager then
14077calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14078will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14079are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14080in overlays.  This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14081overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14082are not being executed.
14083
14084@node Overlay Sample Program
14085@section Overlay Sample Program
14086@cindex overlay example program
14087
14088When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14089at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14090addresses.  To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14091Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}).  Unfortunately,
14092since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14093architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14094portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14095
14096However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14097program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14098suite.  The program consists of the following files from
14099@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14100
14101@table @file
14102@item overlays.c
14103The main program file.
14104@item ovlymgr.c
14105A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14106@item foo.c
14107@itemx bar.c
14108@itemx baz.c
14109@itemx grbx.c
14110Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14111@item d10v.ld
14112@itemx m32r.ld
14113Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14114and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14115@end table
14116
14117You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14118cross-compiler like this:
14119
14120@smallexample
14121$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14122$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14123$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14124$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14125$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14126$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14127$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14128                  baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14129@end smallexample
14130
14131The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14132you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14133target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14134
14135
14136@node Languages
14137@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14138@cindex languages
14139
14140Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14141rarely expressed in the same manner.  For instance, in ANSI C,
14142dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14143Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}.  Values can also be
14144represented (and displayed) differently.  Hex numbers in C appear as
14145@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14146
14147@cindex working language
14148Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14149allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14150native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14151consistent with the syntax of your program's native language.  The
14152language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14153language}.
14154
14155@menu
14156* Setting::                     Switching between source languages
14157* Show::                        Displaying the language
14158* Checks::                      Type and range checks
14159* Supported Languages::         Supported languages
14160* Unsupported Languages::       Unsupported languages
14161@end menu
14162
14163@node Setting
14164@section Switching Between Source Languages
14165
14166There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14167set it automatically, or select it manually yourself.  You can use the
14168@code{set language} command for either purpose.  On startup, @value{GDBN}
14169defaults to setting the language automatically.  The working language is
14170used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14171are printed, etc.
14172
14173In addition to the working language, every source file that
14174@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language.  For some object
14175file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14176source file is in.  However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14177language from the name of the file.  The language of a source file
14178controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14179show each frame appropriately for its own language.  There is no way to
14180set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14181set the language associated with a filename extension.  @xref{Show, ,
14182Displaying the Language}.
14183
14184This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14185as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14186another language.  In that case, make the
14187program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14188@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14189program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14190
14191@menu
14192* Filenames::                   Filename extensions and languages.
14193* Manually::                    Setting the working language manually
14194* Automatically::               Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14195@end menu
14196
14197@node Filenames
14198@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14199
14200If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14201@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14202
14203@table @file
14204@item .ada
14205@itemx .ads
14206@itemx .adb
14207@itemx .a
14208Ada source file.
14209
14210@item .c
14211C source file
14212
14213@item .C
14214@itemx .cc
14215@itemx .cp
14216@itemx .cpp
14217@itemx .cxx
14218@itemx .c++
14219C@t{++} source file
14220
14221@item .d
14222D source file
14223
14224@item .m
14225Objective-C source file
14226
14227@item .f
14228@itemx .F
14229Fortran source file
14230
14231@item .mod
14232Modula-2 source file
14233
14234@item .s
14235@itemx .S
14236Assembler source file.  This actually behaves almost like C, but
14237@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14238@end table
14239
14240In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14241extension.  @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14242
14243@node Manually
14244@subsection Setting the Working Language
14245
14246If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14247expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14248your program.
14249
14250@kindex set language
14251If you wish, you may set the language manually.  To do this, issue the
14252command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14253a language, such as
14254@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14255For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14256
14257Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14258language automatically.  This can lead to confusion if you try
14259to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14260source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14261languages---but means different things.  For instance, if the current
14262source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14263command such as:
14264
14265@smallexample
14266print a = b + c
14267@end smallexample
14268
14269@noindent
14270might not have the effect you intended.  In C, this means to add
14271@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}.  The result
14272printed would be the value of @code{a}.  In Modula-2, this means to compare
14273@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14274
14275@node Automatically
14276@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14277
14278To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14279@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}.  @value{GDBN}
14280then infers the working language.  That is, when your program stops in a
14281frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14282working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14283frame.  If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14284or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14285does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14286not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14287
14288This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14289entirely in one source language.  However, program modules and libraries
14290written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14291a different source language.  Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14292case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14293
14294@node Show
14295@section Displaying the Language
14296
14297The following commands help you find out which language is the
14298working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14299
14300@table @code
14301@item show language
14302@anchor{show language}
14303@kindex show language
14304Display the current working language.  This is the
14305language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14306build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14307
14308@item info frame
14309@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14310Display the source language for this frame.  This language becomes the
14311working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14312@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14313information listed here.
14314
14315@item info source
14316@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14317Display the source language of this source file.
14318@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14319information listed here.
14320@end table
14321
14322In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14323not in the standard list.  You can then set the extension associated
14324with a language explicitly:
14325
14326@table @code
14327@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14328@kindex set extension-language
14329Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14330assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14331
14332@item info extensions
14333@kindex info extensions
14334List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14335@end table
14336
14337@node Checks
14338@section Type and Range Checking
14339
14340Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14341errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks.  These include
14342checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14343sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time.  Checks such as
14344these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14345by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14346errors when your program is running.
14347
14348By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14349rules of the current source language.  Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14350the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14351into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14352
14353@menu
14354* Type Checking::               An overview of type checking
14355* Range Checking::              An overview of range checking
14356@end menu
14357
14358@cindex type checking
14359@cindex checks, type
14360@node Type Checking
14361@subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14362
14363Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14364arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14365otherwise an error occurs.  These checks prevent type mismatch
14366errors from ever causing any run-time problems.  For example,
14367
14368@smallexample
14369int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return  b ? 1 : 2; @}
14370
14371(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14372$1 = 2
14373@exdent but
14374(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14375Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14376@end smallexample
14377
14378The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14379@samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14380
14381For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14382@value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14383to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14384When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14385expressions like the second example above.
14386
14387Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14388related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14389For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14390a @code{struct foo}.  These particular type errors have nothing to do
14391with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14392little sense to evaluate anyway.
14393
14394@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14395
14396@kindex set check type
14397@kindex show check type
14398@table @code
14399@item set check type on
14400@itemx set check type off
14401Set strict type checking on or off.  If any type mismatches occur in
14402evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14403message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14404
14405@item show check type
14406Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14407is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14408@end table
14409
14410@cindex range checking
14411@cindex checks, range
14412@node Range Checking
14413@subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14414
14415In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14416bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks.  Such range
14417checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14418computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14419not exceed the bounds of the array.
14420
14421For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14422@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14423always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14424warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14425
14426A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14427array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14428of any type.  Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14429error.  In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14430result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14431the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14432
14433@smallexample
14434@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14435@end smallexample
14436
14437This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14438specific to individual compilers or machines.  @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14439Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14440
14441@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14442
14443@kindex set check range
14444@kindex show check range
14445@table @code
14446@item set check range auto
14447Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14448@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14449each language.
14450
14451@item set check range on
14452@itemx set check range off
14453Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14454current working language.  A warning is issued if the setting does not
14455match the language default.  If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14456then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14457
14458@item set check range warn
14459Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14460but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway.  Evaluating the
14461expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14462memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14463systems).
14464
14465@item show range
14466Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14467being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14468@end table
14469
14470@node Supported Languages
14471@section Supported Languages
14472
14473@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14474OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14475@c This is false ...
14476Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14477language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14478and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14479,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14480language.
14481
14482The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14483supported by @value{GDBN}.  These sections are not meant to be language
14484tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14485@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14486formats should look like for different languages.  There are many good
14487books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14488language reference or tutorial.
14489
14490@menu
14491* C::                           C and C@t{++}
14492* D::                           D
14493* Go::                          Go
14494* Objective-C::                 Objective-C
14495* OpenCL C::                    OpenCL C
14496* Fortran::                     Fortran
14497* Pascal::                      Pascal
14498* Rust::                        Rust
14499* Modula-2::                    Modula-2
14500* Ada::                         Ada
14501@end menu
14502
14503@node C
14504@subsection C and C@t{++}
14505
14506@cindex C and C@t{++}
14507@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14508
14509Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14510to both languages.  Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14511together.
14512
14513@cindex C@t{++}
14514@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14515@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14516The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14517compiler and @value{GDBN}.  Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14518effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14519C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14520compiler (@code{aCC}).
14521
14522@menu
14523* C Operators::                 C and C@t{++} operators
14524* C Constants::                 C and C@t{++} constants
14525* C Plus Plus Expressions::     C@t{++} expressions
14526* C Defaults::                  Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14527* C Checks::                    C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14528* Debugging C::                 @value{GDBN} and C
14529* Debugging C Plus Plus::       @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14530* Decimal Floating Point::      Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14531@end menu
14532
14533@node C Operators
14534@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14535
14536@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14537
14538Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
14539@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures.  Operators are
14540often defined on groups of types.
14541
14542For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14543
14544@itemize @bullet
14545
14546@item
14547@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14548specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14549
14550@item
14551@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14552@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14553
14554@item
14555@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14556
14557@item
14558@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14559
14560@end itemize
14561
14562@noindent
14563The following operators are supported.  They are listed here
14564in order of increasing precedence:
14565
14566@table @code
14567@item ,
14568The comma or sequencing operator.  Expressions in a comma-separated list
14569are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14570expression being the last expression evaluated.
14571
14572@item =
14573Assignment.  The value of an assignment expression is the value
14574assigned.  Defined on scalar types.
14575
14576@item @var{op}=
14577Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14578and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14579@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.  The operator
14580@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14581@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14582
14583@item ?:
14584The ternary operator.  @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14585of as:  if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}.  The argument @var{a}
14586should be of an integral type.
14587
14588@item ||
14589Logical @sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
14590
14591@item &&
14592Logical @sc{and}.  Defined on integral types.
14593
14594@item |
14595Bitwise @sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
14596
14597@item ^
14598Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
14599
14600@item &
14601Bitwise @sc{and}.  Defined on integral types.
14602
14603@item ==@r{, }!=
14604Equality and inequality.  Defined on scalar types.  The value of these
14605expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14606
14607@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14608Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14609Defined on scalar types.  The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14610and non-zero for true.
14611
14612@item <<@r{, }>>
14613left shift, and right shift.  Defined on integral types.
14614
14615@item @@
14616The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14617
14618@item +@r{, }-
14619Addition and subtraction.  Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14620pointer types.
14621
14622@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14623Multiplication, division, and modulus.  Multiplication and division are
14624defined on integral and floating-point types.  Modulus is defined on
14625integral types.
14626
14627@item ++@r{, }--
14628Increment and decrement.  When appearing before a variable, the
14629operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14630when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14631operation takes place.
14632
14633@item *
14634Pointer dereferencing.  Defined on pointer types.  Same precedence as
14635@code{++}.
14636
14637@item &
14638Address operator.  Defined on variables.  Same precedence as @code{++}.
14639
14640For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14641allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14642to examine the address
14643where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14644stored.
14645
14646@item -
14647Negative.  Defined on integral and floating-point types.  Same
14648precedence as @code{++}.
14649
14650@item !
14651Logical negation.  Defined on integral types.  Same precedence as
14652@code{++}.
14653
14654@item ~
14655Bitwise complement operator.  Defined on integral types.  Same precedence as
14656@code{++}.
14657
14658
14659@item .@r{, }->
14660Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member.  For convenience,
14661@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14662pointer based on the stored type information.
14663Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14664
14665@item .*@r{, }->*
14666Dereferences of pointers to members.
14667
14668@item []
14669Array indexing.  @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14670@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}.  Same precedence as @code{->}.
14671
14672@item ()
14673Function parameter list.  Same precedence as @code{->}.
14674
14675@item ::
14676C@t{++} scope resolution operator.  Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14677and @code{class} types.
14678
14679@item ::
14680Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14681(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  Same precedence as @code{::},
14682above.
14683@end table
14684
14685If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14686attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14687predefined meaning.
14688
14689@node C Constants
14690@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14691
14692@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14693
14694@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14695following ways:
14696
14697@itemize @bullet
14698@item
14699Integer constants are a sequence of digits.  Octal constants are
14700specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14701by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}.  Constants may also end with a letter
14702@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14703@code{long} value.
14704
14705@item
14706Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14707point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14708exponent.  An exponent is of the form:
14709@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14710sequence of digits.  The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14711A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14712@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14713the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14714a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14715constant.
14716
14717@item
14718Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14719integral equivalents.
14720
14721@item
14722Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14723(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14724(usually its @sc{ascii} value).  Within quotes, the single character may
14725be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14726the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14727of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14728@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14729@samp{\n} for newline.
14730
14731Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14732constant with @samp{L}, as in C.  For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14733form of @samp{x}.  The target wide character set is used when
14734computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14735
14736@item
14737String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14738double quotes (@code{"}).  Any valid character constant (as described
14739above) may appear.  Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14740a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14741characters.
14742
14743Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14744with @samp{L}, as in C.  The target wide character set is used when
14745computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14746
14747@item
14748Pointer constants are an integral value.  You can also write pointers
14749to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14750
14751@item
14752Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14753and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14754integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14755and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14756@end itemize
14757
14758@node C Plus Plus Expressions
14759@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14760
14761@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14762@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14763
14764@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14765@cindex C@t{++} compilers
14766@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14767@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14768@quotation
14769@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14770the proper compiler and the proper debug format.  Currently,
14771@value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14772with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible.  The DWARF
14773debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14774popular platforms.  Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14775work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14776code.  @xref{Compilation}.
14777@end quotation
14778
14779@enumerate
14780
14781@cindex member functions
14782@item
14783Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14784
14785@smallexample
14786count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14787@end smallexample
14788
14789@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14790@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14791@item
14792While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14793expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14794that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14795pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.  @code{using}
14796declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14797
14798@cindex call overloaded functions
14799@cindex overloaded functions, calling
14800@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14801@item
14802You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14803call to the right definition, with some restrictions.  @value{GDBN} does not
14804perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14805calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14806in the program.  It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14807default arguments.
14808
14809It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14810promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14811class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14812functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14813number of function arguments.
14814
14815Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14816@code{set overload-resolution off}.  @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14817,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14818
14819You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14820explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14821@smallexample
14822p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14823@end smallexample
14824
14825The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14826see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14827
14828@cindex reference declarations
14829@item
14830@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14831references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14832source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14833
14834In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14835reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14836avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14837The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14838you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14839
14840@item
14841@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14842expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do.  Since
14843one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14844necessary, for example in an expression like
14845@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}.  @value{GDBN} also allows
14846resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14847debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14848
14849@item
14850@value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14851specification.
14852@end enumerate
14853
14854@node C Defaults
14855@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14856
14857@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14858
14859If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14860defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14861C or C@t{++}.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14862selects the working language.
14863
14864If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14865recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14866@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14867these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14868@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14869for further details.
14870
14871@node C Checks
14872@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14873
14874@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14875
14876By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14877checking is used.  However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14878will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14879constants to pointers.
14880
14881Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations.  Array
14882indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14883that is not itself an array.
14884
14885@node Debugging C
14886@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14887
14888The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14889the @code{union} type.  When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14890inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed.  Otherwise, it
14891appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14892
14893The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14894with pointers and a memory allocation function.  @xref{Expressions,
14895,Expressions}.
14896
14897@node Debugging C Plus Plus
14898@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14899
14900@cindex commands for C@t{++}
14901
14902Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14903designed specifically for use with C@t{++}.  Here is a summary:
14904
14905@table @code
14906@cindex break in overloaded functions
14907@item @r{breakpoint menus}
14908When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14909@value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14910locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14911@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14912
14913@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14914@item rbreak @var{regex}
14915Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14916breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14917classes.
14918@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14919
14920@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14921@item catch throw
14922@itemx catch rethrow
14923@itemx catch catch
14924Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands.  @xref{Set
14925Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14926
14927@cindex inheritance
14928@item ptype @var{typename}
14929Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14930@var{typename}.
14931@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14932
14933@item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14934The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14935method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}.  This shows
14936one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14937multiple inheritance is in use.
14938
14939@cindex C@t{++} demangling
14940@item demangle @var{name}
14941Demangle @var{name}.
14942@xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14943
14944@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14945@item set print demangle
14946@itemx show print demangle
14947@itemx set print asm-demangle
14948@itemx show print asm-demangle
14949Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14950displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14951@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14952
14953@item set print object
14954@itemx show print object
14955Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14956@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14957
14958@item set print vtbl
14959@itemx show print vtbl
14960Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14961@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14962(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14963ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14964
14965@kindex set overload-resolution
14966@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14967@item set overload-resolution on
14968Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation.  The default
14969is on.  For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14970and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14971using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14972Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14973If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14974
14975@item set overload-resolution off
14976Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation.  For
14977overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14978chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14979symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type.  For
14980overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14981searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14982argument types.
14983
14984@kindex show overload-resolution
14985@item show overload-resolution
14986Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14987
14988@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14989You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14990the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14991@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}.  You can
14992also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14993available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14994@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14995@end table
14996
14997@node Decimal Floating Point
14998@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14999@cindex decimal floating point format
15000
15001@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15002decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15003@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15004specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15005
15006There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15007Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15008PowerPC and S/390.  @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15009configured target.
15010
15011Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15012to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15013(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15014
15015In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15016point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15017underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15018
15019In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15020to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15021See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15022
15023@node D
15024@subsection D
15025
15026@cindex D
15027@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15028GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15029specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15030
15031@node Go
15032@subsection Go
15033
15034@cindex Go (programming language)
15035@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15036@file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15037
15038Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15039
15040@table @code
15041@cindex current Go package
15042@item The current Go package
15043The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15044specifying global variables and functions.
15045
15046For example, given the program:
15047
15048@example
15049package main
15050var myglob = "Shall we?"
15051func main () @{
15052  // ...
15053@}
15054@end example
15055
15056When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15057
15058@example
15059(gdb) p myglob
15060(gdb) p main.myglob
15061@end example
15062
15063@cindex builtin Go types
15064@item Builtin Go types
15065The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15066as a string.
15067
15068@cindex builtin Go functions
15069@item Builtin Go functions
15070The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15071function and handles it internally.
15072
15073@cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15074@item Restrictions on Go expressions
15075All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15076The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15077Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15078@end table
15079
15080@node Objective-C
15081@subsection Objective-C
15082
15083@cindex Objective-C
15084This section provides information about some commands and command
15085options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code.  See also
15086@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15087few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15088
15089@menu
15090* Method Names in Commands::
15091* The Print Command with Objective-C::
15092@end menu
15093
15094@node Method Names in Commands
15095@subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15096
15097The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15098names as line specifications:
15099
15100@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15101@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15102@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15103@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15104@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15105@itemize
15106@item @code{clear}
15107@item @code{break}
15108@item @code{info line}
15109@item @code{jump}
15110@item @code{list}
15111@end itemize
15112
15113A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15114
15115@smallexample
15116-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15117@end smallexample
15118
15119where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15120plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method.  The class
15121name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15122brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15123source code.  For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15124instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15125debugged, enter:
15126
15127@smallexample
15128break -[Fruit create]
15129@end smallexample
15130
15131To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15132enter:
15133
15134@smallexample
15135list +[NSText initialize]
15136@end smallexample
15137
15138In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15139required.  In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15140sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search.  It
15141is also possible to specify just a method name:
15142
15143@smallexample
15144break create
15145@end smallexample
15146
15147You must specify the complete method name, including any colons.  If
15148your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15149you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15150method.  Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15151none apply.
15152
15153As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15154@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15155
15156@smallexample
15157clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15158@end smallexample
15159
15160@node The Print Command with Objective-C
15161@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15162@cindex Objective-C, print objects
15163@kindex print-object
15164@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15165
15166The print command has also been extended to accept methods.  For example:
15167
15168@smallexample
15169print -[@var{object} hash]
15170@end smallexample
15171
15172@cindex print an Objective-C object description
15173@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15174@noindent
15175will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15176and print the result.  Also, an additional command has been added,
15177@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15178the description of an object.  However, this command may only work
15179with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15180function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15181
15182@node OpenCL C
15183@subsection OpenCL C
15184
15185@cindex OpenCL C
15186This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15187
15188@menu
15189* OpenCL C Datatypes::
15190* OpenCL C Expressions::
15191* OpenCL C Operators::
15192@end menu
15193
15194@node OpenCL C Datatypes
15195@subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15196
15197@cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15198@value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15199by OpenCL 1.1.  In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15200data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15201extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15202
15203@node OpenCL C Expressions
15204@subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15205
15206@cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15207@value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15208lvalue where possible.  Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15209supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15210
15211@node OpenCL C Operators
15212@subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15213
15214@cindex OpenCL C Operators
15215@value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15216vector data types.
15217
15218@node Fortran
15219@subsection Fortran
15220@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15221
15222@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15223currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15224
15225@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15226Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15227among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15228functions.  When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15229will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15230underscore.
15231
15232@menu
15233* Fortran Operators::           Fortran operators and expressions
15234* Fortran Defaults::            Default settings for Fortran
15235* Special Fortran Commands::    Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15236@end menu
15237
15238@node Fortran Operators
15239@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15240
15241@cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15242
15243Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
15244@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15245arithmetic types.  Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15246
15247@table @code
15248@item **
15249The exponentiation operator.  It raises the first operand to the power
15250of the second one.
15251
15252@item :
15253The range operator.  Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15254represent a section of array.
15255
15256@item %
15257The access component operator.  Normally used to access elements in derived
15258types.  Also suitable for unions.  As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15259this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15260union type.
15261@end table
15262
15263@node Fortran Defaults
15264@subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15265
15266@cindex Fortran Defaults
15267
15268Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15269default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols.  You can
15270change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15271@ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15272
15273@node Special Fortran Commands
15274@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15275
15276@cindex Special Fortran commands
15277
15278@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15279such as displaying common blocks.
15280
15281@table @code
15282@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15283@kindex info common
15284@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15285This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15286block whose name is @var{common-name}.  With no argument, the names of
15287all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15288printed.
15289@end table
15290
15291@node Pascal
15292@subsection Pascal
15293
15294@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15295Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15296nested functions does not currently work.  @value{GDBN} does not support
15297entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15298syntax.
15299
15300The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15301controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15302@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15303
15304@node Rust
15305@subsection Rust
15306
15307@value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15308Programming Language}.  Type- and value-printing, and expression
15309parsing, are reasonably complete.  However, there are a few
15310peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15311
15312@itemize @bullet
15313@item
15314Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15315crate.  Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15316crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15317
15318That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15319crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15320to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15321@samp{B}.
15322
15323As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15324items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15325
15326@item
15327Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15328expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15329For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15330@samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15331@samp{K::x::y}.
15332
15333However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15334debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15335circumvent this.  To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15336a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15337scope.
15338
15339In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15340the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15341
15342@item
15343The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15344expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15345
15346@item
15347Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15348
15349@item
15350The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15351@code{Drop} trait.  Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15352never be destroyed.
15353
15354@item
15355@value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics.  In order
15356to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15357will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15358
15359@item
15360@value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust.  In most
15361cases this does not cause any problems.  However, in an expression
15362context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15363invalid results.  This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15364operator between the function name and its generic arguments.  For
15365example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15366@code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15367@code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15368
15369@item
15370As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15371the debugging information it generates.  These holes prevent certain
15372features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15373@itemize @bullet
15374
15375@item
15376Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15377
15378@item
15379Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15380
15381@item
15382Operator overloading is not implemented.
15383
15384@item
15385When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15386type names.
15387
15388@item
15389The type @code{Self} is not available.
15390
15391@item
15392@code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15393available in the crate.
15394@end itemize
15395@end itemize
15396
15397@node Modula-2
15398@subsection Modula-2
15399
15400@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15401
15402The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15403output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15404developed).  Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15405attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15406to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15407table.
15408
15409@cindex expressions in Modula-2
15410@menu
15411* M2 Operators::                Built-in operators
15412* Built-In Func/Proc::          Built-in functions and procedures
15413* M2 Constants::                Modula-2 constants
15414* M2 Types::                    Modula-2 types
15415* M2 Defaults::                 Default settings for Modula-2
15416* Deviations::                  Deviations from standard Modula-2
15417* M2 Checks::                   Modula-2 type and range checks
15418* M2 Scope::                    The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15419* GDB/M2::                      @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15420@end menu
15421
15422@node M2 Operators
15423@subsubsection Operators
15424@cindex Modula-2 operators
15425
15426Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
15427@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures.  Operators are
15428often defined on groups of types.  For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15429following definitions hold:
15430
15431@itemize @bullet
15432
15433@item
15434@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15435their subranges.
15436
15437@item
15438@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15439
15440@item
15441@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15442
15443@item
15444@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15445@var{type}}.
15446
15447@item
15448@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15449
15450@item
15451@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15452
15453@item
15454@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15455@end itemize
15456
15457@noindent
15458The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15459increasing precedence:
15460
15461@table @code
15462@item ,
15463Function argument or array index separator.
15464
15465@item :=
15466Assignment.  The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15467@var{value}.
15468
15469@item <@r{, }>
15470Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15471types.
15472
15473@item <=@r{, }>=
15474Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15475on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15476set types.  Same precedence as @code{<}.
15477
15478@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15479Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15480Same precedence as @code{<}.  In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15481available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15482comment character.
15483
15484@item IN
15485Set membership.  Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15486Same precedence as @code{<}.
15487
15488@item OR
15489Boolean disjunction.  Defined on boolean types.
15490
15491@item AND@r{, }&
15492Boolean conjunction.  Defined on boolean types.
15493
15494@item @@
15495The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15496
15497@item +@r{, }-
15498Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15499and difference on set types.
15500
15501@item *
15502Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15503on set types.
15504
15505@item /
15506Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15507types.  Same precedence as @code{*}.
15508
15509@item DIV@r{, }MOD
15510Integer division and remainder.  Defined on integral types.  Same
15511precedence as @code{*}.
15512
15513@item -
15514Negative.  Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15515
15516@item ^
15517Pointer dereferencing.  Defined on pointer types.
15518
15519@item NOT
15520Boolean negation.  Defined on boolean types.  Same precedence as
15521@code{^}.
15522
15523@item .
15524@code{RECORD} field selector.  Defined on @code{RECORD} data.  Same
15525precedence as @code{^}.
15526
15527@item []
15528Array indexing.  Defined on @code{ARRAY} data.  Same precedence as @code{^}.
15529
15530@item ()
15531Procedure argument list.  Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects.  Same precedence
15532as @code{^}.
15533
15534@item ::@r{, }.
15535@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15536@end table
15537
15538@quotation
15539@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15540treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15541@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15542@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15543@end quotation
15544
15545
15546@node Built-In Func/Proc
15547@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15548@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15549
15550Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15551In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15552
15553@table @var
15554
15555@item a
15556represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15557
15558@item c
15559represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15560
15561@item i
15562represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15563
15564@item m
15565represents an identifier that belongs to a set.  Generally used in the
15566same function with the metavariable @var{s}.  The type of @var{s} should
15567be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15568
15569@item n
15570represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15571
15572@item r
15573represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15574
15575@item t
15576represents a type.
15577
15578@item v
15579represents a variable.
15580
15581@item x
15582represents a variable or constant of one of many types.  See the
15583explanation of the function for details.
15584@end table
15585
15586All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15587
15588@table @code
15589@item ABS(@var{n})
15590Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15591
15592@item CAP(@var{c})
15593If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15594equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15595
15596@item CHR(@var{i})
15597Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15598
15599@item DEC(@var{v})
15600Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one.  Returns the new value.
15601
15602@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15603Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}.  Returns the
15604new value.
15605
15606@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15607Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}.  Returns the new
15608set.
15609
15610@item FLOAT(@var{i})
15611Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15612
15613@item HIGH(@var{a})
15614Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15615
15616@item INC(@var{v})
15617Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one.  Returns the new value.
15618
15619@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15620Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}.  Returns the
15621new value.
15622
15623@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15624Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15625there.  Returns the new set.
15626
15627@item MAX(@var{t})
15628Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15629
15630@item MIN(@var{t})
15631Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15632
15633@item ODD(@var{i})
15634Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15635
15636@item ORD(@var{x})
15637Returns the ordinal value of its argument.  For example, the ordinal
15638value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15639the @sc{ascii} character set).  The argument @var{x} must be of an
15640ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15641
15642@item SIZE(@var{x})
15643Returns the size of its argument.  The argument @var{x} can be a
15644variable or a type.
15645
15646@item TRUNC(@var{r})
15647Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15648
15649@item TSIZE(@var{x})
15650Returns the size of its argument.  The argument @var{x} can be a
15651variable or a type.
15652
15653@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15654Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15655@end table
15656
15657@quotation
15658@emph{Warning:}  Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15659@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15660an error.
15661@end quotation
15662
15663@cindex Modula-2 constants
15664@node M2 Constants
15665@subsubsection Constants
15666
15667@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15668ways:
15669
15670@itemize @bullet
15671
15672@item
15673Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits.  When used in an
15674expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15675rest of the expression.  Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15676trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15677
15678@item
15679Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15680decimal point and another sequence of digits.  An optional exponent can
15681then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15682@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent.  All of the
15683digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15684digits.
15685
15686@item
15687Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15688like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).  They may
15689also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15690followed by a @samp{C}.
15691
15692@item
15693String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15694pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15695Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed.  @xref{C
15696Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15697sequences.
15698
15699@item
15700Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15701
15702@item
15703Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15704@code{FALSE}.
15705
15706@item
15707Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15708
15709@item
15710Set constants are not yet supported.
15711@end itemize
15712
15713@node M2 Types
15714@subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15715@cindex Modula-2 types
15716
15717Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15718syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15719types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types.  You can also
15720print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15721This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15722sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15723
15724The first example contains the following section of code:
15725
15726@smallexample
15727VAR
15728   s: SET OF CHAR ;
15729   r: [20..40] ;
15730@end smallexample
15731
15732@noindent
15733and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15734@code{r} and @code{s}.
15735
15736@smallexample
15737(@value{GDBP}) print s
15738@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15739(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15740SET OF CHAR
15741(@value{GDBP}) print r
1574221
15743(@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15744[20..40]
15745@end smallexample
15746
15747@noindent
15748Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15749
15750@smallexample
15751VAR
15752   s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15753@end smallexample
15754
15755@noindent
15756then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15757
15758@smallexample
15759(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15760type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15761@end smallexample
15762
15763@noindent
15764Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15765expressions using the debugger.
15766
15767The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15768and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15769
15770@smallexample
15771VAR
15772   s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15773@end smallexample
15774
15775@smallexample
15776(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15777ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15778@end smallexample
15779
15780Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15781is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15782arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15783above.
15784
15785Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15786
15787@smallexample
15788TYPE
15789   colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15790   t = [blue..yellow] ;
15791VAR
15792   s: t ;
15793BEGIN
15794   s := blue ;
15795@end smallexample
15796
15797@noindent
15798The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15799and value of a variable.
15800
15801@smallexample
15802(@value{GDBP}) print s
15803$1 = blue
15804(@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15805type = [blue..yellow]
15806@end smallexample
15807
15808@noindent
15809In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15810displayed.  Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15811their @code{C} counterparts.
15812
15813@smallexample
15814VAR
15815   s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15816BEGIN
15817   s[1] := 1 ;
15818@end smallexample
15819
15820@smallexample
15821(@value{GDBP}) print s
15822$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15823(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15824type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15825@end smallexample
15826
15827The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15828pointer types as shown in this example:
15829
15830@smallexample
15831VAR
15832   s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15833BEGIN
15834   NEW(s) ;
15835   s^[1] := 1 ;
15836@end smallexample
15837
15838@noindent
15839and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15840
15841@smallexample
15842(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15843type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15844@end smallexample
15845
15846@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15847Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15848types:
15849
15850@smallexample
15851TYPE
15852   foo = RECORD
15853            f1: CARDINAL ;
15854            f2: CHAR ;
15855            f3: myarray ;
15856         END ;
15857
15858   myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15859   myrange = [-2..2] ;
15860VAR
15861   s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15862@end smallexample
15863
15864@noindent
15865and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15866below.
15867
15868@smallexample
15869(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15870type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15871    f1 : CARDINAL;
15872    f2 : CHAR;
15873    f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15874END
15875@end smallexample
15876
15877@node M2 Defaults
15878@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15879@cindex Modula-2 defaults
15880
15881If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15882both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15883Modula-2.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15884selected the working language.
15885
15886If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15887code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15888working language to Modula-2.  @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15889Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15890
15891@node Deviations
15892@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15893@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15894
15895A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15896This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15897
15898@itemize @bullet
15899@item
15900Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15901integers.  This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15902debugging.  (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15903pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15904through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15905returned a pointer.)
15906
15907@item
15908C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15909non-printable characters.  @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15910escape sequences embedded.  Single non-printable characters are
15911printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15912
15913@item
15914The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15915argument.
15916
15917@item
15918All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15919@end itemize
15920
15921@node M2 Checks
15922@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15923@cindex Modula-2 checks
15924
15925@quotation
15926@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15927range checking.
15928@end quotation
15929@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15930
15931@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15932
15933@itemize @bullet
15934@item
15935They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15936@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15937
15938@item
15939They have been declared on the same line.  (Note:  This is true of the
15940@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15941@end itemize
15942
15943As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15944whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15945
15946Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15947index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15948
15949@node M2 Scope
15950@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15951@cindex scope
15952@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15953@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15954@ifinfo
15955@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15956@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15957@end ifinfo
15958@ifnotinfo
15959@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15960@end ifnotinfo
15961
15962There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15963(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}).  The two have
15964similar syntax:
15965
15966@smallexample
15967
15968@var{module} . @var{id}
15969@var{scope} :: @var{id}
15970@end smallexample
15971
15972@noindent
15973where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15974@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15975identifier within your program, except another module.
15976
15977Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15978specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}.  If it is not
15979found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15980enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15981
15982Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15983the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15984definition module specified by @var{module}.  With this operator, it is
15985an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15986module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15987@var{module}.
15988
15989@node GDB/M2
15990@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15991
15992Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15993Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15994specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15995@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}.  The first four
15996apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15997analogue in Modula-2.
15998
15999The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16000with any language, is not useful with Modula-2.  Its
16001intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16002created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}.  However, because an
16003address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16004@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16005
16006@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16007In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16008interpreted as the beginning of a comment.  Use @code{<>} instead.
16009
16010@node Ada
16011@subsection Ada
16012@cindex Ada
16013
16014The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16015output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16016Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16017attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16018to be difficult.
16019
16020
16021@cindex expressions in Ada
16022@menu
16023* Ada Mode Intro::              General remarks on the Ada syntax
16024                                   and semantics supported by Ada mode
16025                                   in @value{GDBN}.
16026* Omissions from Ada::          Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16027* Additions to Ada::            Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16028* Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16029                                   subprograms.
16030* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16031* Ada Exceptions::              Ada Exceptions
16032* Ada Tasks::                   Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16033* Ada Tasks and Core Files::    Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16034* Ravenscar Profile::           Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16035                                   Profile
16036* Ada Glitches::                Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16037@end menu
16038
16039@node Ada Mode Intro
16040@subsubsection Introduction
16041@cindex Ada mode, general
16042
16043The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16044syntax, with some extensions.
16045The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16046
16047@itemize @bullet
16048@item
16049That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16050arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16051leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16052program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16053
16054@item
16055That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16056are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16057
16058@item
16059That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16060@end itemize
16061
16062Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16063user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16064according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16065names with their packages, regardless of context.  Where this causes
16066ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16067
16068The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16069As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16070was translated from an Ada source file.
16071
16072While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments.  This is useful
16073mostly for documenting command files.  The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16074(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16075middle (to allow based literals).
16076
16077@node Omissions from Ada
16078@subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16079@cindex Ada, omissions from
16080
16081Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16082
16083@itemize @bullet
16084@item
16085Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16086
16087@itemize @minus
16088@item
16089@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16090 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16091
16092@item
16093@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16094
16095@item
16096@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16097
16098@item
16099@t{'Tag}.
16100
16101@item
16102@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16103operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16104
16105@item
16106@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16107@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16108
16109@item
16110@t{'Address}.
16111@end itemize
16112
16113@item
16114The names in
16115@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16116concatenation is not implemented.  Thus, escape characters in strings are
16117not currently available.
16118
16119@item
16120Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16121equality of representations.  They will generally work correctly
16122for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16123They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16124types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16125(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16126zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16127indeterminate values.
16128
16129@item
16130The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16131@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16132are not implemented.
16133
16134@item
16135@cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16136@cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16137@cindex aggregates (Ada)
16138There is limited support for array and record aggregates.  They are
16139permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16140
16141@smallexample
16142(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16143(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16144(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16145(@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16146(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16147(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16148@end smallexample
16149
16150Changing a
16151discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16152undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16153However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16154them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16155aggregate assignment.  For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16156declared to have a type such as:
16157
16158@smallexample
16159type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16160    Id : Integer;
16161    Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16162end record;
16163@end smallexample
16164
16165you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16166assignments:
16167
16168@smallexample
16169(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16170(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16171@end smallexample
16172
16173As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16174rules concerning aggregates.  You may leave out some of the
16175components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16176component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16177original values upon assignment.  You may freely use dynamic values as
16178indices in component associations.  You may even use overlapping or
16179redundant component associations, although which component values are
16180assigned in such cases is not defined.
16181
16182@item
16183Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16184
16185@item
16186The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16187than that of real Ada.  It makes only limited use of the context in
16188which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16189looser in its rules for allowing type matches.  As a result, some
16190function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16191the proper resolution.
16192
16193@item
16194The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16195
16196@item
16197Entry calls are not implemented.
16198
16199@item
16200Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16201formats are not supported.
16202
16203@item
16204It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16205
16206@item
16207The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16208are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16209context.
16210Should your program
16211redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16212you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16213@end itemize
16214
16215@node Additions to Ada
16216@subsubsection Additions to Ada
16217@cindex Ada, deviations from
16218
16219As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16220extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16221
16222@itemize @bullet
16223@item
16224If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16225a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16226then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16227@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.  In
16228Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16229in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16230Ada.  However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16231which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16232
16233@item
16234@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16235appears in function or file @var{B}.''  When @var{B} is a file name,
16236you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16237
16238@item
16239The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16240@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16241
16242@item
16243A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16244(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16245@end itemize
16246
16247In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16248additions specific to Ada:
16249
16250@itemize @bullet
16251@item
16252The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16253its right-hand operand as its value.  Thus, you may enter
16254
16255@smallexample
16256(@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16257(@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16258@end smallexample
16259
16260@item
16261The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,''  returning as its value
16262the value of its right-hand operand.
16263This allows, for example,
16264complex conditional breaks:
16265
16266@smallexample
16267(@value{GDBP}) break f
16268(@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16269@end smallexample
16270
16271@item
16272Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16273characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16274which is also used to print strings.  A sequence of characters of the form
16275@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16276(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal.  The
16277sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16278in strings.   For example,
16279@smallexample
16280   "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16281@end smallexample
16282@noindent
16283contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16284after each period.
16285
16286@item
16287The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16288@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case).  For example, it is valid
16289to write
16290
16291@smallexample
16292(@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16293@end smallexample
16294
16295@item
16296When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16297array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16298For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16299of 3 might print as
16300
16301@smallexample
16302(3 => 10, 17, 1)
16303@end smallexample
16304
16305@noindent
16306That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16307clause.
16308
16309@item
16310You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16311multi-character subsequence of
16312their names (an exact match gets preference).
16313For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16314in place of  @t{a'length}.
16315
16316@item
16317@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16318Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16319to lower case.  The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16320some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16321For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16322enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16323For example,
16324@smallexample
16325(@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16326@end smallexample
16327
16328@item
16329Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16330access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16331specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag).  Likewise, component
16332selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16333object.
16334
16335@end itemize
16336
16337@node Overloading support for Ada
16338@subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16339@cindex overloading, Ada
16340
16341The debugger supports limited overloading.  Given a subprogram call in which
16342the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16343actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16344the set of definitions.  It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16345procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16346functions to procedures elsewhere.
16347
16348If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16349one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16350use, for instance:
16351
16352@smallexample
16353(@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16354Multiple matches for f
16355[0] cancel
16356[1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16357[2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16358>
16359@end smallexample
16360
16361In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16362(type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16363instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16364
16365Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16366case:
16367
16368@table @code
16369
16370@kindex set ada print-signatures
16371@item set ada print-signatures
16372Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16373selection menus.  It is @code{on} by default.
16374@xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16375
16376@kindex show ada print-signatures
16377@item show ada print-signatures
16378Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16379overloads selection menu.
16380@xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16381
16382@end table
16383
16384@node Stopping Before Main Program
16385@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16386
16387@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16388It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16389before reaching the main procedure.
16390As defined in the Ada Reference
16391Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16392@code{adainit}.  To run your program up to the beginning of
16393elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16394@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16395
16396@node Ada Exceptions
16397@subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16398
16399A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16400
16401@table @code
16402@kindex info exceptions
16403@item info exceptions
16404@itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16405The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16406defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16407With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16408whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16409@end table
16410
16411Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16412without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16413argument.
16414
16415@smallexample
16416(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16417All defined Ada exceptions:
16418constraint_error: 0x613da0
16419program_error: 0x613d20
16420storage_error: 0x613ce0
16421tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16422const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16423(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16424All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16425constraint_error: 0x613da0
16426const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16427@end smallexample
16428
16429It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16430when an exception is raised.  For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16431
16432@node Ada Tasks
16433@subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16434@cindex Ada, tasking
16435
16436Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16437@value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16438
16439@table @code
16440@kindex info tasks
16441@item info tasks
16442This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16443
16444
16445@smallexample
16446@iftex
16447@leftskip=0.5cm
16448@end iftex
16449(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16450  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                 Name
16451   1   8088000   0   15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16452   2   80a4000   1   15 Accept Statement      b
16453   3   809a800   1   15 Child Activation Wait a
16454*  4   80ae800   3   15 Runnable              c
16455
16456@end smallexample
16457
16458@noindent
16459In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16460task currently being inspected.
16461
16462@table @asis
16463@item ID
16464Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16465
16466@item TID
16467The Ada task ID.
16468
16469@item P-ID
16470The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16471
16472@item Pri
16473The base priority of the task.
16474
16475@item State
16476Current state of the task.
16477
16478@table @code
16479@item Unactivated
16480The task has been created but has not been activated.  It cannot be
16481executing.
16482
16483@item Runnable
16484The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada.  (It may be waiting
16485for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16486
16487@item Terminated
16488The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5).  Any dependents
16489that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16490terminated themselves.
16491
16492@item Child Activation Wait
16493The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16494
16495@item Accept Statement
16496The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16497
16498@item Waiting on entry call
16499The task is waiting on an entry call.
16500
16501@item Async Select Wait
16502The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16503select statement.
16504
16505@item Delay Sleep
16506The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16507alternative open.
16508
16509@item Child Termination Wait
16510The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16511waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16512waiting on a terminate Phase.
16513
16514@item Wait Child in Term Alt
16515The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16516finish terminating.
16517
16518@item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16519The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16520@end table
16521
16522@item Name
16523Name of the task in the program.
16524
16525@end table
16526
16527@kindex info task @var{taskno}
16528@item info task @var{taskno}
16529This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16530the following example:
16531@smallexample
16532@iftex
16533@leftskip=0.5cm
16534@end iftex
16535(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16536  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                  Name
16537   1   8077880    0  15 Child Activation Wait  main_task
16538*  2   807c468    1  15 Runnable               task_1
16539(@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16540Ada Task: 0x807c468
16541Name: task_1
16542Thread: 0x807f378
16543Parent: 1 (main_task)
16544Base Priority: 15
16545State: Runnable
16546@end smallexample
16547
16548@item task
16549@kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16550@cindex current Ada task ID
16551This command prints the ID of the current task.
16552
16553@smallexample
16554@iftex
16555@leftskip=0.5cm
16556@end iftex
16557(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16558  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                  Name
16559   1   8077870    0  15 Child Activation Wait  main_task
16560*  2   807c458    1  15 Runnable               t
16561(@value{GDBP}) task
16562[Current task is 2]
16563@end smallexample
16564
16565@item task @var{taskno}
16566@cindex Ada task switching
16567This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16568command (@pxref{Threads}).  It switches the context of debugging
16569from the current task to the given task.
16570
16571@smallexample
16572@iftex
16573@leftskip=0.5cm
16574@end iftex
16575(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16576  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                  Name
16577   1   8077870    0  15 Child Activation Wait  main_task
16578*  2   807c458    1  15 Runnable               t
16579(@value{GDBP}) task 1
16580[Switching to task 1]
16581#0  0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16582(@value{GDBP}) bt
16583#0  0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16584#1  0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16585#2  0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16586#3  0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16587#4  0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16588@end smallexample
16589
16590@item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16591@itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16592@cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16593@cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16594@kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16595These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16596command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).  The
16597@var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16598in @ref{Specify Location}.
16599
16600Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16601to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16602particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint.  The @var{taskno} is one of the
16603numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16604column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16605
16606If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16607breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16608program.
16609
16610You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16611well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16612breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16613
16614For example,
16615
16616@smallexample
16617@iftex
16618@leftskip=0.5cm
16619@end iftex
16620(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16621  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                 Name
16622   1 140022020   0   15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16623   2 140045060   1   15 Accept/Select Wait    t2
16624   3 140044840   1   15 Runnable              t1
16625*  4 140056040   1   15 Runnable              t3
16626(@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16627Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16628(@value{GDBP}) cont
16629Continuing.
16630task # 1 running
16631task # 2 running
16632
16633Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
1663415               flush;
16635(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16636  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                 Name
16637   1 140022020   0   15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16638*  2 140045060   1   15 Runnable              t2
16639   3 140044840   1   15 Runnable              t1
16640   4 140056040   1   15 Delay Sleep           t3
16641@end smallexample
16642@end table
16643
16644@node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16645@subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16646@cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16647
16648When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16649tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16650the platform being used.
16651For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16652switching is not supported.
16653
16654On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16655memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support.  When inspecting
16656a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16657privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16658Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16659file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16660
16661@node Ravenscar Profile
16662@subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16663@cindex Ravenscar Profile
16664
16665The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16666specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16667requirements.
16668
16669@table @code
16670@kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16671@cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16672@item set ravenscar task-switching on
16673Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16674Profile.  This is the default.
16675
16676@kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16677@item set ravenscar task-switching off
16678Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16679Profile.  This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16680for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16681the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16682To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16683
16684@kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16685@item show ravenscar task-switching
16686Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16687using the Ravenscar Profile.
16688
16689@end table
16690
16691@node Ada Glitches
16692@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16693@cindex Ada, problems
16694
16695Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16696we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16697@value{GDBN},
16698some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16699and the GNU Ada compiler.
16700
16701@itemize @bullet
16702@item
16703Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16704storage are invisible to the debugger.
16705
16706@item
16707Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16708argument lists are treated as positional).
16709
16710@item
16711Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16712
16713@item
16714Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16715floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16716the host machine.
16717
16718@item
16719The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16720the standard symbols defined by the Ada language.  @value{GDBN} knows about
16721this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16722look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16723symbols in other packages or subprograms.  If you have
16724defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16725local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16726GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion.  When this happens,
16727you can usually resolve the confusion
16728by qualifying the problematic names with package
16729@code{Standard} explicitly.
16730@end itemize
16731
16732Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16733information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16734of affected entities.  In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16735around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16736to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16737enabled.
16738
16739@kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16740@kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16741@table @code
16742
16743@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16744Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16745value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16746types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16747a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16748This is the default.
16749
16750@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16751This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler.  If @value{GDBN}
16752sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16753trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16754the issue.  It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16755@code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16756recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16757
16758@end table
16759
16760@cindex GNAT descriptive types
16761@cindex GNAT encoding
16762Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16763of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16764@file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16765how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16766In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16767which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16768
16769These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16770format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16771types available in Ada.  Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16772Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16773types by their pure DWARF equivalent.  To facilitate that transition,
16774a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16775those descriptive types.  It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16776well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16777
16778@table @code
16779
16780@kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16781@item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16782Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16783The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16784
16785@kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16786@item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16787Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16788
16789@end table
16790
16791@node Unsupported Languages
16792@section Unsupported Languages
16793
16794@cindex unsupported languages
16795@cindex minimal language
16796In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16797@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16798It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16799of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16800This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16801an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16802
16803If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16804select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16805language.
16806
16807@node Symbols
16808@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16809
16810The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16811symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16812program.  This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16813does not change as your program executes.  @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16814program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16815(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16816file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16817
16818@cindex symbol names
16819@cindex names of symbols
16820@cindex quoting names
16821Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16822characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters.  The
16823most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16824source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}).  File names
16825are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16826ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16827@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}.  To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16828@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16829
16830@smallexample
16831p 'foo.c'::x
16832@end smallexample
16833
16834@noindent
16835looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16836
16837@table @code
16838@cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16839@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16840@kindex set case-sensitive
16841@item set case-sensitive on
16842@itemx set case-sensitive off
16843@itemx set case-sensitive auto
16844Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16845with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16846Occasionally, you may wish to control that.  The command @code{set
16847case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16848case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones.  If
16849you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16850suitable for the source language.  The default is case-sensitive
16851matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16852case-insensitive matches.
16853
16854@kindex show case-sensitive
16855@item show case-sensitive
16856This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16857lookups.
16858
16859@kindex set print type methods
16860@item set print type methods
16861@itemx set print type methods on
16862@itemx set print type methods off
16863Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16864declared in that class.  You can control this behavior either by
16865passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16866print type methods}.  Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16867display the methods; this is the default.  Specifying @code{off} will
16868cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16869
16870@kindex show print type methods
16871@item show print type methods
16872This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16873classes.
16874
16875@kindex set print type typedefs
16876@item set print type typedefs
16877@itemx set print type typedefs on
16878@itemx set print type typedefs off
16879
16880Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16881defined in that class.  You can control this behavior either by
16882passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16883print type typedefs}.  Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16884display the typedef definitions; this is the default.  Specifying
16885@code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16886Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16887printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16888types.
16889
16890@kindex show print type typedefs
16891@item show print type typedefs
16892This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16893printing classes.
16894
16895@kindex info address
16896@cindex address of a symbol
16897@item info address @var{symbol}
16898Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored.  For a register
16899variable, this says which register it is kept in.  For a non-register
16900local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16901is always stored.
16902
16903Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16904at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16905the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16906
16907@kindex info symbol
16908@cindex symbol from address
16909@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16910@item info symbol @var{addr}
16911Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16912If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16913nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16914
16915@smallexample
16916(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16917_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16918@end smallexample
16919
16920@noindent
16921This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command.  You can use
16922it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16923
16924For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16925library containing the symbol is also printed:
16926
16927@smallexample
16928(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16929_start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16930(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16931__read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16932@end smallexample
16933
16934@kindex demangle
16935@cindex demangle
16936@item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16937Demangle @var{name}.
16938If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16939@var{name} in.  Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16940
16941The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16942and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16943
16944The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16945of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16946
16947@kindex whatis
16948@item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16949Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16950or a name of a data type.  With no argument, print the data type of
16951@code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16952
16953If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16954is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16955assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16956
16957If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16958literal type as it is used in the source code.  If the type was
16959defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16960the data type underlying the @code{typedef}.  If the type of the
16961variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16962@code{struct} or  @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16963fields or methods.  It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16964name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}).  If you want to see the members of
16965such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16966
16967If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16968@code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16969Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16970in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}.  However, if that
16971underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16972unroll it.
16973
16974For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16975@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16976@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16977
16978@var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16979Available flags are:
16980
16981@table @code
16982@item r
16983Display in ``raw'' form.  Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16984parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16985members.  The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16986
16987@item m
16988Do not print methods defined in the class.
16989
16990@item M
16991Print methods defined in the class.  This is the default, but the flag
16992exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16993
16994@item t
16995Do not print typedefs defined in the class.  Note that this controls
16996whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16997names are substituted when printing other types.
16998
16999@item T
17000Print typedefs defined in the class.  This is the default, but the flag
17001exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17002@end table
17003
17004@kindex ptype
17005@item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17006@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17007detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17008@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17009
17010Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17011@code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17012a variable, expression, or a data type.  This means that @code{ptype}
17013of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17014present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that.  @code{typedef}s at
17015the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled.  Only @code{typedef}s of
17016fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17017@code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17018
17019For example, for this variable declaration:
17020
17021@smallexample
17022typedef double real_t;
17023struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17024typedef struct complex complex_t;
17025complex_t var;
17026real_t *real_pointer_var;
17027@end smallexample
17028
17029@noindent
17030the two commands give this output:
17031
17032@smallexample
17033@group
17034(@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17035type = complex_t
17036(@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17037type = struct complex @{
17038    real_t real;
17039    double imag;
17040@}
17041(@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17042type = struct complex
17043(@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17044type = struct complex
17045(@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17046type = struct complex @{
17047    real_t real;
17048    double imag;
17049@}
17050(@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17051type = real_t *
17052(@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17053type = double *
17054@end group
17055@end smallexample
17056
17057@noindent
17058As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17059the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17060
17061@cindex incomplete type
17062Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17063of complex data structure.  If the debug information included in the
17064program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17065the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}.  For example,
17066given these declarations:
17067
17068@smallexample
17069    struct foo;
17070    struct foo *fooptr;
17071@end smallexample
17072
17073@noindent
17074but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17075
17076@smallexample
17077  (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17078  $1 = <incomplete type>
17079@end smallexample
17080
17081@noindent
17082``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17083completely specified.
17084
17085@kindex info types
17086@item info types @var{regexp}
17087@itemx info types
17088Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17089expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17090no argument).  Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17091complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17092types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17093@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17094name is @code{value}.
17095
17096This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17097@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17098lists all source files where a type is defined.
17099
17100@kindex info type-printers
17101@item info type-printers
17102Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17103have ``type printers'' available.  When using @command{ptype} or
17104@command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17105is needed.  @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17106type printers.
17107
17108@code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17109
17110@kindex enable type-printer
17111@kindex disable type-printer
17112@item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17113@item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17114These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17115
17116@kindex info scope
17117@cindex local variables
17118@item info scope @var{location}
17119List all the variables local to a particular scope.  This command
17120accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17121an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17122to the scope defined by that location.  (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17123details about supported forms of @var{location}.)  For example:
17124
17125@smallexample
17126(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17127Scope for command_line_handler:
17128Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17129Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17130Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17131Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17132Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17133Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17134Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17135@end smallexample
17136
17137@noindent
17138This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17139during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17140collect}.
17141
17142@kindex info source
17143@item info source
17144Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17145the function containing the current point of execution:
17146@itemize @bullet
17147@item
17148the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17149@item
17150the directory it was compiled in,
17151@item
17152its length, in lines,
17153@item
17154which programming language it is written in,
17155@item
17156if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17157(which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17158@item
17159whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17160if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17161@item
17162whether the debugging information includes information about
17163preprocessor macros.
17164@end itemize
17165
17166
17167@kindex info sources
17168@item info sources
17169Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17170debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17171have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17172
17173@kindex info functions
17174@item info functions
17175Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17176
17177@item info functions @var{regexp}
17178Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17179whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17180Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17181include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17182start with @code{step}.  If a function name contains characters
17183that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17184@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17185
17186@kindex info variables
17187@item info variables
17188Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17189outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17190
17191@item info variables @var{regexp}
17192Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17193variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17194@var{regexp}.
17195
17196@kindex info classes
17197@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17198@item info classes
17199@itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17200Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17201(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17202expression.
17203
17204@kindex info selectors
17205@item info selectors
17206@itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17207Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17208(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17209expression.
17210
17211@ignore
17212This was never implemented.
17213@kindex info methods
17214@item info methods
17215@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17216The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17217methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17218specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes.  Many
17219C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods.  Thus, the output
17220from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use.  The
17221@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17222which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17223@end ignore
17224
17225@cindex opaque data types
17226@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17227@item set opaque-type-resolution on
17228Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types.  An opaque type is a type
17229declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17230@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17231source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17232another source file.  The default is on.
17233
17234A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17235the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17236
17237@item set opaque-type-resolution off
17238Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types.  In this case, the type
17239is printed as follows:
17240@smallexample
17241@{<no data fields>@}
17242@end smallexample
17243
17244@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17245@item show opaque-type-resolution
17246Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17247
17248@kindex set print symbol-loading
17249@cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17250@item set print symbol-loading
17251@itemx set print symbol-loading full
17252@itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17253@itemx set print symbol-loading off
17254The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17255printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17256By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17257shared library, and normally this is what you want.  However, when
17258debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17259can be annoying.
17260When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17261and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17262it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17263libraries.  When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17264
17265@kindex show print symbol-loading
17266@item show print symbol-loading
17267Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17268entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17269
17270@kindex maint print symbols
17271@cindex symbol dump
17272@kindex maint print psymbols
17273@cindex partial symbol dump
17274@kindex maint print msymbols
17275@cindex minimal symbol dump
17276@item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17277@itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17278@itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17279@itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17280@itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17281Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17282the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17283If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17284that objfile.
17285If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17286with code at that address.  Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17287@code{main}.
17288If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17289source file.
17290
17291These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17292These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17293@samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17294tables.
17295You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17296If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17297about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17298defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17299Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17300``ELF symbols''.
17301
17302@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17303@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17304
17305@kindex maint info symtabs
17306@kindex maint info psymtabs
17307@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17308@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17309@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17310@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17311@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17312@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17313
17314List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17315structures whose names match @var{regexp}.  If @var{regexp} is not
17316given, list them all.  The output includes expressions which you can
17317copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17318structure in more detail.  For example:
17319
17320@smallexample
17321(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17322@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17323  ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17324  @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17325    ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17326    readin no
17327    fullname (null)
17328    text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17329    globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17330    statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17331    dependencies (none)
17332  @}
17333@}
17334(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17335(@value{GDBP})
17336@end smallexample
17337@noindent
17338We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17339the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17340and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17341If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17342read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17343
17344@smallexample
17345(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17346Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17347line 1574.
17348(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17349@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17350  ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17351  @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17352    ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17353    dirname (null)
17354    fullname (null)
17355    blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17356    linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17357    debugformat DWARF 2
17358  @}
17359@}
17360(@value{GDBP})
17361@end smallexample
17362
17363@kindex maint info line-table
17364@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17365@cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17366@item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17367
17368List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17369instances whose name matches @var{regexp}.  If @var{regexp} is not
17370given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17371
17372@kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17373@cindex symbol cache size
17374@item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17375Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17376The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17377most applications.  This option exists to allow for experimenting
17378with different sizes.
17379
17380@kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17381@item maint show symbol-cache-size
17382Show the size of the symbol cache.
17383
17384@kindex maint print symbol-cache
17385@cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17386@item maint print symbol-cache
17387Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17388This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17389
17390@kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17391@cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17392@item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17393Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17394This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17395
17396@kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17397@cindex symbol cache, flushing
17398@item maint flush-symbol-cache
17399Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17400This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17401It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17402
17403@end table
17404
17405@node Altering
17406@chapter Altering Execution
17407
17408Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17409find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17410correct results in the rest of the run.  You can find the answer by
17411experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17412program.
17413
17414For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17415locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17416address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17417
17418@menu
17419* Assignment::                  Assignment to variables
17420* Jumping::                     Continuing at a different address
17421* Signaling::                   Giving your program a signal
17422* Returning::                   Returning from a function
17423* Calling::                     Calling your program's functions
17424* Patching::                    Patching your program
17425* Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17426@end menu
17427
17428@node Assignment
17429@section Assignment to Variables
17430
17431@cindex assignment
17432@cindex setting variables
17433To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17434@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.  For example,
17435
17436@smallexample
17437print x=4
17438@end smallexample
17439
17440@noindent
17441stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17442value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17443@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17444information on operators in supported languages.
17445
17446@kindex set variable
17447@cindex variables, setting
17448If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17449@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command.  @code{set} is
17450really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17451not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17452,Value History}).  The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17453
17454If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17455appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17456variable} command instead of just @code{set}.  This command is identical
17457to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands.  For example, if your
17458program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17459a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17460command @code{set width}:
17461
17462@smallexample
17463(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17464type = double
17465(@value{GDBP}) p width
17466$4 = 13
17467(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17468Invalid syntax in expression.
17469@end smallexample
17470
17471@noindent
17472The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}.  In
17473order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17474
17475@smallexample
17476(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17477@end smallexample
17478
17479Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17480with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17481@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}.  For example, if
17482your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17483to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17484the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17485
17486@smallexample
17487@group
17488(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17489type = double
17490(@value{GDBP}) p g
17491$1 = 1
17492(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17493(@value{GDBP}) p g
17494$2 = 1
17495(@value{GDBP}) r
17496The program being debugged has been started already.
17497Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17498Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17499"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17500                                 Invalid bfd target.
17501(@value{GDBP}) show g
17502The current BFD target is "=4".
17503@end group
17504@end smallexample
17505
17506@noindent
17507The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17508@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value.  In order to set the variable
17509@code{g}, use
17510
17511@smallexample
17512(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17513@end smallexample
17514
17515@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17516freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17517and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17518same length or shorter.
17519@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17520@comment        /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17521
17522To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17523construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17524(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17525to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17526and representation in memory), and
17527
17528@smallexample
17529set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17530@end smallexample
17531
17532@noindent
17533stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17534
17535@node Jumping
17536@section Continuing at a Different Address
17537
17538Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17539it stopped, with the @code{continue} command.  You can instead continue at
17540an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17541
17542@table @code
17543@kindex jump
17544@kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17545@item jump @var{location}
17546@itemx j @var{location}
17547Resume execution at @var{location}.  Execution stops again immediately
17548if there is a breakpoint there.  @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17549of the different forms of @var{location}.  It is common
17550practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17551@code{jump}.  @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17552
17553The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17554the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17555register other than the program counter.  If @var{location} is in
17556a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17557be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17558of local variables.  For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17559confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17560executing.  However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17561well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17562@end table
17563
17564On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17565command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}.  The
17566difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17567changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue.  For
17568example,
17569
17570@smallexample
17571set $pc = 0x485
17572@end smallexample
17573
17574@noindent
17575makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17576address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17577@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17578
17579The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17580up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17581that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17582detail.
17583
17584@c @group
17585@node Signaling
17586@section Giving your Program a Signal
17587@cindex deliver a signal to a program
17588
17589@table @code
17590@kindex signal
17591@item signal @var{signal}
17592Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17593signal @var{signal}.  The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17594signal.  For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17595SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17596
17597Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17598giving a signal.  This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17599a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17600@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17601signal.
17602
17603@emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17604delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17605reported a stop.  This includes the situation where a thread was
17606stopped due to a signal.  So if you want to continue execution
17607suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17608same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command.  If you issue
17609the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17610@value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17611
17612Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17613@code{kill} utility from the shell.  Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17614causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17615the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}).  The @code{signal} command
17616passes the signal directly to your program.
17617
17618@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17619after executing the command.
17620
17621@kindex queue-signal
17622@item queue-signal @var{signal}
17623Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17624when execution of the thread resumes.  The @var{signal} can be the name or
17625the number of a signal.  For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17626@code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17627The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17628otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17629You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17630@code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17631
17632Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17633for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17634will be delivered.  This is useful when your program stopped on account
17635of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17636@code{continue} command.
17637
17638This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17639is just queued, execution is not resumed.  And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17640be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17641(@pxref{Signals}).
17642@end table
17643@c @end group
17644
17645@xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17646commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17647
17648@node Returning
17649@section Returning from a Function
17650
17651@table @code
17652@cindex returning from a function
17653@kindex return
17654@item return
17655@itemx return @var{expression}
17656You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17657command.  If you give an
17658@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17659value.
17660@end table
17661
17662When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17663(and all frames within it).  You can think of this as making the
17664discarded frame return prematurely.  If you wish to specify a value to
17665be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17666
17667This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17668Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17669innermost remaining frame.  That frame becomes selected.  The
17670specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17671of functions.
17672
17673The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17674program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17675returned.  In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17676and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17677selected stack frame returns naturally.
17678
17679@value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17680the inferior.  The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17681type being returned by the selected stack frame.  For example it is common for
17682OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17683CPU registers.  Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17684registers.  Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17685specific placement rules.  @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17686current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17687assignment into the right register(s).
17688
17689Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info.  @value{GDBN} will always
17690use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17691debug info is available.  For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17692function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17693int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17694into a @code{long long int}:
17695
17696@smallexample
17697Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
1769829        return 31;
17699(@value{GDBP}) return -1
17700Make func return now? (y or n) y
17701#0  0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
1770243        printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17703(@value{GDBP})
17704@end smallexample
17705
17706However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17707function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17708to return from user.  Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17709in different inferior registers than the caller code expects.  For example,
17710typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17711of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17712architectures).  Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17713an appropriate cast explicitly:
17714
17715@smallexample
17716Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17717(@value{GDBP}) return -1
17718Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17719Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17720(@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17721Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17722#0  0x00400526 in main ()
17723(@value{GDBP})
17724@end smallexample
17725
17726@node Calling
17727@section Calling Program Functions
17728
17729@table @code
17730@cindex calling functions
17731@cindex inferior functions, calling
17732@item print @var{expr}
17733Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17734The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17735debugged.
17736
17737@kindex call
17738@item call @var{expr}
17739Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17740returned values.
17741
17742You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17743execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17744(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17745with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17746print.  If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17747value history.
17748@end table
17749
17750It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17751@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17752the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments).  What happens
17753in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17754
17755Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17756call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17757exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17758frame.  In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17759an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found.  GDB builds a
17760dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17761seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame.  What happens
17762in that case is controlled by the
17763@code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17764
17765@table @code
17766@item set unwindonsignal
17767@kindex set unwindonsignal
17768@cindex unwind stack in called functions
17769@cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17770Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17771that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged.  If set to on,
17772@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17773the context to what it was before the call.  If set to off (the
17774default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17775received.
17776
17777@item show unwindonsignal
17778@kindex show unwindonsignal
17779Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17780@value{GDBN}.
17781
17782@item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17783@kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17784@cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17785@cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17786Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17787unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17788debugged.  If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17789it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17790the call.  If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17791the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17792
17793@item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17794@kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17795Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17796@value{GDBN}.
17797
17798@end table
17799
17800@cindex weak alias functions
17801Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17802for another function.  In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17803the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17804which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17805As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17806even crash.  A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17807function instead.
17808
17809@node Patching
17810@section Patching Programs
17811
17812@cindex patching binaries
17813@cindex writing into executables
17814@cindex writing into corefiles
17815
17816By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17817executable code (or the corefile) read-only.  This prevents accidental
17818alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17819patching your program's binary.
17820
17821If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17822explicitly with the @code{set write} command.  For example, you might
17823want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17824repairs.
17825
17826@table @code
17827@kindex set write
17828@item set write on
17829@itemx set write off
17830If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17831core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17832off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17833
17834If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17835@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17836write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17837
17838@item show write
17839@kindex show write
17840Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17841as well as reading.
17842@end table
17843
17844@node Compiling and Injecting Code
17845@section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17846@cindex injecting code
17847@cindex writing into executables
17848@cindex compiling code
17849
17850@value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17851programs running under @value{GDBN}.  GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17852@file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17853This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17854
17855@table @code
17856@kindex compile code
17857@item compile code @var{source-code}
17858@itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17859Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17860language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}).  If compilation and
17861injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17862@value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17863message will be printed.  If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17864successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17865and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17866It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17867After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17868new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17869
17870The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17871The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17872E.g.:
17873
17874@smallexample
17875compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17876@end smallexample
17877
17878If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17879may conflict.  The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17880from actual source code.  E.g.:
17881
17882@smallexample
17883compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17884@end smallexample
17885
17886Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text.  To
17887enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17888following the command.  This will start the multiple-line editor and
17889allow you to type as many lines of source code as required.  When you
17890have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17891editor.
17892
17893@smallexample
17894compile code
17895>printf ("hello\n");
17896>printf ("world\n");
17897>end
17898@end smallexample
17899
17900Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17901provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope.  In this case, you must
17902specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17903@code{_gdb_expr_}.  The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17904inferior.  Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17905@var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17906inferior symbols otherwise.
17907
17908@kindex compile file
17909@item compile file @var{filename}
17910@itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17911Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17912
17913@smallexample
17914compile file /home/user/example.c
17915@end smallexample
17916@end table
17917
17918@table @code
17919@item compile print @var{expr}
17920@itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17921Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17922current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}).  By default the
17923value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17924you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17925@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17926Formats}.
17927
17928@item compile print
17929@itemx compile print /@var{f}
17930@cindex reprint the last value
17931Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17932multiple lines of text.  To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17933command without any text following the command.  This will start the
17934multiple-line editor.
17935@end table
17936
17937@noindent
17938The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17939
17940@table @code
17941@anchor{set debug compile}
17942@item set debug compile
17943@cindex compile command debugging info
17944Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17945injecting the code.  The default is off.
17946
17947@item show debug compile
17948Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17949compiling and injecting the code.
17950@end table
17951
17952@subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17953
17954@value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17955to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17956and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17957injecting process.
17958
17959@noindent
17960The options used, in increasing precedence:
17961
17962@table @asis
17963@item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17964These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17965system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17966(@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17967
17968@item compilation options recorded in the target
17969@value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17970into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17971to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}.  One has to
17972explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17973@value{NGCC} produces no DWARF.  This feature is only relevant for
17974platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17975try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17976
17977@item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17978@end table
17979
17980@noindent
17981You can override compilation options using the following command:
17982
17983@table @code
17984@item set compile-args
17985@cindex compile command options override
17986Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17987@code{compile} commands.  These options override any conflicting ones
17988from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17989compilation.
17990
17991@item show compile-args
17992Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17993This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17994use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17995@end table
17996
17997@subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17998
17999There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18000command.  As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18001highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18002
18003@table @asis
18004@item C code examples and caveats
18005When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18006attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler.  The source
18007code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18008access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18009the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18010
18011Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18012follow.  This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18013much like any other normal debugging session.
18014
18015@smallexample
18016void function1 (void)
18017@{
18018   int i = 42;
18019   printf ("function 1\n");
18020@}
18021
18022void function2 (void)
18023@{
18024   int j = 12;
18025   function1 ();
18026@}
18027
18028int main(void)
18029@{
18030   int k = 6;
18031   int *p;
18032   function2 ();
18033   return 0;
18034@}
18035@end smallexample
18036
18037For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18038been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18039@code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18040
18041To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18042program must be compiled and packaged with debug information.  The
18043@code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule.  Without debug
18044information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18045be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18046
18047So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18048information enabled.  The @code{compile} command will have access to
18049all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18050out).  Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18051@code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18052the variable @code{k}.  You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18053and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}.  You can also
18054read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18055@code{C}.  Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18056@code{compile} command are persistent.  In the following example:
18057
18058@smallexample
18059compile code k = 3;
18060@end smallexample
18061
18062@noindent
18063the variable @code{k} is now 3.  It will retain that value until
18064something else in the example program changes it, or another
18065@code{compile} command changes it.
18066
18067Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18068injected by the @code{compile} command.  In the example, the variables
18069@code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18070currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18071are not in scope.  Therefore, the following command
18072
18073@smallexample
18074compile code j = 3;
18075@end smallexample
18076
18077@noindent
18078will result in a compilation error message.
18079
18080Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18081scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18082the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18083
18084You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18085part of your source code.  Variables and types that are created as part
18086of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18087the duration of its run.  This example is valid:
18088
18089@smallexample
18090compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18091@end smallexample
18092
18093However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18094command has completed:
18095
18096@smallexample
18097compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18098@end smallexample
18099
18100@noindent
18101a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18102exists.  Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18103command is removed when its execution ends.  Caution is advised
18104when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18105code submitted to the @code{compile} command.  This example is valid:
18106
18107@smallexample
18108compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18109@end smallexample
18110
18111The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}.  The variable
18112@code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18113it has been assigned.  However, pointers require particular care in
18114assignment.  If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18115changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18116variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18117to an invalid location when the command exits.  The following example
18118would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18119
18120@smallexample
18121compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18122@end smallexample
18123
18124In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18125@code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18126However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18127assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18128location when the command exists.  A general rule should be followed
18129in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18130or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18131
18132Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18133defined in @code{compile} command.  Types defined in the @code{compile}
18134command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18135Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18136@code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18137need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18138
18139@smallexample
18140(gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18141(gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18142gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18143Compilation failed.
18144(gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
1814542
18146@end smallexample
18147
18148Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18149accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18150Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18151will print to the console.
18152@end table
18153
18154@subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18155
18156@value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
18157may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
18158@value{GDBN} is running.  Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
18159shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
18160command @code{set environment}).  @xref{Environment}.  @code{PATH} on
18161@value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18162target architecture and operating system.
18163
18164Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18165@code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18166debugged.  @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18167example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18168@code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18169for pattern @code{s390x?}.  @var{os} is currently supported only for
18170pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18171
18172@node GDB Files
18173@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18174
18175@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18176both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18177program.  To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18178@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18179
18180@menu
18181* Files::                       Commands to specify files
18182* File Caching::                Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18183* Separate Debug Files::        Debugging information in separate files
18184* MiniDebugInfo::               Debugging information in a special section
18185* Index Files::                 Index files speed up GDB
18186* Symbol Errors::               Errors reading symbol files
18187* Data Files::                  GDB data files
18188@end menu
18189
18190@node Files
18191@section Commands to Specify Files
18192
18193@cindex symbol table
18194@cindex core dump file
18195
18196You may want to specify executable and core dump file names.  The usual
18197way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18198@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18199Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18200
18201Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18202@value{GDBN} session.  Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18203specify a file you want to use.  Or you are debugging a remote target
18204via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18205Program}).  In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18206new files are useful.
18207
18208@table @code
18209@cindex executable file
18210@kindex file
18211@item file @var{filename}
18212Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged.  It is read for its
18213symbols and for the contents of pure memory.  It is also the program
18214executed when you use the @code{run} command.  If you do not specify a
18215directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18216@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18217directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18218to run.  You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18219and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18220
18221@cindex unlinked object files
18222@cindex patching object files
18223You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18224the @code{file} command.  You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18225file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables.  Also,
18226if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18227@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique.  Note
18228that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18229case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18230the wrong place.  But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18231
18232@item file
18233@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18234has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18235
18236@kindex exec-file
18237@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18238Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18239in @var{filename}.  @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18240if necessary to locate your program.  Omitting @var{filename} means to
18241discard information on the executable file.
18242
18243@kindex symbol-file
18244@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18245Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}.  @code{PATH} is
18246searched when necessary.  Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18247table and program to run from the same file.
18248
18249@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18250program's symbol table.
18251
18252The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18253some breakpoints and auto-display expressions.  This is because they may
18254contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18255which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18256@value{GDBN}.
18257
18258@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18259executing it once.
18260
18261When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18262understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18263generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18264other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18265Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18266using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18267optimized code.
18268
18269For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18270using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18271symbol table in full right away.  Instead, it scans the symbol table
18272quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present.  The
18273details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18274
18275The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18276start up faster.  For the most part, it is invisible except for
18277occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18278file are being read.  (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18279pauses into messages if desired.  @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18280Warnings and Messages}.)
18281
18282We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet.  When the
18283symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18284symbol table data in full right away.  Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18285still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18286in stabs format.
18287
18288@kindex readnow
18289@cindex reading symbols immediately
18290@cindex symbols, reading immediately
18291@item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18292@itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18293You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18294tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18295load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18296entire symbol table available.
18297
18298@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18299@c flux.  13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18300@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18301@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18302@c only current dir is used.  FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18303@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18304@c files.
18305
18306@kindex core-file
18307@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18308@itemx core
18309Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18310of memory''.  Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18311address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18312executable file itself for other parts.
18313
18314@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18315to be used.
18316
18317Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18318under @value{GDBN}.  So, if you have been running your program and you
18319wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18320the program is running.  To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18321(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18322
18323@kindex add-symbol-file
18324@cindex dynamic linking
18325@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18326@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18327@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18328The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18329information from the file @var{filename}.  You would use this command
18330when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18331into the program that is running.  The @var{address} should give the memory
18332address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18333this out for itself.  You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18334of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18335section name and base address for that section.  You can specify any
18336@var{address} as an expression.
18337
18338The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18339originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command.  You can use the
18340@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18341thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18342
18343Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18344
18345@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18346@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18347@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18348@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18349@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18350Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18351executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18352relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18353information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18354
18355@itemize @bullet
18356@item
18357the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18358that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18359@item
18360every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18361been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18362@item
18363you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18364provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18365@end itemize
18366
18367@noindent
18368Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18369relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18370typically make the requirements above easy to meet.  However, it's
18371important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18372procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18373assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet.  In
18374general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18375relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18376as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18377way.
18378
18379@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18380
18381@kindex remove-symbol-file
18382@item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18383@item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18384Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command.  The
18385file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18386that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory.  Example:
18387
18388@smallexample
18389(gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18390add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18391    .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18392(y or n) y
18393Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18394(gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18395Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18396(gdb)
18397@end smallexample
18398
18399
18400@code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18401
18402@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18403@cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18404@cindex load symbols from memory
18405@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18406Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18407object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18408For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18409process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18410some system calls.  The argument can be any expression whose
18411evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18412For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18413@code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18414
18415@kindex section
18416@item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18417The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18418@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}.  This can be used if the
18419exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18420@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18421itself are wrong.  Each section must be changed separately.  The
18422@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18423their addresses.
18424
18425@kindex info files
18426@kindex info target
18427@item info files
18428@itemx info target
18429@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18430current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18431including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18432use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded.  The
18433command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18434current ones.
18435
18436@kindex maint info sections
18437@item maint info sections
18438Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18439is @code{maint info sections}.  In addition to the section information
18440displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18441offset of each section in the executable and core dump files.  In addition,
18442@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18443may be arbitrarily combined):
18444
18445@table @code
18446@item ALLOBJ
18447Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18448@item @var{sections}
18449Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18450@item @var{section-flags}
18451Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18452The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18453@table @code
18454@item ALLOC
18455Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18456Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18457@item LOAD
18458Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18459Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18460@item RELOC
18461Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18462@item READONLY
18463Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18464@item CODE
18465Section contains executable code only.
18466@item DATA
18467Section contains data only (no executable code).
18468@item ROM
18469Section will reside in ROM.
18470@item CONSTRUCTOR
18471Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18472@item HAS_CONTENTS
18473Section is not empty.
18474@item NEVER_LOAD
18475An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18476@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18477A notification to the linker that the section contains
18478COFF shared library information.
18479@item IS_COMMON
18480Section contains common symbols.
18481@end table
18482@end table
18483@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18484@cindex read-only sections
18485@item set trust-readonly-sections on
18486Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18487really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18488In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18489out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18490For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18491enhancement to debugging performance.
18492
18493The default is off.
18494
18495@item set trust-readonly-sections off
18496Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections.  This means that
18497the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18498and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18499
18500@item show trust-readonly-sections
18501Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18502@end table
18503
18504All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18505as arguments.  @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18506name and remembers it that way.
18507
18508@cindex shared libraries
18509@anchor{Shared Libraries}
18510@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18511Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18512DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18513
18514On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18515shared libraries.  @xref{Expat}.
18516
18517@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18518when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18519(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18520references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18521debugging a core file).
18522
18523@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18524@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18525@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18526
18527There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18528symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18529particularly large or there are many of them.
18530
18531To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18532commands:
18533
18534@table @code
18535@kindex set auto-solib-add
18536@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18537If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18538will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18539attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18540informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded.  If @var{mode}
18541is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18542@code{sharedlibrary} command.  The default value is @code{on}.
18543
18544@cindex memory used for symbol tables
18545If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18546takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18547memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18548symbols from shared libraries.  To that end, type @kbd{set
18549auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18550library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18551@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18552the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18553
18554@kindex show auto-solib-add
18555@item show auto-solib-add
18556Display the current autoloading mode.
18557@end table
18558
18559@cindex load shared library
18560To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18561command:
18562
18563@table @code
18564@kindex info sharedlibrary
18565@kindex info share
18566@item info share @var{regex}
18567@itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18568Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18569that match @var{regex}.  If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18570all shared libraries that are loaded.
18571
18572@kindex info dll
18573@item info dll @var{regex}
18574This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18575
18576@kindex sharedlibrary
18577@kindex share
18578@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18579@itemx share @var{regex}
18580Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18581Unix regular expression.
18582As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18583required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}.  If
18584@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18585loaded.
18586
18587@item nosharedlibrary
18588@kindex nosharedlibrary
18589@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18590Unload all shared object library symbols.  This discards all symbols
18591that have been loaded from all shared libraries.  Symbols from shared
18592libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18593discarded.
18594@end table
18595
18596Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18597when any of shared library events happen.  The best way to do this is
18598to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18599Catchpoints}).
18600
18601@value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18602command for this.  This command exists for historical reasons.  It is
18603less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18604conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18605
18606@table @code
18607@item set stop-on-solib-events
18608@kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18609This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18610when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18611The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18612shared library.
18613
18614@item show stop-on-solib-events
18615@kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18616Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18617library events happen.
18618@end table
18619
18620Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18621configurations.  @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18622this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18623on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18624libraries from the target.  If copies of the target libraries are
18625provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18626copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18627not.
18628
18629@cindex where to look for shared libraries
18630For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18631libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18632may try to load the host's libraries.  @value{GDBN} has two variables
18633to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18634
18635@table @code
18636@cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18637@cindex system root, alternate
18638@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18639@kindex set sysroot
18640@item set sysroot @var{path}
18641Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged.  Any
18642absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18643runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18644target program's memory.  When starting processes remotely, and when
18645attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18646executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18647@value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system.  If you use
18648@code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18649to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18650e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18651@var{path}.
18652
18653If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18654system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18655from the remote system.  This is only supported when using a remote
18656target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18657Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).  The part of @var{path}
18658following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18659root prefix on the remote file system.  If @var{path} starts with the
18660sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18661@file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18662functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18663provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}.  If you want
18664to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18665named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18666equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18667
18668For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18669SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18670absolute file name with @var{path}.  But first, on Unix hosts,
18671@value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18672slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18673
18674@smallexample
18675  c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18676@end smallexample
18677
18678Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18679@var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18680system:
18681
18682@smallexample
18683  c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18684@end smallexample
18685
18686If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18687the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18688for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18689colons:
18690
18691@smallexample
18692  c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18693@end smallexample
18694
18695This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18696with more than one drive.  E.g., you may want to setup your local
18697copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18698@samp{z}):
18699
18700@smallexample
18701 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18702 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18703 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18704@end smallexample
18705
18706@noindent
18707and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18708@value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18709@file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18710
18711If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18712removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18713
18714@smallexample
18715  c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18716@end smallexample
18717
18718This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18719if you don't want or need to.
18720
18721The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18722sysroot}.
18723
18724@cindex default system root
18725@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18726You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18727@samp{--with-sysroot} option.  If the system root is inside
18728@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18729@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18730automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18731location.
18732
18733@kindex show sysroot
18734@item show sysroot
18735Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18736
18737@kindex set solib-search-path
18738@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18739If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18740directories to search for shared libraries.  @samp{solib-search-path}
18741is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18742path to the library is relative instead of absolute.  If you want to
18743use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18744@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18745finding your host's libraries.  @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18746it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18747of shared library symbols.
18748
18749@kindex show solib-search-path
18750@item show solib-search-path
18751Display the current shared library search path.
18752
18753@cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18754@kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18755@kindex show target-file-system-kind
18756@item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18757Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18758
18759Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18760make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on.  For
18761example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18762system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18763@value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18764@file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}.  On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18765drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18766indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18767normally considered a directory separator character.  In that case,
18768the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18769as a relative file name with no directory components.  This would make
18770it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18771shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18772with @code{set solib-search-path}.  Setting
18773@code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18774to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18775map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18776semantics.  The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18777to one of the supported file system kinds.  In that case, @value{GDBN}
18778tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18779current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18780Current ABI}).  The supported file system settings are:
18781
18782@table @code
18783@item unix
18784Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18785kind.  Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18786are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18787the forward slash.
18788
18789@item dos-based
18790Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18791File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18792followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18793both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18794considered directory separators.
18795
18796@item auto
18797Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18798target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18799This is the default.
18800@end table
18801@end table
18802
18803@cindex file name canonicalization
18804@cindex base name differences
18805When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18806frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18807program's debug info.  Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18808@dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18809even for very large programs.  (The base name of a file is the last
18810portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18811This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18812cannot have more than one base name.  This is usually true, but
18813references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18814facilities violate that assumption.  If your program records files
18815using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18816using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18817@code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18818pair of file names it needs to compare.  This will make file-name
18819comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18820
18821@table @code
18822@item set basenames-may-differ
18823@kindex set basenames-may-differ
18824Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18825
18826@item show basenames-may-differ
18827@kindex show basenames-may-differ
18828Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18829@end table
18830
18831@node File Caching
18832@section File Caching
18833@cindex caching of opened files
18834@cindex caching of bfd objects
18835
18836To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18837reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files.  @xref{Top, ,
18838BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.  The following commands
18839allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18840
18841@table @code
18842@kindex maint info bfds
18843@item maint info bfds
18844This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18845@value{GDBN}.
18846
18847@kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18848@kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18849@kindex bfd caching
18850@item maint set bfd-sharing
18851@item maint show bfd-sharing
18852Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared.  When sharing is
18853enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18854than reopening the same file.  Turning sharing off does not cause
18855already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18856that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object.  Similarly,
18857re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18858objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18859
18860@kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18861@kindex bfd caching
18862@item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18863Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18864
18865@kindex show debug bfd-cache
18866@kindex bfd caching
18867@item show debug bfd-cache
18868Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18869@end table
18870
18871@node Separate Debug Files
18872@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18873@cindex separate debugging information files
18874@cindex debugging information in separate files
18875@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18876@cindex debugging information directory, global
18877@cindex global debugging information directories
18878@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18879@cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18880
18881@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18882file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18883@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18884Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18885than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18886information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18887install only when they need to debug a problem.
18888
18889@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18890file:
18891
18892@itemize @bullet
18893@item
18894The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18895the separate debug info file.  The separate debug file's name is
18896usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18897name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18898(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}).  In addition, the
18899debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18900checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18901the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18902
18903@item
18904The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18905also present in the corresponding debug info file.  (This is supported
18906only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18907for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.)  For more details about
18908this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18909command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18910The GNU Linker}.  The debug info file's name is not specified
18911explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18912below.
18913@end itemize
18914
18915Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18916uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18917
18918@itemize @bullet
18919@item
18920For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18921the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18922directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18923directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18924directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18925
18926@item
18927For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18928@file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18929a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18930first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18931are the rest of the bit string.  (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18932hex characters, not 10.)
18933@end itemize
18934
18935So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18936@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18937file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18938@code{abcdef1234}.  If the list of the global debug directories includes
18939@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18940debug information files, in the indicated order:
18941
18942@itemize @minus
18943@item
18944@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18945@item
18946@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18947@item
18948@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18949@item
18950@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18951@end itemize
18952
18953@anchor{debug-file-directory}
18954Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18955configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}.  During @value{GDBN} run
18956you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18957@value{GDBN} is currently using.
18958
18959@table @code
18960
18961@kindex set debug-file-directory
18962@item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18963Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18964information files to @var{directory}.  Multiple path components can be set
18965concatenating them by a path separator.
18966
18967@kindex show debug-file-directory
18968@item show debug-file-directory
18969Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18970information files.
18971
18972@end table
18973
18974@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18975@cindex debug link sections
18976A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18977@code{.gnu_debuglink}.  The section must contain:
18978
18979@itemize
18980@item
18981A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18982a zero byte,
18983@item
18984zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18985boundary within the section, and
18986@item
18987a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18988executable file itself.  The checksum is computed on the debugging
18989information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18990zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18991@end itemize
18992
18993Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18994contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18995described above.
18996
18997@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18998@cindex build ID sections
18999The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19000ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider).  This section is
19001often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19002It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19003the same across multiple builds of the same build tree.  The default
19004algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19005content for the build ID string.  The same section with an identical
19006value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19007stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19008
19009The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19010executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19011debugging information.  The sections of the debugging information file
19012should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19013but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19014in an ordinary executable.
19015
19016The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19017@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19018the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19019following commands:
19020
19021@smallexample
19022@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19023@kbd{strip -g foo}
19024@end smallexample
19025
19026@noindent
19027These commands remove the debugging
19028information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19029@file{foo.debug}.  You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19030two files:
19031
19032@itemize @bullet
19033@item
19034The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19035behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19036
19037@smallexample
19038@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19039@end smallexample
19040
19041Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19042a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19043foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19044the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19045
19046@item
19047Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19048the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}.  Build ID support plus
19049compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19050utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19051@end itemize
19052
19053@noindent
19054
19055@cindex CRC algorithm definition
19056The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19057IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19058
19059@c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19060@c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19061@c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19062@c different ways!
19063@ifhtml
19064@display
19065@html
19066 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19067 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19068@end html
19069@end display
19070@end ifhtml
19071@ifnothtml
19072@display
19073 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19074 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19075@end display
19076@end ifnothtml
19077
19078The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19079significant bit of each byte first.  The initial pattern
19080@code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19081the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19082CRC.
19083
19084@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19085@dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19086However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19087@emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19088trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19089
19090To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19091which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}.  Inverting the
19092initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19093this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19094@code{0xffffffff}.
19095
19096@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19097@smallexample
19098unsigned long
19099gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19100                     unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19101@{
19102  static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19103    @{
19104      0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19105      0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19106      0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19107      0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19108      0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19109      0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19110      0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19111      0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19112      0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19113      0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19114      0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19115      0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19116      0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19117      0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19118      0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19119      0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19120      0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19121      0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19122      0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19123      0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19124      0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19125      0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19126      0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19127      0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19128      0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19129      0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19130      0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19131      0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19132      0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19133      0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19134      0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19135      0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19136      0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19137      0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19138      0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19139      0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19140      0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19141      0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19142      0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19143      0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19144      0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19145      0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19146      0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19147      0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19148      0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19149      0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19150      0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19151      0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19152      0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19153      0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19154      0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19155      0x2d02ef8d
19156    @};
19157  unsigned char *end;
19158
19159  crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19160  for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19161    crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19162  return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19163@}
19164@end smallexample
19165
19166@noindent
19167This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19168
19169@node MiniDebugInfo
19170@section Debugging information in a special section
19171@cindex separate debug sections
19172@cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19173
19174Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19175special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section.  This feature is called
19176@dfn{MiniDebugInfo}.  This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19177is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19178
19179The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19180information for use in simple backtraces.  It is not intended to be a
19181replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19182Debug Files}).  The example below shows the intended use; however,
19183@value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19184debugging information might be included in the section.
19185
19186@value{GDBN} has support for this extension.  If the section exists,
19187then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19188can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19189
19190This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19191standard utilities:
19192
19193@smallexample
19194# Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19195# to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19196nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19197  | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19198
19199# Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19200# (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19201# of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19202nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19203  | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19204  | sort > funcsyms
19205
19206# Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19207# table.
19208comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19209
19210# Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19211objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19212
19213# Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19214# removing some unnecessary sections.
19215objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19216  --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19217
19218# Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19219strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19220
19221# Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19222# original binary.
19223xz mini_debuginfo
19224objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19225@end smallexample
19226
19227@node Index Files
19228@section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19229@cindex index files
19230@cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19231
19232When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19233file in order to construct an internal symbol table.  This lets most
19234@value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19235on.  For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19236@value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19237startup.
19238
19239The index is stored as a section in the symbol file.  @value{GDBN} can
19240write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19241using @command{objcopy}.
19242
19243To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19244
19245@table @code
19246@item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19247@kindex save gdb-index
19248Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19249@value{GDBN}.  Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19250with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19251@var{directory}.
19252@end table
19253
19254Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19255file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19256
19257@smallexample
19258$ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19259    --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19260@end smallexample
19261
19262@value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19263sections that have been deprecated.  Usually they are deprecated because
19264they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19265To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19266specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19267The default is @code{off}.
19268This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19269@xref{Index Section Format}.
19270
19271@emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19272must be done before gdb reads the file.  The following will not work:
19273
19274@smallexample
19275$ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19276@end smallexample
19277
19278Instead you must do, for example,
19279
19280@smallexample
19281$ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19282@end smallexample
19283
19284There are currently some limitation on indices.  They only work when
19285for DWARF debugging information, not stabs.  And, they do not
19286currently work for programs using Ada.
19287
19288@node Symbol Errors
19289@section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19290
19291While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19292such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19293output.  By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19294they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19295debugging compilers.  If you are interested in seeing information
19296about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19297only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19298times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19299to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19300complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19301Messages}).
19302
19303The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19304
19305@table @code
19306@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19307
19308The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19309(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements).  This
19310error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19311in its outer scope blocks.
19312
19313@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19314the same scope as the outer block.  In the error message, @var{symbol}
19315may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19316function.
19317
19318@item block at @var{address} out of order
19319
19320The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19321order of increasing addresses.  This error indicates that it does not
19322do so.
19323
19324@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19325locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading.  (You
19326can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19327@code{set verbose on}.  @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19328Messages}.)
19329
19330@item bad block start address patched
19331
19332The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19333smaller than the address of the preceding source line.  This is known
19334to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19335
19336@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19337starting on the previous source line.
19338
19339@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19340
19341@cindex foo
19342Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19343larger than the size of the string table.
19344
19345@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19346name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19347with this name.
19348
19349@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19350
19351The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19352not yet know how to read.  @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19353uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19354
19355@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19356This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19357are not accessible.  If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19358debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19359on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19360and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19361
19362@item stub type has NULL name
19363
19364@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19365
19366@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19367The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19368information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19369it.
19370
19371@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19372
19373@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19374
19375@end table
19376
19377@node Data Files
19378@section GDB Data Files
19379
19380@cindex prefix for data files
19381@value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file.  These files
19382are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19383
19384You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19385is currently using.
19386
19387@table @code
19388@kindex set data-directory
19389@item set data-directory @var{directory}
19390Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19391to @var{directory}.
19392
19393@kindex show data-directory
19394@item show data-directory
19395Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19396@end table
19397
19398@cindex default data directory
19399@cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19400You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19401@samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option.  If the data directory is inside
19402@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19403@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19404automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19405location.
19406
19407The data directory may also be specified with the
19408@code{--data-directory} command line option.
19409@xref{Mode Options}.
19410
19411@node Targets
19412@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19413
19414@cindex debugging target
19415A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19416
19417Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19418in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19419you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands.  When you need more
19420flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19421host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19422realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19423command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19424(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19425
19426@cindex target architecture
19427It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19428architectures}.  When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19429one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19430command.
19431
19432@table @code
19433@kindex set architecture
19434@kindex show architecture
19435@item set architecture @var{arch}
19436This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}.  The
19437value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19438supported architectures.
19439
19440@item show architecture
19441Show the current target architecture.
19442
19443@item set processor
19444@itemx processor
19445@kindex set processor
19446@kindex show processor
19447These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19448and @code{show architecture}.
19449@end table
19450
19451@menu
19452* Active Targets::              Active targets
19453* Target Commands::             Commands for managing targets
19454* Byte Order::                  Choosing target byte order
19455@end menu
19456
19457@node Active Targets
19458@section Active Targets
19459
19460@cindex stacking targets
19461@cindex active targets
19462@cindex multiple targets
19463
19464There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19465recording sessions.  Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19466and process mutually exclusive.  Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19467on multiple active targets, one in each class.  This allows you to (for
19468example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19469the executable file after the process finishes.  Or if you start process
19470recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19471presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19472remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19473
19474Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19475file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).  To
19476specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19477command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19478
19479@node Target Commands
19480@section Commands for Managing Targets
19481
19482@table @code
19483@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19484Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19485process.  A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19486facilities.  You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19487protocol of the target machine.
19488
19489Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19490typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19491with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19492
19493The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19494after executing the command.
19495
19496@kindex help target
19497@item help target
19498Displays the names of all targets available.  To display targets
19499currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19500(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19501
19502@item help target @var{name}
19503Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19504select it.
19505
19506@kindex set gnutarget
19507@item set gnutarget @var{args}
19508@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files.  @value{GDBN}
19509knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19510a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19511with the @code{set gnutarget} command.  Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19512with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19513
19514@quotation
19515@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19516you must know the actual BFD name.
19517@end quotation
19518
19519@noindent
19520@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19521
19522@kindex show gnutarget
19523@item show gnutarget
19524Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19525@code{gnutarget} is set to read.  If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19526@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19527and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19528@end table
19529
19530@cindex common targets
19531Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19532configuration):
19533
19534@table @code
19535@kindex target
19536@item target exec @var{program}
19537@cindex executable file target
19538An executable file.  @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19539@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19540
19541@item target core @var{filename}
19542@cindex core dump file target
19543A core dump file.  @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19544@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19545
19546@item target remote @var{medium}
19547@cindex remote target
19548A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19549connection.  This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19550protocol over @var{medium} for debugging.  @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19551
19552For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19553machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19554
19555@smallexample
19556target remote /dev/ttya
19557@end smallexample
19558
19559@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command.  This is only
19560useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19561system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19562clobbered by the download.
19563
19564@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19565@cindex built-in simulator target
19566Builtin CPU simulator.  @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19567In general,
19568@smallexample
19569        target sim
19570        load
19571        run
19572@end smallexample
19573@noindent
19574works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19575drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19576provide these.  For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19577see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19578Processors}.
19579
19580@item target native
19581@cindex native target
19582Setup for local/native process debugging.  Useful to make the
19583@code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19584etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19585(@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19586
19587@end table
19588
19589Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19590your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19591
19592Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19593you've successfully established a connection.  You may wish to control
19594various aspects of this process.
19595
19596@table @code
19597
19598@item set hash
19599@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19600@cindex hash mark while downloading
19601This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19602downloading a file to the remote monitor.  If on, a hash mark is
19603displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19604monitor.
19605
19606@item show hash
19607@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19608Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19609
19610@item set debug monitor
19611@kindex set debug monitor
19612@cindex display remote monitor communications
19613Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19614@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19615
19616@item show debug monitor
19617@kindex show debug monitor
19618Show the current status of displaying communications between
19619@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19620@end table
19621
19622@table @code
19623
19624@kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19625@item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19626@anchor{load}
19627Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19628@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available.  Where it exists, it
19629is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19630on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19631@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19632the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19633
19634If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19635execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19636target is @dots{}}''
19637
19638The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19639For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19640link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19641specifies a fixed address.
19642@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19643
19644It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19645specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}.  When
19646@var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19647
19648Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19649load programs into flash memory.
19650
19651@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19652@end table
19653
19654@table @code
19655
19656@kindex flash-erase
19657@item flash-erase
19658@anchor{flash-erase}
19659
19660Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19661
19662@end table
19663
19664@node Byte Order
19665@section Choosing Target Byte Order
19666
19667@cindex choosing target byte order
19668@cindex target byte order
19669
19670Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19671offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19672orders.  Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19673designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19674which to use.  However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19675@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19676
19677@table @code
19678@kindex set endian
19679@item set endian big
19680Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19681
19682@item set endian little
19683Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19684
19685@item set endian auto
19686Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19687executable.
19688
19689@item show endian
19690Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19691
19692@end table
19693
19694Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19695data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19696target system.
19697
19698
19699@node Remote Debugging
19700@chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19701@cindex remote debugging
19702
19703If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19704@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19705For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19706or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19707powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19708
19709Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19710to make this work with particular debugging targets.  In addition,
19711@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19712but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19713write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19714communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19715
19716Other remote targets may be available in your
19717configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19718
19719@menu
19720* Connecting::                  Connecting to a remote target
19721* File Transfer::               Sending files to a remote system
19722* Server::	                Using the gdbserver program
19723* Remote Configuration::        Remote configuration
19724* Remote Stub::                 Implementing a remote stub
19725@end menu
19726
19727@node Connecting
19728@section Connecting to a Remote Target
19729@cindex remote debugging, connecting
19730@cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19731@cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19732@cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19733@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19734@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19735
19736This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19737types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19738symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19739connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19740
19741@subsection Types of Remote Connections
19742
19743@value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19744mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.  Note that many remote targets
19745support only @code{target remote} mode.  There are several major
19746differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19747
19748@table @asis
19749
19750@cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19751@item Result of detach or program exit
19752@strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19753detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.  When using
19754@code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19755
19756@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19757you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19758though no program is running.  You can rerun the program, attach to a
19759running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19760
19761When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19762invoked using the @option{--once} option.  If the @option{--once} option
19763was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19764@code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19765
19766@item Specifying the program to debug
19767For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19768program on the host system.  If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19769some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19770target.
19771
19772@strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19773on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19774(@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19775
19776@cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19777@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19778on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19779to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19780
19781@anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19782You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19783or process ID to attach.  To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19784option.  Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19785the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19786@code{run} command in this scenario).  Note that the conditions under which
19787@code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19788(@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}).  The
19789@option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19790
19791@item The @code{run} command
19792@strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19793supported.  Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19794the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data.  The
19795remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19796@kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19797
19798@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19799supported.  The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19800@code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19801the program to run.  Command line arguments are supported, except for
19802wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19803
19804If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19805@code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19806resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19807@code{target remote} mode.
19808
19809@anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19810@item Attaching
19811@strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19812not supported.  To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19813must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19814
19815@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19816you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19817established.  If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19818@code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19819(@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19820
19821@end table
19822
19823@anchor{Host and target files}
19824@subsection Host and Target Files
19825@cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19826@cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19827
19828@value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19829information for your program running on the target.  This requires
19830access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19831symbol files.  Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19832remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19833
19834Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19835@pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19836the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}.  With such a
19837target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19838@code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19839
19840If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19841program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19842unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19843@code{file} command.  Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19844the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19845the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).  Alternatively, you
19846may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19847target libraries.
19848
19849The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19850and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19851system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19852are.  Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19853during debugging.  On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19854files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19855programs.
19856
19857@subsection Remote Connection Commands
19858@cindex remote connection commands
19859@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19860over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}.  In
19861each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19862program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies.  The
19863@code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19864establish a connection to the target.  Both commands accept the same
19865arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19866
19867@table @code
19868
19869@item target remote @var{serial-device}
19870@itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19871@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19872Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target.  For example,
19873to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19874
19875@smallexample
19876target remote /dev/ttyb
19877@end smallexample
19878
19879If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19880@samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19881(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19882@code{target} command.
19883
19884@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19885@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19886@itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19887@itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19888@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19889Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19890The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19891address; @var{port} must be a decimal number.  The @var{host} could be
19892the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19893it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19894target.
19895
19896For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19897@code{manyfarms}:
19898
19899@smallexample
19900target remote manyfarms:2828
19901@end smallexample
19902
19903If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19904debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19905same host), you can omit the hostname.  For example, to connect to
19906port 1234 on your local machine:
19907
19908@smallexample
19909target remote :1234
19910@end smallexample
19911@noindent
19912
19913Note that the colon is still required here.
19914
19915@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19916@itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19917@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19918Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}.  For example, to
19919connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19920
19921@smallexample
19922target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19923@end smallexample
19924
19925When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19926keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''.  @acronym{UDP}
19927can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19928cause havoc with your debugging session.
19929
19930@item target remote | @var{command}
19931@itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19932@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19933Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19934pipe.  The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19935by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19936protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19937standard output.  You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19938that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19939using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19940
19941If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19942@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal.  (If the
19943program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19944
19945@end table
19946
19947@cindex interrupting remote programs
19948@cindex remote programs, interrupting
19949Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19950interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19951program.  This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19952and the serial drivers the remote system uses.  If you type the
19953interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19954
19955@smallexample
19956Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19957Give up (and stop debugging it)?  (y or n)
19958@end smallexample
19959
19960In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19961the remote debugging session.  (If you decide you want to try again later,
19962you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.)  If you type
19963@kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19964
19965In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19966@value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19967
19968@table @code
19969@kindex detach (remote)
19970@item detach
19971When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19972@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19973Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19974will depend on your particular remote stub.  After the @code{detach}
19975command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19976another target.  In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19977still connected to the target.
19978
19979@kindex disconnect
19980@item disconnect
19981The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19982the target is generally not resumed.  It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19983(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging.  After
19984the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19985another target.
19986
19987@cindex send command to remote monitor
19988@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19989@cindex add new commands for external monitor
19990@kindex monitor
19991@item monitor @var{cmd}
19992This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19993remote monitor.  Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19994sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19995can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19996and implement.
19997@end table
19998
19999@node File Transfer
20000@section Sending files to a remote system
20001@cindex remote target, file transfer
20002@cindex file transfer
20003@cindex sending files to remote systems
20004
20005Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20006connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}.  This is convenient
20007for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20008running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface.  For other targets,
20009e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20010the only way to upload or download files.
20011
20012Not all remote targets support these commands.
20013
20014@table @code
20015@kindex remote put
20016@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20017Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20018@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20019
20020@kindex remote get
20021@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20022Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20023on the host system.
20024
20025@kindex remote delete
20026@item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20027Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20028
20029@end table
20030
20031@node Server
20032@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20033
20034@kindex gdbserver
20035@cindex remote connection without stubs
20036@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20037allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20038@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20039linking in the usual debugging stub.
20040
20041@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20042because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20043that @value{GDBN} itself does.  In fact, a system that can run
20044@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20045@value{GDBN} locally!  @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20046because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself.  It is
20047also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20048started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20049Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20050the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20051do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20052by cross-compiling.  You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20053choice for debugging.
20054
20055@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20056or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20057protocol.
20058
20059@quotation
20060@emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20061Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20062@value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20063target system with the same privileges as the user running
20064@code{gdbserver}.
20065@end quotation
20066
20067@anchor{Running gdbserver}
20068@subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20069@cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20070@cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20071
20072Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system.  You need a copy of the
20073program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20074@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20075strip the program if necessary to save space.  @value{GDBN} on the host
20076system does all the symbol handling.
20077
20078To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20079the name of your program; and the arguments for your program.  The usual
20080syntax is:
20081
20082@smallexample
20083target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20084@end smallexample
20085
20086@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20087hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20088stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20089For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20090@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20091@file{/dev/com1}:
20092
20093@smallexample
20094target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20095@end smallexample
20096
20097@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20098with it.
20099
20100To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20101
20102@smallexample
20103target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20104@end smallexample
20105
20106The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20107specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20108TCP.  The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20109expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20110(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.)  You can choose any number
20111you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20112TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20113reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20114conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20115and exits.}  You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20116@code{target remote} command.
20117
20118The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20119with ssh:
20120
20121@smallexample
20122(gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20123@end smallexample
20124
20125The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20126and we don't want escape-character handling.  Ssh does this by default when
20127a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20128You could elide it if you want to.
20129
20130Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20131@code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20132display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20133Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20134
20135@anchor{Attaching to a program}
20136@subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20137@cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20138@cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20139
20140On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20141This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument.  The syntax is:
20142
20143@smallexample
20144target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20145@end smallexample
20146
20147@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.  It isn't
20148necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20149
20150In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20151@value{GDBN} attach command
20152(@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20153
20154@pindex pidof
20155You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20156@code{pidof} utility:
20157
20158@smallexample
20159target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20160@end smallexample
20161
20162In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20163has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20164@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20165
20166@subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20167
20168This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20169port.
20170
20171@code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20172terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode.  On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20173extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20174@value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20175which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20176mode.  Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20177cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20178stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20179
20180When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20181Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}.  For
20182completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20183
20184@cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20185By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20186subsequent connections are possible.  However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20187with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20188connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.  This
20189means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20190first one.  It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20191connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20192connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode.  The
20193@option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20194multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20195instance closes its port after the first connection.
20196
20197@anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20198@subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20199
20200You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20201specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to.  Then you can
20202attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20203program.  For more information,
20204@pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20205
20206@cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20207The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20208status information about the debugging process.
20209@cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20210The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20211remote protocol debug output.  These options are intended for
20212@code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20213
20214@cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20215The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20216@code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20217Possible options are:
20218
20219@table @code
20220@item none
20221Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20222@item all
20223Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20224@item timestamps
20225Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20226@end table
20227
20228Options are processed in order.  Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20229appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20230
20231@cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20232The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20233for debugging.  The option should be followed by the name of the
20234wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20235@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20236
20237@code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20238command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20239program to debug, then any arguments to the program.  The wrapper
20240runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20241
20242You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20243its arguments as a wrapper.  Several standard Unix utilities do
20244this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}.  Any Unix shell script ending
20245with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20246
20247For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20248the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20249environment:
20250
20251@smallexample
20252$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20253@end smallexample
20254
20255@subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20256
20257The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20258@itemize
20259
20260@item
20261Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20262
20263@item
20264Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20265(@pxref{Host and target files}).
20266Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20267connect.  Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20268@value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20269@code{--with-sysroot}).
20270
20271@item
20272Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20273For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20274the @code{target} command.  Otherwise you may get an error whose
20275text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20276@samp{Connection refused}.  Don't use the @code{load}
20277command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20278program is already on the target.
20279
20280@end itemize
20281
20282@anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20283@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20284@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20285
20286During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20287@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20288Here are the available commands.
20289
20290@table @code
20291@item monitor help
20292List the available monitor commands.
20293
20294@item monitor set debug 0
20295@itemx monitor set debug 1
20296Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20297
20298@item monitor set remote-debug 0
20299@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20300Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20301protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20302
20303@item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20304Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20305Possible options are:
20306
20307@table @code
20308@item none
20309Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20310@item all
20311Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20312@item timestamps
20313Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20314@end table
20315
20316Options are processed in order.  Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20317appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20318
20319@item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20320@cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20321When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20322directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20323libthread-db-search-path}).  If you omit @var{path},
20324@samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20325
20326The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20327not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20328
20329@item monitor exit
20330Tell gdbserver to exit immediately.  This command should be followed by
20331@code{disconnect} to close the debugging session.  @code{gdbserver} will
20332detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20333Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20334of a multi-process mode debug session.
20335
20336@end table
20337
20338@subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20339@cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20340
20341On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20342tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20343
20344For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20345@dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20346This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20347@code{gdbserver}.  In addition, support for static tracepoints
20348requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20349support.  At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20350@url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported.  This support
20351is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20352standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20353@code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20354to point at such headers.  You can explicitly disable the support
20355using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20356
20357There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20358
20359@table @code
20360@item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20361
20362You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20363library.  On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20364@code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20365
20366@item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20367
20368You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20369your system's support for preloading shared libraries.  Many Unixes
20370support the concept of preloading user defined libraries.  In most
20371cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20372in the environment.  See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20373@option{--wrapper} command line option.
20374
20375@item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20376
20377On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20378by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20379of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library.  On most Unix
20380systems, the function is @code{dlopen}.  You'll use the @code{call}
20381command for that.  For example:
20382
20383@smallexample
20384(@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20385@end smallexample
20386
20387Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20388available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20389@end table
20390
20391On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20392systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20393remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20394loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20395program's address space yet, including the in-process agent.  In that
20396case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20397features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20398libraries.  The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20399main procedure.  E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20400@code{gdbserver} like so:
20401
20402@smallexample
20403$ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20404@end smallexample
20405
20406Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20407
20408@smallexample
20409$ gdb myprogram
20410(@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
204110x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20412(@value{GDBP}) b main
20413(@value{GDBP}) continue
20414@end smallexample
20415
20416The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20417process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20418command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20419process.  You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20420tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20421tracing.
20422
20423@node Remote Configuration
20424@section Remote Configuration
20425
20426@kindex set remote
20427@kindex show remote
20428This section documents the configuration options available when
20429debugging remote programs.  For the options related to the File I/O
20430extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20431system-call-allowed}.
20432
20433@table @code
20434@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20435@cindex address size for remote targets
20436@cindex bits in remote address
20437Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20438number of bits.  @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20439that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target.  The
20440default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20441
20442@item show remoteaddresssize
20443Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20444
20445@item set serial baud @var{n}
20446@cindex baud rate for remote targets
20447Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud.  The
20448value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20449remote targets.
20450
20451@item show serial baud
20452Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20453
20454@item set serial parity @var{parity}
20455Set the parity for the remote serial I/O.  Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20456@code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}.  The default is @code{none}.
20457
20458@item show serial parity
20459Show the current parity of the serial port.
20460
20461@item set remotebreak
20462@cindex interrupt remote programs
20463@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20464@anchor{set remotebreak}
20465If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20466when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20467on the remote.  If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20468character instead.  The default is off, since most remote systems
20469expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20470
20471@item show remotebreak
20472Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20473interrupt the remote program.
20474
20475@item set remoteflow on
20476@itemx set remoteflow off
20477@kindex set remoteflow
20478Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20479on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20480
20481@item show remoteflow
20482@kindex show remoteflow
20483Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20484
20485@item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20486Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20487communications to @var{base}.  Supported values of @var{base} are:
20488@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}.  The default is
20489@code{ascii}.
20490
20491@item show remotelogbase
20492Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20493protocol.
20494
20495@item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20496@cindex record serial communications on file
20497Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}.  The
20498default is not to record at all.
20499
20500@item show remotelogfile.
20501Show the current setting  of the file name on which to record the
20502serial communications.
20503
20504@item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20505@cindex timeout for serial communications
20506@cindex remote timeout
20507Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20508@var{num} seconds.  The default is 2 seconds.
20509
20510@item show remotetimeout
20511Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20512responses.
20513
20514@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20515@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20516@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20517@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20518@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20519@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20520Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20521watchpoints.  A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20522
20523@cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20524@cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20525@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20526@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20527Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20528a remote hardware watchpoint.  A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20529as unlimited.
20530
20531@item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20532Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20533a remote hardware watchpoint.
20534
20535@item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20536@itemx show remote exec-file
20537@anchor{set remote exec-file}
20538@cindex executable file, for remote target
20539Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20540extended-remote}.  This should be set to a filename valid on the
20541target system.  If it is not set, the target will use a default
20542filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20543
20544@item set remote interrupt-sequence
20545@cindex interrupt remote programs
20546@cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20547Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20548@samp{BREAK-g} as the
20549sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20550@samp{Ctrl-C} is a default.  Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20551is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20552Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20553It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20554
20555@item show interrupt-sequence
20556Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20557is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20558@code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20559also known as Magic SysRq g.
20560
20561@item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20562@cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20563Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20564@value{GDBN} connects to it.  This is mostly needed when you debug
20565Linux kernel.  Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20566which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20567
20568@item show interrupt-on-connect
20569Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20570to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20571
20572@kindex set tcp
20573@kindex show tcp
20574@item set tcp auto-retry on
20575@cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20576Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections.  This is useful if the remote
20577debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20578condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20579before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect.  When auto-retry is
20580enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20581to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20582@code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20583
20584@item set tcp auto-retry off
20585Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20586
20587@item show tcp auto-retry
20588Show the current auto-retry setting.
20589
20590@item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20591@itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20592@cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20593@cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20594Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20595@var{seconds}.  The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20596(enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20597that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20598value.  If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20599@value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20600unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}.  The default is 15 seconds.
20601
20602@item show tcp connect-timeout
20603Show the current connection timeout setting.
20604@end table
20605
20606@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20607The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20608your debugging stub.  If you need to override the autodetection, you
20609can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets.  Each
20610packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20611packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20612or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet).  They
20613all default to @samp{auto}.  For more information about each packet,
20614see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20615
20616During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20617If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20618in @value{GDBN}.  You may want to report the problem to the
20619@value{GDBN} developers.
20620
20621For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20622packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}.  The available settings
20623are:
20624
20625@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20626@item Command Name
20627@tab Remote Packet
20628@tab Related Features
20629
20630@item @code{fetch-register}
20631@tab @code{p}
20632@tab @code{info registers}
20633
20634@item @code{set-register}
20635@tab @code{P}
20636@tab @code{set}
20637
20638@item @code{binary-download}
20639@tab @code{X}
20640@tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20641
20642@item @code{read-aux-vector}
20643@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20644@tab @code{info auxv}
20645
20646@item @code{symbol-lookup}
20647@tab @code{qSymbol}
20648@tab Detecting multiple threads
20649
20650@item @code{attach}
20651@tab @code{vAttach}
20652@tab @code{attach}
20653
20654@item @code{verbose-resume}
20655@tab @code{vCont}
20656@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20657
20658@item @code{run}
20659@tab @code{vRun}
20660@tab @code{run}
20661
20662@item @code{software-breakpoint}
20663@tab @code{Z0}
20664@tab @code{break}
20665
20666@item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20667@tab @code{Z1}
20668@tab @code{hbreak}
20669
20670@item @code{write-watchpoint}
20671@tab @code{Z2}
20672@tab @code{watch}
20673
20674@item @code{read-watchpoint}
20675@tab @code{Z3}
20676@tab @code{rwatch}
20677
20678@item @code{access-watchpoint}
20679@tab @code{Z4}
20680@tab @code{awatch}
20681
20682@item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20683@tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20684@tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20685
20686@item @code{target-features}
20687@tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20688@tab @code{set architecture}
20689
20690@item @code{library-info}
20691@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20692@tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20693
20694@item @code{memory-map}
20695@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20696@tab @code{info mem}
20697
20698@item @code{read-sdata-object}
20699@tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20700@tab @code{print $_sdata}
20701
20702@item @code{read-spu-object}
20703@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20704@tab @code{info spu}
20705
20706@item @code{write-spu-object}
20707@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20708@tab @code{info spu}
20709
20710@item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20711@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20712@tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20713
20714@item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20715@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20716@tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20717
20718@item @code{threads}
20719@tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20720@tab @code{info threads}
20721
20722@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20723@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20724@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20725
20726@item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20727@tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20728@tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20729
20730@item @code{search-memory}
20731@tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20732@tab @code{find}
20733
20734@item @code{supported-packets}
20735@tab @code{qSupported}
20736@tab Remote communications parameters
20737
20738@item @code{catch-syscalls}
20739@tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20740@tab @code{catch syscall}
20741
20742@item @code{pass-signals}
20743@tab @code{QPassSignals}
20744@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20745
20746@item @code{program-signals}
20747@tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20748@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20749
20750@item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20751@tab @code{vFile:close}
20752@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20753
20754@item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20755@tab @code{vFile:open}
20756@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20757
20758@item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20759@tab @code{vFile:pread}
20760@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20761
20762@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20763@tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20764@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20765
20766@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20767@tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20768@tab @code{remote delete}
20769
20770@item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20771@tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20772@tab Host I/O
20773
20774@item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20775@tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20776@tab Host I/O
20777
20778@item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20779@tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20780@tab Host I/O
20781
20782@item @code{noack-packet}
20783@tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20784@tab Packet acknowledgment
20785
20786@item @code{osdata}
20787@tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20788@tab @code{info os}
20789
20790@item @code{query-attached}
20791@tab @code{qAttached}
20792@tab Querying remote process attach state.
20793
20794@item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20795@tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20796@tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20797
20798@item @code{trace-status}
20799@tab @code{qTStatus}
20800@tab @code{tstatus}
20801
20802@item @code{traceframe-info}
20803@tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20804@tab Traceframe info
20805
20806@item @code{install-in-trace}
20807@tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20808@tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20809
20810@item @code{disable-randomization}
20811@tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20812@tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20813
20814@item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20815@tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20816@tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20817
20818@item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20819@tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20820@tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20821
20822@item @code{swbreak-feature}
20823@tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20824@tab @code{break}
20825
20826@item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20827@tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20828@tab @code{hbreak}
20829
20830@item @code{fork-event-feature}
20831@tab @code{fork stop reason}
20832@tab @code{fork}
20833
20834@item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20835@tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20836@tab @code{vfork}
20837
20838@item @code{exec-event-feature}
20839@tab @code{exec stop reason}
20840@tab @code{exec}
20841
20842@item @code{thread-events}
20843@tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20844@tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20845
20846@item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20847@tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20848@tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20849
20850@end multitable
20851
20852@node Remote Stub
20853@section Implementing a Remote Stub
20854
20855@cindex debugging stub, example
20856@cindex remote stub, example
20857@cindex stub example, remote debugging
20858The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20859communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20860@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}.  Normally, you can simply allow
20861these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details.  (If you're
20862implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20863with one of the existing stub files.  @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20864organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20865
20866@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20867To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20868@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20869prerequisites for the program to run by itself.  For example, for a C
20870program, you need:
20871
20872@enumerate
20873@item
20874A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20875have a name like @file{crt0}.  The startup routine may be supplied by
20876your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20877
20878@item
20879A C subroutine library to support your program's
20880subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20881
20882@item
20883A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20884download program.  These are often supplied by the hardware
20885manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20886documentation.
20887@end enumerate
20888
20889The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20890communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20891machine).  In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20892
20893@table @emph
20894@item On the host,
20895@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20896else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20897(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20898
20899@item On the target,
20900you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20901implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.  The file containing these
20902subroutines is called  a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20903
20904On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20905@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20906@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20907@end table
20908
20909The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20910machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20911@sc{sparc} boards.
20912
20913@cindex remote serial stub list
20914These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20915
20916@table @code
20917
20918@item i386-stub.c
20919@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20920@cindex Intel
20921@cindex i386
20922For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20923
20924@item m68k-stub.c
20925@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20926@cindex Motorola 680x0
20927@cindex m680x0
20928For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20929
20930@item sh-stub.c
20931@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20932@cindex Renesas
20933@cindex SH
20934For Renesas SH architectures.
20935
20936@item sparc-stub.c
20937@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20938@cindex Sparc
20939For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20940
20941@item sparcl-stub.c
20942@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20943@cindex Fujitsu
20944@cindex SparcLite
20945For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20946
20947@end table
20948
20949The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20950recently added stubs.
20951
20952@menu
20953* Stub Contents::       What the stub can do for you
20954* Bootstrapping::       What you must do for the stub
20955* Debug Session::       Putting it all together
20956@end menu
20957
20958@node Stub Contents
20959@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20960
20961@cindex remote serial stub
20962The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20963subroutines:
20964
20965@table @code
20966@item set_debug_traps
20967@findex set_debug_traps
20968@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20969This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20970program stops.  You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20971program's startup code.
20972
20973@item handle_exception
20974@findex handle_exception
20975@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20976This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20977explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20978run when a trap is triggered.
20979
20980@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20981execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20982with @value{GDBN} on the host machine.  This is where the communications
20983protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20984representative on the target machine.  It begins by sending summary
20985information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20986retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20987execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20988@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20989machine.
20990
20991@item breakpoint
20992@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20993Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20994breakpoint.  Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20995way for @value{GDBN} to get control.  For instance, if your target
20996machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20997pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20998@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}.  On some machines,
20999simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21000again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21001your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21002@value{GDBN} session gets control.
21003
21004Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21005to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21006start of your debugging session.
21007@end table
21008
21009@node Bootstrapping
21010@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21011
21012@cindex remote stub, support routines
21013The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21014chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21015debugging target machine.
21016
21017First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21018serial port.
21019
21020@table @code
21021@item int getDebugChar()
21022@findex getDebugChar
21023Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21024It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21025different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21026
21027@item void putDebugChar(int)
21028@findex putDebugChar
21029Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21030It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21031different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21032@end table
21033
21034@cindex control C, and remote debugging
21035@cindex interrupting remote targets
21036If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21037running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21038for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21039character).  That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21040remote system to stop.
21041
21042Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21043probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21044is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21045@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21046
21047Other routines you need to supply are:
21048
21049@table @code
21050@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21051@findex exceptionHandler
21052Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21053handling tables.  You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21054way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21055are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21056containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21057The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21058its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21059might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc).  When this
21060exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21061@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21062and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs.  So if
21063you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21064should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21065
21066For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21067gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs.  The gate
21068should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level).  The
21069@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21070help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21071
21072@item void flush_i_cache()
21073@findex flush_i_cache
21074On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21075instruction cache, if any, on your target machine.  If there is no
21076instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21077
21078On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21079function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21080@end table
21081
21082@noindent
21083You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21084
21085@table @code
21086@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21087@findex memset
21088This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21089memory to a known value.  If you have one of the free versions of
21090@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21091either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21092@end table
21093
21094If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21095library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21096but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21097subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21098
21099
21100@node Debug Session
21101@subsection Putting it All Together
21102
21103@cindex remote serial debugging summary
21104In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21105steps.
21106
21107@enumerate
21108@item
21109Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21110(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21111@display
21112@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21113@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21114@end display
21115
21116@item
21117Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21118procedure is called:
21119
21120@smallexample
21121set_debug_traps();
21122breakpoint();
21123@end smallexample
21124
21125On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21126automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21127breakpoint.  If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21128@code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21129after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21130doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21131progress.
21132
21133@item
21134For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21135@code{exceptionHook}.  Normally you just use:
21136
21137@smallexample
21138void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21139@end smallexample
21140
21141@noindent
21142but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21143function in your program, that function is called when
21144@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21145error).  The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21146one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21147
21148@item
21149Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21150your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21151
21152@item
21153Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21154the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21155
21156@item
21157@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21158@c document that.  FIXME.
21159Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21160whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21161
21162@item
21163Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21164(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21165
21166@end enumerate
21167
21168@node Configurations
21169@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21170
21171While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21172cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions.  This chapter
21173describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21174
21175There are three major categories of configurations: native
21176configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21177operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21178different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21179are quite different from each other.
21180
21181@menu
21182* Native::
21183* Embedded OS::
21184* Embedded Processors::
21185* Architectures::
21186@end menu
21187
21188@node Native
21189@section Native
21190
21191This section describes details specific to particular native
21192configurations.
21193
21194@menu
21195* BSD libkvm Interface::	Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21196* SVR4 Process Information::    SVR4 process information
21197* DJGPP Native::                Features specific to the DJGPP port
21198* Cygwin Native::		Features specific to the Cygwin port
21199* Hurd Native::                 Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21200* Darwin::			Features specific to Darwin
21201@end menu
21202
21203@node BSD libkvm Interface
21204@subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21205
21206@cindex libkvm
21207@cindex kernel memory image
21208@cindex kernel crash dump
21209
21210BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21211interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21212memory images, including live systems and crash dumps.  @value{GDBN}
21213uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21214dumps on many native BSD configurations.  This is implemented as a
21215special @code{kvm} debugging target.  For debugging a live system, load
21216the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21217@code{kvm} target:
21218
21219@smallexample
21220(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21221@end smallexample
21222
21223For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21224argument:
21225
21226@smallexample
21227(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21228@end smallexample
21229
21230Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21231available:
21232
21233@table @code
21234@kindex kvm
21235@item kvm pcb
21236Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21237
21238@item kvm proc
21239Set current context from proc address.  This command isn't available on
21240modern FreeBSD systems.
21241@end table
21242
21243@node SVR4 Process Information
21244@subsection SVR4 Process Information
21245@cindex /proc
21246@cindex examine process image
21247@cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21248
21249Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21250@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21251process using file-system subroutines.
21252
21253If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21254facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21255information about the process running your program, or about any
21256process running on your system.  This includes, as of this writing,
21257@sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21258
21259This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21260that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21261
21262@table @code
21263@kindex info proc
21264@cindex process ID
21265@item info proc
21266@itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21267Summarize available information about any running process.  If a
21268process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21269that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21270debugged.  The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21271line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21272executable file's absolute file name.
21273
21274On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21275@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21276within a process.  If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21277a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21278needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21279a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21280
21281@item info proc cmdline
21282@cindex info proc cmdline
21283Show the original command line of the process.  This command is
21284specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21285
21286@item info proc cwd
21287@cindex info proc cwd
21288Show the current working directory of the process.  This command is
21289specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21290
21291@item info proc exe
21292@cindex info proc exe
21293Show the name of executable of the process.  This command is specific
21294to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21295
21296@item info proc mappings
21297@cindex memory address space mappings
21298Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21299information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21300rights to each range.  On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21301includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21302memory access rights to that range.
21303
21304@item info proc stat
21305@itemx info proc status
21306@cindex process detailed status information
21307These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems.  They show
21308the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21309how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21310the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21311consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21312value; etc.  For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21313(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21314
21315@item info proc all
21316Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21317above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21318
21319@ignore
21320@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21321@comment procfs.c was re-written.  Keep their descriptions around
21322@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21323@kindex info proc times
21324@item info proc times
21325Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21326its children.
21327
21328@kindex info proc id
21329@item info proc id
21330Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21331the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21332@end ignore
21333
21334@item set procfs-trace
21335@kindex set procfs-trace
21336@cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21337This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21338
21339@item show procfs-trace
21340@kindex show procfs-trace
21341Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21342
21343@item set procfs-file @var{file}
21344@kindex set procfs-file
21345Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21346@var{file}.  @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21347contents of the file.  The default is to display the trace on the
21348standard output.
21349
21350@item show procfs-file
21351@kindex show procfs-file
21352Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21353
21354@item proc-trace-entry
21355@itemx proc-trace-exit
21356@itemx proc-untrace-entry
21357@itemx proc-untrace-exit
21358@kindex proc-trace-entry
21359@kindex proc-trace-exit
21360@kindex proc-untrace-entry
21361@kindex proc-untrace-exit
21362These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21363from the @code{syscall} interface.
21364
21365@item info pidlist
21366@kindex info pidlist
21367@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21368For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21369processes and all the threads within each process.
21370
21371@item info meminfo
21372@kindex info meminfo
21373@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21374For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21375@end table
21376
21377@node DJGPP Native
21378@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21379@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21380@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21381@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21382
21383@cindex DPMI
21384@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21385MS-Windows.  @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21386that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21387top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21388
21389@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21390defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port.  This
21391subsection describes those commands.
21392
21393@table @code
21394@kindex info dos
21395@item info dos
21396This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21397information about the target system and important OS structures.
21398
21399@kindex sysinfo
21400@cindex MS-DOS system info
21401@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21402@item info dos sysinfo
21403This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21404platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21405DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21406
21407@cindex GDT
21408@cindex LDT
21409@cindex IDT
21410@cindex segment descriptor tables
21411@cindex descriptor tables display
21412@item info dos gdt
21413@itemx info dos ldt
21414@itemx info dos idt
21415These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21416and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT).  The descriptor
21417tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21418that is currently in use.  The segment's selector is an index into a
21419descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21420descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21421rights.
21422
21423A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21424segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21425allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21426conventional memory).  However, the DPMI host will usually define
21427additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21428
21429@cindex garbled pointers
21430These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21431Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21432displayed.  An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21433display a single entry whose index is given by the argument.  For
21434example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21435debugged program's data segment:
21436
21437@smallexample
21438@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21439@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21440@end smallexample
21441
21442@noindent
21443This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21444the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21445
21446@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21447@item info dos pde
21448@itemx info dos pte
21449These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21450Directory and the Page Tables.  Page Directories and Page Tables are
21451data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21452into physical addresses.  A Page Table includes an entry for every
21453page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21454may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries.  A
21455Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21456that is currently in use.
21457
21458Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21459Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21460the Page Tables.  An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21461@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21462Directory table.  An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21463means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21464the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21465
21466@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21467These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21468Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21469controller.
21470
21471These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21472
21473@cindex physical address from linear address
21474@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21475This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21476address.  The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21477already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21478because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21479segment.  For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21480the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21481
21482@smallexample
21483@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21484@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21485@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21486@end smallexample
21487
21488@noindent
21489This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21490whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21491attributes of that page.
21492
21493Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21494since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21495address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21496be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21497declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21498@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21499
21500Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21501transfer buffer:
21502
21503@smallexample
21504@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21505@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21506@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21507@end smallexample
21508
21509@noindent
21510(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
215113rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.)  The output
21512clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21513memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21514linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21515
21516This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21517@end table
21518
21519@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21520In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21521debugging via a serial data link.  The following commands are specific
21522to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21523
21524@table @code
21525@kindex set com1base
21526@kindex set com1irq
21527@kindex set com2base
21528@kindex set com2irq
21529@kindex set com3base
21530@kindex set com3irq
21531@kindex set com4base
21532@kindex set com4irq
21533@item set com1base @var{addr}
21534This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21535port.
21536
21537@item set com1irq @var{irq}
21538This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21539for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21540
21541There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21542etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21543other 3 COM ports.
21544
21545@kindex show com1base
21546@kindex show com1irq
21547@kindex show com2base
21548@kindex show com2irq
21549@kindex show com3base
21550@kindex show com3irq
21551@kindex show com4base
21552@kindex show com4irq
21553The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21554display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21555lines used by the COM ports.
21556
21557@item info serial
21558@kindex info serial
21559@cindex DOS serial port status
21560This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports.  For each
21561port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21562IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21563counts of various errors encountered so far.
21564@end table
21565
21566
21567@node Cygwin Native
21568@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21569@cindex MS Windows debugging
21570@cindex native Cygwin debugging
21571@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21572
21573@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21574DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21575
21576@cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21577@cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21578MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21579special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21580by typing @kbd{C-c}.  For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21581supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21582sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21583ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21584
21585There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21586this section.  Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21587described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21588
21589@table @code
21590@kindex info w32
21591@item info w32
21592This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21593information about the target system and important OS structures.
21594
21595@item info w32 selector
21596This command displays information returned by
21597the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21598It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21599a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21600Without argument, this command displays information
21601about the six segment registers.
21602
21603@item info w32 thread-information-block
21604This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21605Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21606selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21607
21608@kindex signal-event
21609@item signal-event @var{id}
21610This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}.  Used to resume
21611crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21612
21613To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21614@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21615@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21616(for x86_64 versions):
21617
21618@itemize @minus
21619@item
21620@code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21621Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21622"attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21623
21624The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21625crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21626the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21627to attach.
21628
21629@item
21630@code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}.  @code{1} will
21631make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21632automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21633``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21634terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21635@end itemize
21636
21637@kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21638@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21639@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21640@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21641If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21642happen inside the Cygwin DLL.  If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21643@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21644exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21645``bookkeeping''.  This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21646Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21647@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21648
21649@kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21650@item show cygwin-exceptions
21651Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21652inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21653
21654@kindex set new-console
21655@item set new-console @var{mode}
21656If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21657be started in a new console on next start.
21658If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21659be started in the same console as the debugger.
21660
21661@kindex show new-console
21662@item show new-console
21663Displays whether a new console is used
21664when the debuggee is started.
21665
21666@kindex set new-group
21667@item set new-group @var{mode}
21668This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21669start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21670This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21671@samp{Ctrl-C}.
21672
21673@kindex show new-group
21674@item show new-group
21675Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21676
21677@kindex set debugevents
21678@item set debugevents
21679This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21680to the debuggee seen by the debugger.  This includes events that
21681signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21682unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21683Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21684
21685@kindex set debugexec
21686@item set debugexec
21687This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21688(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21689
21690@kindex set debugexceptions
21691@item set debugexceptions
21692This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21693debuggee seen by the debugger.
21694
21695@kindex set debugmemory
21696@item set debugmemory
21697This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21698and writes by the debugger.
21699
21700@kindex set shell
21701@item set shell
21702This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21703via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21704
21705@kindex show shell
21706@item show shell
21707Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21708
21709@end table
21710
21711@menu
21712* Non-debug DLL Symbols::  Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21713@end menu
21714
21715@node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21716@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21717@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21718@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21719
21720Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21721not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21722@file{kernel32.dll}).  When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21723symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21724information contained in the DLL's export table.  This section
21725describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21726``minimal symbols''.
21727
21728Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21729will have been loaded.  The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21730start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21731program run once to completion.
21732
21733@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21734
21735In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21736tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21737DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}.  The plain name is
21738also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21739sufficient.  In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21740(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21741necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21742contents of the DLL.  Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21743exclamation mark (``!'')  being interpreted as a language operator.
21744
21745Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21746though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa.  Since
21747symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21748some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21749@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21750(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21751
21752@smallexample
21753(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21754All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21755
21756Non-debugging symbols:
217570x77e885f4  CreateFileA
217580x77e885f4  KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21759@end smallexample
21760
21761@smallexample
21762(@value{GDBP}) info function !
21763All functions matching regular expression "!":
21764
21765Non-debugging symbols:
217660x6100114c  cygwin1!__assert
217670x61004034  cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
217680x61004240  cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21769[etc...]
21770@end smallexample
21771
21772@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21773
21774Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21775type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21776refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21777contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21778contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21779means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21780a function within a DLL without a running program.
21781
21782Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21783automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21784variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21785type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21786problem:
21787
21788@smallexample
21789(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21790$1 = 268572168
21791@end smallexample
21792
21793@smallexample
21794(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
217950x10021610:      "\230y\""
21796@end smallexample
21797
21798And two possible solutions:
21799
21800@smallexample
21801(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21802$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21803@end smallexample
21804
21805@smallexample
21806(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
218070x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>:    0x10021608      0x00000000
21808(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
218090x10021608:     0x0022fd98
21810(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
218110x22fd98:        "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21812@end smallexample
21813
21814Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21815starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21816examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21817function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21818to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21819
21820@smallexample
21821(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21822Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21823@end smallexample
21824
21825The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21826break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21827safe.
21828
21829@node Hurd Native
21830@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21831@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21832
21833This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21834@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21835
21836@table @code
21837@item set signals
21838@itemx set sigs
21839@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21840@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21841This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21842@value{GDBN}.  Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21843affected by this command.  @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21844@code{signals}.
21845
21846@item show signals
21847@itemx show sigs
21848@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21849@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21850Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21851
21852@item set signal-thread
21853@itemx set sigthread
21854@kindex set signal-thread
21855@kindex set sigthread
21856This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21857thread.  That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21858process.  @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21859signal-thread}.
21860
21861@item show signal-thread
21862@itemx show sigthread
21863@kindex show signal-thread
21864@kindex show sigthread
21865These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21866delivered a signal.
21867
21868@item set stopped
21869@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21870This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21871as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal.  The stopped process can be
21872continued by delivering a signal to it.
21873
21874@item show stopped
21875@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21876This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21877stopped.
21878
21879@item set exceptions
21880@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21881Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21882When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21883single-stepping will work.  To restore the default, set exception
21884trapping on.
21885
21886@item show exceptions
21887@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21888Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21889
21890@item set task pause
21891@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21892@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21893@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21894This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21895Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21896whenever @value{GDBN} gets control.  Setting it to off will take
21897effect the next time the inferior is continued.  If this option is set
21898to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21899thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21900
21901@item show task pause
21902@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21903Show the current state of task suspension.
21904
21905@item set task detach-suspend-count
21906@cindex task suspend count
21907@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21908This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21909@value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21910
21911@item show task detach-suspend-count
21912Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21913
21914@item set task exception-port
21915@itemx set task excp
21916@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21917This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21918forward exceptions.  The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21919rights} of the task.  @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21920
21921@item set noninvasive
21922@cindex noninvasive task options
21923This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21924invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned.  This
21925is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21926@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21927
21928@item info send-rights
21929@itemx info receive-rights
21930@itemx info port-rights
21931@itemx info port-sets
21932@itemx info dead-names
21933@itemx info ports
21934@itemx info psets
21935@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21936@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21937@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21938@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21939@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21940These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21941receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21942There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21943port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21944
21945@item set thread pause
21946@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21947@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21948@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21949This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21950control.  Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21951thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control.  Setting it to
21952off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21953Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21954control, the whole task is suspended.  However, if you used @code{set
21955task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21956only the current thread.
21957
21958@item show thread pause
21959@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21960This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21961
21962@item set thread run
21963This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21964
21965@item show thread run
21966Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21967
21968@item set thread detach-suspend-count
21969@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21970@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21971This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21972thread when detaching.  This number is relative to the suspend count
21973found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21974takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21975
21976@item show thread detach-suspend-count
21977Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21978detaching.
21979
21980@item set thread exception-port
21981@itemx set thread excp
21982Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions.  This
21983overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21984@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21985
21986@item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21987Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21988value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread.  This command
21989changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21990
21991@item set thread default
21992@itemx show thread default
21993@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21994Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21995default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21996thread default exception-port}, etc.).  The @code{thread default}
21997variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21998threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21999the non-default commands.
22000@end table
22001
22002@node Darwin
22003@subsection Darwin
22004@cindex Darwin
22005
22006@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22007
22008@table @code
22009@item set debug darwin @var{num}
22010@kindex set debug darwin
22011When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22012the Darwin support.  Higher values produce more verbose output.
22013
22014@item show debug darwin
22015@kindex show debug darwin
22016Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22017
22018@item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22019@kindex set debug mach-o
22020When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22021@value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files.  (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22022file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.)  Higher
22023values produce more verbose output.  This is a command to diagnose
22024problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22025usage.
22026
22027@item show debug mach-o
22028@kindex show debug mach-o
22029Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22030
22031@item set mach-exceptions on
22032@itemx set mach-exceptions off
22033@kindex set mach-exceptions
22034On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22035mapped to a Posix signal.  Use this command to turn on trapping of
22036Mach exceptions in the inferior.  This might be sometimes useful to
22037better understand the cause of a fault.  The default is off.
22038
22039@item show mach-exceptions
22040@kindex show mach-exceptions
22041Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22042@end table
22043
22044
22045@node Embedded OS
22046@section Embedded Operating Systems
22047
22048This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22049embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22050architectures.
22051
22052@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22053various real-time operating systems.
22054
22055@node Embedded Processors
22056@section Embedded Processors
22057
22058This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22059configurations.
22060
22061@cindex send command to simulator
22062Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22063allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22064
22065@table @code
22066@item sim @var{command}
22067@kindex sim@r{, a command}
22068Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator.  Consult the
22069documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22070acceptable commands.
22071@end table
22072
22073
22074@menu
22075* ARC::                         Synopsys ARC
22076* ARM::                         ARM
22077* M68K::                        Motorola M68K
22078* MicroBlaze::			Xilinx MicroBlaze
22079* MIPS Embedded::               MIPS Embedded
22080* PowerPC Embedded::            PowerPC Embedded
22081* AVR::                         Atmel AVR
22082* CRIS::                        CRIS
22083* Super-H::                     Renesas Super-H
22084@end menu
22085
22086@node ARC
22087@subsection Synopsys ARC
22088@cindex Synopsys ARC
22089@cindex ARC specific commands
22090@cindex ARC600
22091@cindex ARC700
22092@cindex ARC EM
22093@cindex ARC HS
22094
22095@value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22096
22097@table @code
22098@item set debug arc
22099@kindex set debug arc
22100Control the level of ARC specific debug messages.  Use 0 for no messages (the
22101default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22102
22103@item show debug arc
22104@kindex show debug arc
22105Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22106
22107@item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22108@kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22109Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22110
22111@end table
22112
22113@node ARM
22114@subsection ARM
22115
22116@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22117
22118@table @code
22119@item set arm disassembler
22120@kindex set arm
22121This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles.  The
22122@code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22123
22124@item show arm disassembler
22125@kindex show arm
22126Show the current disassembly style.
22127
22128@item set arm apcs32
22129@cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22130This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22131
22132@item show arm apcs32
22133Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22134
22135@item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22136This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type.  The
22137argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22138
22139@table @code
22140@item auto
22141Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22142@item softfpa
22143Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22144processors.
22145@item fpa
22146GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22147@item softvfp
22148Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22149@item vfp
22150VFP co-processor.
22151@end table
22152
22153@item show arm fpu
22154Show the current type of the FPU.
22155
22156@item set arm abi
22157This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22158
22159@item show arm abi
22160Show the currently used ABI.
22161
22162@item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22163@value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22164whether instructions are ARM or Thumb.  This command controls
22165@value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22166available.  The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22167use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22168register).
22169
22170@item show arm fallback-mode
22171Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22172
22173@item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22174This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22175instructions are ARM or Thumb.  The default is @samp{auto}, which
22176causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22177of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22178
22179@item show arm force-mode
22180Show the current forced instruction mode.
22181
22182@item set debug arm
22183Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22184target support subsystem.
22185
22186@item show debug arm
22187Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22188@end table
22189
22190@table @code
22191@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22192The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22193
22194@table @code
22195@item --swi-support=@var{type}
22196Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.  The argument
22197@var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22198The default value is @code{all}.
22199
22200@table @code
22201@item none
22202@item demon
22203@item angel
22204@item redboot
22205@item all
22206@end table
22207@end table
22208@end table
22209
22210@node M68K
22211@subsection M68k
22212
22213The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22214
22215@node MicroBlaze
22216@subsection MicroBlaze
22217@cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22218@cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22219
22220The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22221FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series.  Boards with these processors
22222usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22223Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22224This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22225the target FPGA.  The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22226communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22227presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board.  By default
22228@code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}.  (While it is possible to change
22229this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22230commands.  Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22231
22232Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22233
22234@table @code
22235@item target remote :1234
22236Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22237on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22238
22239@item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22240Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22241running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22242
22243@item load
22244Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22245
22246@item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22247Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22248
22249@item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22250Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22251@end table
22252
22253@node MIPS Embedded
22254@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22255
22256@noindent
22257@value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22258
22259@table @code
22260@item set mipsfpu double
22261@itemx set mipsfpu single
22262@itemx set mipsfpu none
22263@itemx set mipsfpu auto
22264@itemx show mipsfpu
22265@kindex set mipsfpu
22266@kindex show mipsfpu
22267@cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22268@cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22269If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22270coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22271need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22272file).  This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22273functions which return floating point values.  It also allows
22274@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22275functions on the board.  If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22276with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22277processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}.  The default
22278double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22279@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22280
22281In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22282floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22283and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22284
22285As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22286@samp{show mipsfpu}.
22287@end table
22288
22289@node PowerPC Embedded
22290@subsection PowerPC Embedded
22291
22292@cindex DVC register
22293@value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22294implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22295
22296@smallexample
22297(@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22298  if  @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22299@end smallexample
22300
22301The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22302such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22303debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22304variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte).  This feature
22305is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22306or newer.
22307
22308When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22309ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22310in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22311watching variables of scalar types.
22312
22313You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22314region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22315
22316@smallexample
22317(@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22318(@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22319@end smallexample
22320
22321PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints.  See the discussion
22322about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22323
22324@cindex ranged breakpoint
22325PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22326@dfn{ranged breakpoints}.  A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22327the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22328the range it specifies.  To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22329use the @code{break-range} command.
22330
22331@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22332
22333@table @code
22334@kindex break-range
22335@item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22336Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22337@var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22338a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22339location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22340for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22341The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22342executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22343(including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22344
22345@kindex set powerpc
22346@item set powerpc soft-float
22347@itemx show powerpc soft-float
22348Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22349convention.  By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22350on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22351
22352@item set powerpc vector-abi
22353@itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22354Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22355arguments and return values.  The valid options are @samp{auto};
22356@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22357@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22358registers.  By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22359based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22360
22361@item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22362@itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22363Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22364of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22365address of its first byte.
22366
22367@end table
22368
22369@node AVR
22370@subsection Atmel AVR
22371@cindex AVR
22372
22373When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22374following AVR-specific commands:
22375
22376@table @code
22377@item info io_registers
22378@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22379@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22380This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers.  For
22381each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22382@end table
22383
22384@node CRIS
22385@subsection CRIS
22386@cindex CRIS
22387
22388When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22389following CRIS-specific commands:
22390
22391@table @code
22392@item set cris-version @var{ver}
22393@cindex CRIS version
22394Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22395The CRIS version affects register names and sizes.  This command is useful in
22396case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22397
22398@item show cris-version
22399Show the current CRIS version.
22400
22401@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22402@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22403Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging.  The default is @samp{on}.
22404Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22405@code{R59}.
22406
22407@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22408Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22409
22410@item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22411@cindex CRIS mode
22412Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}.  It should only be changed when
22413debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22414@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22415
22416@item show cris-mode
22417Show the current CRIS mode.
22418@end table
22419
22420@node Super-H
22421@subsection Renesas Super-H
22422@cindex Super-H
22423
22424For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22425commands:
22426
22427@table @code
22428@item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22429@kindex set sh calling-convention
22430Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22431Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22432With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22433convention.  If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22434that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22435is called using the Renesas calling convention.  If the calling convention
22436is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22437regardless of the DWARF-2 information.  This can be used to override the
22438default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22439does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22440
22441@item show sh calling-convention
22442@kindex show sh calling-convention
22443Show the current calling convention setting.
22444
22445@end table
22446
22447
22448@node Architectures
22449@section Architectures
22450
22451This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22452all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22453
22454@menu
22455* AArch64::
22456* i386::
22457* Alpha::
22458* MIPS::
22459* HPPA::               HP PA architecture
22460* SPU::                Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22461* PowerPC::
22462* Nios II::
22463@end menu
22464
22465@node AArch64
22466@subsection AArch64
22467@cindex AArch64 support
22468
22469When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22470following special commands:
22471
22472@table @code
22473@item set debug aarch64
22474@kindex set debug aarch64
22475This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22476messages are to be displayed.
22477
22478@item show debug aarch64
22479Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22480
22481@end table
22482
22483@node i386
22484@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22485
22486@table @code
22487@item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22488@kindex set struct-convention
22489@cindex struct return convention
22490@cindex struct/union returned in registers
22491Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22492@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}.  Possible values of
22493@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22494default).  @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22495are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22496@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22497be returned in a register.
22498
22499@item show struct-convention
22500@kindex show struct-convention
22501Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22502from functions.
22503@end table
22504
22505
22506@subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22507@cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22508
22509Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22510@footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22511registers.} through @samp{BND3}.  Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22512which are the lower bound and upper bound.  Bounds are effective addresses or
22513memory locations.  The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22514complement form.  A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22515(1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22516
22517@samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22518through @samp{bnd3raw}.  Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22519display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22520upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22521@value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}.  In this sense it
22522can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22523
22524As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22525access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71.  The values present on
22526bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22527
22528@smallexample
22529	bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22530	bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22531@end smallexample
22532
22533This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw.  Any
22534change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22535counterpart.  When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22536Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22537the pointer.
22538
22539Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22540application memory.  These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22541the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds.  Evaluating and changing
22542bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22543bugs on MPX context.  @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22544
22545@table @code
22546@item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22547@kindex show mpx bound
22548Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22549
22550@item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22551@kindex  set mpx bound
22552Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22553This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22554whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22555for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22556@end table
22557
22558When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22559GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22560before calling the function.  As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22561pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22562
22563This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22564program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22565Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22566clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22567function.
22568
22569You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22570execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22571called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22572continuing the execution.  For example:
22573
22574@smallexample
22575	$ break *upper
22576	Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22577	$ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22578	Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22579	$ print $bnd0
22580	@{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22581@end smallexample
22582
22583At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22584violations caused along the execution of the call.  In order to know how to
22585set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22586
22587@node Alpha
22588@subsection Alpha
22589
22590See the following section.
22591
22592@node MIPS
22593@subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22594
22595@cindex stack on Alpha
22596@cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22597@cindex Alpha stack
22598@cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22599Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22600sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22601find the beginning of a function.
22602
22603@cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22604To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22605@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22606you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22607commands:
22608
22609@table @code
22610@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22611@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22612Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22613search for the beginning of a function.  A value of @var{0} (the
22614default) means there is no limit.  However, except for @var{0}, the
22615larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22616and therefore the longer it takes to run.  You should only need to use
22617this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22618
22619@item show heuristic-fence-post
22620Display the current limit.
22621@end table
22622
22623@noindent
22624These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22625for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22626
22627Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22628programs:
22629
22630@table @code
22631@item set mips abi @var{arg}
22632@kindex set mips abi
22633@cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22634Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior.  Possible
22635values of @var{arg} are:
22636
22637@table @samp
22638@item auto
22639The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22640default).
22641@item o32
22642@item o64
22643@item n32
22644@item n64
22645@item eabi32
22646@item eabi64
22647@end table
22648
22649@item show mips abi
22650@kindex show mips abi
22651Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22652
22653@item set mips compression @var{arg}
22654@kindex set mips compression
22655@cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22656Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22657@acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22658inferior.  @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22659internal interpretation purposes.  This setting is only referred to
22660when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22661the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22662Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22663provided by the executable.
22664
22665Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22666The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22667executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22668identified as such.
22669
22670This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22671debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22672implicitly from an executable.
22673
22674The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22675identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22676@acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s.  If these function-scope annotations
22677are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22678compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22679
22680@item show mips compression
22681@kindex show mips compression
22682Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22683@value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22684
22685@item set mipsfpu
22686@itemx show mipsfpu
22687@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22688
22689@item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22690@kindex set mips mask-address
22691@cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22692This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22693@acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off.  The argument @var{arg} can be
22694@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}.  The latter is the default
22695setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22696
22697@item show mips mask-address
22698@kindex show mips mask-address
22699Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22700not.
22701
22702@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22703@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22704This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22705transfer data in 32-bit quantities.  If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22706that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22707and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22708
22709@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22710@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22711Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22712
22713@item set debug mips
22714@kindex set debug mips
22715This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22716target code in @value{GDBN}.
22717
22718@item show debug mips
22719@kindex show debug mips
22720Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22721@end table
22722
22723
22724@node HPPA
22725@subsection HPPA
22726@cindex HPPA support
22727
22728When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22729following special commands:
22730
22731@table @code
22732@item set debug hppa
22733@kindex set debug hppa
22734This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22735messages are to be displayed.
22736
22737@item show debug hppa
22738Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22739
22740@item maint print unwind @var{address}
22741@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22742This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22743given @var{address}.
22744
22745@end table
22746
22747
22748@node SPU
22749@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22750@cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22751@cindex SPU
22752
22753When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22754it provides the following special commands:
22755
22756@table @code
22757@item info spu event
22758@kindex info spu
22759Display SPU event facility status.  Shows current event mask
22760and pending event status.
22761
22762@item info spu signal
22763Display SPU signal notification facility status.  Shows pending
22764signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22765notification channels.
22766
22767@item info spu mailbox
22768Display SPU mailbox facility status.  Shows all pending entries,
22769in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22770SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22771
22772@item info spu dma
22773Display MFC DMA status.  Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22774DMA queue.  For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22775and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22776
22777@item info spu proxydma
22778Display MFC Proxy-DMA status.  Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22779Proxy-DMA queue.  For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22780and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22781
22782@end table
22783
22784When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22785on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22786special commands:
22787
22788@table @code
22789@item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22790@kindex set spu
22791Set whether to stop for new SPE threads.  When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22792will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22793function.  The default is @code{off}.
22794
22795@item show spu stop-on-load
22796@kindex show spu
22797Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22798
22799@item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22800Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.  When set to
22801@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22802cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops.  This provides a consistent
22803view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache.  If an application
22804does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22805
22806@item show spu auto-flush-cache
22807Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22808
22809@end table
22810
22811@node PowerPC
22812@subsection PowerPC
22813@cindex PowerPC architecture
22814
22815When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22816pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22817numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22818in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22819@code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22820
22821The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22822by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22823@code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22824
22825For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22826wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22827
22828@node Nios II
22829@subsection Nios II
22830@cindex Nios II architecture
22831
22832When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22833it provides the following special commands:
22834
22835@table @code
22836
22837@item set debug nios2
22838@kindex set debug nios2
22839This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22840target code in @value{GDBN}.
22841
22842@item show debug nios2
22843@kindex show debug nios2
22844Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22845@end table
22846
22847@node Controlling GDB
22848@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22849
22850You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22851@code{set} command.  For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22852data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.  Other settings are
22853described here.
22854
22855@menu
22856* Prompt::                      Prompt
22857* Editing::                     Command editing
22858* Command History::             Command history
22859* Screen Size::                 Screen size
22860* Numbers::                     Numbers
22861* ABI::                         Configuring the current ABI
22862* Auto-loading::                Automatically loading associated files
22863* Messages/Warnings::           Optional warnings and messages
22864* Debugging Output::            Optional messages about internal happenings
22865* Other Misc Settings::         Other Miscellaneous Settings
22866@end menu
22867
22868@node Prompt
22869@section Prompt
22870
22871@cindex prompt
22872
22873@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22874called the @dfn{prompt}.  This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.  You
22875can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command.  For
22876instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22877the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22878which one you are talking to.
22879
22880@emph{Note:}  @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22881prompt you set.  This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22882or a prompt that does not.
22883
22884@table @code
22885@kindex set prompt
22886@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22887Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22888
22889@kindex show prompt
22890@item show prompt
22891Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22892@end table
22893
22894Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22895prompt extensions.  The commands for interacting with these extensions
22896are:
22897
22898@table @code
22899@kindex set extended-prompt
22900@item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22901Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22902@xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22903substitution.  Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22904string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22905is displayed.
22906
22907For example:
22908
22909@smallexample
22910set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22911@end smallexample
22912
22913Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22914@var{prompt_hook} hook.  @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22915
22916@kindex show extended-prompt
22917@item show extended-prompt
22918Prints the extended prompt.  Any escape sequences specified as part of
22919the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22920corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22921@end table
22922
22923@node Editing
22924@section Command Editing
22925@cindex readline
22926@cindex command line editing
22927
22928@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface.  This
22929@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22930command line interface to the user.  Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22931or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22932substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22933debugging sessions.
22934
22935You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22936command @code{set}.
22937
22938@table @code
22939@kindex set editing
22940@cindex editing
22941@item set editing
22942@itemx set editing on
22943Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22944
22945@item set editing off
22946Disable command line editing.
22947
22948@kindex show editing
22949@item show editing
22950Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22951@end table
22952
22953@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22954@xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22955@end ifset
22956@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22957@xref{Command Line Editing},
22958@end ifclear
22959for more details about the Readline
22960interface.  Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22961encouraged to read that chapter.
22962
22963@node Command History
22964@section Command History
22965@cindex command history
22966
22967@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22968debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22969happened.  Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22970history facility.
22971
22972@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22973package, to provide the history facility.
22974@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22975@xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22976@end ifset
22977@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22978@xref{Using History Interactively},
22979@end ifclear
22980for the detailed description of the History library.
22981
22982To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22983the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22984(@pxref{Server Prefix}).  This
22985means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22986affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22987pressed on a line by itself.
22988
22989@cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22990The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22991history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22992use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22993
22994Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22995history.
22996
22997@table @code
22998@cindex history substitution
22999@cindex history file
23000@kindex set history filename
23001@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23002@item set history filename @var{fname}
23003Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23004This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23005list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23006exits.  You can access this list through history expansion or through
23007the history command editing characters listed below.  This file defaults
23008to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23009@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23010is not set.
23011
23012@cindex save command history
23013@kindex set history save
23014@item set history save
23015@itemx set history save on
23016Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23017@code{set history filename} command.  By default, this option is disabled.
23018
23019@item set history save off
23020Stop recording command history in a file.
23021
23022@cindex history size
23023@kindex set history size
23024@cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23025@item set history size @var{size}
23026@itemx set history size unlimited
23027Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23028This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23029to 256 if this variable is not set.  Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23030are ignored.  If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23031either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23032@value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23033
23034@cindex remove duplicate history
23035@kindex set history remove-duplicates
23036@item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23037@itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23038Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23039If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23040history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23041entry being added to the command history list.  If @var{count} is
23042@code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded.  If @var{count} is 0, then
23043removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23044
23045Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23046removal.  This option is set to 0 by default.
23047
23048@end table
23049
23050History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23051@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23052@xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23053@end ifset
23054@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23055@xref{Event Designators},
23056@end ifclear
23057for more details.
23058
23059@cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23060Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23061is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23062@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23063follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23064a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded.  The readline
23065history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23066@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23067
23068The commands to control history expansion are:
23069
23070@table @code
23071@item set history expansion on
23072@itemx set history expansion
23073@kindex set history expansion
23074Enable history expansion.  History expansion is off by default.
23075
23076@item set history expansion off
23077Disable history expansion.
23078
23079@c @group
23080@kindex show history
23081@item show history
23082@itemx show history filename
23083@itemx show history save
23084@itemx show history size
23085@itemx show history expansion
23086These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23087@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23088@c @end group
23089@end table
23090
23091@table @code
23092@kindex show commands
23093@cindex show last commands
23094@cindex display command history
23095@item show commands
23096Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23097
23098@item show commands @var{n}
23099Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23100
23101@item show commands +
23102Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23103@end table
23104
23105@node Screen Size
23106@section Screen Size
23107@cindex size of screen
23108@cindex screen size
23109@cindex pagination
23110@cindex page size
23111@cindex pauses in output
23112
23113Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23114information output to the screen.  To help you read all of it,
23115@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23116output.  Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23117to discard the remaining output.  Also, the screen width setting
23118determines when to wrap lines of output.  Depending on what is being
23119printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23120rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23121
23122Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23123driver software.  For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23124together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23125@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings.  If this is not correct,
23126you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23127width} commands:
23128
23129@table @code
23130@kindex set height
23131@kindex set width
23132@kindex show width
23133@kindex show height
23134@item set height @var{lpp}
23135@itemx set height unlimited
23136@itemx show height
23137@itemx set width @var{cpl}
23138@itemx set width unlimited
23139@itemx show width
23140These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23141a screen width of @var{cpl} characters.  The associated @code{show}
23142commands display the current settings.
23143
23144If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23145@value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23146output is.  This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23147buffer.
23148
23149Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23150width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23151
23152@item set pagination on
23153@itemx set pagination off
23154@kindex set pagination
23155Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on.  Turning
23156pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}.  Note that
23157running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23158Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23159
23160@item show pagination
23161@kindex show pagination
23162Show the current pagination mode.
23163@end table
23164
23165@node Numbers
23166@section Numbers
23167@cindex number representation
23168@cindex entering numbers
23169
23170You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23171@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23172@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23173begin with @samp{0x}.  Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23174@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
2317510; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23176format is specified---is base 10.  You can change the default base for
23177both input and output with the commands described below.
23178
23179@table @code
23180@kindex set input-radix
23181@item set input-radix @var{base}
23182Set the default base for numeric input.  Supported choices
23183for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16.  The base must itself be
23184specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23185example, any of
23186
23187@smallexample
23188set input-radix 012
23189set input-radix 10.
23190set input-radix 0xa
23191@end smallexample
23192
23193@noindent
23194sets the input base to decimal.  On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23195leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23196@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23197interpreted in the current radix.  Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23198@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23199change the radix.
23200
23201@kindex set output-radix
23202@item set output-radix @var{base}
23203Set the default base for numeric display.  Supported choices
23204for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16.  The base must itself be
23205specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23206
23207@kindex show input-radix
23208@item show input-radix
23209Display the current default base for numeric input.
23210
23211@kindex show output-radix
23212@item show output-radix
23213Display the current default base for numeric display.
23214
23215@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23216@itemx show radix
23217@kindex set radix
23218@kindex show radix
23219These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23220of numbers.  @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23221the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23222default value of 10.
23223
23224@end table
23225
23226@node ABI
23227@section Configuring the Current ABI
23228
23229@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23230application automatically.  However, sometimes you need to override its
23231conclusions.  Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23232current ABI.
23233
23234@cindex OS ABI
23235@kindex set osabi
23236@kindex show osabi
23237@cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23238
23239One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23240system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23241@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23242but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23243One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23244an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23245not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23246platform provides.
23247
23248When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23249``Newlib'' OS ABI.  This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23250@code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23251The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23252
23253@table @code
23254@item show osabi
23255Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23256
23257@item set osabi
23258With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23259
23260@item set osabi @var{abi}
23261Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23262@end table
23263
23264@cindex float promotion
23265
23266Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23267function depends on whether the function is prototyped.  For a prototyped
23268(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23269according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}.  For unprototyped
23270(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23271@code{double} and then passed.
23272
23273Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23274a function is prototyped.  If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23275as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23276
23277@table @code
23278@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23279@item set coerce-float-to-double
23280@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23281Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23282to an unprototyped function.  This is the default setting.
23283
23284@item set coerce-float-to-double off
23285Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23286functions.
23287
23288@kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23289@item show coerce-float-to-double
23290Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23291@end table
23292
23293@kindex set cp-abi
23294@kindex show cp-abi
23295@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23296objects.  The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23297used to build your application.  @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23298programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23299multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23300program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23301Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23302before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23303``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler.  Other C@t{++} compilers may
23304use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well.  The default setting is
23305``auto''.
23306
23307@table @code
23308@item show cp-abi
23309Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23310
23311@item set cp-abi
23312With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23313
23314@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23315@itemx set cp-abi auto
23316Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23317@end table
23318
23319@node Auto-loading
23320@section Automatically loading associated files
23321@cindex auto-loading
23322
23323@value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23324without being explicitly told so by the user.  We call this feature
23325@dfn{auto-loading}.  While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23326@value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23327results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23328sources).
23329
23330@menu
23331* Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23332* libthread_db.so.1 file::             @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23333
23334* Auto-loading safe path::             @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23335* Auto-loading verbose mode::          @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23336@end menu
23337
23338There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23339In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23340in various extension languages.  @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23341
23342Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23343file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23344(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23345
23346For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23347control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23348
23349@table @code
23350@anchor{set auto-load off}
23351@kindex set auto-load off
23352@item set auto-load off
23353Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23354You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23355(@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23356@smallexample
23357$ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23358@end smallexample
23359
23360Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23361and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23362still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23363To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23364@option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23365@code{set auto-load no}.
23366
23367@anchor{show auto-load}
23368@kindex show auto-load
23369@item show auto-load
23370Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23371or disabled.
23372
23373@smallexample
23374(gdb) show auto-load
23375gdb-scripts:  Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23376libthread-db:  Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23377local-gdbinit:  Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23378                is on.
23379python-scripts:  Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23380safe-path:  List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23381            is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23382scripts-directory:  List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23383                    is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23384@end smallexample
23385
23386@anchor{info auto-load}
23387@kindex info auto-load
23388@item info auto-load
23389Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23390not.
23391
23392@smallexample
23393(gdb) info auto-load
23394gdb-scripts:
23395Loaded  Script
23396Yes     /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23397libthread-db:  No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23398local-gdbinit:  Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23399                loaded.
23400python-scripts:
23401Loaded  Script
23402Yes     /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23403@end smallexample
23404@end table
23405
23406These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23407
23408@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23409@item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23410@tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23411@item @xref{show auto-load}.
23412@tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23413@item @xref{info auto-load}.
23414@tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23415@item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23416@tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23417@item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23418@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23419@item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23420@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23421@item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23422@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23423@item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23424@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23425@item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23426@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23427@item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23428@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23429@item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23430@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23431@item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23432@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23433@item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23434@tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23435@item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23436@tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23437@item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23438@tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23439@item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23440@tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23441@item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23442@tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23443@item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23444@tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23445@item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23446@tab Control for thread debugging library.
23447@item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23448@tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23449@item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23450@tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23451@item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23452@tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23453@item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23454@tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23455@item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23456@tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23457@end multitable
23458
23459@node Init File in the Current Directory
23460@subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23461@cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23462
23463By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23464from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23465see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23466
23467Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23468configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23469
23470@table @code
23471@anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23472@kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23473@item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23474Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23475(@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23476
23477@anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23478@kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23479@item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23480Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23481current directory is enabled or disabled.
23482
23483@anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23484@kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23485@item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23486Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23487current directory have been auto-loaded.
23488@end table
23489
23490@node libthread_db.so.1 file
23491@subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23492@cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23493
23494This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23495
23496@value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23497to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23498
23499The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23500without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23501libraries have to be trusted in general.  In all other cases of
23502@samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23503auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23504library.
23505
23506Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23507@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23508
23509@table @code
23510@anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23511@kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23512@item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23513Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23514
23515@anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23516@kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23517@item show auto-load libthread-db
23518Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23519enabled or disabled.
23520
23521@anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23522@kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23523@item info auto-load libthread-db
23524Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23525for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23526@end table
23527
23528@node Auto-loading safe path
23529@subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23530@cindex auto-loading safe-path
23531
23532As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23533an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23534@value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23535directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23536Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23537
23538If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23539get loaded:
23540
23541@smallexample
23542$ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23543Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23544warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23545         declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23546         to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23547warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23548         declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23549         to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23550@end smallexample
23551
23552@noindent
23553To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23554invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23555
23556@smallexample
23557$ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23558@end smallexample
23559
23560The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23561
23562@table @code
23563@anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23564@kindex set auto-load safe-path
23565@item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23566Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23567loading and execution of scripts.  You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23568Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23569directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23570(@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23571If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23572its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23573
23574The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23575systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23576to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23577
23578@anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23579@kindex show auto-load safe-path
23580@item show auto-load safe-path
23581Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23582scripts.
23583
23584@anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23585@kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23586@item add-auto-load-safe-path
23587Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23588automatic loading and execution of scripts.  Multiple entries may be delimited
23589by the host platform path separator in use.
23590@end table
23591
23592This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23593to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}).  @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23594substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23595The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23596@value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23597
23598Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23599corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23600@option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23601This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23602system superuser only.  Users can add their source directories in init files in
23603their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}).  See also deprecated
23604init file in the current directory
23605(@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23606
23607To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23608example, you could use one of the following ways:
23609
23610@table @asis
23611@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23612Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23613You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23614by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23615
23616@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23617Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23618@value{GDBN} session.
23619
23620@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23621Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23622This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23623from trusted sources.
23624
23625@item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23626During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23627This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23628trusted sources.
23629@end table
23630
23631On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23632also suppresses any such warning messages:
23633
23634@table @asis
23635@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23636You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23637
23638@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23639Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23640(@pxref{Home Directory Init File}).  While it is improbable, you could also
23641use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23642@end table
23643
23644This setting applies to the file names as entered by user.  If no entry matches
23645@value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23646their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23647entries again.  @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23648own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23649recommended to be entered.
23650
23651@node Auto-loading verbose mode
23652@subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23653@cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23654
23655For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23656be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23657execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23658all the files attempted to be loaded.  Both existing and non-existing files may
23659be printed.
23660
23661For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23662(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23663may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23664
23665@smallexample
23666(gdb) set debug auto-load on
23667(gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23668auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23669           for objfile "/tmp/true".
23670auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23671auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23672auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23673warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23674         by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23675@end smallexample
23676
23677@table @code
23678@anchor{set debug auto-load}
23679@kindex set debug auto-load
23680@item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23681Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23682
23683@anchor{show debug auto-load}
23684@kindex show debug auto-load
23685@item show debug auto-load
23686Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23687on or off.
23688@end table
23689
23690@node Messages/Warnings
23691@section Optional Warnings and Messages
23692
23693@cindex verbose operation
23694@cindex optional warnings
23695By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings.  If you are
23696running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23697command.  This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23698internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23699
23700Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23701which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23702see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23703
23704@table @code
23705@kindex set verbose
23706@item set verbose on
23707Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23708
23709@item set verbose off
23710Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23711
23712@kindex show verbose
23713@item show verbose
23714Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23715@end table
23716
23717By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23718object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23719find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23720Symbol Files}).
23721
23722@table @code
23723
23724@kindex set complaints
23725@item set complaints @var{limit}
23726Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23727unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem.  Set
23728@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23729to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23730
23731@kindex show complaints
23732@item show complaints
23733Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23734
23735@end table
23736
23737@anchor{confirmation requests}
23738By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23739lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands.  For example, if
23740you try to run a program which is already running:
23741
23742@smallexample
23743(@value{GDBP}) run
23744The program being debugged has been started already.
23745Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23746@end smallexample
23747
23748If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23749commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23750
23751@table @code
23752
23753@kindex set confirm
23754@cindex flinching
23755@cindex confirmation
23756@cindex stupid questions
23757@item set confirm off
23758Disables confirmation requests.  Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23759the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23760automatically disables confirmation requests.
23761
23762@item set confirm on
23763Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23764
23765@kindex show confirm
23766@item show confirm
23767Displays state of confirmation requests.
23768
23769@end table
23770
23771@cindex command tracing
23772If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23773useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}.  In this mode each command will be
23774printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23775quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23776
23777@table @code
23778@kindex set trace-commands
23779@cindex command scripts, debugging
23780@item set trace-commands on
23781Enable command tracing.
23782@item set trace-commands off
23783Disable command tracing.
23784@item show trace-commands
23785Display the current state of command tracing.
23786@end table
23787
23788@node Debugging Output
23789@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23790@cindex optional debugging messages
23791
23792@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23793various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23794interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug.  This
23795section documents those commands.
23796
23797@table @code
23798@kindex set exec-done-display
23799@item set exec-done-display
23800Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23801completion.  When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23802asynchronous command finishes its execution.  The default is off.
23803@kindex show exec-done-display
23804@item show exec-done-display
23805Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23806notification.
23807@kindex set debug
23808@cindex ARM AArch64
23809@item set debug aarch64
23810Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23811The default is off.
23812@kindex show debug
23813@item show debug aarch64
23814Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23815ARM AArch64.
23816@cindex gdbarch debugging info
23817@cindex architecture debugging info
23818@item set debug arch
23819Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info.  The default is off
23820@item show debug arch
23821Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23822@item set debug aix-solib
23823@cindex AIX shared library debugging
23824Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23825support module.  The default is off.
23826@item show debug aix-thread
23827Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23828@item set debug aix-thread
23829@cindex AIX threads
23830Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23831module.
23832@item show debug aix-thread
23833Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23834@item set debug check-physname
23835@cindex physname
23836Check the results of the ``physname'' computation.  When reading DWARF
23837debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23838each entity's name.  @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23839different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23840When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23841both ways and display any discrepancies.
23842@item show debug check-physname
23843Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23844@item set debug coff-pe-read
23845@cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23846Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23847exported symbols.  The default is off.
23848@item show debug coff-pe-read
23849Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23850reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23851@item set debug dwarf-die
23852@cindex DWARF DIEs
23853Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23854The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23855A value of zero turns off the display.
23856@item show debug dwarf-die
23857Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23858@item set debug dwarf-line
23859@cindex DWARF Line Tables
23860Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23861DWARF line tables.  The default is 0 (off).
23862A value of 1 provides basic information.
23863A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23864@item show debug dwarf-line
23865Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23866@item set debug dwarf-read
23867@cindex DWARF Reading
23868Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23869DWARF debug info.  The default is 0 (off).
23870A value of 1 provides basic information.
23871A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23872@item show debug dwarf-read
23873Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23874@item set debug displaced
23875@cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23876Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23877displaced stepping support.  The default is off.
23878@item show debug displaced
23879Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23880related to displaced stepping.
23881@item set debug event
23882@cindex event debugging info
23883Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info.  The
23884default is off.
23885@item show debug event
23886Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23887info.
23888@item set debug expression
23889@cindex expression debugging info
23890Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23891expression parsing.  The default is off.
23892@item show debug expression
23893Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23894@value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23895@item set debug fbsd-lwp
23896@cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23897Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23898@item show debug fbsd-lwp
23899Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23900@item set debug frame
23901@cindex frame debugging info
23902Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info.  The
23903default is off.
23904@item show debug frame
23905Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23906info.
23907@item set debug gnu-nat
23908@cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23909Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23910@item show debug gnu-nat
23911Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23912@item set debug infrun
23913@cindex inferior debugging info
23914Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23915The default is off.  @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23916for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23917@item show debug infrun
23918Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23919@item set debug jit
23920@cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23921Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23922@item show debug jit
23923Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23924@item set debug lin-lwp
23925@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23926@cindex Linux lightweight processes
23927Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23928@item show debug lin-lwp
23929Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23930@item set debug linux-namespaces
23931@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23932Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23933@item show debug linux-namespaces
23934Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23935@item set debug mach-o
23936@cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23937Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23938processing.  The default is off.
23939@item show debug mach-o
23940Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23941reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23942@item set debug notification
23943@cindex remote async notification debugging info
23944Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23945The default is off.
23946@item show debug notification
23947Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23948@item set debug observer
23949@cindex observer debugging info
23950Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging.  This
23951includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23952@item show debug observer
23953Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23954@item set debug overload
23955@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23956Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23957info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc.  The default
23958is off.
23959@item show debug overload
23960Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23961debugging info.
23962@cindex expression parser, debugging info
23963@cindex debug expression parser
23964@item set debug parser
23965Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23966Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23967parser.  @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23968details.  The default is off.
23969@item show debug parser
23970Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23971@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23972@cindex serial connections, debugging
23973@cindex debug remote protocol
23974@cindex remote protocol debugging
23975@cindex display remote packets
23976@item set debug remote
23977Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23978the serial line to the remote machine.  The info is printed on the
23979@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23980@item show debug remote
23981Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23982@item set debug serial
23983Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23984default is off.
23985@item show debug serial
23986Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23987info.
23988@item set debug solib-frv
23989@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23990Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23991@item show debug solib-frv
23992Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23993messages.
23994@item set debug symbol-lookup
23995@cindex symbol lookup
23996Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23997The default is 0 (off).
23998A value of 1 provides basic information.
23999A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24000@item show debug symbol-lookup
24001Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24002@item set debug symfile
24003@cindex symbol file functions
24004Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24005The default is off.  @xref{Files}.
24006@item show debug symfile
24007Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24008@item set debug symtab-create
24009@cindex symbol table creation
24010Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24011The default is 0 (off).
24012A value of 1 provides basic information.
24013A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24014@item show debug symtab-create
24015Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24016@item set debug target
24017@cindex target debugging info
24018Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24019includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24020default is 0.  Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24021value of large memory transfers.
24022@item show debug target
24023Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24024info.
24025@item set debug timestamp
24026@cindex timestampping debugging info
24027Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24028When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24029message.
24030@item show debug timestamp
24031Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24032debugging info.
24033@item set debug varobj
24034@cindex variable object debugging info
24035Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24036info. The default is off.
24037@item show debug varobj
24038Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24039debugging info.
24040@item set debug xml
24041@cindex XML parser debugging
24042Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24043@item show debug xml
24044Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24045@end table
24046
24047@node Other Misc Settings
24048@section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24049@cindex miscellaneous settings
24050
24051@table @code
24052@kindex set interactive-mode
24053@item set interactive-mode
24054If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24055in a terminal.  In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24056for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24057the command prompt.  If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24058in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24059If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24060its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24061is, non-interactively otherwise.
24062
24063In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24064correctly which mode should be used.  But this setting can be useful
24065in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24066inside a cygwin window.
24067
24068@kindex show interactive-mode
24069@item show interactive-mode
24070Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24071@end table
24072
24073@node Extending GDB
24074@chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24075@cindex extending GDB
24076
24077@value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24078@value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24079extensions when it reads a file for debugging.  This allows the
24080user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24081being debugged.
24082
24083@menu
24084* Sequences::                Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24085* Python::                   Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24086* Guile::                    Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24087* Auto-loading extensions::  Automatically loading extensions
24088* Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24089* Aliases::                  Creating new spellings of existing commands
24090@end menu
24091
24092To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24093of evaluating the contents of a file.  When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24094can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24095the filename extension.  Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24096are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24097@xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24098
24099You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24100setting:
24101
24102@table @code
24103@kindex set script-extension
24104@kindex show script-extension
24105@item set script-extension off
24106All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24107
24108@item set script-extension soft
24109The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24110extension.  If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24111evaluates the script using that language.  Otherwise, it evaluates
24112the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24113
24114@item set script-extension strict
24115The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24116extension, and evaluates the script using that language.  If the
24117language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24118
24119@item show script-extension
24120Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24121
24122@end table
24123
24124@node Sequences
24125@section Canned Sequences of Commands
24126
24127Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24128Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24129commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24130files.
24131
24132@menu
24133* Define::             How to define your own commands
24134* Hooks::              Hooks for user-defined commands
24135* Command Files::      How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24136* Output::             Commands for controlled output
24137* Auto-loading sequences::  Controlling auto-loaded command files
24138@end menu
24139
24140@node Define
24141@subsection User-defined Commands
24142
24143@cindex user-defined command
24144@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24145A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24146which you assign a new name as a command.  This is done with the
24147@code{define} command.  User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24148separated by whitespace.  Arguments are accessed within the user command
24149via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}.  A trivial example:
24150
24151@smallexample
24152define adder
24153  print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24154end
24155@end smallexample
24156
24157@noindent
24158To execute the command use:
24159
24160@smallexample
24161adder 1 2 3
24162@end smallexample
24163
24164@noindent
24165This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24166its three arguments.  Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24167reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24168functions calls.
24169
24170@cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24171@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24172In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24173been passed.
24174
24175@smallexample
24176define adder
24177  if $argc == 2
24178    print $arg0 + $arg1
24179  end
24180  if $argc == 3
24181    print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24182  end
24183end
24184@end smallexample
24185
24186Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24187to process a variable number of arguments:
24188
24189@smallexample
24190define adder
24191  set $i = 0
24192  set $sum = 0
24193  while $i < $argc
24194    eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24195    set $i = $i + 1
24196  end
24197  print $sum
24198end
24199@end smallexample
24200
24201@table @code
24202
24203@kindex define
24204@item define @var{commandname}
24205Define a command named @var{commandname}.  If there is already a command
24206by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24207The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24208numbers, dashes, and underscores.  It may also start with any predefined
24209prefix command.  For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24210a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24211
24212The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24213which are given following the @code{define} command.  The end of these
24214commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24215
24216@kindex document
24217@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24218@item document @var{commandname}
24219Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24220accessed by @code{help}.  The command @var{commandname} must already be
24221defined.  This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24222reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24223After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24224@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24225
24226You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24227documentation of a command.  Redefining the command with @code{define}
24228does not change the documentation.
24229
24230@kindex dont-repeat
24231@cindex don't repeat command
24232@item dont-repeat
24233Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24234command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24235(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24236
24237@kindex help user-defined
24238@item help user-defined
24239List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24240COMAND_USER.  The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24241included (if any).
24242
24243@kindex show user
24244@item show user
24245@itemx show user @var{commandname}
24246Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24247not its documentation).  If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24248definitions for all user-defined commands.
24249This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24250
24251@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24252@kindex show max-user-call-depth
24253@kindex set max-user-call-depth
24254@item show max-user-call-depth
24255@itemx set max-user-call-depth
24256The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24257levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24258infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24259This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24260@end table
24261
24262In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24263use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24264
24265When user-defined commands are executed, the
24266commands of the definition are not printed.  An error in any command
24267stops execution of the user-defined command.
24268
24269If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24270without asking when used inside a user-defined command.  Many @value{GDBN}
24271commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24272messages when used in a user-defined command.
24273
24274@node Hooks
24275@subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24276@cindex command hooks
24277@cindex hooks, for commands
24278@cindex hooks, pre-command
24279
24280@kindex hook
24281You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24282command.  Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24283command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24284before that command.
24285
24286@cindex hooks, post-command
24287@kindex hookpost
24288A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24289Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24290@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24291that command.  Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24292pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24293
24294It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks.  If this
24295occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24296
24297@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24298@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not.  FIXME!
24299
24300@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24301In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists.  Defining
24302(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24303execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24304displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24305
24306For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24307single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24308you could define:
24309
24310@smallexample
24311define hook-stop
24312handle SIGALRM nopass
24313end
24314
24315define hook-run
24316handle SIGALRM pass
24317end
24318
24319define hook-continue
24320handle SIGALRM pass
24321end
24322@end smallexample
24323
24324As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24325command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24326you could define:
24327
24328@smallexample
24329define hook-echo
24330echo <<<---
24331end
24332
24333define hookpost-echo
24334echo --->>>\n
24335end
24336
24337(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24338<<<---Hello World--->>>
24339(@value{GDBP})
24340
24341@end smallexample
24342
24343You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24344not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24345name, e.g.@:  @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24346@c FIXME!  So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24347@c or not?
24348You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24349@code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24350@samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24351
24352If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24353@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24354(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24355
24356If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24357get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24358
24359@node Command Files
24360@subsection Command Files
24361
24362@cindex command files
24363@cindex scripting commands
24364A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24365@value{GDBN} commands.  Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24366also be included.  An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24367does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24368terminal.
24369
24370You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24371command.  Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24372scripts that are not Command Files.  The exact behavior can be configured
24373using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24374@xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24375
24376@table @code
24377@kindex source
24378@cindex execute commands from a file
24379@item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24380Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24381@end table
24382
24383The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24384unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24385@emph{flow-control commands} described below.  The commands are not
24386printed as they are executed.  An error in any command terminates
24387execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24388
24389@value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24390If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24391directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24392(specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24393except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24394is not relevant to scripts.
24395
24396If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24397on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24398The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24399search path.  So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24400and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24401look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24402The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24403For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24404the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24405look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24406For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24407it is stripped before concatenation.  For example, if @var{filename} is
24408@file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24409will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24410
24411If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24412each command as it is executed.  The option must be given before
24413@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24414
24415Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24416without asking when used in a command file.  Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24417normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24418when called from command files.
24419
24420@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input.  In this
24421mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24422standard error.  Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24423not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24424the next command.
24425
24426@smallexample
24427gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24428@end smallexample
24429
24430(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24431will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24432would be directed to @file{log}.
24433
24434Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24435commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24436complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24437variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24438built, etc.  @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24439deal with these complexities.  Using these commands, you can write
24440complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24441conditionally, etc.
24442
24443@table @code
24444@kindex if
24445@kindex else
24446@item if
24447@itemx else
24448This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24449commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24450expression to evaluate.  It is followed by a series of commands that
24451are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24452There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24453of commands that are only executed if the expression was false.  The
24454end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24455
24456@kindex while
24457@item while
24458This command allows to write loops.  Its syntax is similar to
24459@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24460to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24461line, terminated by an @code{end}.  These commands are called the
24462@dfn{body} of the loop.  The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24463executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24464
24465@kindex loop_break
24466@item loop_break
24467This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24468Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24469line.
24470
24471@kindex loop_continue
24472@item loop_continue
24473This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24474in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.  Execution
24475branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24476the controlling expression.
24477
24478@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24479@item end
24480Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24481@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24482@end table
24483
24484
24485@node Output
24486@subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24487
24488During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24489@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24490explicitly printed by the commands in the definition.  This section
24491describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24492want.
24493
24494@table @code
24495@kindex echo
24496@item echo @var{text}
24497@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24498@c because it is not in ANSI.
24499Print @var{text}.  Nonprinting characters can be included in
24500@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24501newline.  @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24502In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24503by a space stands for a space.  This is useful for displaying a
24504string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24505trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24506To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24507@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24508
24509A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24510the command onto subsequent lines.  For example,
24511
24512@smallexample
24513echo This is some text\n\
24514which is continued\n\
24515onto several lines.\n
24516@end smallexample
24517
24518produces the same output as
24519
24520@smallexample
24521echo This is some text\n
24522echo which is continued\n
24523echo onto several lines.\n
24524@end smallexample
24525
24526@kindex output
24527@item output @var{expression}
24528Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24529newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }.  The value is not entered in the
24530value history either.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24531on expressions.
24532
24533@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24534Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}.  You can use
24535the same formats as for @code{print}.  @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24536Formats}, for more information.
24537
24538@kindex printf
24539@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24540Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24541the string @var{template}.  To print several values, make
24542@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24543which may be either numbers or pointers.  Their values are printed as
24544specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24545executing the code below:
24546
24547@smallexample
24548printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24549@end smallexample
24550
24551As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24552are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24553by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24554evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24555style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24556printed.
24557
24558For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24559
24560@smallexample
24561printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24562@end smallexample
24563
24564@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24565specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24566character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24567
24568@itemize @bullet
24569@item
24570The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24571
24572@item
24573The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24574width.
24575
24576@item
24577The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24578@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24579
24580@item
24581The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24582supported.
24583
24584@item
24585The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24586
24587@item
24588The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24589@end itemize
24590
24591@noindent
24592Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24593underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24594the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24595supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24596
24597As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24598sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24599@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24600single character.  Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24601supported.
24602
24603Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24604(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24605together with a floating point specifier.
24606letters:
24607
24608@itemize @bullet
24609@item
24610@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24611
24612@item
24613@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24614
24615@item
24616@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24617@end itemize
24618
24619If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24620support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24621such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24622
24623In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24624available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24625
24626Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24627@smallexample
24628printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24629@end smallexample
24630
24631@anchor{eval}
24632@kindex eval
24633@item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24634Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24635the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24636
24637@end table
24638
24639@node Auto-loading sequences
24640@subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24641@cindex native script auto-loading
24642
24643When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24644command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24645@value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24646@xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24647
24648Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24649and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24650
24651@table @code
24652@anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24653@kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24654@item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24655Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24656
24657@anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24658@kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24659@item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24660Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24661disabled.
24662
24663@anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24664@kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24665@cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24666@item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24667Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24668auto-loaded.
24669@end table
24670
24671If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24672matching names are printed.
24673
24674@c Python docs live in a separate file.
24675@include python.texi
24676
24677@c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24678@include guile.texi
24679
24680@node Auto-loading extensions
24681@section Auto-loading extensions
24682@cindex auto-loading extensions
24683
24684@value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24685when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24686command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24687@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24688section of modern file formats like ELF.
24689
24690@menu
24691* objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file.  The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24692* .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section.  The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24693* Which flavor to choose?::
24694@end menu
24695
24696The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24697debugging commands and features.
24698
24699Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24700and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24701See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24702for more information.
24703For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24704For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24705
24706Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24707@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24708
24709@node objfile-gdbdotext file
24710@subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24711@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24712@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24713@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24714
24715When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24716@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24717where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24718where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24719
24720@table @code
24721@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24722GDB's own command language
24723@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24724Python
24725@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24726Guile
24727@end table
24728
24729@var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24730is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24731components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24732If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24733script in the specified extension language.
24734
24735If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24736@var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24737
24738Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24739@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24740
24741For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24742scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename.  But if no scripts are
24743found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24744its @file{.exe} suffix.  This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24745is attempted on any platform.  This makes the script filenames compatible
24746between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24747
24748@table @code
24749@anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24750@kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24751@item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24752Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.  Multiple directory entries
24753may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24754(@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24755
24756Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24757@code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24758
24759@anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24760This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}.  The default
24761@code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24762configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24763
24764Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24765@var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24766reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24767determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).  @file{$debugdir} and
24768@file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24769delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24770platform.
24771
24772The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24773systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24774to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24775
24776@anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24777@kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24778@item show auto-load scripts-directory
24779Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24780
24781@anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24782@kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24783@item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24784Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24785Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24786@end table
24787
24788@value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24789@value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24790@var{objfile} is opened.
24791So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24792is evaluated more than once.
24793
24794@node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24795@subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24796@cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24797
24798For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24799when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24800it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24801If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24802specifying scripts to load.  Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24803specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24804script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24805
24806The following entries are supported:
24807
24808@table @code
24809@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24810@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24811@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24812@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24813@end table
24814
24815@subsubsection Script File Entries
24816
24817If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24818in the current directory and then along the source search path
24819(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24820except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24821directory is not relevant to scripts.
24822
24823File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24824for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24825
24826@example
24827/* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates.  */
24828#define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24829  asm("\
24830.pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24831.byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24832.asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24833.popsection \n\
24834");
24835@end example
24836
24837@noindent
24838For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24839Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24840
24841@example
24842DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24843@end example
24844
24845The script name may include directories if desired.
24846
24847Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24848@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24849
24850If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24851using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24852and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24853will remove duplicates.
24854
24855@subsubsection Script Text Entries
24856
24857Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24858itself instead of loading it from a file.
24859The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24860the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24861contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24862The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24863execute in the specified language.  The name needs to be unique among
24864all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24865on its name.
24866
24867Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24868testsuite.
24869
24870@example
24871#include "symcat.h"
24872#include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24873asm(
24874".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24875".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24876".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24877".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24878".ascii \"  def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24879".ascii \"    super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24880    "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24881".ascii \"  def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24882".ascii \"    print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24883".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24884".byte 0\n"
24885".popsection\n"
24886);
24887@end example
24888
24889Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24890@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24891The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24892containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24893
24894@node Which flavor to choose?
24895@subsection Which flavor to choose?
24896
24897Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24898be clear which one to choose.  This section provides some guidance.
24899
24900@noindent
24901Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24902
24903@itemize @bullet
24904@item
24905Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24906
24907@item
24908Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24909
24910Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24911in the source search path.
24912For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24913isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24914
24915@item
24916Doesn't require source code additions.
24917@end itemize
24918
24919@noindent
24920Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24921
24922@itemize @bullet
24923@item
24924Works with static linking.
24925
24926Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24927trigger their loading.  When an application is statically linked the only
24928objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24929scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24930@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24931
24932@item
24933Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24934
24935Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24936shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24937
24938@item
24939Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24940
24941In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24942libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24943@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24944cumbersome.  It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24945@code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24946top of the source tree to the source search path.
24947@end itemize
24948
24949@node Multiple Extension Languages
24950@section Multiple Extension Languages
24951
24952The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24953and generally do not interfere with each other.
24954There are some things to be aware of, however.
24955
24956@subsection Python comes first
24957
24958Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24959existing behaviour Python comes first.  This is generally solved by the
24960``first one wins'' principle.  @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24961extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24962(say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24963language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24964pretty-printed form of a value).
24965This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24966while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24967reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24968
24969@node Aliases
24970@section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24971@cindex aliases for commands
24972
24973It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24974For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24975a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24976that involves less typing.
24977
24978@value{GDBN} itself uses aliases.  For example @samp{s} is an alias
24979of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24980abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24981
24982Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24983of multi-word commands.  For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24984@samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24985
24986You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24987
24988@table @code
24989
24990@kindex alias
24991@item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24992
24993@end table
24994
24995@var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24996Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24997underscores.
24998
24999@var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25000that is being aliased.
25001
25002The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25003of the command.  Abbreviations are not shown in command
25004lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25005
25006The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25007and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25008
25009Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25010of a command so that there is less to type.
25011Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25012shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25013and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25014The following will accomplish this.
25015
25016@smallexample
25017(gdb) alias -a di = disas
25018@end smallexample
25019
25020Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25021With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25022for it with the @samp{document} command.
25023An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25024
25025Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25026@samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25027This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25028of a command.
25029
25030@smallexample
25031(gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25032(gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25033(gdb) set p elms 20
25034(gdb) show p elms
25035Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25036@end smallexample
25037
25038Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25039and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25040command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25041
25042Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25043@var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25044
25045@smallexample
25046(gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25047@end smallexample
25048
25049Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25050alias for a more complex command.
25051This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25052
25053@smallexample
25054(gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25055(gdb) spe 20
25056@end smallexample
25057
25058@node Interpreters
25059@chapter Command Interpreters
25060@cindex command interpreters
25061
25062@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25063infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25064between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25065
25066@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25067interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25068and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}).  This manual
25069describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25070
25071By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25072However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25073interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25074startup options.  Defined interpreters include:
25075
25076@table @code
25077@item console
25078@cindex console interpreter
25079The traditional console or command-line interpreter.  This is the most often
25080used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25081@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25082
25083@item mi
25084@cindex mi interpreter
25085The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}).  Used primarily
25086by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25087or an IDE.  For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25088Interface}.
25089
25090@item mi2
25091@cindex mi2 interpreter
25092The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25093
25094@item mi1
25095@cindex mi1 interpreter
25096The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25097
25098@end table
25099
25100@cindex invoke another interpreter
25101
25102@kindex interpreter-exec
25103You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25104interpreter using the appropriate command.  If you are running the
25105console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25106
25107@smallexample
25108interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25109@end smallexample
25110
25111@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25112@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25113
25114Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25115duration of the specified command.  It does not change the interpreter
25116permanently.
25117
25118@cindex start a new independent interpreter
25119
25120Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25121possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25122device (usually a tty).
25123
25124For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25125@value{GDBN} console view.  It may do so by embedding a terminal
25126emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25127command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25128terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25129input/output device.  The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25130at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25131while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25132the separate MI interpreter.
25133
25134To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25135@code{new-ui} command:
25136
25137@kindex new-ui
25138@cindex new user interface
25139@smallexample
25140new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25141@end smallexample
25142
25143The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25144This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25145For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc.  The
25146@var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25147interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25148pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems.  For example:
25149
25150@smallexample
25151(@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25152@end smallexample
25153
25154@noindent
25155runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25156
25157@node TUI
25158@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25159@cindex TUI
25160@cindex Text User Interface
25161
25162@menu
25163* TUI Overview::                TUI overview
25164* TUI Keys::                    TUI key bindings
25165* TUI Single Key Mode::         TUI single key mode
25166* TUI Commands::                TUI-specific commands
25167* TUI Configuration::           TUI configuration variables
25168@end menu
25169
25170The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25171interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25172file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25173commands in separate text windows.  The TUI mode is supported only
25174on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25175is available.
25176
25177The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25178@samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25179You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25180using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25181enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}.  @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25182@ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25183
25184@node TUI Overview
25185@section TUI Overview
25186
25187In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25188
25189@table @emph
25190@item command
25191This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25192prompt and the @value{GDBN} output.  The @value{GDBN} input is still
25193managed using readline.
25194
25195@item source
25196The source window shows the source file of the program.  The current
25197line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25198
25199@item assembly
25200The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25201
25202@item register
25203This window shows the processor registers.  Registers are highlighted
25204when their values change.
25205@end table
25206
25207The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25208by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25209Breakpoints are indicated with two markers.  The first marker
25210indicates the breakpoint type:
25211
25212@table @code
25213@item B
25214Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25215
25216@item b
25217Breakpoint which was never hit.
25218
25219@item H
25220Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25221
25222@item h
25223Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25224@end table
25225
25226The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25227
25228@table @code
25229@item +
25230Breakpoint is enabled.
25231
25232@item -
25233Breakpoint is disabled.
25234@end table
25235
25236The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25237thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25238changes.
25239
25240These windows are not all visible at the same time.  The command
25241window is always visible.  The others can be arranged in several
25242layouts:
25243
25244@itemize @bullet
25245@item
25246source only,
25247
25248@item
25249assembly only,
25250
25251@item
25252source and assembly,
25253
25254@item
25255source and registers, or
25256
25257@item
25258assembly and registers.
25259@end itemize
25260
25261A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25262
25263@table @emph
25264@item target
25265Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25266(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25267
25268@item process
25269Gives the current process or thread number.
25270When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25271
25272@item function
25273Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25274The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25275When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25276the string @code{??} is displayed.
25277
25278@item line
25279Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25280When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25281
25282@item pc
25283Indicates the current program counter address.
25284@end table
25285
25286@node TUI Keys
25287@section TUI Key Bindings
25288@cindex TUI key bindings
25289
25290The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25291@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25292(@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25293@end ifset
25294@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25295(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25296@end ifclear
25297The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25298@value{GDBN} standard mode.
25299
25300@table @kbd
25301@kindex C-x C-a
25302@item C-x C-a
25303@kindex C-x a
25304@itemx C-x a
25305@kindex C-x A
25306@itemx C-x A
25307Enter or leave the TUI mode.  When leaving the TUI mode,
25308the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25309its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly.  When reentering
25310the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25311The screen is then refreshed.
25312
25313@kindex C-x 1
25314@item C-x 1
25315Use a TUI layout with only one window.  The layout will
25316either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}.  When the TUI mode
25317is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25318
25319Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25320
25321@kindex C-x 2
25322@item C-x 2
25323Use a TUI layout with at least two windows.  When the current
25324layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25325When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25326previous layout and the new one.
25327
25328Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25329
25330@kindex C-x o
25331@item C-x o
25332Change the active window.  The TUI associates several key bindings
25333(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window.  This command
25334gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25335
25336Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25337
25338@kindex C-x s
25339@item C-x s
25340Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25341keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25342@end table
25343
25344The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25345
25346@table @asis
25347@kindex PgUp
25348@item @key{PgUp}
25349Scroll the active window one page up.
25350
25351@kindex PgDn
25352@item @key{PgDn}
25353Scroll the active window one page down.
25354
25355@kindex Up
25356@item @key{Up}
25357Scroll the active window one line up.
25358
25359@kindex Down
25360@item @key{Down}
25361Scroll the active window one line down.
25362
25363@kindex Left
25364@item @key{Left}
25365Scroll the active window one column left.
25366
25367@kindex Right
25368@item @key{Right}
25369Scroll the active window one column right.
25370
25371@kindex C-L
25372@item @kbd{C-L}
25373Refresh the screen.
25374@end table
25375
25376Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25377are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25378window has the focus.  When another window is active, you must use
25379other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25380and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25381
25382@node TUI Single Key Mode
25383@section TUI Single Key Mode
25384@cindex TUI single key mode
25385
25386The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25387frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys.  Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25388switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25389
25390@table @kbd
25391@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25392@item c
25393continue
25394
25395@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25396@item d
25397down
25398
25399@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25400@item f
25401finish
25402
25403@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25404@item n
25405next
25406
25407@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25408@item q
25409exit the SingleKey mode.
25410
25411@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25412@item r
25413run
25414
25415@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25416@item s
25417step
25418
25419@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25420@item u
25421up
25422
25423@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25424@item v
25425info locals
25426
25427@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25428@item w
25429where
25430@end table
25431
25432Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25433The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25434it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25435with the TUI SingleKey mode.  Once the command is entered the TUI
25436SingleKey mode is restored.  The only way to permanently leave
25437this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25438
25439
25440@node TUI Commands
25441@section TUI-specific Commands
25442@cindex TUI commands
25443
25444The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25445These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25446the TUI mode.  When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25447of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25448
25449Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25450terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25451interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25452these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25453possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25454
25455@table @code
25456@item tui enable
25457@kindex tui enable
25458Activate TUI mode.  The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25459TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25460otherwise a default layout is used.
25461
25462@item tui disable
25463@kindex tui disable
25464Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25465
25466@item info win
25467@kindex info win
25468List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25469
25470@item layout @var{name}
25471@kindex layout
25472Changes which TUI windows are displayed.  In each layout the command
25473window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25474additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25475
25476@table @code
25477@item next
25478Display the next layout.
25479
25480@item prev
25481Display the previous layout.
25482
25483@item src
25484Display the source and command windows.
25485
25486@item asm
25487Display the assembly and command windows.
25488
25489@item split
25490Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25491
25492@item regs
25493When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25494windows.  When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25495register, assembler, and command windows.
25496@end table
25497
25498@item focus @var{name}
25499@kindex focus
25500Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling.  The
25501@var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25502
25503@table @code
25504@item next
25505Make the next window active for scrolling.
25506
25507@item prev
25508Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25509
25510@item src
25511Make the source window active for scrolling.
25512
25513@item asm
25514Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25515
25516@item regs
25517Make the register window active for scrolling.
25518
25519@item cmd
25520Make the command window active for scrolling.
25521@end table
25522
25523@item refresh
25524@kindex refresh
25525Refresh the screen.  This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25526
25527@item tui reg @var{group}
25528@kindex tui reg
25529Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25530@var{group}.  If the register window is not currently displayed this
25531command will cause the register window to be displayed.  The list of
25532register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25533following groups are available on most targets:
25534@table @code
25535@item next
25536Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25537through all of the available register groups.
25538
25539@item prev
25540Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25541through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25542@var{next}.
25543
25544@item general
25545Display the general registers.
25546@item float
25547Display the floating point registers.
25548@item system
25549Display the system registers.
25550@item vector
25551Display the vector registers.
25552@item all
25553Display all registers.
25554@end table
25555
25556@item update
25557@kindex update
25558Update the source window and the current execution point.
25559
25560@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25561@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25562@kindex winheight
25563Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25564lines.  Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25565decrease it.  The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25566source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25567disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25568
25569@item tabset @var{nchars}
25570@kindex tabset
25571Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.  This
25572setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25573assembly windows.
25574@end table
25575
25576@node TUI Configuration
25577@section TUI Configuration Variables
25578@cindex TUI configuration variables
25579
25580Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25581
25582@table @code
25583@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25584@kindex set tui border-kind
25585Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25586The possible values are the following:
25587@table @code
25588@item space
25589Use a space character to draw the border.
25590
25591@item ascii
25592Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25593
25594@item acs
25595Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border.  The border is
25596drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25597@end table
25598
25599@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25600@kindex set tui border-mode
25601@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25602@kindex set tui active-border-mode
25603Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25604or the active window.  The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25605@table @code
25606@item normal
25607Use normal attributes to display the border.
25608
25609@item standout
25610Use standout mode.
25611
25612@item reverse
25613Use reverse video mode.
25614
25615@item half
25616Use half bright mode.
25617
25618@item half-standout
25619Use half bright and standout mode.
25620
25621@item bold
25622Use extra bright or bold mode.
25623
25624@item bold-standout
25625Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25626@end table
25627@end table
25628
25629@node Emacs
25630@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25631
25632@cindex Emacs
25633@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25634A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25635edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25636@value{GDBN}.
25637
25638To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs.  Give the
25639executable file you want to debug as an argument.  This command starts
25640@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25641created Emacs buffer.
25642@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25643
25644Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25645things:
25646
25647@itemize @bullet
25648@item
25649All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25650the GUD buffer.
25651
25652This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25653and output done by the program you are debugging.
25654
25655This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25656commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25657in this way.
25658
25659All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25660with your program.  In particular, you can send signals the usual
25661way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25662stop.
25663
25664@item
25665@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25666
25667Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25668source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25669left margin of the current line.  Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25670source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25671and the source.
25672
25673Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25674usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25675@end itemize
25676
25677We call this @dfn{text command mode}.  Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25678a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25679that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25680@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25681
25682If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25683gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25684your program resides.  If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25685sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25686with the previous buffer.  In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25687program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25688some operating systems it might not find the source.  So, although the
25689@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25690buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25691
25692The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25693line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25694that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.  @xref{Files,
25695,Commands to Specify Files}.
25696
25697By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}.  If you
25698need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25699keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25700customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25701one you want.
25702
25703In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25704addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25705
25706@table @kbd
25707@item C-h m
25708Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25709
25710@item C-c C-s
25711Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25712update the display window to show the current file and location.
25713
25714@item C-c C-n
25715Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25716calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command.  Then update the display window
25717to show the current file and location.
25718
25719@item C-c C-i
25720Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25721display window accordingly.
25722
25723@item C-c C-f
25724Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25725@code{finish} command.
25726
25727@item C-c C-r
25728Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25729command.
25730
25731@item C-c <
25732Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25733(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25734like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25735
25736@item C-c >
25737Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25738@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25739@end table
25740
25741In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25742tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25743
25744In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25745separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25746Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25747become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25748source buffer.  Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25749selected frame become the current one.  In graphical mode, the
25750speedbar displays watch expressions.
25751
25752If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25753it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25754request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25755the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25756frame.
25757
25758The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25759which are visiting the source files in the usual way.  You can edit
25760the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25761communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers.  If you add or
25762delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25763to correspond properly with the code.
25764
25765A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25766given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25767Emacs Manual}).
25768
25769@node GDB/MI
25770@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25771
25772@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25773
25774@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25775@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25776@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25777@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}).  It
25778is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25779use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25780
25781This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface.  It is written
25782in the form of a reference manual.
25783
25784Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25785features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25786(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25787
25788@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25789
25790@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25791This chapter uses the following notation:
25792
25793@itemize @bullet
25794@item
25795@code{|} separates two alternatives.
25796
25797@item
25798@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25799it may or may not be given.
25800
25801@item
25802@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25803may repeat zero or more times.
25804
25805@item
25806@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25807may repeat one or more times.
25808
25809@item
25810@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25811@end itemize
25812
25813@ignore
25814@heading Dependencies
25815@end ignore
25816
25817@menu
25818* GDB/MI General Design::
25819* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25820* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25821* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25822* GDB/MI Output Records::
25823* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25824* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25825* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25826* GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25827* GDB/MI Program Context::
25828* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25829* GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25830* GDB/MI Program Execution::
25831* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25832* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25833* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25834* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25835* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25836* GDB/MI File Commands::
25837@ignore
25838* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25839* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25840* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25841@end ignore
25842* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25843* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25844* GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25845* GDB/MI Support Commands::
25846* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25847@end menu
25848
25849@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25850@node GDB/MI General Design
25851@section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25852@cindex GDB/MI General Design
25853
25854Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25855parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25856and notifications.  Each command results in exactly one response,
25857indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25858For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25859requested information.  For the commands that resume the target, the
25860response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25861Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25862target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25863a command and reported as part of that command response.
25864
25865The important examples of notifications are:
25866@itemize @bullet
25867
25868@item
25869Exec notifications.  These are used to report changes in
25870target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped.  It would not
25871be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25872commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25873different threads.  Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25874happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25875command itself was successfully executed.
25876
25877@item
25878Console output, and status notifications.  Console output
25879notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25880diagnostics for other commands.  Status notifications are used to
25881report the progress of a long-running operation.  Naturally, including
25882this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25883until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25884
25885@item
25886General notifications.  Commands may have various side effects on
25887the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose.  For example,
25888a command may change the selected thread.  Although such changes can
25889be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25890orthogonal frontend design.
25891
25892@end itemize
25893
25894There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25895@value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25896the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25897processed.  Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25898we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25899the user interface.
25900
25901
25902@menu
25903* Context management::
25904* Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25905* Thread groups::
25906@end menu
25907
25908@node Context management
25909@subsection Context management
25910
25911@subsubsection Threads and Frames
25912
25913In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25914done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25915Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25916be specified.  The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25917and supplies them to target on each command.  This is convenient,
25918because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25919explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25920@value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25921to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25922
25923In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25924useful.  First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25925itself.  Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25926each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25927want to access additional threads for internal purposes.  This
25928increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25929frontend may be operating on a wrong one.  Therefore, each MI command
25930should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on.  To
25931make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25932@samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25933identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25934
25935Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25936a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25937operations.  However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25938current thread or frame be changed.  For example, when stopping on a
25939breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
25940hit.  For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
25941@samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
25942frontend's selection to the one specified by user.  @value{GDBN}
25943communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
25944@samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25945
25946Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25947frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25948right context.  However, getting this to work right is cumbersome.  The
25949simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25950before every command.  This doubles the number of commands that need
25951to be sent.  The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25952if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25953thread the frontend wants to operate on.  However, getting this
25954optimization right can be tricky.  In particular, if the frontend
25955sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25956selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25957change.  So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25958problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25959all subsequent commands.  No frontend is known to do this exactly
25960right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25961@samp{--frame} options.
25962
25963@subsubsection Language
25964
25965The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25966By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25967But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25968to use the @samp{--language} option.  This option takes one argument,
25969which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25970For instance:
25971
25972@smallexample
25973-data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25974^done,value="4"
25975(gdb)
25976@end smallexample
25977
25978The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25979@samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25980@samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25981
25982@node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25983@subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25984
25985On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25986even while the target is running.  This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25987command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}).  The frontend may
25988specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25989@code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25990either running the executable or attaching to the target.  After the
25991frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25992find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25993@code{-list-target-features} command.
25994
25995@table @code
25996@item -gdb-set mi-async on
25997@item -gdb-set mi-async off
25998Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25999
26000When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26001@code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26002for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26003
26004When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26005commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26006@code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26007MI commands even while the target is running.
26008
26009@item -gdb-show mi-async
26010Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26011@end table
26012
26013Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26014@code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26015of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26016commands possible.  CLI background commands are now always possible
26017``out of the box'' if the target supports them.  The old spelling is
26018kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26019
26020Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26021many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26022running.  Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26023when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}).  Then,
26024it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26025are running.
26026
26027When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26028target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26029some targets.  In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26030stack will not work, on any target.  Commands that read memory, or
26031modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target.  Note
26032that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26033@code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26034context of a specific thread,  so frontend should try to find a
26035stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26036@samp{--thread} option).
26037
26038Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26039highly target dependent.  However, the two commands
26040@code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26041to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26042
26043@node Thread groups
26044@subsection Thread groups
26045@value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26046On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26047hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26048processes running on each core.  This section describes the MI
26049mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26050
26051The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26052target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26053accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26054thread belongs to.  Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26055neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26056current process in the MI interface.  The only strictly new feature
26057that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26058into processes.
26059
26060To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26061hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26062@dfn{thread group}.  Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26063thread groups.  A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26064and may have additional attributes specific to the type.  A new
26065command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26066thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26067debugging at the moment.  By passing an identifier of a thread group
26068to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26069the members of specific thread group.
26070
26071To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26072wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26073introduced.  Available thread group is an thread group that
26074@value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26075@code{-target-attach} command.  The list of available top-level thread
26076groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26077In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26078after attaching to that thread group.
26079
26080Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26081Programs}).  Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26082type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26083such thread groups.
26084
26085@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26086@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26087@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26088
26089@menu
26090* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26091* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26092@end menu
26093
26094@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26095@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26096
26097@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26098@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26099@table @code
26100@item @var{command} @expansion{}
26101@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26102
26103@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26104@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26105@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26106
26107@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26108@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26109@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26110
26111@item @var{token} @expansion{}
26112"any sequence of digits"
26113
26114@item @var{option} @expansion{}
26115@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26116
26117@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26118@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26119
26120@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26121@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26122
26123@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26124@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26125"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26126
26127@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26128@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26129
26130@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26131@code{CR | CR-LF}
26132@end table
26133
26134@noindent
26135Notes:
26136
26137@itemize @bullet
26138@item
26139The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26140output is described below.
26141
26142@item
26143The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26144finishes.
26145
26146@item
26147Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26148list.  Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26149followed by an optional argument parameter.  Options occur first in the
26150parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26151@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26152@end itemize
26153
26154Pragmatics:
26155
26156@itemize @bullet
26157@item
26158We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26159
26160@item
26161We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26162@end itemize
26163
26164@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26165@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26166
26167@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26168@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26169The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26170followed, optionally, by a single result record.  This result record
26171is for the most recent command.  The sequence of output records is
26172terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26173
26174If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26175corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26176@var{token}.
26177
26178@table @code
26179@item @var{output} @expansion{}
26180@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26181
26182@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26183@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26184
26185@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26186@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26187
26188@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26189@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26190
26191@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26192@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26193
26194@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26195@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26196
26197@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26198@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26199
26200@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26201@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26202
26203@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26204@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26205
26206@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26207@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26208depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26209
26210@item @var{result} @expansion{}
26211@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26212
26213@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26214@code{ @var{string} }
26215
26216@item @var{value} @expansion{}
26217@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26218
26219@item @var{const} @expansion{}
26220@code{@var{c-string}}
26221
26222@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26223@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26224
26225@item @var{list} @expansion{}
26226@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26227@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26228
26229@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26230@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26231
26232@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26233@code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26234
26235@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26236@code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26237
26238@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26239@code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26240
26241@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26242@code{CR | CR-LF}
26243
26244@item @var{token} @expansion{}
26245@emph{any sequence of digits}.
26246@end table
26247
26248@noindent
26249Notes:
26250
26251@itemize @bullet
26252@item
26253All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26254
26255@item
26256The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request.  Note that
26257for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26258may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26259output messages, it is generally omitted.  Frontends should treat
26260all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26261target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26262prior command.
26263
26264@item
26265@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26266@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26267progress of a slow operation.  It can be discarded.  All status output is
26268prefixed by @samp{+}.
26269
26270@item
26271@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26272@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26273(stopped, started, disappeared).  All async output is prefixed by
26274@samp{*}.
26275
26276@item
26277@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26278@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26279client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information).  All notify
26280output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26281
26282@item
26283@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26284@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26285console.  It is the textual response to a CLI command.  All the console
26286output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26287
26288@item
26289@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26290@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26291All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26292
26293@item
26294@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26295@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26296instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log.  All
26297the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26298
26299@item
26300@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26301New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26302@var{values}.
26303
26304
26305@end itemize
26306
26307@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26308details about the various output records.
26309
26310@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26311@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26312@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26313
26314@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26315@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26316
26317For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26318but there may be some unexpected behaviour.  For example, commands
26319that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26320command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26321@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26322@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26323
26324This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26325recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26326(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26327
26328@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26329@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26330@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26331@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26332
26333The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26334program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26335
26336Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26337by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}.  This makes it difficult
26338to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage.  This
26339section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26340might change.
26341
26342Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26343for these the MI version will remain unchanged.  The following is a
26344list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26345parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26346
26347@itemize @bullet
26348@item
26349New MI commands may be added.
26350
26351@item
26352New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26353
26354@item
26355The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26356@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26357
26358@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26359@c   at your own risk.  Yes, in general?
26360
26361@c The order of fields may change?  Shouldn't really matter but it might
26362@c resolve inconsistencies.
26363@end itemize
26364
26365If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26366will be increased by one.  This will allow the front end to parse the
26367output according to the MI version.  Apart from mi0, new versions of
26368@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26369responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26370
26371@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26372@c version?
26373
26374The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26375end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26376follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26377@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26378@cindex mailing lists
26379
26380@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26381@node GDB/MI Output Records
26382@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26383
26384@menu
26385* GDB/MI Result Records::
26386* GDB/MI Stream Records::
26387* GDB/MI Async Records::
26388* GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26389* GDB/MI Frame Information::
26390* GDB/MI Thread Information::
26391* GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26392@end menu
26393
26394@node GDB/MI Result Records
26395@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26396
26397@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26398@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26399In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26400@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26401
26402@table @code
26403@findex ^done
26404@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26405The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26406values.
26407
26408@item "^running"
26409@findex ^running
26410This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}.  Historically, it
26411was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26412target.  This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26413all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26414identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26415which threads are resumed.
26416
26417@item "^connected"
26418@findex ^connected
26419@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26420
26421@item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26422@findex ^error
26423The operation failed.  The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26424the corresponding error message.
26425
26426If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26427code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26428error condition.  At present, only one error code is defined:
26429
26430@table @samp
26431@item "undefined-command"
26432Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26433@end table
26434
26435@item "^exit"
26436@findex ^exit
26437@value{GDBN} has terminated.
26438
26439@end table
26440
26441@node GDB/MI Stream Records
26442@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26443
26444@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26445@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26446@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26447target, and the log.  The output intended for each of these streams is
26448funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26449
26450Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26451identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26452Syntax}).  In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26453@code{@var{string-output}}.  This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26454line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26455
26456@table @code
26457@item "~" @var{string-output}
26458The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26459CLI console window.  It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26460
26461@item "@@" @var{string-output}
26462The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26463target.  This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26464asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26465
26466@item "&" @var{string-output}
26467The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26468internals.
26469@end table
26470
26471@node GDB/MI Async Records
26472@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26473
26474@cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26475@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26476@dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26477additional changes that have occurred.  Those changes can either be a
26478consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26479target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26480
26481The following is the list of possible async records:
26482
26483@table @code
26484
26485@item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26486The target is now running.  The @var{thread} field can be the global
26487thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26488@samp{all} if all threads are running.  The frontend should assume
26489that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26490notification is produced.  The frontend should not assume that this
26491notification is output only once for any command.  @value{GDBN} may
26492emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26493because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26494thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26495it run freely.
26496
26497@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26498The target has stopped.  The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26499following values:
26500
26501@table @code
26502@item breakpoint-hit
26503A breakpoint was reached.
26504@item watchpoint-trigger
26505A watchpoint was triggered.
26506@item read-watchpoint-trigger
26507A read watchpoint was triggered.
26508@item access-watchpoint-trigger
26509An access watchpoint was triggered.
26510@item function-finished
26511An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26512@item location-reached
26513An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26514@item watchpoint-scope
26515A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26516@item end-stepping-range
26517An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26518similar CLI command was accomplished.
26519@item exited-signalled
26520The inferior exited because of a signal.
26521@item exited
26522The inferior exited.
26523@item exited-normally
26524The inferior exited normally.
26525@item signal-received
26526A signal was received by the inferior.
26527@item solib-event
26528The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26529This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26530set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26531in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26532@item fork
26533The inferior has forked.  This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26534(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26535@item vfork
26536The inferior has vforked.  This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26537(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26538@item syscall-entry
26539The inferior entered a system call.  This is reported when @code{catch
26540syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26541@item syscall-return
26542The inferior returned from a system call.  This is reported when
26543@code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26544@item exec
26545The inferior called @code{exec}.  This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26546(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26547@end table
26548
26549The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26550that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26551Depending on whether all-stop
26552mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26553stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26554If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26555value of @code{"all"}.  Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26556field will be a list of thread identifiers.  Presently, this list will
26557always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26558several threads in the list.  The @var{core} field reports the
26559processor core on which the stop event has happened.  This field may be absent
26560if such information is not available.
26561
26562@item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26563@itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26564A thread group was either added or removed.  The @var{id} field
26565contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group.  When a thread
26566group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26567process.  When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26568cannot be used in any way.
26569
26570@item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26571A thread group became associated with a running program,
26572either because the program was just started or the thread group
26573was attached to a program.  The @var{id} field contains the
26574@value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group.  The @var{pid} field
26575contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26576
26577@item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26578A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26579either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26580from.  The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26581thread group.  The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26582only when the inferior exited with some code.
26583
26584@item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26585@itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26586A thread either was created, or has exited.  The @var{id} field
26587contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread.  The @var{gid}
26588field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26589
26590@item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26591Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed.  This notification
26592is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26593@code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26594that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26595changes them.  In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26596(via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26597will generate this notification.  Changing the thread or frame from another
26598user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26599
26600The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26601stopped.  See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26602
26603We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26604highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26605that thread.
26606
26607@item =library-loaded,...
26608Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program.  This
26609notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26610@var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}.  The @var{id} field is an
26611opaque identifier of the library.  For remote debugging case,
26612@var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26613library file on the target, and on the host respectively.  For native
26614debugging, both those fields have the same value.  The
26615@var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26616and should not be relied on to convey any useful information.  The
26617@var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26618group in whose context the library was loaded.  If the field is
26619absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26620thread groups.  The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
26621to this library.
26622
26623@item =library-unloaded,...
26624Reports that a library was unloaded by the program.  This notification
26625has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26626the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26627The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26628thread group in whose context the library was unloaded.  If the field is
26629absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26630thread groups.
26631
26632@item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26633@itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26634Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26635@var{tfnum}.  The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26636frame is @var{tpnum}.
26637
26638@item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26639Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26640initial value @var{initial}.
26641
26642@item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26643@itemx =tsv-deleted
26644Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26645trace state variables are deleted.
26646
26647@item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26648Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26649the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26650trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26651value of trace state variable is known.
26652
26653@item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26654@itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26655@itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26656Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26657respectively.  Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26658user.
26659
26660The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26661breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}.  The
26662@var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26663
26664Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26665command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26666
26667@item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26668@itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26669Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26670inferior.  The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26671group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26672
26673The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution.  If the
26674method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26675and contain the currently used format.  @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26676for existing method and format values.
26677
26678@item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26679Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26680changed to @var{value}.  In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26681the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26682For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26683is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26684
26685@item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26686Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26687written in an inferior.  The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26688thread group corresponding to the affected inferior.  The optional
26689@code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26690executable code.
26691@end table
26692
26693@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26694@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26695
26696When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26697tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26698following fields:
26699
26700@table @code
26701@item number
26702The breakpoint number.  For a breakpoint that represents one location
26703of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26704@samp{1.2}.
26705
26706@item type
26707The type of the breakpoint.  For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26708@samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26709
26710@item catch-type
26711If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26712indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26713
26714@item disp
26715This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26716the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26717meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26718
26719@item enabled
26720This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26721value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26722Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26723
26724@item addr
26725The address of the breakpoint.  This may be a hexidecimal number,
26726giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26727breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26728multiple locations.  This field will not be present if no address can
26729be determined.  For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26730
26731@item func
26732If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26733If not known, this field is not present.
26734
26735@item filename
26736The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26737If not known, this field is not present.
26738
26739@item fullname
26740The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26741known.  If not known, this field is not present.
26742
26743@item line
26744The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26745If not known, this field is not present.
26746
26747@item at
26748If the source file is not known, this field may be provided.  If
26749provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26750by a symbol name.
26751
26752@item pending
26753If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26754text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26755
26756@item evaluated-by
26757Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26758@samp{target}.
26759
26760@item thread
26761If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26762thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26763
26764@item task
26765If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26766field will hold the task identifier.
26767
26768@item cond
26769If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26770
26771@item ignore
26772The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26773
26774@item enable
26775The enable count of the breakpoint.
26776
26777@item traceframe-usage
26778FIXME.
26779
26780@item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26781For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26782
26783@item mask
26784For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26785
26786@item pass
26787A tracepoint's pass count.
26788
26789@item original-location
26790The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26791This field is optional.
26792
26793@item times
26794The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26795
26796@item installed
26797This field is only given for tracepoints.  This is either @samp{y},
26798meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26799is not.
26800
26801@item what
26802Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26803
26804@end table
26805
26806For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26807(@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26808
26809@smallexample
26810-> -break-insert main
26811<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26812    enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26813    fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26814    times="0"@}
26815<- (gdb)
26816@end smallexample
26817
26818@node GDB/MI Frame Information
26819@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26820
26821Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26822frame.  This information is a tuple that may have the following
26823fields:
26824
26825@table @code
26826@item level
26827The level of the stack frame.  The innermost frame has the level of
26828zero.  This field is always present.
26829
26830@item func
26831The name of the function corresponding to the frame.  This field may
26832be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26833
26834@item addr
26835The code address for the frame.  This field is always present.
26836
26837@item file
26838The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26839address.  This field may be absent.
26840
26841@item line
26842The source line corresponding to the frames' code address.  This field
26843may be absent.
26844
26845@item from
26846The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26847corresponds to the frame's code address.  This field may be absent.
26848
26849@end table
26850
26851@node GDB/MI Thread Information
26852@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26853
26854Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26855uses a tuple with the following fields:
26856
26857@table @code
26858@item id
26859The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.  This field is
26860always present.
26861
26862@item target-id
26863Target-specific string identifying the thread.  This field is always present.
26864
26865@item details
26866Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26867It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26868frontend.  This field is optional.
26869
26870@item state
26871Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26872thread is presently running.  This field is always present.
26873
26874@item core
26875The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26876thread was last seen on.  This field is optional.
26877@end table
26878
26879@node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26880@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26881
26882Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26883stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26884@value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26885the @code{exception-name} field.
26886
26887@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26888@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26889@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26890@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26891
26892This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26893the @sc{gdb/mi} interface.  In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26894following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26895the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26896
26897Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26898readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26899
26900@subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26901
26902Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26903information of the breakpoint.
26904
26905@smallexample
26906-> -break-insert main
26907<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26908    enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26909    fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26910    times="0"@}
26911<- (gdb)
26912@end smallexample
26913
26914@subheading Program Execution
26915
26916Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26917reason that execution stopped.
26918
26919@smallexample
26920-> -exec-run
26921<- ^running
26922<- (gdb)
26923<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26924   frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26925   args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26926   file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26927<- (gdb)
26928-> -exec-continue
26929<- ^running
26930<- (gdb)
26931<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26932<- (gdb)
26933@end smallexample
26934
26935@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26936
26937Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26938
26939@smallexample
26940-> (gdb)
26941<- -gdb-exit
26942<- ^exit
26943@end smallexample
26944
26945Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26946take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit.  During that time, @value{GDBN}
26947performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26948or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26949@value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26950fails to exit in reasonable time.
26951
26952@subheading A Bad Command
26953
26954Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26955
26956@smallexample
26957-> -rubbish
26958<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26959<- (gdb)
26960@end smallexample
26961
26962
26963@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26964@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26965@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26966
26967The remaining sections describe blocks of commands.  Each block of
26968commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26969
26970@subheading Motivation
26971
26972The motivation for this collection of commands.
26973
26974@subheading Introduction
26975
26976A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26977
26978@subheading Commands
26979
26980For each command in the block, the following is described:
26981
26982@subsubheading Synopsis
26983
26984@smallexample
26985 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26986@end smallexample
26987
26988@subsubheading Result
26989
26990@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26991
26992The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26993
26994@subsubheading Example
26995
26996Example(s) formatted for readability.  Some of the described commands  have
26997not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26998
26999
27000@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27001@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27002@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27003
27004@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27005@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27006This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27007breakpoints.
27008
27009@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27010@findex -break-after
27011
27012@subsubheading Synopsis
27013
27014@smallexample
27015 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27016@end smallexample
27017
27018The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27019hit @var{count} times.  To see how this is reflected in the output of
27020the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27021@samp{-break-list} command below.
27022
27023@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27024
27025The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27026
27027@subsubheading Example
27028
27029@smallexample
27030(gdb)
27031-break-insert main
27032^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27033enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27034fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27035times="0"@}
27036(gdb)
27037-break-after 1 3
27038~
27039^done
27040(gdb)
27041-break-list
27042^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27043hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27044@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27045@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27046@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27047@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27048@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27049body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27050addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27051line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27052(gdb)
27053@end smallexample
27054
27055@ignore
27056@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27057@findex -break-catch
27058@end ignore
27059
27060@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27061@findex -break-commands
27062
27063@subsubheading Synopsis
27064
27065@smallexample
27066 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27067@end smallexample
27068
27069Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27070@var{number} is hit.  The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27071are the commands.  If no command is specified, any previously-set
27072commands are cleared.  @xref{Break Commands}.  Typical use of this
27073functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27074some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27075
27076@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27077
27078The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27079
27080@subsubheading Example
27081
27082@smallexample
27083(gdb)
27084-break-insert main
27085^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27086enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27087fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27088times="0"@}
27089(gdb)
27090-break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27091^done
27092(gdb)
27093@end smallexample
27094
27095@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27096@findex -break-condition
27097
27098@subsubheading Synopsis
27099
27100@smallexample
27101 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27102@end smallexample
27103
27104Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27105@var{expr} is true.  The condition becomes part of the
27106@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27107command below).
27108
27109@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27110
27111The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27112
27113@subsubheading Example
27114
27115@smallexample
27116(gdb)
27117-break-condition 1 1
27118^done
27119(gdb)
27120-break-list
27121^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27122hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27123@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27124@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27125@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27126@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27127@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27128body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27129addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27130line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27131(gdb)
27132@end smallexample
27133
27134@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27135@findex -break-delete
27136
27137@subsubheading Synopsis
27138
27139@smallexample
27140 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27141@end smallexample
27142
27143Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27144list.  This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27145
27146@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27147
27148The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27149
27150@subsubheading Example
27151
27152@smallexample
27153(gdb)
27154-break-delete 1
27155^done
27156(gdb)
27157-break-list
27158^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27159hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27160@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27161@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27162@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27163@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27164@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27165body=[]@}
27166(gdb)
27167@end smallexample
27168
27169@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27170@findex -break-disable
27171
27172@subsubheading Synopsis
27173
27174@smallexample
27175 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27176@end smallexample
27177
27178Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s).  The field @samp{enabled} in the
27179break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27180
27181@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27182
27183The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27184
27185@subsubheading Example
27186
27187@smallexample
27188(gdb)
27189-break-disable 2
27190^done
27191(gdb)
27192-break-list
27193^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27194hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27195@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27196@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27197@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27198@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27199@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27200body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27201addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27202line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27203(gdb)
27204@end smallexample
27205
27206@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27207@findex -break-enable
27208
27209@subsubheading Synopsis
27210
27211@smallexample
27212 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27213@end smallexample
27214
27215Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27216
27217@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27218
27219The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27220
27221@subsubheading Example
27222
27223@smallexample
27224(gdb)
27225-break-enable 2
27226^done
27227(gdb)
27228-break-list
27229^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27230hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27231@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27232@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27233@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27234@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27235@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27236body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27237addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27238line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27239(gdb)
27240@end smallexample
27241
27242@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27243@findex -break-info
27244
27245@subsubheading Synopsis
27246
27247@smallexample
27248 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27249@end smallexample
27250
27251@c REDUNDANT???
27252Get information about a single breakpoint.
27253
27254The result is a table of breakpoints.  @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27255Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27256table.
27257
27258@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27259
27260The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27261
27262@subsubheading Example
27263N.A.
27264
27265@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27266@findex -break-insert
27267@anchor{-break-insert}
27268
27269@subsubheading Synopsis
27270
27271@smallexample
27272 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27273    [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27274    [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27275@end smallexample
27276
27277@noindent
27278If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27279
27280@table @var
27281@item linespec location
27282A linespec location.  @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27283
27284@item explicit location
27285An explicit location.  @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27286analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27287listed below.  @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27288
27289@table @samp
27290@item --source @var{filename}
27291The source file name of the location.  This option requires the use
27292of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27293
27294@item --function @var{function}
27295The name of a function or method.
27296
27297@item --label @var{label}
27298The name of a label.
27299
27300@item --line @var{lineoffset}
27301An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27302@end table
27303
27304@item address location
27305An address location, *@var{address}.  @xref{Address Locations}.
27306@end table
27307
27308@noindent
27309The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27310
27311@table @samp
27312@item -t
27313Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27314@item -h
27315Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27316@item -f
27317If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27318refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27319breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27320an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27321cannot be parsed.
27322@item -d
27323Create a disabled breakpoint.
27324@item -a
27325Create a tracepoint.  @xref{Tracepoints}.  When this parameter
27326is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27327@item -c @var{condition}
27328Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27329@item -i @var{ignore-count}
27330Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27331@item -p @var{thread-id}
27332Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27333@var{thread-id}.
27334@end table
27335
27336@subsubheading Result
27337
27338@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27339resulting breakpoint.
27340
27341Note: this format is open to change.
27342@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27343
27344@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27345
27346The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27347@samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27348
27349@subsubheading Example
27350
27351@smallexample
27352(gdb)
27353-break-insert main
27354^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27355fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27356times="0"@}
27357(gdb)
27358-break-insert -t foo
27359^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27360fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27361times="0"@}
27362(gdb)
27363-break-list
27364^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27365hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27366@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27367@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27368@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27369@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27370@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27371body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27372addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27373fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27374times="0"@},
27375bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27376addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27377fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27378times="0"@}]@}
27379(gdb)
27380@c -break-insert -r foo.*
27381@c ~int foo(int, int);
27382@c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27383@c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27384@c times="0"@}
27385@c (gdb)
27386@end smallexample
27387
27388@subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27389@findex -dprintf-insert
27390
27391@subsubheading Synopsis
27392
27393@smallexample
27394 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27395    [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27396    [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27397    [ @var{argument} ]
27398@end smallexample
27399
27400@noindent
27401If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27402the @code{-break-insert} command.  @xref{-break-insert}.
27403
27404The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27405
27406@table @samp
27407@item -t
27408Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27409@item -f
27410If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27411refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27412breakpoint.  Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27413an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27414cannot be parsed.
27415@item -d
27416Create a disabled breakpoint.
27417@item -c @var{condition}
27418Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27419@item -i @var{ignore-count}
27420Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27421to @var{ignore-count}.
27422@item -p @var{thread-id}
27423Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27424@var{thread-id}.
27425@end table
27426
27427@subsubheading Result
27428
27429@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27430resulting breakpoint.
27431
27432@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27433
27434@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27435
27436The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27437
27438@subsubheading Example
27439
27440@smallexample
27441(gdb)
274424-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
274434^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27444addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27445fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27446times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27447original-location="foo"@}
27448(gdb)
274495-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
274505^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27451addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27452fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27453times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27454original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27455(gdb)
27456@end smallexample
27457
27458@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27459@findex -break-list
27460
27461@subsubheading Synopsis
27462
27463@smallexample
27464 -break-list
27465@end smallexample
27466
27467Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27468
27469@table @samp
27470@item Number
27471number of the breakpoint
27472@item Type
27473type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27474@item Disposition
27475should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27476or @samp{nokeep}
27477@item Enabled
27478is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27479@item Address
27480memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27481@item What
27482logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27483name, line number
27484@item Thread-groups
27485list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27486@item Times
27487number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27488@end table
27489
27490If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27491@code{body} field is an empty list.
27492
27493@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27494
27495The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27496
27497@subsubheading Example
27498
27499@smallexample
27500(gdb)
27501-break-list
27502^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27503hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27504@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27505@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27506@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27507@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27508@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27509body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27510addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27511times="0"@},
27512bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27513addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27514line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27515(gdb)
27516@end smallexample
27517
27518Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27519
27520@smallexample
27521(gdb)
27522-break-list
27523^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27524hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27525@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27526@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27527@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27528@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27529@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27530body=[]@}
27531(gdb)
27532@end smallexample
27533
27534@subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27535@findex -break-passcount
27536
27537@subsubheading Synopsis
27538
27539@smallexample
27540 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27541@end smallexample
27542
27543Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27544@var{passcount}.  If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27545is not a tracepoint, error is emitted.  This corresponds to CLI
27546command @samp{passcount}.
27547
27548@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27549@findex -break-watch
27550
27551@subsubheading Synopsis
27552
27553@smallexample
27554 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27555@end smallexample
27556
27557Create a watchpoint.  With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27558@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27559read from or on a write to the memory location.  With the @samp{-r}
27560option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27561trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading.  Without
27562either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27563i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27564@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27565
27566Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27567breakpoints inserted.
27568
27569@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27570
27571The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27572@samp{rwatch}.
27573
27574@subsubheading Example
27575
27576Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27577
27578@smallexample
27579(gdb)
27580-break-watch x
27581^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27582(gdb)
27583-exec-continue
27584^running
27585(gdb)
27586*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27587value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27588frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27589fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27590(gdb)
27591@end smallexample
27592
27593Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function.  @value{GDBN} will stop
27594the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27595for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27596
27597@smallexample
27598(gdb)
27599-break-watch C
27600^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27601(gdb)
27602-exec-continue
27603^running
27604(gdb)
27605*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27606wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27607frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27608file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27609fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27610(gdb)
27611-exec-continue
27612^running
27613(gdb)
27614*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27615frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27616value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27617file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27618fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27619(gdb)
27620@end smallexample
27621
27622Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27623execution.  Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27624deleted.
27625
27626@smallexample
27627(gdb)
27628-break-watch C
27629^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27630(gdb)
27631-break-list
27632^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27633hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27634@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27635@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27636@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27637@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27638@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27639body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27640addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27641file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27642fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27643times="1"@},
27644bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27645enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27646(gdb)
27647-exec-continue
27648^running
27649(gdb)
27650*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27651value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27652frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27653file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27654fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27655(gdb)
27656-break-list
27657^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27658hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27659@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27660@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27661@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27662@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27663@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27664body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27665addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27666file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27667fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27668times="1"@},
27669bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27670enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27671(gdb)
27672-exec-continue
27673^running
27674^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27675frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27676value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27677file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27678fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27679(gdb)
27680-break-list
27681^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27682hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27683@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27684@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27685@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27686@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27687@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27688body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27689addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27690file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27691fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27692thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27693(gdb)
27694@end smallexample
27695
27696
27697@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27698@node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27699@section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27700
27701This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27702catchpoints.
27703
27704@menu
27705* Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27706* Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27707@end menu
27708
27709@node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27710@subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27711
27712@subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27713@findex -catch-load
27714
27715@subsubheading Synopsis
27716
27717@smallexample
27718 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27719@end smallexample
27720
27721Add a catchpoint for library load events.  If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27722the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27723Breakpoints}).  If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27724in a disabled state.  The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27725expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27726
27727
27728@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27729
27730The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27731
27732@subsubheading Example
27733
27734@smallexample
27735-catch-load -t foo.so
27736^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27737what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27738(gdb)
27739@end smallexample
27740
27741
27742@subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27743@findex -catch-unload
27744
27745@subsubheading Synopsis
27746
27747@smallexample
27748 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27749@end smallexample
27750
27751Add a catchpoint for library unload events.  If the @samp{-t} option is
27752used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27753Breakpoints}).  If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27754created in a disabled state.  The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27755expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27756
27757@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27758
27759The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27760
27761@subsubheading Example
27762
27763@smallexample
27764-catch-unload -d bar.so
27765^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27766what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27767(gdb)
27768@end smallexample
27769
27770@node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27771@subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27772
27773The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27774that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27775
27776@subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27777@findex -catch-assert
27778
27779@subsubheading Synopsis
27780
27781@smallexample
27782 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27783@end smallexample
27784
27785Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27786
27787The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27788
27789@table @samp
27790@item -c @var{condition}
27791Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27792@item -d
27793Create a disabled catchpoint.
27794@item -t
27795Create a temporary catchpoint.
27796@end table
27797
27798@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27799
27800The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27801
27802@subsubheading Example
27803
27804@smallexample
27805-catch-assert
27806^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27807enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27808thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27809original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27810(gdb)
27811@end smallexample
27812
27813@subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27814@findex -catch-exception
27815
27816@subsubheading Synopsis
27817
27818@smallexample
27819 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27820    [ -t ] [ -u ]
27821@end smallexample
27822
27823Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27824By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27825gets raised.  But it is also possible, by using some of the
27826optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27827catchpoints.
27828
27829The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27830
27831@table @samp
27832@item -c @var{condition}
27833Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27834@item -d
27835Create a disabled catchpoint.
27836@item -e @var{exception-name}
27837Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised.  This option cannot
27838be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27839@item -t
27840Create a temporary catchpoint.
27841@item -u
27842Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised.  This option
27843cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27844@end table
27845
27846@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27847
27848The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27849and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27850
27851@subsubheading Example
27852
27853@smallexample
27854-catch-exception -e Program_Error
27855^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27856enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27857what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27858times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27859(gdb)
27860@end smallexample
27861
27862@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27863@node GDB/MI Program Context
27864@section @sc{gdb/mi}  Program Context
27865
27866@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27867@findex -exec-arguments
27868
27869
27870@subsubheading Synopsis
27871
27872@smallexample
27873 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27874@end smallexample
27875
27876Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27877@samp{-exec-run}.
27878
27879@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27880
27881The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27882
27883@subsubheading Example
27884
27885@smallexample
27886(gdb)
27887-exec-arguments -v word
27888^done
27889(gdb)
27890@end smallexample
27891
27892
27893@ignore
27894@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27895@findex -exec-show-arguments
27896
27897@subsubheading Synopsis
27898
27899@smallexample
27900 -exec-show-arguments
27901@end smallexample
27902
27903Print the arguments of the program.
27904
27905@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27906
27907The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27908
27909@subsubheading Example
27910N.A.
27911@end ignore
27912
27913
27914@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27915@findex -environment-cd
27916
27917@subsubheading Synopsis
27918
27919@smallexample
27920 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27921@end smallexample
27922
27923Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27924
27925@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27926
27927The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27928
27929@subsubheading Example
27930
27931@smallexample
27932(gdb)
27933-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27934^done
27935(gdb)
27936@end smallexample
27937
27938
27939@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27940@findex -environment-directory
27941
27942@subsubheading Synopsis
27943
27944@smallexample
27945 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27946@end smallexample
27947
27948Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27949If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27950search path.  If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27951@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27952occurs as normal.
27953Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks.  Specifying
27954multiple directories in a single command
27955results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27956search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27957If blanks are needed as
27958part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27959the name.  In the command output, the path will show up separated
27960by the system directory-separator character.  The directory-separator
27961character must not be used
27962in any directory name.
27963If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27964
27965@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27966
27967The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27968
27969@subsubheading Example
27970
27971@smallexample
27972(gdb)
27973-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27974^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27975(gdb)
27976-environment-directory ""
27977^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27978(gdb)
27979-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27980^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27981(gdb)
27982-environment-directory -r
27983^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27984(gdb)
27985@end smallexample
27986
27987
27988@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27989@findex -environment-path
27990
27991@subsubheading Synopsis
27992
27993@smallexample
27994 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27995@end smallexample
27996
27997Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27998If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27999search path that existed at gdb start-up.  If directories @var{pathdir} are
28000supplied in addition to the
28001@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28002occurs as normal.
28003Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks.  Specifying
28004multiple directories in a single command
28005results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28006search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28007If blanks are needed as
28008part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28009the name.  In the command output, the path will show up separated
28010by the system directory-separator character.  The directory-separator
28011character must not be used
28012in any directory name.
28013If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28014
28015
28016@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28017
28018The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28019
28020@subsubheading Example
28021
28022@smallexample
28023(gdb)
28024-environment-path
28025^done,path="/usr/bin"
28026(gdb)
28027-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28028^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28029(gdb)
28030-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28031^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28032(gdb)
28033@end smallexample
28034
28035
28036@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28037@findex -environment-pwd
28038
28039@subsubheading Synopsis
28040
28041@smallexample
28042 -environment-pwd
28043@end smallexample
28044
28045Show the current working directory.
28046
28047@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28048
28049The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28050
28051@subsubheading Example
28052
28053@smallexample
28054(gdb)
28055-environment-pwd
28056^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28057(gdb)
28058@end smallexample
28059
28060@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28061@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28062@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28063
28064
28065@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28066@findex -thread-info
28067
28068@subsubheading Synopsis
28069
28070@smallexample
28071 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28072@end smallexample
28073
28074Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28075@var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28076@var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID.  When printing
28077information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28078current thread.
28079
28080@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28081
28082The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28083about all threads.
28084
28085@subsubheading Result
28086
28087The result is a list of threads.  The following attributes are
28088defined for a given thread:
28089
28090@table @samp
28091@item current
28092This field exists only for the current thread.  It has the value @samp{*}.
28093
28094@item id
28095The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
28096
28097@item target-id
28098The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
28099
28100@item details
28101Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format.  This
28102field is optional.
28103
28104@item name
28105The name of the thread.  If the user specified a name using the
28106@code{thread name} command, then this name is given.  Otherwise, if
28107@value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28108name is given.  If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28109field is omitted.
28110
28111@item frame
28112The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
28113
28114@item state
28115The thread's state.  The @samp{state} field may have the following
28116values:
28117
28118@table @code
28119@item stopped
28120The thread is stopped.  Frame information is available for stopped
28121threads.
28122
28123@item running
28124The thread is running.  There's no frame information for running
28125threads.
28126
28127@end table
28128
28129@item core
28130If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
28131then this field is the core identifier.  This field is optional.
28132
28133@end table
28134
28135@subsubheading Example
28136
28137@smallexample
28138-thread-info
28139^done,threads=[
28140@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28141   frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28142           args=[]@},state="running"@},
28143@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28144   frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28145           args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28146           file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28147           state="running"@}],
28148current-thread-id="1"
28149(gdb)
28150@end smallexample
28151
28152@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28153@findex -thread-list-ids
28154
28155@subsubheading Synopsis
28156
28157@smallexample
28158 -thread-list-ids
28159@end smallexample
28160
28161Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28162At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28163threads.
28164
28165This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28166@code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28167
28168@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28169
28170Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28171
28172@subsubheading Example
28173
28174@smallexample
28175(gdb)
28176-thread-list-ids
28177^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28178current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28179(gdb)
28180@end smallexample
28181
28182
28183@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28184@findex -thread-select
28185
28186@subsubheading Synopsis
28187
28188@smallexample
28189 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28190@end smallexample
28191
28192Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28193thread.  It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28194topmost frame for that thread.
28195
28196This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28197@samp{--thread} option to each command.
28198
28199@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28200
28201The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28202
28203@subsubheading Example
28204
28205@smallexample
28206(gdb)
28207-exec-next
28208^running
28209(gdb)
28210*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28211file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28212(gdb)
28213-thread-list-ids
28214^done,
28215thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28216number-of-threads="3"
28217(gdb)
28218-thread-select 3
28219^done,new-thread-id="3",
28220frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28221args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28222@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28223(gdb)
28224@end smallexample
28225
28226@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28227@node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28228@section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28229
28230@subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28231@findex -ada-task-info
28232
28233@subsubheading Synopsis
28234
28235@smallexample
28236 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28237@end smallexample
28238
28239Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28240@var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28241
28242@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28243
28244The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28245about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28246
28247@subsubheading Result
28248
28249The result is a table of Ada tasks.  The following columns are
28250defined for each Ada task:
28251
28252@table @samp
28253@item current
28254This field exists only for the current thread.  It has the value @samp{*}.
28255
28256@item id
28257The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28258
28259@item task-id
28260The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28261
28262@item thread-id
28263The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28264task.
28265
28266This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28267on top of a thread.  But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28268thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28269
28270@item parent-id
28271This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28272In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28273
28274@item priority
28275The base priority of the task.
28276
28277@item state
28278The current state of the task.  For a detailed description of the
28279possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28280
28281@item name
28282The name of the task.
28283
28284@end table
28285
28286@subsubheading Example
28287
28288@smallexample
28289-ada-task-info
28290^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28291hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28292@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28293@{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28294@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28295@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28296@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28297@{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28298@{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28299body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id="   644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28300state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28301(gdb)
28302@end smallexample
28303
28304@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28305@node GDB/MI Program Execution
28306@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28307
28308These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28309record @samp{*stopped}.  Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28310asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28311other cases.
28312
28313@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28314@findex -exec-continue
28315
28316@subsubheading Synopsis
28317
28318@smallexample
28319 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28320@end smallexample
28321
28322Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28323to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event.  If the
28324@samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28325it reaches a stop event.  Stop events may include
28326@itemize @bullet
28327@item
28328breakpoints or watchpoints
28329@item
28330signals or exceptions
28331@item
28332the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28333@item
28334the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28335@end itemize
28336In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28337Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28338value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable.  If @samp{--all} is
28339specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed.  The @samp{--all} option is
28340ignored in all-stop mode.  If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28341specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28342
28343@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28344
28345The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28346
28347@subsubheading Example
28348
28349@smallexample
28350-exec-continue
28351^running
28352(gdb)
28353@@Hello world
28354*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28355func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28356line="13"@}
28357(gdb)
28358@end smallexample
28359
28360
28361@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28362@findex -exec-finish
28363
28364@subsubheading Synopsis
28365
28366@smallexample
28367 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28368@end smallexample
28369
28370Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28371function is exited.  Displays the results returned by the function.
28372If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28373execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28374function was called.
28375
28376@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28377
28378The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28379
28380@subsubheading Example
28381
28382Function returning @code{void}.
28383
28384@smallexample
28385-exec-finish
28386^running
28387(gdb)
28388@@hello from foo
28389*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28390file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28391(gdb)
28392@end smallexample
28393
28394Function returning other than @code{void}.  The name of the internal
28395@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28396value itself.
28397
28398@smallexample
28399-exec-finish
28400^running
28401(gdb)
28402*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28403args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28404file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28405gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28406(gdb)
28407@end smallexample
28408
28409
28410@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28411@findex -exec-interrupt
28412
28413@subsubheading Synopsis
28414
28415@smallexample
28416 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28417@end smallexample
28418
28419Interrupts the background execution of the target.  Note how the token
28420associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28421that has been interrupted.  The token for the interrupt itself only
28422appears in the @samp{^done} output.  If the user is trying to
28423interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28424
28425Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28426asynchronous just like other execution commands.  That is, first the
28427@samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28428reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28429
28430In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28431All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28432@samp{--all}  option is specified.  If the @samp{--thread-group}
28433option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28434
28435@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28436
28437The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28438
28439@subsubheading Example
28440
28441@smallexample
28442(gdb)
28443111-exec-continue
28444111^running
28445
28446(gdb)
28447222-exec-interrupt
28448222^done
28449(gdb)
28450111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28451frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28452fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28453(gdb)
28454
28455(gdb)
28456-exec-interrupt
28457^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28458(gdb)
28459@end smallexample
28460
28461@subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28462@findex -exec-jump
28463
28464@subsubheading Synopsis
28465
28466@smallexample
28467 -exec-jump @var{location}
28468@end smallexample
28469
28470Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28471parameter.  @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28472different forms of @var{location}.
28473
28474@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28475
28476The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28477
28478@subsubheading Example
28479
28480@smallexample
28481-exec-jump foo.c:10
28482*running,thread-id="all"
28483^running
28484@end smallexample
28485
28486
28487@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28488@findex -exec-next
28489
28490@subsubheading Synopsis
28491
28492@smallexample
28493 -exec-next [--reverse]
28494@end smallexample
28495
28496Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28497of the next source line is reached.
28498
28499If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28500of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28501source line.  If you issue this command on the first line of a
28502function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28503source line where the function was called.
28504
28505
28506@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28507
28508The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28509
28510@subsubheading Example
28511
28512@smallexample
28513-exec-next
28514^running
28515(gdb)
28516*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28517(gdb)
28518@end smallexample
28519
28520
28521@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28522@findex -exec-next-instruction
28523
28524@subsubheading Synopsis
28525
28526@smallexample
28527 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28528@end smallexample
28529
28530Executes one machine instruction.  If the instruction is a function
28531call, continues until the function returns.  If the program stops at an
28532instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28533printed as well.
28534
28535If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28536of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction.  If the
28537previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28538it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28539(from the current stack frame) is reached.
28540
28541@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28542
28543The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28544
28545@subsubheading Example
28546
28547@smallexample
28548(gdb)
28549-exec-next-instruction
28550^running
28551
28552(gdb)
28553*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28554addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28555(gdb)
28556@end smallexample
28557
28558
28559@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28560@findex -exec-return
28561
28562@subsubheading Synopsis
28563
28564@smallexample
28565 -exec-return
28566@end smallexample
28567
28568Makes current function return immediately.  Doesn't execute the inferior.
28569Displays the new current frame.
28570
28571@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28572
28573The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28574
28575@subsubheading Example
28576
28577@smallexample
28578(gdb)
28579200-break-insert callee4
28580200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28581file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28582(gdb)
28583000-exec-run
28584000^running
28585(gdb)
28586000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28587frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28588file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28589fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28590(gdb)
28591205-break-delete
28592205^done
28593(gdb)
28594111-exec-return
28595111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28596args=[@{name="strarg",
28597value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28598file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28599fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28600(gdb)
28601@end smallexample
28602
28603
28604@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28605@findex -exec-run
28606
28607@subsubheading Synopsis
28608
28609@smallexample
28610 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28611@end smallexample
28612
28613Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning.  The inferior
28614executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28615exits.  In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28616the program has exited exceptionally.
28617
28618When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28619is specified, the current inferior is started.  If the
28620@samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28621group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28622If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28623
28624Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28625the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28626following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28627(@pxref{Starting}).
28628
28629@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28630
28631The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28632
28633@subsubheading Examples
28634
28635@smallexample
28636(gdb)
28637-break-insert main
28638^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28639(gdb)
28640-exec-run
28641^running
28642(gdb)
28643*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28644frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28645fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28646(gdb)
28647@end smallexample
28648
28649@noindent
28650Program exited normally:
28651
28652@smallexample
28653(gdb)
28654-exec-run
28655^running
28656(gdb)
28657x = 55
28658*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28659(gdb)
28660@end smallexample
28661
28662@noindent
28663Program exited exceptionally:
28664
28665@smallexample
28666(gdb)
28667-exec-run
28668^running
28669(gdb)
28670x = 55
28671*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28672(gdb)
28673@end smallexample
28674
28675Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28676@code{SIGINT}.  In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28677
28678@smallexample
28679(gdb)
28680*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28681signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28682@end smallexample
28683
28684
28685@c @subheading -exec-signal
28686
28687
28688@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28689@findex -exec-step
28690
28691@subsubheading Synopsis
28692
28693@smallexample
28694 -exec-step [--reverse]
28695@end smallexample
28696
28697Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28698of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28699function call.  If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28700function.  If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28701execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28702previously executed source line.
28703
28704@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28705
28706The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28707
28708@subsubheading Example
28709
28710Stepping into a function:
28711
28712@smallexample
28713-exec-step
28714^running
28715(gdb)
28716*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28717frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28718@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28719fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28720(gdb)
28721@end smallexample
28722
28723Regular stepping:
28724
28725@smallexample
28726-exec-step
28727^running
28728(gdb)
28729*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28730(gdb)
28731@end smallexample
28732
28733
28734@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28735@findex -exec-step-instruction
28736
28737@subsubheading Synopsis
28738
28739@smallexample
28740 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28741@end smallexample
28742
28743Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction.  If the
28744@samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28745inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28746The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28747whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not.  In the
28748former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28749as well.
28750
28751@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28752
28753The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28754
28755@subsubheading Example
28756
28757@smallexample
28758(gdb)
28759-exec-step-instruction
28760^running
28761
28762(gdb)
28763*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28764frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28765fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28766(gdb)
28767-exec-step-instruction
28768^running
28769
28770(gdb)
28771*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28772frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28773fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28774(gdb)
28775@end smallexample
28776
28777
28778@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28779@findex -exec-until
28780
28781@subsubheading Synopsis
28782
28783@smallexample
28784 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28785@end smallexample
28786
28787Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28788argument is reached.  If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28789until a source line greater than the current one is reached.  The
28790reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28791
28792@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28793
28794The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28795
28796@subsubheading Example
28797
28798@smallexample
28799(gdb)
28800-exec-until recursive2.c:6
28801^running
28802(gdb)
28803x = 55
28804*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28805file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28806(gdb)
28807@end smallexample
28808
28809@ignore
28810@subheading -file-clear
28811Is this going away????
28812@end ignore
28813
28814@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28815@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28816@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28817
28818@subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28819@findex -enable-frame-filters
28820
28821@smallexample
28822-enable-frame-filters
28823@end smallexample
28824
28825@value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28826the MI commands relating to stack traces.  As there is no way to
28827implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28828request that this functionality be enabled.
28829
28830Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28831
28832Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28833this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28834
28835@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28836@findex -stack-info-frame
28837
28838@subsubheading Synopsis
28839
28840@smallexample
28841 -stack-info-frame
28842@end smallexample
28843
28844Get info on the selected frame.
28845
28846@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28847
28848The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28849(without arguments).
28850
28851@subsubheading Example
28852
28853@smallexample
28854(gdb)
28855-stack-info-frame
28856^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28857file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28858fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28859(gdb)
28860@end smallexample
28861
28862@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28863@findex -stack-info-depth
28864
28865@subsubheading Synopsis
28866
28867@smallexample
28868 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28869@end smallexample
28870
28871Return the depth of the stack.  If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28872is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28873
28874@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28875
28876There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28877
28878@subsubheading Example
28879
28880For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28881
28882@smallexample
28883(gdb)
28884-stack-info-depth
28885^done,depth="12"
28886(gdb)
28887-stack-info-depth 4
28888^done,depth="4"
28889(gdb)
28890-stack-info-depth 12
28891^done,depth="12"
28892(gdb)
28893-stack-info-depth 11
28894^done,depth="11"
28895(gdb)
28896-stack-info-depth 13
28897^done,depth="12"
28898(gdb)
28899@end smallexample
28900
28901@anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28902@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28903@findex -stack-list-arguments
28904
28905@subsubheading Synopsis
28906
28907@smallexample
28908 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28909    [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28910@end smallexample
28911
28912Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28913and @var{high-frame} (inclusive).  If @var{low-frame} and
28914@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28915call stack.  If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28916at the corresponding level.  It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28917larger than the actual number of frames.  On the other hand,
28918@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28919which case only existing frames will be returned.
28920
28921If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28922the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28923values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28924type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28925structures and unions.  If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28926supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28927
28928If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28929are not available are not listed.  Partially available arguments
28930are still displayed, however.
28931
28932Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28933deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28934
28935@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28936
28937@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command.  @code{gdbtk} has a
28938@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28939functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28940
28941@subsubheading Example
28942
28943@smallexample
28944(gdb)
28945-stack-list-frames
28946^done,
28947stack=[
28948frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28949file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28950fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28951frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28952file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28953fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28954frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28955file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28956fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28957frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28958file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28959fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28960frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28961file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28962fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28963(gdb)
28964-stack-list-arguments 0
28965^done,
28966stack-args=[
28967frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28968frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28969frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28970frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28971frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28972(gdb)
28973-stack-list-arguments 1
28974^done,
28975stack-args=[
28976frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28977frame=@{level="1",
28978 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28979frame=@{level="2",args=[
28980@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28981@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28982@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28983@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28984@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28985@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28986frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28987(gdb)
28988-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28989^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28990(gdb)
28991-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28992^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28993args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28994@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28995(gdb)
28996@end smallexample
28997
28998@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28999
29000
29001@anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29002@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29003@findex -stack-list-frames
29004
29005@subsubheading Synopsis
29006
29007@smallexample
29008 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29009@end smallexample
29010
29011List the frames currently on the stack.  For each frame it displays the
29012following info:
29013
29014@table @samp
29015@item @var{level}
29016The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29017@item @var{addr}
29018The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29019@item @var{func}
29020Function name.
29021@item @var{file}
29022File name of the source file where the function lives.
29023@item @var{fullname}
29024The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29025@item @var{line}
29026Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29027@item @var{from}
29028The shared library where this function is defined.  This is only given
29029if the frame's function is not known.
29030@end table
29031
29032If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29033whole stack.  If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29034levels are between the two arguments (inclusive).  If the two arguments
29035are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.  It is
29036an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29037frames.  On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29038actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29039returned.  If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29040Python frame filters will not be executed.
29041
29042@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29043
29044The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29045
29046@subsubheading Example
29047
29048Full stack backtrace:
29049
29050@smallexample
29051(gdb)
29052-stack-list-frames
29053^done,stack=
29054[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29055  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29056frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29057  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29058frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29059  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29060frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29061  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29062frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29063  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29064frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29065  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29066frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29067  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29068frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29069  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29070frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29071  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29072frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29073  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29074frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29075  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29076frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29077  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29078(gdb)
29079@end smallexample
29080
29081Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29082
29083@smallexample
29084(gdb)
29085-stack-list-frames 3 5
29086^done,stack=
29087[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29088  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29089frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29090  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29091frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29092  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29093(gdb)
29094@end smallexample
29095
29096Show a single frame:
29097
29098@smallexample
29099(gdb)
29100-stack-list-frames 3 3
29101^done,stack=
29102[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29103  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29104(gdb)
29105@end smallexample
29106
29107
29108@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29109@findex -stack-list-locals
29110@anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29111
29112@subsubheading Synopsis
29113
29114@smallexample
29115 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29116@end smallexample
29117
29118Display the local variable names for the selected frame.  If
29119@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29120the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29121values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29122type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29123structures and unions.  In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29124display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29125other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29126more detail.  If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29127Python frame filters will not be executed.
29128
29129If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29130that are not available are not listed.  Partially available local
29131variables are still displayed, however.
29132
29133This command is deprecated in favor of the
29134@samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29135
29136@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29137
29138@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29139
29140@subsubheading Example
29141
29142@smallexample
29143(gdb)
29144-stack-list-locals 0
29145^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29146(gdb)
29147-stack-list-locals --all-values
29148^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29149  @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29150-stack-list-locals --simple-values
29151^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29152  @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29153(gdb)
29154@end smallexample
29155
29156@anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29157@subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29158@findex -stack-list-variables
29159
29160@subsubheading Synopsis
29161
29162@smallexample
29163 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29164@end smallexample
29165
29166Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame.  If
29167@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29168the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29169values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29170type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29171structures and unions.  If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29172supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29173
29174If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29175and arguments that are not available are not listed.  Partially
29176available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29177
29178@subsubheading Example
29179
29180@smallexample
29181(gdb)
29182-stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29183^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29184(gdb)
29185@end smallexample
29186
29187
29188@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29189@findex -stack-select-frame
29190
29191@subsubheading Synopsis
29192
29193@smallexample
29194 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29195@end smallexample
29196
29197Change the selected frame.  Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29198the stack.
29199
29200This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29201option to every command.
29202
29203@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29204
29205The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29206@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29207
29208@subsubheading Example
29209
29210@smallexample
29211(gdb)
29212-stack-select-frame 2
29213^done
29214(gdb)
29215@end smallexample
29216
29217@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29218@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29219@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29220
29221@ignore
29222
29223@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29224
29225For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29226expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29227used by @code{Insight}.
29228
29229The two main reasons for that are:
29230
29231@enumerate 1
29232@item
29233It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29234
29235@item
29236It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29237now).
29238@end enumerate
29239
29240The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29241slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}.  This section
29242describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29243hints about their use.
29244
29245@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29246expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29247least, the following operations:
29248
29249@itemize @bullet
29250@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29251@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29252@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29253@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29254@end itemize
29255
29256@end ignore
29257
29258@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29259
29260@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29261
29262Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29263changing values of expressions.  Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29264work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29265simple and efficient presentation in the frontend.  A variable object
29266is identified by string name.  When a variable object is created, the
29267frontend specifies the expression for that variable object.  The
29268expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29269expression, and can even involve CPU registers.  After creating a
29270variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29271operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29272object, or to change display format.
29273
29274Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure.  Any variable object
29275that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29276a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29277element of a structure.  A child variable object can itself have
29278children, recursively.  Recursion ends when we reach
29279leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types.  Child variable
29280objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29281is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29282child will be created.
29283
29284For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29285string, or set the value from a string.  String value can be also
29286obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29287that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29288contents.  Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29289
29290A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29291the program stops.  Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29292variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29293operation.  This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29294be transferred to the frontend.  As noted above, children variable
29295objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29296real value.  As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29297variables that frontend has created.
29298
29299The automatic update is not always desirable.  For example, a frontend
29300might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29301and never update it.  For another example,  fetching memory is
29302relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29303to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29304visible on the screen, or ``closed''.  This is possible using so
29305called ``frozen variable objects''.  Such variable objects are never
29306implicitly updated.
29307
29308Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}.  For the
29309fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29310object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29311variables.  The meaning of expression never changes.  For a floating
29312variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29313expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29314frame.  Consider this example:
29315
29316@smallexample
29317void do_work(...)
29318@{
29319        struct work_state state;
29320
29321        if (...)
29322           do_work(...);
29323@}
29324@end smallexample
29325
29326If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29327this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29328object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29329@code{do_work} invocation.  On the other hand, a floating variable
29330object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29331
29332If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29333refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29334thread and frame in which the variable object is created.  When such
29335variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29336thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29337and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29338
29339The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29340access this functionality:
29341
29342@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29343@item @strong{Operation}
29344@tab @strong{Description}
29345
29346@item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29347@tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29348@item @code{-var-create}
29349@tab create a variable object
29350@item @code{-var-delete}
29351@tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29352@item @code{-var-set-format}
29353@tab set the display format of this variable
29354@item @code{-var-show-format}
29355@tab show the display format of this variable
29356@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29357@tab tells how many children this object has
29358@item @code{-var-list-children}
29359@tab return a list of the object's children
29360@item @code{-var-info-type}
29361@tab show the type of this variable object
29362@item @code{-var-info-expression}
29363@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29364@item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29365@tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29366@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29367@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29368@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29369@tab get the value of this variable
29370@item @code{-var-assign}
29371@tab set the value of this variable
29372@item @code{-var-update}
29373@tab update the variable and its children
29374@item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29375@tab set frozeness attribute
29376@item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29377@tab set range of children to display on update
29378@end multitable
29379
29380In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29381how it can be used.
29382
29383@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29384
29385@subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29386@findex -enable-pretty-printing
29387
29388@smallexample
29389-enable-pretty-printing
29390@end smallexample
29391
29392@value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29393MI variable object commands.  However, because there was no way to
29394implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29395request that this functionality be enabled.
29396
29397Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29398
29399Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29400this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29401
29402This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29403may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29404
29405@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29406@findex -var-create
29407
29408@subsubheading Synopsis
29409
29410@smallexample
29411 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29412    @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29413@end smallexample
29414
29415This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29416a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29417register.
29418
29419The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29420referenced.  It must be unique.  If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29421system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically.  It will be
29422unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29423The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29424
29425The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29426specified by @var{frame-addr}.  A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29427frame should be used.  A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29428object must be created.
29429
29430@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29431begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29432
29433@itemize @bullet
29434@item
29435@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29436
29437@item
29438@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29439
29440@item
29441@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29442@end itemize
29443
29444@cindex dynamic varobj
29445A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer.  In this
29446case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}.  Dynamic varobjs
29447have slightly different semantics in some cases.  If the
29448@code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29449will never create a dynamic varobj.  This ensures backward
29450compatibility for existing clients.
29451
29452@subsubheading Result
29453
29454This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj.  These
29455are:
29456
29457@table @samp
29458@item name
29459The name of the varobj.
29460
29461@item numchild
29462The number of children of the varobj.  This number is not necessarily
29463reliable for a dynamic varobj.  Instead, you must examine the
29464@samp{has_more} attribute.
29465
29466@item value
29467The varobj's scalar value.  For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29468aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29469will not be interesting.
29470
29471@item type
29472The varobj's type.  This is a string representation of the type, as
29473would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.  If @samp{print object}
29474(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29475@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29476@emph{declared} one.
29477
29478@item thread-id
29479If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29480thread's global identifier.
29481
29482@item has_more
29483For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29484children available.  For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29485
29486@item dynamic
29487This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29488varobj is a dynamic varobj.  If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29489then this attribute will not be present.
29490
29491@item displayhint
29492A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end.  The
29493value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29494@code{display_hint} method.  @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29495@end table
29496
29497Typical output will look like this:
29498
29499@smallexample
29500 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29501  has_more="@var{has_more}"
29502@end smallexample
29503
29504
29505@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29506@findex -var-delete
29507
29508@subsubheading Synopsis
29509
29510@smallexample
29511 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29512@end smallexample
29513
29514Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29515With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29516
29517Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29518
29519
29520@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29521@findex -var-set-format
29522
29523@subsubheading Synopsis
29524
29525@smallexample
29526 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29527@end smallexample
29528
29529Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29530@var{format-spec}.
29531
29532@anchor{-var-set-format}
29533The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29534
29535@smallexample
29536 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29537 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29538@end smallexample
29539
29540The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29541based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29542for pointers, etc.).
29543
29544The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29545but with padding zeroes to the left of the value.  For example, a 32-bit
29546hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29547zero-hexadecimal format.
29548
29549For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29550variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29551
29552@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29553@findex -var-show-format
29554
29555@subsubheading Synopsis
29556
29557@smallexample
29558 -var-show-format @var{name}
29559@end smallexample
29560
29561Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29562
29563@smallexample
29564 @var{format} @expansion{}
29565 @var{format-spec}
29566@end smallexample
29567
29568
29569@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29570@findex -var-info-num-children
29571
29572@subsubheading Synopsis
29573
29574@smallexample
29575 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29576@end smallexample
29577
29578Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29579
29580@smallexample
29581 numchild=@var{n}
29582@end smallexample
29583
29584Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29585It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29586be available.
29587
29588
29589@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29590@findex -var-list-children
29591
29592@subsubheading Synopsis
29593
29594@smallexample
29595 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29596@end smallexample
29597@anchor{-var-list-children}
29598
29599Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29600create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist.  With
29601a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29602@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29603@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29604values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29605value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29606and unions.
29607
29608@var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29609to report.  If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29610reset and all children will be reported.  Otherwise, children starting
29611at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29612reported.
29613
29614If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29615@code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29616For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}.  The
29617intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29618update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29619front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29620then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29621different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29622the visible items.
29623
29624For each child the following results are returned:
29625
29626@table @var
29627
29628@item name
29629Name of the variable object created for this child.
29630
29631@item exp
29632The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29633For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29634
29635For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29636expression.  There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29637
29638For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29639designate access qualifiers.  For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29640@samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}.  In this case the
29641type and value are not present.
29642
29643A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29644pseudo-children, regardless of the language.  This information is not
29645available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29646
29647@item numchild
29648Number of children this child has.  For a dynamic varobj, this will be
296490.
29650
29651@item type
29652The type of the child.  If @samp{print object}
29653(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29654@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29655@emph{declared} one.
29656
29657@item value
29658If values were requested, this is the value.
29659
29660@item thread-id
29661If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29662thread's global thread id.  Otherwise this result is not present.
29663
29664@item frozen
29665If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29666
29667@item displayhint
29668A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end.  The
29669value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29670@code{display_hint} method.  @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29671
29672@item dynamic
29673This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29674varobj is a dynamic varobj.  If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29675then this attribute will not be present.
29676
29677@end table
29678
29679The result may have its own attributes:
29680
29681@table @samp
29682@item displayhint
29683A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end.  The
29684value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29685@code{display_hint} method.  @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29686
29687@item has_more
29688This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29689remaining after the end of the selected range.
29690@end table
29691
29692@subsubheading Example
29693
29694@smallexample
29695(gdb)
29696 -var-list-children n
29697 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29698 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29699(gdb)
29700 -var-list-children --all-values n
29701 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29702 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29703@end smallexample
29704
29705
29706@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29707@findex -var-info-type
29708
29709@subsubheading Synopsis
29710
29711@smallexample
29712 -var-info-type @var{name}
29713@end smallexample
29714
29715Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}.  The type is
29716returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29717@value{GDBN} CLI:
29718
29719@smallexample
29720 type=@var{typename}
29721@end smallexample
29722
29723
29724@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29725@findex -var-info-expression
29726
29727@subsubheading Synopsis
29728
29729@smallexample
29730 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29731@end smallexample
29732
29733Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29734variable object in user interface.  The string is generally
29735not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29736
29737For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29738@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29739
29740@smallexample
29741(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29742^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29743@end smallexample
29744
29745@noindent
29746Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29747found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29748
29749Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29750includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29751is of limited use.
29752
29753@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29754@findex -var-info-path-expression
29755
29756@subsubheading Synopsis
29757
29758@smallexample
29759 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29760@end smallexample
29761
29762Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29763context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29764Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29765result can be used only for UI presentation.  Typical use of
29766the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29767watchpoint from a variable object.
29768
29769This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29770and will give an error when invoked on one.
29771
29772For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29773@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29774@code{m_size}.  Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29775@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29776@code{c}.  Then, we'll get this output:
29777@smallexample
29778(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29779^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29780@end smallexample
29781
29782@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29783@findex -var-show-attributes
29784
29785@subsubheading Synopsis
29786
29787@smallexample
29788 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29789@end smallexample
29790
29791List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29792
29793@smallexample
29794 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29795@end smallexample
29796
29797@noindent
29798where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29799
29800@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29801@findex -var-evaluate-expression
29802
29803@subsubheading Synopsis
29804
29805@smallexample
29806 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29807@end smallexample
29808
29809Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29810object and returns its value as a string.  The format of the string
29811can be specified with the @samp{-f} option.  The possible values of
29812this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29813(@pxref{-var-set-format}).  If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29814the current display format will be used.  The current display format
29815can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29816
29817@smallexample
29818 value=@var{value}
29819@end smallexample
29820
29821Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29822before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29823
29824@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29825@findex -var-assign
29826
29827@subsubheading Synopsis
29828
29829@smallexample
29830 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29831@end smallexample
29832
29833Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29834by @var{name}.  The object must be @samp{editable}.  If the variable's
29835value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29836subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29837
29838@subsubheading Example
29839
29840@smallexample
29841(gdb)
29842-var-assign var1 3
29843^done,value="3"
29844(gdb)
29845-var-update *
29846^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29847(gdb)
29848@end smallexample
29849
29850@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29851@findex -var-update
29852
29853@subsubheading Synopsis
29854
29855@smallexample
29856 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29857@end smallexample
29858
29859Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29860@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29861list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29862be a root variable object.  Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29863@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29864@code{-var-update} is different.  If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29865object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29866for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}).  The option
29867@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29868names are printed.  The possible values of this option are the same
29869as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).  It is
29870recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29871number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29872
29873With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29874currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29875diagnostic.
29876
29877If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29878only the selected range of children will be reported.
29879
29880@code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29881@samp{changelist}.
29882
29883Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29884
29885@table @samp
29886@item name
29887The name of the varobj.
29888
29889@item value
29890If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29891present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29892
29893@item in_scope
29894@anchor{-var-update}
29895This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29896
29897@table @code
29898@item "true"
29899The variable object's current value is valid.
29900
29901@item "false"
29902The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29903hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29904scope.
29905
29906@item "invalid"
29907The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29908This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29909either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29910command.  The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29911objects.
29912@end table
29913
29914In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29915be prepared for this possibility.  @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29916
29917@item type_changed
29918This is only present if the varobj is still valid.  If the type
29919changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29920be @samp{false}.
29921
29922When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29923become incorrect.  Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29924deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}.  Also, the varobj's update
29925range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29926unset.
29927
29928@item new_type
29929If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29930hold the new type.
29931
29932@item new_num_children
29933For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29934type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29935
29936The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29937valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29938@value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29939instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29940children which may be available.
29941
29942The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29943number of children known by @value{GDBN}.  This is the only way to
29944detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29945only happen at the end of the update range).
29946
29947@item displayhint
29948The display hint, if any.
29949
29950@item has_more
29951This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29952available outside the varobj's update range.
29953
29954@item dynamic
29955This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29956varobj is a dynamic varobj.  If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29957then this attribute will not be present.
29958
29959@item new_children
29960If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29961update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29962be listed in this attribute.
29963@end table
29964
29965@subsubheading Example
29966
29967@smallexample
29968(gdb)
29969-var-assign var1 3
29970^done,value="3"
29971(gdb)
29972-var-update --all-values var1
29973^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29974type_changed="false"@}]
29975(gdb)
29976@end smallexample
29977
29978@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29979@findex -var-set-frozen
29980@anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29981
29982@subsubheading Synopsis
29983
29984@smallexample
29985 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29986@end smallexample
29987
29988Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}.  The
29989@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29990frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen.  If a variable object is
29991frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29992implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29993a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}.  Only
29994@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29995values of its children.  After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29996implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29997Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29998@code{-var-update} does.
29999
30000@subsubheading Example
30001
30002@smallexample
30003(gdb)
30004-var-set-frozen V 1
30005^done
30006(gdb)
30007@end smallexample
30008
30009@subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30010@findex -var-set-update-range
30011@anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30012
30013@subsubheading Synopsis
30014
30015@smallexample
30016 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30017@end smallexample
30018
30019Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30020@code{-var-update}.
30021
30022@var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report.  If
30023@var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30024children will be reported.  Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30025(zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30026
30027@subsubheading Example
30028
30029@smallexample
30030(gdb)
30031-var-set-update-range V 1 2
30032^done
30033@end smallexample
30034
30035@subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30036@findex -var-set-visualizer
30037@anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30038
30039@subsubheading Synopsis
30040
30041@smallexample
30042 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30043@end smallexample
30044
30045Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30046
30047@var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use.  The special value
30048@samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30049
30050If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30051This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30052single argument.  @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30053the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30054Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30055When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30056pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30057
30058The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30059select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30060(@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}).  This is done automatically when
30061a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30062
30063This feature is only available if Python support is enabled.  The MI
30064command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30065can be used to check this.
30066
30067@subsubheading Example
30068
30069Resetting the visualizer:
30070
30071@smallexample
30072(gdb)
30073-var-set-visualizer V None
30074^done
30075@end smallexample
30076
30077Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30078
30079@smallexample
30080(gdb)
30081-var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30082^done
30083@end smallexample
30084
30085Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class.  A lambda expression
30086can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30087
30088@smallexample
30089(gdb)
30090-var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30091^done
30092@end smallexample
30093
30094@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30095@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30096@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30097
30098@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30099@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30100This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30101examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30102
30103For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30104@pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30105
30106@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30107@c @subheading -data-assign
30108@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30109@c @subsubheading GDB Command
30110@c set variable
30111@c @subsubheading Example
30112@c N.A.
30113
30114@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30115@findex -data-disassemble
30116
30117@subsubheading Synopsis
30118
30119@smallexample
30120 -data-disassemble
30121    [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30122  | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30123  -- @var{mode}
30124@end smallexample
30125
30126@noindent
30127Where:
30128
30129@table @samp
30130@item @var{start-addr}
30131is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30132@item @var{end-addr}
30133is the end address
30134@item @var{filename}
30135is the name of the file to disassemble
30136@item @var{linenum}
30137is the line number to disassemble around
30138@item @var{lines}
30139is the number of disassembly lines to be produced.  If it is -1,
30140the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30141specified.  If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30142@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30143@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30144displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30145@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30146are displayed.
30147@item @var{mode}
30148is one of:
30149@itemize @bullet
30150@item 0 disassembly only
30151@item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30152@item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30153@item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30154@item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30155@item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30156@end itemize
30157
30158Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated.  The output is ``source centric''
30159which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30160@xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30161@code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30162@end table
30163
30164@subsubheading Result
30165
30166The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30167@samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30168used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30169
30170For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30171following fields:
30172
30173@table @code
30174@item address
30175The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30176
30177@item func-name
30178The name of the function this instruction is within.
30179
30180@item offset
30181The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30182
30183@item inst
30184The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30185
30186@item opcodes
30187This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5.  This contains the raw opcode
30188bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30189
30190@end table
30191
30192For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30193@samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30194
30195@table @code
30196@item line
30197The line number within @samp{file}.
30198
30199@item file
30200The file name from the compilation unit.  This might be an absolute
30201file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30202used.
30203
30204@item fullname
30205Absolute file name of @samp{file}.  It is converted to a canonical form
30206using the source file search path
30207(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30208and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30209
30210If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30211present in the debug information.
30212
30213@item line_asm_insn
30214This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30215@samp{file}.  The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30216@code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30217@samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30218@samp{opcodes}.
30219
30220@end table
30221
30222Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30223manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30224adjust its format.
30225
30226@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30227
30228The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30229
30230@subsubheading Example
30231
30232Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30233
30234@smallexample
30235(gdb)
30236-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30237^done,
30238asm_insns=[
30239@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30240inst="mov  2, %o0"@},
30241@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30242inst="sethi  %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30243@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30244inst="or  %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30245@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30246inst="sethi  %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30247@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30248inst="or  %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30249(gdb)
30250@end smallexample
30251
30252Disassemble the whole @code{main} function.  Line 32 is part of
30253@code{main}.
30254
30255@smallexample
30256-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30257^done,asm_insns=[
30258@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30259inst="save  %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30260@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30261inst="mov   2, %o0"@},
30262@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30263inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30264[@dots{}]
30265@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30266@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30267(gdb)
30268@end smallexample
30269
30270Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30271
30272@smallexample
30273(gdb)
30274-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30275^done,asm_insns=[
30276@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30277inst="save  %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30278@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30279inst="mov  2, %o0"@},
30280@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30281inst="sethi  %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30282(gdb)
30283@end smallexample
30284
30285Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30286
30287@smallexample
30288(gdb)
30289-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30290^done,asm_insns=[
30291src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30292file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30293fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30294line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30295func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save  %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30296src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30297file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30298fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30299line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30300func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov  2, %o0"@},
30301@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30302inst="sethi  %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30303(gdb)
30304@end smallexample
30305
30306
30307@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30308@findex -data-evaluate-expression
30309
30310@subsubheading Synopsis
30311
30312@smallexample
30313 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30314@end smallexample
30315
30316Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression.  The expression could contain an
30317inferior function call.  The function call will execute synchronously.
30318If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30319
30320@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30321
30322The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30323@samp{call}.  In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30324@samp{gdb_eval} command.
30325
30326@subsubheading Example
30327
30328In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30329@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30330Command Syntax}.  Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30331output.
30332
30333@smallexample
30334211-data-evaluate-expression A
30335211^done,value="1"
30336(gdb)
30337311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30338311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30339(gdb)
30340411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30341411^done,value="4"
30342(gdb)
30343511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30344511^done,value="4"
30345(gdb)
30346@end smallexample
30347
30348
30349@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30350@findex -data-list-changed-registers
30351
30352@subsubheading Synopsis
30353
30354@smallexample
30355 -data-list-changed-registers
30356@end smallexample
30357
30358Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30359
30360@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30361
30362@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30363has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30364
30365@subsubheading Example
30366
30367On a PPC MBX board:
30368
30369@smallexample
30370(gdb)
30371-exec-continue
30372^running
30373
30374(gdb)
30375*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30376func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30377line="5"@}
30378(gdb)
30379-data-list-changed-registers
30380^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30381"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30382"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30383(gdb)
30384@end smallexample
30385
30386
30387@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30388@findex -data-list-register-names
30389
30390@subsubheading Synopsis
30391
30392@smallexample
30393 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30394@end smallexample
30395
30396Show a list of register names for the current target.  If no arguments
30397are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers.  If
30398integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30399names of the registers corresponding to the arguments.  To ensure
30400consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30401include empty register names.
30402
30403@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30404
30405@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30406@samp{-data-list-register-names}.  In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30407corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30408
30409@subsubheading Example
30410
30411For the PPC MBX board:
30412@smallexample
30413(gdb)
30414-data-list-register-names
30415^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30416"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30417"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30418"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30419"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30420"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30421"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30422(gdb)
30423-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30424^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30425(gdb)
30426@end smallexample
30427
30428@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30429@findex -data-list-register-values
30430
30431@subsubheading Synopsis
30432
30433@smallexample
30434 -data-list-register-values
30435    [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30436@end smallexample
30437
30438Display the registers' contents.  The format according to which the
30439registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30440by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display.  A
30441missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30442registers must be returned.  The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30443indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30444
30445Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30446
30447@table @code
30448@item x
30449Hexadecimal
30450@item o
30451Octal
30452@item t
30453Binary
30454@item d
30455Decimal
30456@item r
30457Raw
30458@item N
30459Natural
30460@end table
30461
30462@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30463
30464The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30465all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30466
30467@subsubheading Example
30468
30469For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30470don't appear in the actual output):
30471
30472@smallexample
30473(gdb)
30474-data-list-register-values r 64 65
30475^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30476@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30477(gdb)
30478-data-list-register-values x
30479^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30480@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30481@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30482@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30483@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30484@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30485@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30486@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30487@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30488@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30489@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30490@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30491@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30492@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30493@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30494@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30495@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30496@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30497@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30498@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30499@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30500@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30501@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30502@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30503@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30504@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30505@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30506@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30507@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30508@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30509@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30510@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30511@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30512@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30513@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30514@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30515(gdb)
30516@end smallexample
30517
30518
30519@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30520@findex -data-read-memory
30521
30522This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30523
30524@subsubheading Synopsis
30525
30526@smallexample
30527 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30528   @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30529   @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30530@end smallexample
30531
30532@noindent
30533where:
30534
30535@table @samp
30536@item @var{address}
30537An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30538read.  Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30539quoted using the C convention.
30540
30541@item @var{word-format}
30542The format to be used to print the memory words.  The notation is the
30543same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30544,Output Formats}).
30545
30546@item @var{word-size}
30547The size of each memory word in bytes.
30548
30549@item @var{nr-rows}
30550The number of rows in the output table.
30551
30552@item @var{nr-cols}
30553The number of columns in the output table.
30554
30555@item @var{aschar}
30556If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump.  The
30557value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30558member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30559characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30560
30561@item @var{byte-offset}
30562An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30563@end table
30564
30565This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30566@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes.  In total,
30567@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30568(returned as @samp{total-bytes}).  Should less than the requested number
30569of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30570using @samp{N/A}.  The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30571in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30572@samp{addr}.
30573
30574The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30575@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30576@samp{prev-page}.
30577
30578@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30579
30580The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.  @code{gdbtk} has
30581@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30582
30583@subsubheading Example
30584
30585Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30586@code{-6} bytes.  Format as three rows of two columns.  One byte per
30587word.  Display each word in hex.
30588
30589@smallexample
30590(gdb)
305919-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
305929^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30593next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30594prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30595@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30596@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30597@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30598(gdb)
30599@end smallexample
30600
30601Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30602display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30603
30604@smallexample
30605(gdb)
306065-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
306075^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30608next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30609next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30610@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30611(gdb)
30612@end smallexample
30613
30614Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30615as eight rows of four columns.  Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30616used as the non-printable character.
30617
30618@smallexample
30619(gdb)
306204-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
306214^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30622next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30623next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30624@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30625@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30626@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30627@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30628@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30629@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30630@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30631@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30632(gdb)
30633@end smallexample
30634
30635@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30636@findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30637
30638@subsubheading Synopsis
30639
30640@smallexample
30641 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30642   @var{address} @var{count}
30643@end smallexample
30644
30645@noindent
30646where:
30647
30648@table @samp
30649@item @var{address}
30650An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30651to be read.  Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30652quoted using the C convention.
30653
30654@item @var{count}
30655The number of addressable memory units to read.  This should be an integer
30656literal.
30657
30658@item @var{offset}
30659The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading.  This
30660should be an integer literal.  This option is provided so that a frontend
30661is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30662arithmetics itself.
30663
30664@end table
30665
30666This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30667specified range.  First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30668map (if one is defined) will be skipped.  @xref{Memory Region
30669Attributes}.  Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30670regions.  For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30671@value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30672
30673In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30674and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30675every address, which is not practical.   Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30676attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30677of the region, using a binary division scheme.  This heuristic works
30678well for reading accross a memory map boundary.  Note that if a region
30679has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30680@value{GDBN} will not read it.
30681
30682The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30683the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30684list of tuples.  Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30685and has the following fields:
30686
30687@table @code
30688@item begin
30689The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30690
30691@item end
30692The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30693
30694@item offset
30695The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30696the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30697
30698@item contents
30699The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30700
30701@end table
30702
30703
30704
30705@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30706
30707The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30708
30709@subsubheading Example
30710
30711@smallexample
30712(gdb)
30713-data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30714^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30715              end="0xbffff15e",
30716              contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30717(gdb)
30718@end smallexample
30719
30720
30721@subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30722@findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30723
30724@subsubheading Synopsis
30725
30726@smallexample
30727 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30728 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30729@end smallexample
30730
30731@noindent
30732where:
30733
30734@table @samp
30735@item @var{address}
30736An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30737to be written.  Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30738be quoted using the C convention.
30739
30740@item @var{contents}
30741The hex-encoded data to write.  It is an error if @var{contents} does
30742not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30743
30744@item @var{count}
30745Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30746written.  If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30747@value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30748@var{count} memory units.
30749
30750@end table
30751
30752@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30753
30754There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30755
30756@subsubheading Example
30757
30758@smallexample
30759(gdb)
30760-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30761^done
30762(gdb)
30763@end smallexample
30764
30765@smallexample
30766(gdb)
30767-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30768^done
30769(gdb)
30770@end smallexample
30771
30772@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30773@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30774@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30775
30776The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30777tracepoints.  For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30778
30779@subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30780@findex -trace-find
30781
30782@subsubheading Synopsis
30783
30784@smallexample
30785 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30786@end smallexample
30787
30788Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30789@var{parameters}.  The following table lists permissible
30790modes and their parameters.  For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30791
30792@table @samp
30793
30794@item none
30795No parameters are required.  Stops examining trace frames.
30796
30797@item frame-number
30798An integer is required as parameter.  Selects tracepoint frame with
30799that index.
30800
30801@item tracepoint-number
30802An integer is required as parameter.  Finds next
30803trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30804
30805@item pc
30806An address is required as parameter.  Finds
30807next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30808address.
30809
30810@item pc-inside-range
30811Two addresses are required as parameters.  Finds next trace
30812frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30813specified range.  Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30814
30815@item pc-outside-range
30816Two addresses are required as parameters.  Finds
30817next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30818the specified range.  Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30819
30820@item line
30821Line specification is required as parameter.  @xref{Specify Location}.
30822Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30823the specified location.
30824
30825@end table
30826
30827If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30828have fields.  Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30829
30830@table @samp
30831@item found
30832This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30833on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30834
30835@item traceframe
30836The index of the found traceframe.  This field is present iff
30837the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30838
30839@item tracepoint
30840The index of the found tracepoint.  This field is present iff
30841the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30842
30843@item frame
30844The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30845frame.  This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30846@xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30847
30848@end table
30849
30850@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30851
30852The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30853
30854@subheading -trace-define-variable
30855@findex -trace-define-variable
30856
30857@subsubheading Synopsis
30858
30859@smallexample
30860 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30861@end smallexample
30862
30863Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist.  If
30864@var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30865trace variable to that value.  Note that the @var{name} should start
30866with the @samp{$} character.
30867
30868@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30869
30870The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30871
30872@subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30873@findex -trace-frame-collected
30874
30875@subsubheading Synopsis
30876
30877@smallexample
30878 -trace-frame-collected
30879    [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30880    [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30881    [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30882    [--memory-contents]
30883@end smallexample
30884
30885This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30886trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30887that have been collected at a particular trace frame.  The optional
30888parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30889See the output description table below for more details.
30890
30891The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30892varobjs and inspect the objects themselves.  The items returned by
30893this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30894which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30895memory range and which is a computed expression.
30896
30897For instance, if the actions were
30898@smallexample
30899collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30900collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30901@end smallexample
30902
30903@noindent
30904the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}.  The
30905object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30906element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected.  The remaining
30907objects would be computed expressions.
30908
30909An example output would be:
30910
30911@smallexample
30912(gdb)
30913-trace-frame-collected
30914^done,
30915  explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30916  computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30917                        @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30918                        @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30919                        @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30920                        @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30921  registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30922             @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30923             @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30924             ...
30925             @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30926  tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30927  memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30928          @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30929(gdb)
30930@end smallexample
30931
30932Where:
30933
30934@table @code
30935@item explicit-variables
30936The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30937opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30938members).  For each object, its name and value are printed.
30939The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30940field is output.  If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30941if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30942type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30943arrays, structures and unions.
30944
30945@item computed-expressions
30946The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30947current trace frame.  The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30948this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30949@code{explicit-variables} set.  See above.
30950
30951@item registers
30952The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30953For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30954The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30955option.  See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30956list of the allowed formats.  The default is @samp{x}.
30957
30958@item tvars
30959The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30960trace frame.  For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30961current value are returned.
30962
30963@item memory
30964The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30965frame.  Its content is a list of tuples.  Each tuple represents a
30966collected memory range and has the following fields:
30967
30968@table @code
30969@item address
30970The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30971
30972@item length
30973The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30974
30975@item contents
30976The contents of the memory block, in hex.  This field is only present
30977if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30978
30979@end table
30980
30981@end table
30982
30983@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30984
30985There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30986
30987@subsubheading Example
30988
30989@subheading -trace-list-variables
30990@findex -trace-list-variables
30991
30992@subsubheading Synopsis
30993
30994@smallexample
30995 -trace-list-variables
30996@end smallexample
30997
30998Return a table of all defined trace variables.  Each element of the
30999table has the following fields:
31000
31001@table @samp
31002@item name
31003The name of the trace variable.  This field is always present.
31004
31005@item initial
31006The initial value.  This is a 64-bit signed integer.  This
31007field is always present.
31008
31009@item current
31010The value the trace variable has at the moment.  This is a 64-bit
31011signed integer.  This field is absent iff current value is
31012not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31013presently running.
31014
31015@end table
31016
31017@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31018
31019The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31020
31021@subsubheading Example
31022
31023@smallexample
31024(gdb)
31025-trace-list-variables
31026^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31027hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31028     @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31029     @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31030body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31031      variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31032(gdb)
31033@end smallexample
31034
31035@subheading -trace-save
31036@findex -trace-save
31037
31038@subsubheading Synopsis
31039
31040@smallexample
31041 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31042@end smallexample
31043
31044Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}.  Without the
31045@samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31046in a local file.  With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31047to perform the save.
31048
31049By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format.  You can
31050supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31051@ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31052
31053@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31054
31055The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31056
31057
31058@subheading -trace-start
31059@findex -trace-start
31060
31061@subsubheading Synopsis
31062
31063@smallexample
31064 -trace-start
31065@end smallexample
31066
31067Starts a tracing experiment.  The result of this command does not
31068have any fields.
31069
31070@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31071
31072The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31073
31074@subheading -trace-status
31075@findex -trace-status
31076
31077@subsubheading Synopsis
31078
31079@smallexample
31080 -trace-status
31081@end smallexample
31082
31083Obtains the status of a tracing experiment.  The result may include
31084the following fields:
31085
31086@table @samp
31087
31088@item supported
31089May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31090supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31091@samp{file} when examining trace file.  In the latter case, examining
31092of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31093started.  This field is always present.
31094
31095@item running
31096May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31097tracing experiement is in progress on target.  This field is present
31098if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31099
31100@item stop-reason
31101Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time.  This field
31102may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet.  The
31103value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31104the @code{-trace-stop} command.  The value of @samp{overflow} means
31105the tracing buffer is full.  The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31106tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31107The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31108tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31109This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31110
31111@item stopping-tracepoint
31112The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded.  This field is
31113present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31114@samp{passcount}.
31115
31116@item frames
31117@itemx frames-created
31118The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31119in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31120during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31121circular trace buffer filled up.  Both fields are optional.
31122
31123@item buffer-size
31124@itemx buffer-free
31125These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31126remaining space.  These fields are optional.
31127
31128@item circular
31129The value of the circular trace buffer flag.  @code{1} means that the
31130trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31131necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31132and may fill up.
31133
31134@item disconnected
31135The value of the disconnected tracing flag.  @code{1} means that
31136tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31137that the trace run will stop.
31138
31139@item trace-file
31140The filename of the trace file being examined.  This field is
31141optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31142
31143@end table
31144
31145@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31146
31147The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31148
31149@subheading -trace-stop
31150@findex -trace-stop
31151
31152@subsubheading Synopsis
31153
31154@smallexample
31155 -trace-stop
31156@end smallexample
31157
31158Stops a tracing experiment.  The result of this command has the same
31159fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31160@samp{running} fields are not output.
31161
31162@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31163
31164The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31165
31166
31167@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31168@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31169@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31170
31171
31172@ignore
31173@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31174@findex -symbol-info-address
31175
31176@subsubheading Synopsis
31177
31178@smallexample
31179 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31180@end smallexample
31181
31182Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31183
31184@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31185
31186The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31187
31188@subsubheading Example
31189N.A.
31190
31191
31192@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31193@findex -symbol-info-file
31194
31195@subsubheading Synopsis
31196
31197@smallexample
31198 -symbol-info-file
31199@end smallexample
31200
31201Show the file for the symbol.
31202
31203@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31204
31205There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.  @code{gdbtk} has
31206@samp{gdb_find_file}.
31207
31208@subsubheading Example
31209N.A.
31210
31211
31212@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31213@findex -symbol-info-function
31214
31215@subsubheading Synopsis
31216
31217@smallexample
31218 -symbol-info-function
31219@end smallexample
31220
31221Show which function the symbol lives in.
31222
31223@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31224
31225@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31226
31227@subsubheading Example
31228N.A.
31229
31230
31231@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31232@findex -symbol-info-line
31233
31234@subsubheading Synopsis
31235
31236@smallexample
31237 -symbol-info-line
31238@end smallexample
31239
31240Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31241
31242@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31243
31244The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31245@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31246
31247@subsubheading Example
31248N.A.
31249
31250
31251@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31252@findex -symbol-info-symbol
31253
31254@subsubheading Synopsis
31255
31256@smallexample
31257 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31258@end smallexample
31259
31260Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31261
31262@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31263
31264The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31265
31266@subsubheading Example
31267N.A.
31268
31269
31270@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31271@findex -symbol-list-functions
31272
31273@subsubheading Synopsis
31274
31275@smallexample
31276 -symbol-list-functions
31277@end smallexample
31278
31279List the functions in the executable.
31280
31281@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31282
31283@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31284@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31285
31286@subsubheading Example
31287N.A.
31288@end ignore
31289
31290
31291@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31292@findex -symbol-list-lines
31293
31294@subsubheading Synopsis
31295
31296@smallexample
31297 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31298@end smallexample
31299
31300Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31301addresses for the given source filename.  The entries are sorted in
31302ascending PC order.
31303
31304@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31305
31306There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31307
31308@subsubheading Example
31309@smallexample
31310(gdb)
31311-symbol-list-lines basics.c
31312^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31313(gdb)
31314@end smallexample
31315
31316
31317@ignore
31318@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31319@findex -symbol-list-types
31320
31321@subsubheading Synopsis
31322
31323@smallexample
31324 -symbol-list-types
31325@end smallexample
31326
31327List all the type names.
31328
31329@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31330
31331The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31332@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31333
31334@subsubheading Example
31335N.A.
31336
31337
31338@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31339@findex -symbol-list-variables
31340
31341@subsubheading Synopsis
31342
31343@smallexample
31344 -symbol-list-variables
31345@end smallexample
31346
31347List all the global and static variable names.
31348
31349@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31350
31351@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31352
31353@subsubheading Example
31354N.A.
31355
31356
31357@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31358@findex -symbol-locate
31359
31360@subsubheading Synopsis
31361
31362@smallexample
31363 -symbol-locate
31364@end smallexample
31365
31366@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31367
31368@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31369
31370@subsubheading Example
31371N.A.
31372
31373
31374@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31375@findex -symbol-type
31376
31377@subsubheading Synopsis
31378
31379@smallexample
31380 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31381@end smallexample
31382
31383Show type of @var{variable}.
31384
31385@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31386
31387The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31388@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31389
31390@subsubheading Example
31391N.A.
31392@end ignore
31393
31394
31395@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31396@node GDB/MI File Commands
31397@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31398
31399This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31400and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31401
31402@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31403@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31404
31405@subsubheading Synopsis
31406
31407@smallexample
31408 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31409@end smallexample
31410
31411Specify the executable file to be debugged.  This file is the one from
31412which the symbol table is also read.  If no file is specified, the
31413command clears the executable and symbol information.  If breakpoints
31414are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31415error messages.  Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31416notification.
31417
31418@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31419
31420The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31421
31422@subsubheading Example
31423
31424@smallexample
31425(gdb)
31426-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31427^done
31428(gdb)
31429@end smallexample
31430
31431
31432@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31433@findex -file-exec-file
31434
31435@subsubheading Synopsis
31436
31437@smallexample
31438 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31439@end smallexample
31440
31441Specify the executable file to be debugged.  Unlike
31442@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31443from this file.  If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31444about the executable file.  No output is produced, except a completion
31445notification.
31446
31447@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31448
31449The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31450
31451@subsubheading Example
31452
31453@smallexample
31454(gdb)
31455-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31456^done
31457(gdb)
31458@end smallexample
31459
31460
31461@ignore
31462@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31463@findex -file-list-exec-sections
31464
31465@subsubheading Synopsis
31466
31467@smallexample
31468 -file-list-exec-sections
31469@end smallexample
31470
31471List the sections of the current executable file.
31472
31473@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31474
31475The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31476information as this command.  @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31477@samp{gdb_load_info}.
31478
31479@subsubheading Example
31480N.A.
31481@end ignore
31482
31483
31484@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31485@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31486
31487@subsubheading Synopsis
31488
31489@smallexample
31490 -file-list-exec-source-file
31491@end smallexample
31492
31493List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31494to the current source file for the current executable.  The macro
31495information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31496whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31497
31498@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31499
31500The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31501
31502@subsubheading Example
31503
31504@smallexample
31505(gdb)
31506123-file-list-exec-source-file
31507123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31508(gdb)
31509@end smallexample
31510
31511
31512@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31513@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31514
31515@subsubheading Synopsis
31516
31517@smallexample
31518 -file-list-exec-source-files
31519@end smallexample
31520
31521List the source files for the current executable.
31522
31523It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31524name) of a source file.
31525
31526@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31527
31528The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31529@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31530
31531@subsubheading Example
31532@smallexample
31533(gdb)
31534-file-list-exec-source-files
31535^done,files=[
31536@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31537@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31538@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31539(gdb)
31540@end smallexample
31541
31542@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31543@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31544
31545@subsubheading Synopsis
31546
31547@smallexample
31548 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31549@end smallexample
31550
31551List the shared libraries in the program.
31552With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31553names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31554
31555@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31556
31557The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.  The fields
31558have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31559The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31560library.  Each range has the following fields:
31561
31562@table @samp
31563@item from
31564The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31565@item to
31566The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31567@end table
31568
31569@subsubheading Example
31570@smallexample
31571(gdb)
31572-file-list-exec-source-files
31573^done,shared-libraries=[
31574@{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31575@{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31576(gdb)
31577@end smallexample
31578
31579
31580@ignore
31581@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31582@findex -file-list-symbol-files
31583
31584@subsubheading Synopsis
31585
31586@smallexample
31587 -file-list-symbol-files
31588@end smallexample
31589
31590List symbol files.
31591
31592@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31593
31594The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31595
31596@subsubheading Example
31597N.A.
31598@end ignore
31599
31600
31601@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31602@findex -file-symbol-file
31603
31604@subsubheading Synopsis
31605
31606@smallexample
31607 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31608@end smallexample
31609
31610Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument.  When
31611used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info.  No output is
31612produced, except for a completion notification.
31613
31614@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31615
31616The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31617
31618@subsubheading Example
31619
31620@smallexample
31621(gdb)
31622-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31623^done
31624(gdb)
31625@end smallexample
31626
31627@ignore
31628@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31629@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31630@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31631
31632The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31633
31634@c @subheading -overlay-auto
31635
31636@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31637
31638@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31639
31640@c @subheading -overlay-map
31641
31642@c @subheading -overlay-off
31643
31644@c @subheading -overlay-on
31645
31646@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31647
31648@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31649@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31650@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31651
31652Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31653
31654@c @subheading -signal-handle
31655
31656@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31657
31658@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31659@end ignore
31660
31661
31662@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31663@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31664@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31665
31666
31667@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31668@findex -target-attach
31669
31670@subsubheading Synopsis
31671
31672@smallexample
31673 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31674@end smallexample
31675
31676Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31677@value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}.  If attaching to a thread
31678group, the id previously returned by
31679@samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31680
31681@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31682
31683The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31684
31685@subsubheading Example
31686@smallexample
31687(gdb)
31688-target-attach 34
31689=thread-created,id="1"
31690*stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31691^done
31692(gdb)
31693@end smallexample
31694
31695@ignore
31696@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31697@findex -target-compare-sections
31698
31699@subsubheading Synopsis
31700
31701@smallexample
31702 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31703@end smallexample
31704
31705Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31706Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31707
31708@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31709
31710The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31711
31712@subsubheading Example
31713N.A.
31714@end ignore
31715
31716
31717@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31718@findex -target-detach
31719
31720@subsubheading Synopsis
31721
31722@smallexample
31723 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31724@end smallexample
31725
31726Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31727If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31728the specified process, or specified thread group.  There's no output.
31729
31730@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31731
31732The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31733
31734@subsubheading Example
31735
31736@smallexample
31737(gdb)
31738-target-detach
31739^done
31740(gdb)
31741@end smallexample
31742
31743
31744@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31745@findex -target-disconnect
31746
31747@subsubheading Synopsis
31748
31749@smallexample
31750 -target-disconnect
31751@end smallexample
31752
31753Disconnect from the remote target.  There's no output and the target is
31754generally not resumed.
31755
31756@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31757
31758The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31759
31760@subsubheading Example
31761
31762@smallexample
31763(gdb)
31764-target-disconnect
31765^done
31766(gdb)
31767@end smallexample
31768
31769
31770@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31771@findex -target-download
31772
31773@subsubheading Synopsis
31774
31775@smallexample
31776 -target-download
31777@end smallexample
31778
31779Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31780It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31781
31782@table @samp
31783@item section
31784The name of the section.
31785@item section-sent
31786The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31787@item section-size
31788The size of the section.
31789@item total-sent
31790The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31791@item total-size
31792The size of the overall executable to download.
31793@end table
31794
31795@noindent
31796Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31797@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31798
31799In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31800downloaded.  These messages include the following fields:
31801
31802@table @samp
31803@item section
31804The name of the section.
31805@item section-size
31806The size of the section.
31807@item total-size
31808The size of the overall executable to download.
31809@end table
31810
31811@noindent
31812At the end, a summary is printed.
31813
31814@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31815
31816The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31817
31818@subsubheading Example
31819
31820Note: each status message appears on a single line.  Here the messages
31821have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31822
31823@smallexample
31824(gdb)
31825-target-download
31826+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31827+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31828total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31829+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31830total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31831+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31832total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31833+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31834total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31835+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31836total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31837+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31838total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31839+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31840total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31841+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31842total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31843+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31844total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31845+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31846total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31847+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31848total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31849+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31850total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31851+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31852total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31853+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31854+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31855+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31856+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31857total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31858+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31859total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31860+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31861total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31862+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31863total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31864+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31865total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31866+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31867total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31868^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31869write-rate="429"
31870(gdb)
31871@end smallexample
31872
31873
31874@ignore
31875@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31876@findex -target-exec-status
31877
31878@subsubheading Synopsis
31879
31880@smallexample
31881 -target-exec-status
31882@end smallexample
31883
31884Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31885not, for instance).
31886
31887@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31888
31889There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31890
31891@subsubheading Example
31892N.A.
31893
31894
31895@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31896@findex -target-list-available-targets
31897
31898@subsubheading Synopsis
31899
31900@smallexample
31901 -target-list-available-targets
31902@end smallexample
31903
31904List the possible targets to connect to.
31905
31906@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31907
31908The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31909
31910@subsubheading Example
31911N.A.
31912
31913
31914@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31915@findex -target-list-current-targets
31916
31917@subsubheading Synopsis
31918
31919@smallexample
31920 -target-list-current-targets
31921@end smallexample
31922
31923Describe the current target.
31924
31925@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31926
31927The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31928other things).
31929
31930@subsubheading Example
31931N.A.
31932
31933
31934@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31935@findex -target-list-parameters
31936
31937@subsubheading Synopsis
31938
31939@smallexample
31940 -target-list-parameters
31941@end smallexample
31942
31943@c ????
31944@end ignore
31945
31946@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31947
31948No equivalent.
31949
31950@subsubheading Example
31951N.A.
31952
31953@subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
31954@findex -target-flash-erase
31955
31956@subsubheading Synopsis
31957
31958@smallexample
31959 -target-flash-erase
31960@end smallexample
31961
31962Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
31963
31964The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
31965
31966The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
31967addresses and memory region sizes.
31968
31969@smallexample
31970(gdb)
31971-target-flash-erase
31972^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
31973(gdb)
31974@end smallexample
31975
31976@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31977@findex -target-select
31978
31979@subsubheading Synopsis
31980
31981@smallexample
31982 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31983@end smallexample
31984
31985Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target.  This command takes two args:
31986
31987@table @samp
31988@item @var{type}
31989The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31990@item @var{parameters}
31991Device names, host names and the like.  @xref{Target Commands, ,
31992Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31993@end table
31994
31995The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31996which the target program is, in the following form:
31997
31998@smallexample
31999^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32000  args=[@var{arg list}]
32001@end smallexample
32002
32003@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32004
32005The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32006
32007@subsubheading Example
32008
32009@smallexample
32010(gdb)
32011-target-select remote /dev/ttya
32012^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32013(gdb)
32014@end smallexample
32015
32016@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32017@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32018@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32019
32020
32021@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32022@findex -target-file-put
32023
32024@subsubheading Synopsis
32025
32026@smallexample
32027 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32028@end smallexample
32029
32030Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32031@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32032
32033@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32034
32035The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32036
32037@subsubheading Example
32038
32039@smallexample
32040(gdb)
32041-target-file-put localfile remotefile
32042^done
32043(gdb)
32044@end smallexample
32045
32046
32047@subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32048@findex -target-file-get
32049
32050@subsubheading Synopsis
32051
32052@smallexample
32053 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32054@end smallexample
32055
32056Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32057on the host system.
32058
32059@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32060
32061The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32062
32063@subsubheading Example
32064
32065@smallexample
32066(gdb)
32067-target-file-get remotefile localfile
32068^done
32069(gdb)
32070@end smallexample
32071
32072
32073@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32074@findex -target-file-delete
32075
32076@subsubheading Synopsis
32077
32078@smallexample
32079 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32080@end smallexample
32081
32082Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32083
32084@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32085
32086The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32087
32088@subsubheading Example
32089
32090@smallexample
32091(gdb)
32092-target-file-delete remotefile
32093^done
32094(gdb)
32095@end smallexample
32096
32097
32098@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32099@node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32100@section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32101
32102@subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32103@findex -info-ada-exceptions
32104
32105@subsubheading Synopsis
32106
32107@smallexample
32108 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32109@end smallexample
32110
32111List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32112With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32113names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32114
32115@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32116
32117The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32118
32119@subsubheading Result
32120
32121The result is a table of Ada exceptions.  The following columns are
32122defined for each exception:
32123
32124@table @samp
32125@item name
32126The name of the exception.
32127
32128@item address
32129The address of the exception.
32130
32131@end table
32132
32133@subsubheading Example
32134
32135@smallexample
32136-info-ada-exceptions aint
32137^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32138hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32139@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32140body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32141@{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32142@end smallexample
32143
32144@subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32145
32146The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32147raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32148Catchpoint Commands}.
32149
32150
32151@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32152@node GDB/MI Support Commands
32153@section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32154
32155Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32156some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32157about support for these capabilities.  Similarly, it is also possible
32158to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32159
32160@subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32161@cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32162@findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32163
32164@subsubheading Synopsis
32165
32166@smallexample
32167 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32168@end smallexample
32169
32170Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32171
32172Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32173is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32174Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}.  However,
32175for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32176dash.
32177
32178@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32179
32180There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32181
32182@subsubheading Result
32183
32184The result is a tuple.  There is currently only one field:
32185
32186@table @samp
32187@item exists
32188This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32189@code{"false"} otherwise.
32190
32191@end table
32192
32193@subsubheading Example
32194
32195Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32196
32197@smallexample
32198-info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32199^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32200@end smallexample
32201
32202@noindent
32203And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32204to the debugger:
32205
32206@smallexample
32207-info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32208^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32209@end smallexample
32210
32211@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32212@findex -list-features
32213@cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32214
32215Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32216this version of gdb implements.  A feature can be a command,
32217or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32218important bugfix.  While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32219of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32220startup.
32221
32222The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32223available feature.  Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32224have any internal structure.  The list of possible feature names
32225is given below.
32226
32227Example output:
32228
32229@smallexample
32230(gdb) -list-features
32231^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32232@end smallexample
32233
32234The current list of features is:
32235
32236@ftable @samp
32237@item frozen-varobjs
32238Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32239as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32240of @code{-varobj-create}.
32241@item pending-breakpoints
32242Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32243command.
32244@item python
32245Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32246pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32247@samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32248@item thread-info
32249Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32250@item data-read-memory-bytes
32251Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32252@code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32253@item breakpoint-notifications
32254Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32255CLI will be announced via async records.
32256@item ada-task-info
32257Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32258@item language-option
32259Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32260option (@pxref{Context management}).
32261@item info-gdb-mi-command
32262Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32263@item undefined-command-error-code
32264Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32265records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32266(@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32267@item exec-run-start-option
32268Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32269option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32270@end ftable
32271
32272@subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32273@findex -list-target-features
32274
32275Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32276target.  Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32277unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32278features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment.  Whenever
32279a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32280@code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32281may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32282Example output:
32283
32284@smallexample
32285(gdb) -list-target-features
32286^done,result=["async"]
32287@end smallexample
32288
32289The current list of features is:
32290
32291@table @samp
32292@item async
32293Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32294execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32295while the target is running.
32296
32297@item reverse
32298Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32299@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32300
32301@end table
32302
32303@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32304@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32305@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32306
32307@c @subheading -gdb-complete
32308
32309@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32310@findex -gdb-exit
32311
32312@subsubheading Synopsis
32313
32314@smallexample
32315 -gdb-exit
32316@end smallexample
32317
32318Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32319
32320@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32321
32322Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32323
32324@subsubheading Example
32325
32326@smallexample
32327(gdb)
32328-gdb-exit
32329^exit
32330@end smallexample
32331
32332
32333@ignore
32334@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32335@findex -exec-abort
32336
32337@subsubheading Synopsis
32338
32339@smallexample
32340 -exec-abort
32341@end smallexample
32342
32343Kill the inferior running program.
32344
32345@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32346
32347The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32348
32349@subsubheading Example
32350N.A.
32351@end ignore
32352
32353
32354@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32355@findex -gdb-set
32356
32357@subsubheading Synopsis
32358
32359@smallexample
32360 -gdb-set
32361@end smallexample
32362
32363Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32364@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32365
32366@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32367
32368The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32369
32370@subsubheading Example
32371
32372@smallexample
32373(gdb)
32374-gdb-set $foo=3
32375^done
32376(gdb)
32377@end smallexample
32378
32379
32380@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32381@findex -gdb-show
32382
32383@subsubheading Synopsis
32384
32385@smallexample
32386 -gdb-show
32387@end smallexample
32388
32389Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32390
32391@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32392
32393The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32394
32395@subsubheading Example
32396
32397@smallexample
32398(gdb)
32399-gdb-show annotate
32400^done,value="0"
32401(gdb)
32402@end smallexample
32403
32404@c @subheading -gdb-source
32405
32406
32407@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32408@findex -gdb-version
32409
32410@subsubheading Synopsis
32411
32412@smallexample
32413 -gdb-version
32414@end smallexample
32415
32416Show version information for @value{GDBN}.  Used mostly in testing.
32417
32418@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32419
32420The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}.  @value{GDBN} by
32421default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32422
32423@subsubheading Example
32424
32425@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32426@c box in TeX.
32427@smallexample
32428(gdb)
32429-gdb-version
32430~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32431~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32432~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32433~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32434~ certain conditions.
32435~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32436~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB.  Type "show warranty" for
32437~ details.
32438~This GDB was configured as
32439 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32440^done
32441(gdb)
32442@end smallexample
32443
32444@subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32445@findex -list-thread-groups
32446
32447@subheading Synopsis
32448
32449@smallexample
32450-list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32451@end smallexample
32452
32453Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}).  When a single thread
32454group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32455When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32456thread groups.  Without any parameters, lists information about all
32457top-level thread groups.
32458
32459Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32460With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32461available on the target.
32462
32463The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32464a @samp{groups} result.  The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32465as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32466Information}).  The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32467each tuple describing a thread group.  If top-level groups are
32468requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32469are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result.  The format
32470of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32471
32472To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32473together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32474and the recursion depth.  Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32475permitted.  If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32476will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32477@samp{threads} field.
32478
32479In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32480the following caveats:
32481
32482@itemize @bullet
32483@item
32484When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32485be the @samp{threads} result.  Because threads may not contain
32486anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32487
32488@item
32489When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32490be available.  In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32491be inaccessible.  Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32492not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32493The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32494is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32495
32496@end itemize
32497
32498The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32499have the following fields:
32500
32501@table @code
32502@item id
32503Identifier of the thread group.  This field is always present.
32504The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32505convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32506
32507@item type
32508The type of the thread group.  At present, only @samp{process} is a
32509valid type.
32510
32511@item pid
32512The target-specific process identifier.  This field is only present
32513for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32514
32515@item exit-code
32516The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32517This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32518only if the process is not running.
32519
32520@item num_children
32521The number of children this thread group has.  This field may be
32522absent for an available thread group.
32523
32524@item threads
32525This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32526thread.  It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32527specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32528
32529@item cores
32530This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32531thread of the group is running on.  This field may be absent if
32532such information is not available.
32533
32534@item executable
32535The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32536The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32537and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32538
32539@end table
32540
32541@subheading Example
32542
32543@smallexample
32544@value{GDBP}
32545-list-thread-groups
32546^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32547-list-thread-groups 17
32548^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32549   frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32550@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32551   frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32552           file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32553-list-thread-groups --available
32554^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32555-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32556 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32557                threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32558                         @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32559-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32560^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32561               threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32562                        @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32563@end smallexample
32564
32565@subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32566@findex -info-os
32567
32568@subsubheading Synopsis
32569
32570@smallexample
32571-info-os [ @var{type} ]
32572@end smallexample
32573
32574If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32575operating-system-specific information types.  If one of these types is
32576supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32577of data of that type.
32578
32579The types of information available depend on the target operating
32580system.
32581
32582@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32583
32584The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32585
32586@subsubheading Example
32587
32588When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32589like this:
32590
32591@smallexample
32592@value{GDBP}
32593-info-os
32594^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32595hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32596     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32597     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32598body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32599            col2="CPUs"@},
32600      item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32601            col2="File descriptors"@},
32602      item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32603            col2="Kernel modules"@},
32604      item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32605            col2="Message queues"@},
32606      item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32607            col2="Processes"@},
32608      item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32609            col2="Process groups"@},
32610      item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32611            col2="Semaphores"@},
32612      item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32613            col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32614      item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32615            col2="Sockets"@},
32616      item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32617            col2="Threads"@}]
32618@value{GDBP}
32619-info-os processes
32620^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32621hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32622     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32623     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32624     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32625body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32626      item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32627      item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32628      ...
32629      item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32630      item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32631(gdb)
32632@end smallexample
32633
32634(Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32635does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32636for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32637popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32638@code{info os} omits it.)
32639
32640@subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32641@findex -add-inferior
32642
32643@subheading Synopsis
32644
32645@smallexample
32646-add-inferior
32647@end smallexample
32648
32649Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}).  The created
32650inferior is not associated with any executable.  Such association may
32651be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32652(@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}).  The command response has a single
32653field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32654thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32655
32656@subheading Example
32657
32658@smallexample
32659@value{GDBP}
32660-add-inferior
32661^done,inferior="i3"
32662@end smallexample
32663
32664@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32665@findex -interpreter-exec
32666
32667@subheading Synopsis
32668
32669@smallexample
32670-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32671@end smallexample
32672@anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32673
32674Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32675
32676@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32677
32678The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32679
32680@subheading Example
32681
32682@smallexample
32683(gdb)
32684-interpreter-exec console "break main"
32685&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32686&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32687~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32688^done
32689(gdb)
32690@end smallexample
32691
32692@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32693@findex -inferior-tty-set
32694
32695@subheading Synopsis
32696
32697@smallexample
32698-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32699@end smallexample
32700
32701Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32702
32703@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32704
32705The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32706
32707@subheading Example
32708
32709@smallexample
32710(gdb)
32711-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32712^done
32713(gdb)
32714@end smallexample
32715
32716@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32717@findex -inferior-tty-show
32718
32719@subheading Synopsis
32720
32721@smallexample
32722-inferior-tty-show
32723@end smallexample
32724
32725Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32726
32727@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32728
32729The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32730
32731@subheading Example
32732
32733@smallexample
32734(gdb)
32735-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32736^done
32737(gdb)
32738-inferior-tty-show
32739^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32740(gdb)
32741@end smallexample
32742
32743@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32744@findex -enable-timings
32745
32746@subheading Synopsis
32747
32748@smallexample
32749-enable-timings [yes | no]
32750@end smallexample
32751
32752Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32753command as a field in its output.  This command is to help frontend
32754developers optimize the performance of their code.  No argument is
32755equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32756
32757@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32758
32759No equivalent.
32760
32761@subheading Example
32762
32763@smallexample
32764(gdb)
32765-enable-timings
32766^done
32767(gdb)
32768-break-insert main
32769^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32770addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32771fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32772times="0"@},
32773time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32774(gdb)
32775-enable-timings no
32776^done
32777(gdb)
32778-exec-run
32779^running
32780(gdb)
32781*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32782frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32783@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32784fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32785(gdb)
32786@end smallexample
32787
32788@node Annotations
32789@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32790
32791This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}.  Annotations were
32792designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32793similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32794relatively high level.
32795
32796The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32797(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32798
32799@ignore
32800This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32801@end ignore
32802
32803@menu
32804* Annotations Overview::  What annotations are; the general syntax.
32805* Server Prefix::       Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32806* Prompting::           Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32807* Errors::              Annotations for error messages.
32808* Invalidation::        Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32809* Annotations for Running::
32810                        Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32811* Source Annotations::  Annotations describing source code.
32812@end menu
32813
32814@node Annotations Overview
32815@section What is an Annotation?
32816@cindex annotations
32817
32818Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32819characters, and the name of the annotation.  If there is no additional
32820information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32821is followed immediately by a newline.  If there is additional
32822information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32823additional information, and a newline.  The additional information
32824cannot contain newline characters.
32825
32826Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32827characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}.  Currently there is
32828no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32829@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32830annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32831means those three characters as output.
32832
32833The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32834@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32835how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32836values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output.  Level 0
32837is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32838subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32839for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32840been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32841Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32842
32843@table @code
32844@kindex set annotate
32845@item set annotate @var{level}
32846The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32847annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32848
32849@item show annotate
32850@kindex show annotate
32851Show the current annotation level.
32852@end table
32853
32854This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32855
32856A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32857
32858@smallexample
32859$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32860GNU gdb 6.0
32861Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32862GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32863and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32864under certain conditions.
32865Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32866There is absolutely no warranty for GDB.  Type "show warranty"
32867for details.
32868This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32869
32870^Z^Zpre-prompt
32871(@value{GDBP})
32872^Z^Zprompt
32873@kbd{quit}
32874
32875^Z^Zpost-prompt
32876$
32877@end smallexample
32878
32879Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32880@value{GDBN}.  The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32881denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32882output from @value{GDBN}.
32883
32884@node Server Prefix
32885@section The Server Prefix
32886@cindex server prefix
32887
32888If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32889the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32890command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself.  This
32891means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32892a transparent manner.
32893
32894The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32895the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32896value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32897@code{print} command.
32898
32899Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32900(@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32901
32902@node Prompting
32903@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32904
32905@cindex annotations for prompts
32906When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32907to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32908over, etc.
32909
32910Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}.  Each
32911input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32912denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32913annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32914annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32915associated with the input.  For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32916features the following annotations:
32917
32918@smallexample
32919^Z^Zpre-prompt
32920^Z^Zprompt
32921^Z^Zpost-prompt
32922@end smallexample
32923
32924The input types are
32925
32926@table @code
32927@findex pre-prompt annotation
32928@findex prompt annotation
32929@findex post-prompt annotation
32930@item prompt
32931When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32932
32933@findex pre-commands annotation
32934@findex commands annotation
32935@findex post-commands annotation
32936@item commands
32937When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32938command.  The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32939
32940@findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32941@findex overload-choice annotation
32942@findex post-overload-choice annotation
32943@item overload-choice
32944When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32945
32946@findex pre-query annotation
32947@findex query annotation
32948@findex post-query annotation
32949@item query
32950When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32951
32952@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32953@findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32954@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32955@item prompt-for-continue
32956When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue.  Note: Don't
32957expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32958prompting.  This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32959presence of annotations.
32960@end table
32961
32962@node Errors
32963@section Errors
32964@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32965
32966@findex quit annotation
32967@smallexample
32968^Z^Zquit
32969@end smallexample
32970
32971This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32972
32973@findex error annotation
32974@smallexample
32975^Z^Zerror
32976@end smallexample
32977
32978This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32979
32980Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32981in the middle of may end abruptly.  For example, if a
32982@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32983cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}.  One
32984cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32985does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32986to the top level.
32987
32988@findex error-begin annotation
32989A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32990
32991@smallexample
32992^Z^Zerror-begin
32993@end smallexample
32994
32995Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32996message.
32997
32998Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32999@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33000@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33001
33002@node Invalidation
33003@section Invalidation Notices
33004
33005@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33006The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33007changed.
33008
33009@table @code
33010@findex frames-invalid annotation
33011@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33012
33013The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33014have changed.
33015
33016@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33017@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33018
33019The breakpoints may have changed.  For example, the user just added or
33020deleted a breakpoint.
33021@end table
33022
33023@node Annotations for Running
33024@section Running the Program
33025@cindex annotations for running programs
33026
33027@findex starting annotation
33028@findex stopping annotation
33029When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33030@code{step} or @code{continue},
33031
33032@smallexample
33033^Z^Zstarting
33034@end smallexample
33035
33036is output.  When the program stops,
33037
33038@smallexample
33039^Z^Zstopped
33040@end smallexample
33041
33042is output.  Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33043annotations describe how the program stopped.
33044
33045@table @code
33046@findex exited annotation
33047@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33048The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33049successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33050
33051@findex signalled annotation
33052@findex signal-name annotation
33053@findex signal-name-end annotation
33054@findex signal-string annotation
33055@findex signal-string-end annotation
33056@item ^Z^Zsignalled
33057The program exited with a signal.  After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33058annotation continues:
33059
33060@smallexample
33061@var{intro-text}
33062^Z^Zsignal-name
33063@var{name}
33064^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33065@var{middle-text}
33066^Z^Zsignal-string
33067@var{string}
33068^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33069@var{end-text}
33070@end smallexample
33071
33072@noindent
33073where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33074@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33075as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.  The arguments
33076@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33077user's benefit and have no particular format.
33078
33079@findex signal annotation
33080@item ^Z^Zsignal
33081The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33082just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33083terminated with it.
33084
33085@findex breakpoint annotation
33086@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33087The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33088
33089@findex watchpoint annotation
33090@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33091The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33092@end table
33093
33094@node Source Annotations
33095@section Displaying Source
33096@cindex annotations for source display
33097
33098@findex source annotation
33099The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33100
33101@smallexample
33102^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33103@end smallexample
33104
33105where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33106file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33107first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33108within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33109debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33110@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33111line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33112@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33113source which is being displayed.  The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33114followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33115depend on the language).
33116
33117@node JIT Interface
33118@chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33119@cindex just-in-time compilation
33120@cindex JIT compilation interface
33121
33122This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33123interface.  A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33124executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33125performance while maintaining platform independence.
33126
33127Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33128portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33129object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33130and debug information.  In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33131@value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33132symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33133
33134If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33135it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary.  If
33136you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33137of this chapter.  At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33138LLVM JIT.
33139
33140Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface.  The
33141JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33142variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol.  When @value{GDBN}
33143attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33144find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33145out about additional code.
33146
33147@menu
33148* Declarations::                Relevant C struct declarations
33149* Registering Code::            Steps to register code
33150* Unregistering Code::          Steps to unregister code
33151* Custom Debug Info::           Emit debug information in a custom format
33152@end menu
33153
33154@node Declarations
33155@section JIT Declarations
33156
33157These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33158implement the interface:
33159
33160@smallexample
33161typedef enum
33162@{
33163  JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33164  JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33165  JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33166@} jit_actions_t;
33167
33168struct jit_code_entry
33169@{
33170  struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33171  struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33172  const char *symfile_addr;
33173  uint64_t symfile_size;
33174@};
33175
33176struct jit_descriptor
33177@{
33178  uint32_t version;
33179  /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33180     to be explicit about the bitwidth.  */
33181  uint32_t action_flag;
33182  struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33183  struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33184@};
33185
33186/* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function.  */
33187void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33188
33189/* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33190   debugger may check the version before we can set it.  */
33191struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33192@end smallexample
33193
33194If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33195modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33196a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33197
33198@node Registering Code
33199@section Registering Code
33200
33201To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33202
33203@itemize @bullet
33204@item
33205Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33206information.  The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33207
33208@item
33209Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33210file.
33211
33212@item
33213Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33214
33215@item
33216Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33217
33218@item
33219Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33220@code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33221@end itemize
33222
33223When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33224@code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33225new code.  However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33226@value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33227
33228@node Unregistering Code
33229@section Unregistering Code
33230
33231If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33232
33233@itemize @bullet
33234@item
33235Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33236
33237@item
33238Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33239
33240@item
33241Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33242@code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33243@end itemize
33244
33245If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33246and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33247
33248@node Custom Debug Info
33249@section Custom Debug Info
33250@cindex custom JIT debug info
33251@cindex JIT debug info reader
33252
33253Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33254or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33255debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace.  The
33256issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33257format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33258by the JIT compiler.  This section gives a brief overview on writing
33259such a parser.  More specific details can be found in the source file
33260@file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33261@file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33262
33263The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33264not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33265runtime).  Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33266@code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33267the readers from a preconfigured directory.  Once loaded, the shared
33268object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33269compiler.
33270
33271@menu
33272* Using JIT Debug Info Readers::       How to use supplied readers correctly
33273* Writing JIT Debug Info Readers::     Creating a debug-info reader
33274@end menu
33275
33276@node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33277@subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33278@kindex jit-reader-load
33279@kindex jit-reader-unload
33280
33281Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33282and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33283
33284@table @code
33285@item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33286Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33287object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name.  In
33288the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33289pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33290system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33291@file{/usr/local/lib}).
33292
33293Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33294reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33295reporting an error.  A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33296the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33297@code{jit-reader-load}.
33298
33299@item jit-reader-unload
33300Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33301
33302@end table
33303
33304@node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33305@subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33306@cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33307
33308As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33309certain ABI.  This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33310
33311@file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33312required to write a reader.  It is installed (along with
33313@value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33314the system include directory.
33315
33316Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license.  A reader
33317can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33318@code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33319
33320The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33321which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33322
33323@findex gdb_init_reader
33324@smallexample
33325extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33326@end smallexample
33327
33328@cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33329
33330@code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33331functions.  These functions are executed to read the debug info
33332generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33333(@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33334(@code{get_Frame_id}).  It also has a callback that is called when the
33335reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}).  The struct looks like this
33336
33337@smallexample
33338struct gdb_reader_funcs
33339@{
33340  /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION.  */
33341  int reader_version;
33342
33343  /* For use by the reader.  */
33344  void *priv_data;
33345
33346  gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33347  gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33348  gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33349  gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33350@};
33351@end smallexample
33352
33353@cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33354@cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33355
33356The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33357@value{GDBN} to do their job.  For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33358passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33359and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33360@code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33361files and new symbol tables inside those object files.  @code{struct
33362gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33363frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33364frame.  Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33365target's address space.
33366
33367@node In-Process Agent
33368@chapter In-Process Agent
33369@cindex debugging agent
33370The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33371because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution.  However,
33372as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33373multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33374and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33375example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33376timing may conceal the bugs.  On the other hand, in some applications,
33377it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33378long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33379If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33380introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33381code itself is correct.  It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33382behavior without interrupting it.
33383
33384Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33385some bugs.  In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33386reduce the number of operations performed by debugger.  The
33387@dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33388process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33389itself.  As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33390performance of debugging can be improved accordingly.  Note that
33391interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33392because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33393
33394The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33395(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations.  The
33396agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33397data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33398
33399@anchor{Control Agent}
33400You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33401debugging with the following commands:
33402
33403@table @code
33404@kindex set agent on
33405@item set agent on
33406Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33407debugger.  Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33408by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities.  For example,
33409if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33410and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33411conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33412
33413@kindex set agent off
33414@item set agent off
33415Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent.  All
33416of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33417
33418@kindex show agent
33419@item show agent
33420Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33421the in-process agent.
33422@end table
33423
33424@menu
33425* In-Process Agent Protocol::
33426@end menu
33427
33428@node In-Process Agent Protocol
33429@section In-Process Agent Protocol
33430@cindex in-process agent protocol
33431
33432The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33433GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}).  This section documents the protocol
33434used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33435In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33436(@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33437in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33438some other information.  The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33439of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33440types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33441
33442@menu
33443* IPA Protocol Objects::
33444* IPA Protocol Commands::
33445@end menu
33446
33447@node IPA Protocol Objects
33448@subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33449@cindex ipa protocol objects
33450
33451The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33452complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33453
33454The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33455or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33456two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33457However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33458
33459@enumerate
33460@item
33461word size.  On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33462compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33463@item
33464ABI.  Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33465GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33466the other one.
33467@end enumerate
33468
33469Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33470
33471@enumerate
33472@item
33473agent expression object.  It represents an agent expression
33474(@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33475@anchor{agent expression object}
33476@item
33477tracepoint action object.  It represents a tracepoint action
33478(@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33479memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33480@anchor{tracepoint action object}
33481@item
33482tracepoint object.  It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33483@anchor{tracepoint object}
33484
33485@end enumerate
33486
33487The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33488object:
33489
33490@multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33491@headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33492@item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33493@item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33494@item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33495@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33496@item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33497@item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33498address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33499of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33500@item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33501@item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33502memory address for collecting.
33503@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33504@item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33505@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33506@item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33507@item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33508@item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33509@item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33510@item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33511@item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33512@item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33513@item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33514@item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33515@item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33516@item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33517@item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33518@item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33519@item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33520@item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33521@item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33522@item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33523@ref{agent expression object}
33524@tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33525@ref{agent expression object}
33526@item actions @tab variable
33527@tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33528@end multitable
33529
33530@node IPA Protocol Commands
33531@subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33532@cindex ipa protocol commands
33533
33534The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33535specification.  They don't exist in real commands.
33536
33537@table @samp
33538
33539@item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33540Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33541(@pxref{tracepoint object}).  The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33542head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33543in IPA finally.
33544
33545Replies:
33546@table @samp
33547@item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33548@var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33549The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad.  Both of
33550@var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33551The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33552The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33553@item E @var{NN}
33554for an error
33555
33556@end table
33557
33558@item close
33559Closes the in-process agent.  This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33560is about to kill inferiors.
33561
33562@item qTfSTM
33563@xref{qTfSTM}.
33564@item qTsSTM
33565@xref{qTsSTM}.
33566@item qTSTMat
33567@xref{qTSTMat}.
33568@item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33569Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33570
33571Replies:
33572@table @samp
33573@item E @var{NN}
33574for an error
33575@end table
33576@item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33577Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33578@end table
33579
33580@node GDB Bugs
33581@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33582@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33583@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33584
33585Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33586
33587Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33588may not.  But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33589the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better.  Bug
33590reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33591
33592In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33593information that enables us to fix the bug.
33594
33595@menu
33596* Bug Criteria::                Have you found a bug?
33597* Bug Reporting::               How to report bugs
33598@end menu
33599
33600@node Bug Criteria
33601@section Have You Found a Bug?
33602@cindex bug criteria
33603
33604If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33605
33606@itemize @bullet
33607@cindex fatal signal
33608@cindex debugger crash
33609@cindex crash of debugger
33610@item
33611If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33612@value{GDBN} bug.  Reliable debuggers never crash.
33613
33614@cindex error on valid input
33615@item
33616If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33617bug.  (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33618somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33619
33620@cindex invalid input
33621@item
33622If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33623that is a bug.  However, you should note that your idea of
33624``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33625for traditional practice''.
33626
33627@item
33628If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33629for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33630@end itemize
33631
33632@node Bug Reporting
33633@section How to Report Bugs
33634@cindex bug reports
33635@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33636
33637A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33638If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33639contact that organization first.
33640
33641You can find contact information for many support companies and
33642individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33643distribution.
33644@c should add a web page ref...
33645
33646@ifset BUGURL
33647@ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33648In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33649@value{GDBN}.  The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33650@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33651page}.  Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33652be used.
33653
33654@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33655@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.}  Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33656not want to receive bug reports.  Those that do have arranged to receive
33657@samp{bug-gdb}.
33658
33659The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33660serves as a repeater.  The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33661the same messages.  Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33662newsgroup instead of mailing them.  This appears to work, but it has one
33663problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33664path back to the sender.  Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33665we may be unable to reach you.  For this reason, it is better to send
33666bug reports to the mailing list.
33667@end ifset
33668@ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33669In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33670@value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33671@end ifclear
33672@end ifset
33673
33674The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33675@strong{report all the facts}.  If you are not sure whether to state a
33676fact or leave it out, state it!
33677
33678Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33679problem and assume that some details do not matter.  Thus, you might
33680assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33681Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure.  Perhaps the bug is a
33682stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33683name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33684of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33685the bug.  Play it safe and give a specific, complete example.  That is the
33686easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33687
33688Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33689bug.  It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33690you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33691self-contained.
33692
33693Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33694bell?''  Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33695@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33696bugs properly.
33697
33698To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33699
33700@itemize @bullet
33701@item
33702The version of @value{GDBN}.  @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33703with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33704version}.
33705
33706Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33707the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33708
33709@item
33710The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33711version number.
33712
33713@item
33714The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33715@value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33716@option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33717@code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33718
33719@item
33720What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33721``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33722
33723@item
33724What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33725debugging---e.g.@:  ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33726C Compiler''.  For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33727to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33728those compilers.
33729
33730@item
33731The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33732observe the bug.  For example, did you use @samp{-O}?  To guarantee
33733you will not omit something important, list them all.  A copy of the
33734Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33735
33736If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33737and then we might not encounter the bug.
33738
33739@item
33740A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33741reproduce the bug.
33742
33743@item
33744A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33745incorrect.  For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33746
33747Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33748will certainly notice it.  But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33749not notice unless it is glaringly wrong.  You might as well not give us
33750a chance to make a mistake.
33751
33752Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33753say so explicitly.  Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33754copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33755the C library on your system.  (This has happened!)  Your copy might
33756crash and ours would not.  If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33757ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33758us.  If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33759to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33760
33761@pindex script
33762@cindex recording a session script
33763To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33764such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33765Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33766include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33767
33768Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33769inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33770
33771@item
33772If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33773diffs.  If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33774it by context, not by line number.
33775
33776The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33777sources.  Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33778
33779@end itemize
33780
33781Here are some things that are not necessary:
33782
33783@itemize @bullet
33784@item
33785A description of the envelope of the bug.
33786
33787Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33788which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33789changes will not affect it.
33790
33791This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33792will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33793with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33794We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33795
33796Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33797of the original one, that is a convenience for us.  Errors in the
33798output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33799less time, and so on.
33800
33801However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33802report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33803
33804@item
33805A patch for the bug.
33806
33807A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one.  But do not omit
33808the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33809a patch is all we need.  We might see problems with your patch and decide
33810to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33811
33812Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33813construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33814through the code.  If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33815to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33816
33817And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33818patch should be an improvement, we will not install it.  A test case will
33819help us to understand.
33820
33821@item
33822A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33823
33824Such guesses are usually wrong.  Even we cannot guess right about such
33825things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33826@end itemize
33827
33828@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33829@c and consists of the two following files:
33830@c     rluser.texi
33831@c     hsuser.texi
33832@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33833@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33834@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33835@include rluser.texi
33836@include hsuser.texi
33837@end ifclear
33838
33839@node In Memoriam
33840@appendix In Memoriam
33841
33842The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33843contributors:
33844
33845@table @code
33846@item Fred Fish
33847Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33848to Free Software in general.  Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33849the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33850
33851@item Michael Snyder
33852Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33853with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011.  In addition
33854to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33855adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33856@end table
33857
33858Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33859enjoyable members of the Free Software Community.  We will miss them.
33860
33861@node Formatting Documentation
33862@appendix Formatting Documentation
33863
33864@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33865@cindex reference card
33866The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33867for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33868subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33869@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33870release.}.  If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33871you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33872
33873The release also includes the source for the reference card.  You
33874can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33875
33876@smallexample
33877make refcard.dvi
33878@end smallexample
33879
33880The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33881mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33882that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33883high.  You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33884your @sc{dvi} output program.
33885
33886@cindex documentation
33887
33888All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33889distribution.  The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33890a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33891on-line information and a printed manual.  You can use one of the Info
33892formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33893and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33894
33895@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33896version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory.  The main Info
33897file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33898subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory.  If
33899necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33900but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33901Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33902@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33903
33904If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33905Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33906@code{makeinfo}.
33907
33908If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33909@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33910version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33911
33912@smallexample
33913cd gdb
33914make gdb.info
33915@end smallexample
33916
33917If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33918a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33919Texinfo definitions file.
33920
33921@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33922produces output files called @sc{dvi} files.  To print a typeset
33923document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files.  If your system
33924has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program.  The precise
33925command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33926(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}.  The @sc{dvi} print command may
33927require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33928
33929@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33930@file{texinfo.tex}.  This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33931written in Texinfo format.  On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33932typeset a Texinfo file.  @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33933and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33934directory.
33935
33936If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33937typeset and print this manual.  First switch to the @file{gdb}
33938subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33939@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33940
33941@smallexample
33942make gdb.dvi
33943@end smallexample
33944
33945Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33946
33947@node Installing GDB
33948@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33949@cindex installation
33950
33951@menu
33952* Requirements::                Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33953* Running Configure::           Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33954* Separate Objdir::             Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33955* Config Names::                Specifying names for hosts and targets
33956* Configure Options::           Summary of options for configure
33957* System-wide configuration::   Having a system-wide init file
33958@end menu
33959
33960@node Requirements
33961@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33962@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33963
33964Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33965Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33966
33967@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33968@table @asis
33969@item ISO C90 compiler
33970@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90.  It should be buildable with any
33971working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33972
33973@end table
33974
33975@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33976@table @asis
33977@item Expat
33978@anchor{Expat}
33979@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library.  This library may be
33980included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33981can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33982The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33983standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33984use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33985
33986Expat is used for:
33987
33988@itemize @bullet
33989@item
33990Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33991@item
33992Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33993@item
33994Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33995or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33996@item
33997MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33998@item
33999Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34000@item
34001Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34002@pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34003@end itemize
34004
34005@item zlib
34006@cindex compressed debug sections
34007@value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34008compressed debug sections.  Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34009of producing binaries with compressed debug sections.  If @value{GDBN}
34010is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34011information in such binaries.
34012
34013The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34014distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34015@url{http://zlib.net}.
34016
34017@item iconv
34018@value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34019Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation.  If you are
34020on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library.  Some
34021other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34022
34023If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34024in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34025This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34026directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34027
34028On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv.  If you
34029have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34030@option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34031
34032@value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34033arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34034in the top-most source directory.  If Libiconv is built this way, and
34035if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34036implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34037by @value{GDBN}.  One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34038Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34039Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34040@end table
34041
34042@node Running Configure
34043@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34044@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34045@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34046of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34047build the @code{gdb} program.
34048@iftex
34049@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34050@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34051look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34052installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34053@end iftex
34054
34055The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34056@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34057appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34058
34059For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34060@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.  That directory contains:
34061
34062@table @code
34063@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34064script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34065
34066@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34067the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34068
34069@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34070source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34071
34072@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34073@sc{gnu} include files
34074
34075@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34076source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34077
34078@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34079source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34080
34081@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34082source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34083
34084@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34085source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34086
34087@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34088source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34089@end table
34090
34091The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34092from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34093this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34094
34095First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34096if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}.  Pass the
34097identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34098argument.
34099
34100For example:
34101
34102@smallexample
34103cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34104./configure @var{host}
34105make
34106@end smallexample
34107
34108@noindent
34109where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34110@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34111(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34112correct value by examining your system.)
34113
34114Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34115@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34116libraries, then @code{gdb} itself.  The configured source files, and the
34117binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34118
34119@need 750
34120@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34121system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34122shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34123
34124@smallexample
34125sh configure @var{host}
34126@end smallexample
34127
34128If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34129directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34130@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34131@file{configure}
34132creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34133you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34134
34135You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34136source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory.  If you run
34137@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34138that subdirectory.  That is usually not what you want.  In particular,
34139if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34140of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34141configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34142directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory.  This leads to build errors
34143about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34144
34145You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34146However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34147the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable.  Remember
34148that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34149let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34150
34151@node Separate Objdir
34152@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34153
34154If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34155you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34156host and target.  @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34157allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34158rather than in the source directory.  If your @code{make} program
34159handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34160@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34161program specified there.
34162
34163To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34164with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34165(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34166itself from your working directory.  If the path to @file{configure}
34167would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34168the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34169
34170For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34171separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34172
34173@smallexample
34174@group
34175cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34176mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34177cd ../gdb-sun4
34178../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34179make
34180@end group
34181@end smallexample
34182
34183When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34184directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34185(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory.  In
34186the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34187directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34188@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34189
34190Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34191instance of @file{gdb} in it.  If your path to @file{configure} looks
34192like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34193one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package.  This leads to
34194build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34195
34196One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34197directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34198@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34199programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34200You specify a cross-debugging target by
34201giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34202
34203When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34204it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34205called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34206
34207The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34208directory also runs recursively.  If you type @code{make} in a source
34209directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34210directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34211will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34212
34213When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34214directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34215if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34216with each other.
34217
34218@node Config Names
34219@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34220
34221The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34222script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34223aliases are also supported.  The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34224of information in the following pattern:
34225
34226@smallexample
34227@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34228@end smallexample
34229
34230For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34231or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34232option.  The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34233
34234The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34235any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34236aliases.  @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34237@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34238script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34239abbreviations---for example:
34240
34241@smallexample
34242% sh config.sub i386-linux
34243i386-pc-linux-gnu
34244% sh config.sub alpha-linux
34245alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34246% sh config.sub hp9k700
34247hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34248% sh config.sub sun4
34249sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34250% sh config.sub sun3
34251m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34252% sh config.sub i986v
34253Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34254@end smallexample
34255
34256@noindent
34257@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34258directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34259
34260@node Configure Options
34261@section @file{configure} Options
34262
34263Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34264are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}.  @file{configure} also has
34265several other options not listed here.  @inforef{What Configure
34266Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34267
34268@smallexample
34269configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34270          @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34271          @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34272          @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34273          @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34274          @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34275          @var{host}
34276@end smallexample
34277
34278@noindent
34279You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34280@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34281@samp{--}.
34282
34283@table @code
34284@item --help
34285Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34286
34287@item --prefix=@var{dir}
34288Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34289@file{@var{dir}}.
34290
34291@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34292Configure the source to install programs under directory
34293@file{@var{dir}}.
34294
34295@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34296@need 2000
34297@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34298@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34299@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34300Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34301@value{GDBN} source directories.  Among other things, you can use this to
34302build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34303directories.  @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34304the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34305directory @var{dirname}.  @file{configure} creates directories under
34306the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34307@var{dirname}.
34308
34309@item --norecursion
34310Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34311propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34312
34313@item --target=@var{target}
34314Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34315@var{target}.  Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34316programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34317
34318There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34319
34320@item @var{host} @dots{}
34321Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34322
34323There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34324@end table
34325
34326There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34327needed for special purposes only.
34328
34329@node System-wide configuration
34330@section System-wide configuration and settings
34331@cindex system-wide init file
34332
34333@value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34334this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34335@value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34336
34337Here is the corresponding configure option:
34338
34339@table @code
34340@item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34341Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34342@var{file}.
34343@end table
34344
34345If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34346it may be subject to relocation.  Two possible cases:
34347
34348@itemize @bullet
34349@item
34350If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34351it will be subject to relocation.  Suppose that the configure options
34352are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34353if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34354init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34355@file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34356
34357@item
34358By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34359it will not be relocated.  E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34360@option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34361then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34362wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34363@end itemize
34364
34365If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34366@option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34367data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34368time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34369system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34370@option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34371Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34372initialization.  If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34373started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34374reread.
34375
34376@menu
34377* System-wide Configuration Scripts::  Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34378@end menu
34379
34380@node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34381@subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34382@cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34383
34384The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34385(as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34386a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files.  To
34387automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34388configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}.  Otherwise, any user
34389should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34390
34391The following scripts are currently available:
34392@itemize @bullet
34393
34394@item @file{elinos.py}
34395@pindex elinos.py
34396@cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34397This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34398It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34399ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34400shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34401and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34402
34403@item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34404@pindex wrs-linux.py
34405@cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34406This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34407Wind River Linux.  It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34408the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34409
34410@end itemize
34411
34412@node Maintenance Commands
34413@appendix Maintenance Commands
34414@cindex maintenance commands
34415@cindex internal commands
34416
34417In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34418includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34419that are not documented elsewhere in this manual.  These commands are
34420provided here for reference.  (For commands that turn on debugging
34421messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34422
34423@table @code
34424@kindex maint agent
34425@kindex maint agent-eval
34426@item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34427@itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34428Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34429This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34430(@pxref{Agent Expressions}).  The @samp{agent} version produces an
34431expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34432@samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34433to a result.  For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34434globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34435of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34436the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34437addition and return the sum.
34438If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34439If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34440
34441@kindex maint agent-printf
34442@item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34443Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34444into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34445This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34446printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34447
34448@kindex maint info breakpoints
34449@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34450Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34451breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34452internal purposes.  Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34453breakpoint numbers.  The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34454is shown:
34455
34456@table @code
34457@item breakpoint
34458Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34459
34460@item watchpoint
34461Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34462
34463@item longjmp
34464Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34465@code{longjmp} calls.
34466
34467@item longjmp resume
34468Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34469
34470@item until
34471Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34472
34473@item finish
34474Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34475
34476@item shlib events
34477Shared library events.
34478
34479@end table
34480
34481@kindex maint info btrace
34482@item maint info btrace
34483Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34484
34485@kindex maint btrace packet-history
34486@item maint btrace packet-history
34487Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34488execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command.  Both the
34489information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34490recording format.
34491
34492@table @code
34493@item bts
34494For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34495code.  For each block, the following information is printed:
34496
34497@table @asis
34498@item Block number
34499Newer blocks have higher numbers.  The oldest block has number zero.
34500@item Lowest @samp{PC}
34501@item Highest @samp{PC}
34502@end table
34503
34504@item pt
34505For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34506Intel Processor Trace packets.  For each packet, the following
34507information is printed:
34508
34509@table @asis
34510@item Packet number
34511Newer packets have higher numbers.  The oldest packet has number zero.
34512@item Trace offset
34513The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34514@item Packet opcode and payload
34515@end table
34516@end table
34517
34518@kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34519@item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34520Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34521packet-history} command.  The history will be computed again when
34522needed.
34523
34524@kindex maint btrace clear
34525@item maint btrace clear
34526Discard the branch trace data.  The data will be fetched anew and the
34527branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34528
34529This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34530buffer.  When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34531available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34532buffer.
34533
34534@kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34535@item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34536@kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34537@item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34538Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34539packet history.
34540
34541@kindex set displaced-stepping
34542@kindex show displaced-stepping
34543@cindex displaced stepping support
34544@cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34545@item set displaced-stepping
34546@itemx show displaced-stepping
34547Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34548if the target supports it.  Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34549over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34550an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34551breakpoint location.  It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34552
34553@table @code
34554@item set displaced-stepping on
34555If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34556displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34557
34558@item set displaced-stepping off
34559@value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34560even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34561
34562@cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34563@item set displaced-stepping auto
34564This is the default mode.  @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34565only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34566architecture supports displaced stepping.
34567@end table
34568
34569@kindex maint check-psymtabs
34570@item maint check-psymtabs
34571Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34572Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34573
34574@kindex maint check-symtabs
34575@item maint check-symtabs
34576Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34577
34578@kindex maint expand-symtabs
34579@item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34580Expand symbol tables.
34581If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34582names matching @var{regexp}.
34583
34584@kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34585@kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34586@cindex demangler crashes
34587@item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34588@itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34589Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34590symbol name demangler.  The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34591If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34592the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34593option to terminate the current session.
34594
34595@kindex maint cplus first_component
34596@item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34597Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34598
34599@kindex maint cplus namespace
34600@item maint cplus namespace
34601Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34602
34603@kindex maint deprecate
34604@kindex maint undeprecate
34605@cindex deprecated commands
34606@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34607@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34608Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}.  Deprecated commands
34609cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them.  The optional
34610argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34611favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34612the replacement as part of the warning.
34613
34614@kindex maint dump-me
34615@item maint dump-me
34616@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34617Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34618This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34619with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34620
34621@kindex maint internal-error
34622@kindex maint internal-warning
34623@kindex maint demangler-warning
34624@cindex demangler crashes
34625@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34626@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34627@itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34628
34629Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34630@code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34631as though an internal problem has been detected.  In addition to
34632reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34633opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34634and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34635@value{GDBN} session.
34636
34637These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34638used as the text of the error or warning message.
34639
34640Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34641
34642@smallexample
34643(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34644@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34645A problem internal to GDB has been detected.  Further
34646debugging may prove unreliable.
34647Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34648Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34649(@value{GDBP})
34650@end smallexample
34651
34652@cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34653@cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34654@cindex demangler crashes
34655
34656@kindex maint set internal-error
34657@kindex maint show internal-error
34658@kindex maint set internal-warning
34659@kindex maint show internal-warning
34660@kindex maint set demangler-warning
34661@kindex maint show demangler-warning
34662@item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34663@itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34664@itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34665@itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34666@itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34667@itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34668When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34669gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34670core file of the current @value{GDBN} session.  These commands let you
34671override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34672described in the table below.
34673
34674@table @samp
34675@item quit
34676You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34677quit.  The default is to ask the user what to do.
34678
34679@item corefile
34680You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34681create a core file.  The default is to ask the user what to do.  Note
34682that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34683demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34684disabled.
34685@end table
34686
34687@kindex maint packet
34688@item maint packet @var{text}
34689If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34690then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34691displays the response packet.  @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34692@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34693checksum.
34694
34695@kindex maint print architecture
34696@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34697Print the entire architecture configuration.  The optional argument
34698@var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34699
34700@kindex maint print c-tdesc
34701@item maint print c-tdesc
34702Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34703a C source file.  The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34704when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34705
34706@kindex maint print dummy-frames
34707@item maint print dummy-frames
34708Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34709
34710@smallexample
34711(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34712@dots{}
34713(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34714Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
3471558	  return (a + b);
34716The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34717@dots{}
34718(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
347190xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34720(@value{GDBP})
34721@end smallexample
34722
34723Takes an optional file parameter.
34724
34725@kindex maint print registers
34726@kindex maint print raw-registers
34727@kindex maint print cooked-registers
34728@kindex maint print register-groups
34729@kindex maint print remote-registers
34730@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34731@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34732@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34733@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34734@itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34735Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34736
34737The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34738the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34739cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34740including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34741to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34742groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34743print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34744and offsets in the `G' packets.
34745
34746These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34747write the information.
34748
34749@kindex maint print reggroups
34750@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34751Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.  The
34752optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34753information.
34754
34755The register groups info looks like this:
34756
34757@smallexample
34758(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34759 Group      Type
34760 general    user
34761 float      user
34762 all        user
34763 vector     user
34764 system     user
34765 save       internal
34766 restore    internal
34767@end smallexample
34768
34769@kindex flushregs
34770@item flushregs
34771This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34772
34773@kindex maint print objfiles
34774@cindex info for known object files
34775@item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34776Print a dump of all known object files.
34777If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34778match @var{regexp}.  For each object file, this command prints its name,
34779address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34780
34781@kindex maint print user-registers
34782@cindex user registers
34783@item maint print user-registers
34784List all currently available @dfn{user registers}.  User registers
34785typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers.  They
34786include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34787@code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}.  @xref{standard registers}.  User
34788registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34789register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34790registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34791
34792@kindex maint print section-scripts
34793@cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34794@item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34795Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34796If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34797matching @var{regexp}.
34798For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34799and the full path if known.
34800@xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34801
34802@kindex maint print statistics
34803@cindex bcache statistics
34804@item maint print statistics
34805This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34806about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34807statistics for the object file.  The objfile data includes the number
34808of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34809defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34810the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34811used by the various tables.  The bcache statistics include the counts,
34812sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34813average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34814savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34815lengths.
34816
34817@kindex maint print target-stack
34818@cindex target stack description
34819@item maint print target-stack
34820A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34821kind of file or process.  Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34822so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34823In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34824until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34825address.
34826
34827This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34828the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34829
34830@kindex maint print type
34831@cindex type chain of a data type
34832@item maint print type @var{expr}
34833Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}.  The argument
34834can be either a type name or a symbol.  If it is a symbol, the type of
34835that symbol is described.  The type chain produced by this command is
34836a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34837data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34838
34839@kindex maint selftest
34840@cindex self tests
34841Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}.  This will
34842print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34843
34844@kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34845@kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34846@item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34847@item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34848Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34849information.
34850
34851The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34852describe a variable's location in an easily readable format.  When
34853@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34854expression in an assembly-like format.  Note that some locations are
34855too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34856always see the disassembly form.
34857
34858Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34859
34860@smallexample
34861(gdb) info addr argc
34862Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34863     1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34864@end smallexample
34865
34866For more information on these expressions, see
34867@uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34868
34869@kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34870@kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34871@item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34872@itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34873Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34874
34875@cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34876In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34877produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34878reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34879This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34880cache if it is not referenced.  A higher limit means that cached
34881compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34882memory will be used.  Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34883slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34884
34885@kindex maint set profile
34886@kindex maint show profile
34887@cindex profiling GDB
34888@item maint set profile
34889@itemx maint show profile
34890Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34891
34892Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34893command to enable it.  When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34894collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34895exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file.  Remember that
34896if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34897(often called @file{gmon.out}).  If you have a record of important profiling
34898data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34899
34900Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34901compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34902
34903@kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34904@kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34905@cindex hardware debug registers
34906@item maint set show-debug-regs
34907@itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34908Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34909registers.  Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable.  If
34910enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34911removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34912triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34913
34914@kindex maint set show-all-tib
34915@kindex maint show show-all-tib
34916@item maint set show-all-tib
34917@itemx maint show show-all-tib
34918Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34919at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34920command.
34921
34922@kindex maint set target-async
34923@kindex maint show target-async
34924@item maint set target-async
34925@itemx maint show target-async
34926This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34927asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}).  Normally the
34928default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34929to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34930
34931@kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34932@kindex maint show target-non-stop
34933@item maint set target-non-stop
34934@itemx maint show target-non-stop
34935
34936This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34937mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34938Mode}).  The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34939if supported by the target.
34940
34941@table @code
34942@item maint set target-non-stop auto
34943This is the default mode.  @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34944non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34945
34946@item maint set target-non-stop on
34947@value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34948does not indicate support.
34949
34950@item maint set target-non-stop off
34951@value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34952target supports it.
34953@end table
34954
34955@kindex maint set per-command
34956@kindex maint show per-command
34957@item maint set per-command
34958@itemx maint show per-command
34959@cindex resources used by commands
34960
34961@value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34962This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34963
34964@table @code
34965@item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34966@itemx maint show per-command space
34967Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34968If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34969took, following the command's own output.
34970This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34971@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34972
34973@item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34974@itemx maint show per-command time
34975Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34976for each command.
34977If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34978took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34979Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34980Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34981CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34982Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34983the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34984to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34985spent by the program been debugged.
34986This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34987@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34988
34989@item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34990@itemx maint show per-command symtab
34991Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34992for each command.
34993If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34994
34995@enumerate a
34996@item
34997number of symbol tables
34998@item
34999number of primary symbol tables
35000@item
35001number of blocks in the blockvector
35002@end enumerate
35003@end table
35004
35005@kindex maint space
35006@cindex memory used by commands
35007@item maint space @var{value}
35008An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35009A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35010
35011@kindex maint time
35012@cindex time of command execution
35013@item maint time @var{value}
35014An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35015A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35016
35017@kindex maint translate-address
35018@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35019Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35020@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}.  If found,
35021@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35022the symbol's location to the specified address.  This is similar to
35023the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35024command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35025
35026If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35027is also printed.  For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35028executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35029
35030@end table
35031
35032The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35033@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35034
35035@table @code
35036@item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35037@kindex set watchdog
35038@cindex watchdog timer
35039@cindex timeout for commands
35040Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35041target operation to finish.  If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35042reports and error and the command is aborted.
35043
35044@item show watchdog
35045Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35046@end table
35047
35048@node Remote Protocol
35049@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35050
35051@menu
35052* Overview::
35053* Packets::
35054* Stop Reply Packets::
35055* General Query Packets::
35056* Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35057* Tracepoint Packets::
35058* Host I/O Packets::
35059* Interrupts::
35060* Notification Packets::
35061* Remote Non-Stop::
35062* Packet Acknowledgment::
35063* Examples::
35064* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35065* Library List Format::
35066* Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35067* Memory Map Format::
35068* Thread List Format::
35069* Traceframe Info Format::
35070* Branch Trace Format::
35071* Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35072@end menu
35073
35074@node Overview
35075@section Overview
35076
35077There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35078protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35079machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35080recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35081
35082In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35083transmitted and received data, respectively.
35084
35085@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35086@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35087@cindex remote serial protocol
35088All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35089and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35090@var{packet}.  A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35091@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35092@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35093
35094@smallexample
35095@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35096@end smallexample
35097@noindent
35098
35099@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35100@noindent
35101The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35102characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35103eight bit unsigned checksum).
35104
35105Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35106specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35107
35108@smallexample
35109@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35110@end smallexample
35111
35112@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35113@noindent
35114That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment.  @value{GDBN}
35115has never output @var{sequence-id}s.  Stubs that handle packets added
35116since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35117
35118When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35119response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35120the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35121retransmission):
35122
35123@smallexample
35124-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35125<- @code{+}
35126@end smallexample
35127@noindent
35128
35129The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35130once a connection is established.
35131@xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35132
35133The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35134debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}.  In
35135the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35136when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35137threads in all attached processes.  This is the default all-stop mode
35138behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35139execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35140
35141@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35142exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35143exceptions).
35144
35145@cindex remote protocol, field separator
35146Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35147@samp{:}.  Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35148@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35149
35150Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35151@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35152would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35153
35154@cindex remote protocol, binary data
35155@anchor{Binary Data}
35156Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35157digits per byte of binary data.  This allowed the traditional remote
35158protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35159Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35160connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35161binary data.
35162
35163The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35164as an escape character.  Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35165character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35166For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35167bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}.  The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35168@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35169@samp{@}}) must always be escaped.  Responses sent by the stub
35170must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35171is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35172(described next).
35173
35174Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35175Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35176instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35177repeat count.  The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35178binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35179@code{@var{n}+29}.  For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35180produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35181code 32) for a repeat count of 3.  (This is because run-length
35182encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.)  Thus, for example,
35183@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35184after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
351853}} more times.
35186
35187The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35188greater than 126 must not be used.  Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35189seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35190five (@samp{"}).  For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35191@samp{0*"00}.
35192
35193The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35194error number.  That number is not well defined.
35195
35196@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35197For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35198(@samp{$#00}) should be returned.  That way it is possible to extend the
35199protocol.  A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35200on that response.
35201
35202At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35203commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35204for memory access.  Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35205can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35206(step) commands.  Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35207support the @samp{vCont} command.  All other commands are optional.
35208
35209@node Packets
35210@section Packets
35211
35212The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35213@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35214@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35215I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35216
35217Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35218syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning.  We
35219include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35220part of the packet's syntax.  No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35221separate its components.  For example, a template like @samp{foo
35222@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35223bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35224@var{baz}.  @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35225@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35226@var{baz}.
35227
35228@cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35229@anchor{thread-id syntax}
35230Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35231a thread.  Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35232interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings.  A @var{thread-id}
35233can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35234pick any thread.
35235
35236In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35237which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35238process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35239The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35240format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35241interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35242to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35243indicate an arbitrary process or thread.  Specifying just a process, as
35244@samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}.  It is an
35245error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35246@samp{p-1.@var{tid}}.  Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35247for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35248ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35249
35250The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35251@value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35252feature using @samp{qSupported}.  @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35253more information.
35254
35255Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35256letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35257
35258Here are the packet descriptions.
35259
35260@table @samp
35261
35262@item !
35263@cindex @samp{!} packet
35264@anchor{extended mode}
35265Enable extended mode.  In extended mode, the remote server is made
35266persistent.  The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35267debugged.
35268
35269Reply:
35270@table @samp
35271@item OK
35272The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35273@end table
35274
35275@item ?
35276@cindex @samp{?} packet
35277@anchor{? packet}
35278Indicate the reason the target halted.  The reply is the same as for
35279step and continue.  This packet has a special interpretation when the
35280target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35281
35282Reply:
35283@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35284
35285@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35286@cindex @samp{A} packet
35287Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35288specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35289@var{arg}.  See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35290
35291Reply:
35292@table @samp
35293@item OK
35294The arguments were set.
35295@item E @var{NN}
35296An error occurred.
35297@end table
35298
35299@item b @var{baud}
35300@cindex @samp{b} packet
35301(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35302Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35303
35304JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change?  When it's
35305received, or after the ACK is transmitted.  In either case, there are
35306problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35307
35308Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35309it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35310some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35311switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35312of view, nothing actually happened.}
35313
35314@item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35315@cindex @samp{B} packet
35316Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35317breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35318
35319Don't use this packet.  Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35320(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35321
35322@cindex @samp{bc} packet
35323@anchor{bc}
35324@item bc
35325Backward continue.  Execute the target system in reverse.  No parameter.
35326@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35327
35328Reply:
35329@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35330
35331@cindex @samp{bs} packet
35332@anchor{bs}
35333@item bs
35334Backward single step.  Execute one instruction in reverse.  No parameter.
35335@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35336
35337Reply:
35338@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35339
35340@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35341@cindex @samp{c} packet
35342Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume.  If @var{addr}
35343is omitted, resume at current address.
35344
35345This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support.  @xref{vCont
35346packet}.
35347
35348Reply:
35349@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35350
35351@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35352@cindex @samp{C} packet
35353Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number).  If
35354@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35355
35356This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support.  @xref{vCont
35357packet}.
35358
35359Reply:
35360@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35361
35362@item d
35363@cindex @samp{d} packet
35364Toggle debug flag.
35365
35366Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35367(@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35368
35369@item D
35370@itemx D;@var{pid}
35371@cindex @samp{D} packet
35372The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35373remote system.  It is sent to the remote target
35374before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35375
35376The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35377protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35378detach only a specific process.  The @var{pid} is specified as a
35379big-endian hex string.
35380
35381Reply:
35382@table @samp
35383@item OK
35384for success
35385@item E @var{NN}
35386for an error
35387@end table
35388
35389@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35390@cindex @samp{F} packet
35391A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35392This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.  @xref{File-I/O
35393Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35394
35395@item g
35396@anchor{read registers packet}
35397@cindex @samp{g} packet
35398Read general registers.
35399
35400Reply:
35401@table @samp
35402@item @var{XX@dots{}}
35403Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits.  The bytes
35404with the register are transmitted in target byte order.  The size of
35405each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35406determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35407@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35408
35409When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35410Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35411literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35412that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35413is unavailable.  For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
354144 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35415registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35416have been collected, and both have zero value:
35417
35418@smallexample
35419-> @code{g}
35420<- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35421@end smallexample
35422
35423@item E @var{NN}
35424for an error.
35425@end table
35426
35427@item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35428@cindex @samp{G} packet
35429Write general registers.  @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35430description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35431
35432Reply:
35433@table @samp
35434@item OK
35435for success
35436@item E @var{NN}
35437for an error
35438@end table
35439
35440@item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35441@cindex @samp{H} packet
35442Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35443@samp{G}, et.al.).  Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35444should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35445is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35446option), and @samp{g} for other operations.  The thread designator
35447@var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35448@ref{thread-id syntax}.
35449
35450Reply:
35451@table @samp
35452@item OK
35453for success
35454@item E @var{NN}
35455for an error
35456@end table
35457
35458@c FIXME: JTC:
35459@c   'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model.  If a
35460@c        thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35461@c        to continue to execute?  As I mentioned above, I think the
35462@c        semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35463@c        described.  For example:
35464@c
35465@c        'g':    If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35466@c                selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35467@c                otherwise returns current registers.
35468@c
35469@c        'G'     If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35470@c                selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35471@c                that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35472
35473@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35474@anchor{cycle step packet}
35475@cindex @samp{i} packet
35476Step the remote target by a single clock cycle.  If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35477present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles.  If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35478step starting at that address.
35479
35480@item I
35481@cindex @samp{I} packet
35482Signal, then cycle step.  @xref{step with signal packet}.  @xref{cycle
35483step packet}.
35484
35485@item k
35486@cindex @samp{k} packet
35487Kill request.
35488
35489The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35490
35491For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35492system.  For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35493
35494For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35495
35496A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35497that are under @value{GDBN}'s control.  For more precise control, use
35498the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35499
35500If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35501@samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35502acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35503
35504If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35505not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35506probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35507(@pxref{? packet}).
35508
35509@item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35510@cindex @samp{m} packet
35511Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35512(@pxref{addressable memory unit}).  Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35513any particular boundary.
35514
35515The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35516data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35517and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35518use byte accesses, or not.  For this reason, this packet may not be
35519suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35520@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35521@cindex size of remote memory accesses
35522@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35523
35524Reply:
35525@table @samp
35526@item @var{XX@dots{}}
35527Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35528The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35529server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35530@item E @var{NN}
35531@var{NN} is errno
35532@end table
35533
35534@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35535@cindex @samp{M} packet
35536Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35537(@pxref{addressable memory unit}).  The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35538byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35539
35540Reply:
35541@table @samp
35542@item OK
35543for success
35544@item E @var{NN}
35545for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35546written).
35547@end table
35548
35549@item p @var{n}
35550@cindex @samp{p} packet
35551Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35552@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35553register value is encoded.
35554
35555Reply:
35556@table @samp
35557@item @var{XX@dots{}}
35558the register's value
35559@item E @var{NN}
35560for an error
35561@item @w{}
35562Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35563@end table
35564
35565@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35566@anchor{write register packet}
35567@cindex @samp{P} packet
35568Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}.  The register
35569number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35570digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35571
35572Reply:
35573@table @samp
35574@item OK
35575for success
35576@item E @var{NN}
35577for an error
35578@end table
35579
35580@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35581@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35582@cindex @samp{q} packet
35583@cindex @samp{Q} packet
35584General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}).  These packets are
35585described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35586
35587@item r
35588@cindex @samp{r} packet
35589Reset the entire system.
35590
35591Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35592
35593@item R @var{XX}
35594@cindex @samp{R} packet
35595Restart the program being debugged.  The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35596This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35597
35598The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35599
35600@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35601@cindex @samp{s} packet
35602Single step, resuming at @var{addr}.  If
35603@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35604
35605This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support.  @xref{vCont
35606packet}.
35607
35608Reply:
35609@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35610
35611@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35612@anchor{step with signal packet}
35613@cindex @samp{S} packet
35614Step with signal.  This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35615requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35616
35617This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support.  @xref{vCont
35618packet}.
35619
35620Reply:
35621@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35622
35623@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35624@cindex @samp{t} packet
35625Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35626@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35627There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35628
35629@item T @var{thread-id}
35630@cindex @samp{T} packet
35631Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive.  @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35632
35633Reply:
35634@table @samp
35635@item OK
35636thread is still alive
35637@item E @var{NN}
35638thread is dead
35639@end table
35640
35641@item v
35642Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35643up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35644
35645@item vAttach;@var{pid}
35646@cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35647Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35648The process ID is a
35649hexadecimal integer identifying the process.  In all-stop mode, all
35650threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35651attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35652
35653@c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35654@c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process.  After
35655@c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35656@c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35657@c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35658@c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35659@c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35660@c stopping or restarting threads.
35661
35662This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35663
35664Reply:
35665@table @samp
35666@item E @var{nn}
35667for an error
35668@item @r{Any stop packet}
35669for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35670@item OK
35671for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35672@end table
35673
35674@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35675@cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35676@anchor{vCont packet}
35677Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35678
35679For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35680@var{thread-id} is applied.  Threads that don't match any action
35681remain in their current state.  Thread IDs are specified using the
35682syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.  If multiprocess
35683extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35684can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35685@samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}.  An action with no
35686@var{thread-id} matches all threads.  Specifying no actions is an
35687error.
35688
35689Currently supported actions are:
35690
35691@table @samp
35692@item c
35693Continue.
35694@item C @var{sig}
35695Continue with signal @var{sig}.  The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35696@item s
35697Step.
35698@item S @var{sig}
35699Step with signal @var{sig}.  The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35700@item t
35701Stop.
35702@item r @var{start},@var{end}
35703Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35704addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35705The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35706of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35707a breakpoint.  @xref{range stepping}.
35708
35709If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35710becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action.  In other words,
35711single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35712jumps to @var{start}).
35713
35714(A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35715the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35716in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35717
35718@end table
35719
35720The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35721@samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35722not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35723
35724The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35725(@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35726A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35727When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35728the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35729signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35730as an implementation detail.
35731
35732The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
35733@samp{r} actions for threads that are already running.  Conversely,
35734the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
35735stopped.
35736
35737@emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
35738@value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
35739the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
35740
35741The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35742multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
35743
35744Reply:
35745@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35746
35747@item vCont?
35748@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35749Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35750
35751Reply:
35752@table @samp
35753@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35754The @samp{vCont} packet is supported.  Each @var{action} is a supported
35755command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35756@item @w{}
35757The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35758@end table
35759
35760@anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35761@item vCtrlC
35762@cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35763Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35764terminal.  This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35765(@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35766while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35767@xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35768variant.
35769
35770Reply:
35771@table @samp
35772@item E @var{nn}
35773for an error
35774@item OK
35775for success
35776@end table
35777
35778@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35779@cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35780Perform a file operation on the target system.  For details,
35781see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35782
35783@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35784@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35785Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35786@var{addr}.  The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35787its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35788flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35789Format}).  @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35790together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35791stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35792packet is received.
35793
35794Reply:
35795@table @samp
35796@item OK
35797for success
35798@item E @var{NN}
35799for an error
35800@end table
35801
35802@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35803@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35804Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}.  The data
35805is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35806packet (@pxref{Binary Data}).  The memory ranges specified by
35807@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35808not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35809(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35810have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35811@samp{vFlashWrite} packets).  If a packet writes to an address that was
35812neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35813target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35814
35815
35816Reply:
35817@table @samp
35818@item OK
35819for success
35820@item E.memtype
35821for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35822@item E @var{NN}
35823for an error
35824@end table
35825
35826@item vFlashDone
35827@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35828Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35829The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35830@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35831@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received.  The contents of the affected
35832regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35833request is completed.
35834
35835@item vKill;@var{pid}
35836@cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35837@anchor{vKill packet}
35838Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35839hexadecimal integer identifying the process.  This packet is used in
35840preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35841supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35842
35843Reply:
35844@table @samp
35845@item E @var{nn}
35846for an error
35847@item OK
35848for success
35849@end table
35850
35851@item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35852@cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35853Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35854command line.  The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings.  If
35855@var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35856(e.g.@: the last program run).  The program is created in the stopped
35857state.
35858
35859@c FIXME:  What about non-stop mode?
35860
35861This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35862
35863Reply:
35864@table @samp
35865@item E @var{nn}
35866for an error
35867@item @r{Any stop packet}
35868for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35869@end table
35870
35871@item vStopped
35872@cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35873@xref{Notification Packets}.
35874
35875@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35876@anchor{X packet}
35877@cindex @samp{X} packet
35878Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35879Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35880units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35881@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35882
35883Reply:
35884@table @samp
35885@item OK
35886for success
35887@item E @var{NN}
35888for an error
35889@end table
35890
35891@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35892@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35893@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35894@cindex @samp{z} packet
35895@cindex @samp{Z} packets
35896Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35897watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35898
35899Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35900separately.
35901
35902@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35903for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}.  A
35904remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35905@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair.  To
35906avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35907be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35908
35909@item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35910@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35911@cindex @samp{z0} packet
35912@cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35913Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
35914@var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35915
35916A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35917@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction.  The
35918@var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
35919breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted.  E.g., the @sc{arm} and
35920@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint.  Some
35921architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
35922(@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
35923architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
35924@var{kind} is hex-encoded.  @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
35925conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
35926the target's side.  These are the conditions that should be taken into
35927consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
35928reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35929
35930See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35931for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35932
35933The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35934concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35935
35936@table @samp
35937
35938@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35939@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35940actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35941
35942@end table
35943
35944The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35945run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35946The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35947nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35948continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35949Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35950separators.  Each expression has the following form:
35951
35952@table @samp
35953
35954@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35955@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35956actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35957
35958@end table
35959
35960@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35961code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35962overlays).  The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35963target, is not defined.}
35964
35965Reply:
35966@table @samp
35967@item OK
35968success
35969@item @w{}
35970not supported
35971@item E @var{NN}
35972for an error
35973@end table
35974
35975@item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35976@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35977@cindex @samp{z1} packet
35978@cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35979Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35980address @var{addr}.
35981
35982A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35983dependent on being able to modify the target's memory.  The
35984@var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
35985same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35986
35987@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35988movement.}
35989
35990Reply:
35991@table @samp
35992@item OK
35993success
35994@item @w{}
35995not supported
35996@item E @var{NN}
35997for an error
35998@end table
35999
36000@item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36001@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36002@cindex @samp{z2} packet
36003@cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36004Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36005The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36006
36007Reply:
36008@table @samp
36009@item OK
36010success
36011@item @w{}
36012not supported
36013@item E @var{NN}
36014for an error
36015@end table
36016
36017@item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36018@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36019@cindex @samp{z3} packet
36020@cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36021Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36022The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36023
36024Reply:
36025@table @samp
36026@item OK
36027success
36028@item @w{}
36029not supported
36030@item E @var{NN}
36031for an error
36032@end table
36033
36034@item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36035@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36036@cindex @samp{z4} packet
36037@cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36038Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36039The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36040
36041Reply:
36042@table @samp
36043@item OK
36044success
36045@item @w{}
36046not supported
36047@item E @var{NN}
36048for an error
36049@end table
36050
36051@end table
36052
36053@node Stop Reply Packets
36054@section Stop Reply Packets
36055@cindex stop reply packets
36056
36057The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36058@samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36059receive any of the below as a reply.  Except for @samp{?}
36060and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36061when the target halts.  In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36062number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36063@value{GDBN} source code.
36064
36065In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36066such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36067notification.  @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36068
36069As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36070reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36071syntax.  No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36072components.
36073
36074@table @samp
36075
36076@item S @var{AA}
36077The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36078number).  This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36079@var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36080
36081@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36082@cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36083The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36084number).  This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36085@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36086and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36087round-trip latency.  Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36088this way.  Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36089
36090@itemize @bullet
36091@item
36092If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36093corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value.  The data @var{r} is a
36094series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36095two-digit hex number.
36096
36097@item
36098If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36099the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36100
36101@item
36102If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36103the core on which the stop event was detected.
36104
36105@item
36106If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36107specific event that stopped the target.  The currently defined stop
36108reasons are listed below.  The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36109signal.  At most one stop reason should be present.
36110
36111@item
36112Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36113and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36114future.
36115@end itemize
36116
36117The currently defined stop reasons are:
36118
36119@table @samp
36120@item watch
36121@itemx rwatch
36122@itemx awatch
36123The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36124hex.
36125
36126@item syscall_entry
36127@itemx syscall_return
36128The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36129syscall number, in hex.
36130
36131@cindex shared library events, remote reply
36132@item library
36133The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36134@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36135list of loaded libraries.  The @var{r} part is ignored.
36136
36137@cindex replay log events, remote reply
36138@item replaylog
36139The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36140logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36141beginning when executing backward) of the log.  The value of @var{r}
36142will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}.  @xref{Reverse Execution},
36143for more information.
36144
36145@item swbreak
36146@anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36147The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36148irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36149breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program.  The @var{r}
36150part must be left empty.
36151
36152On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36153breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36154breakpoint address plus an offset.  On such targets, the stub is
36155responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36156address.
36157
36158This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36159did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36160appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
36161remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36162indicating support.
36163
36164This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36165
36166@item hwbreak
36167The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36168The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36169
36170The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36171apply.
36172
36173@cindex fork events, remote reply
36174@item fork
36175The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36176is the thread ID of the new child process.  Refer to
36177@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36178field.  This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36179fork events.
36180
36181This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36182did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36183appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
36184remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36185indicating support.
36186
36187@cindex vfork events, remote reply
36188@item vfork
36189The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36190is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36191@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36192field.  This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36193vfork events.
36194
36195This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36196did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36197appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
36198remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36199indicating support.
36200
36201@cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36202@item vforkdone
36203The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36204has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36205address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36206shared. The @var{r} part is ignored.  This packet is only
36207applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36208
36209This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36210did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36211appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
36212remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36213indicating support.
36214
36215@cindex exec events, remote reply
36216@item exec
36217The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36218is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36219This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36220
36221This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36222did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36223appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
36224remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36225indicating support.
36226
36227@cindex thread create event, remote reply
36228@anchor{thread create event}
36229@item create
36230The packet indicates that the thread was just created.  The new thread
36231is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36232(@pxref{vCont packet}).  This packet should not be sent by default;
36233@value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet.  See
36234also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.  The
36235@var{r} part is ignored.
36236
36237@end table
36238
36239@item W @var{AA}
36240@itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36241The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status.  This is only
36242applicable to certain targets.
36243
36244The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36245exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36246support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36247extensions}.  Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36248hex strings.
36249
36250@item X @var{AA}
36251@itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36252The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36253
36254The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36255terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36256support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36257extensions}.  Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36258hex strings.
36259
36260@anchor{thread exit event}
36261@cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36262@item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36263
36264The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status.  This response
36265should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36266@ref{QThreadEvents} packet.  See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36267@var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36268
36269@item N
36270There are no resumed threads left in the target.  In other words, even
36271though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited.  For
36272example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
362732.  The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36274subsequently exits.  At this point, even though the process is still
36275alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36276executing either.  The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36277that it can stop waiting for stop replies.  This packet should not be
36278sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36279@value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36280@samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The remote stub must
36281also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36282support.
36283
36284@item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36285@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36286written as the program's console output.  This can happen at any time
36287while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36288for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.  This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36289
36290@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36291@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36292be called.  This is just the name of the function.  Translation into the
36293correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36294@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36295system calls.
36296
36297@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36298this very system call.
36299
36300The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36301call a host system call on behalf of the target.  @value{GDBN} replies
36302with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36303reply packet from the target.  The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36304or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued.  @xref{File-I/O Remote
36305Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36306
36307@end table
36308
36309@node General Query Packets
36310@section General Query Packets
36311@cindex remote query requests
36312
36313Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36314packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}.  General
36315query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36316sending information to and from the stub.
36317
36318The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36319indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to.  For example,
36320@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36321definitions with the stub.  These packet names follow some
36322conventions:
36323
36324@itemize @bullet
36325@item
36326The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36327@item
36328Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36329letter.
36330@item
36331The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36332lower case, followed by a period.  For example, packets designed at
36333the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36334foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36335@end itemize
36336
36337The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36338parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36339separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}.  Stubs must be careful to match the
36340full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36341in case two packet names share a common prefix.  New packets should not begin
36342with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36343packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36344for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36345are difficult to upgrade.  The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36346existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36347packet.}.
36348
36349Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36350has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36351explanation of the packet's meaning.  We include spaces in some of the
36352templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax.  No
36353@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36354
36355Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36356
36357@table @samp
36358
36359@item QAgent:1
36360@itemx QAgent:0
36361Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36362delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36363
36364@item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36365@cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36366Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36367target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36368pairs.  Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36369@samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36370@samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36371indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36372indicating that it may.  (The target can then use this to set up its
36373own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36374insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36375
36376@item qC
36377@cindex current thread, remote request
36378@cindex @samp{qC} packet
36379Return the current thread ID.
36380
36381Reply:
36382@table @samp
36383@item QC @var{thread-id}
36384Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36385@ref{thread-id syntax}.
36386@item @r{(anything else)}
36387Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36388@end table
36389
36390@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36391@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36392@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36393@anchor{qCRC packet}
36394Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36395IEEE 802.3.  The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36396significant bit of each byte first.  The initial pattern code
36397@code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36398
36399@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36400files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36401Files}).  However the algorithm is slightly different.  When validating
36402separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36403significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36404detect trailing zeros.
36405
36406Reply:
36407@table @samp
36408@item E @var{NN}
36409An error (such as memory fault)
36410@item C @var{crc32}
36411The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36412@end table
36413
36414@item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36415@cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36416@cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36417Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36418of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36419to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36420debugging experience.  On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36421of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36422processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36423with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36424randomization.
36425
36426This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36427
36428Reply:
36429@table @samp
36430@item OK
36431The request succeeded.
36432
36433@item E @var{nn}
36434An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36435
36436@item @w{}
36437An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36438by the stub.
36439@end table
36440
36441This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36442by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36443This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36444address space randomization.
36445
36446@item qfThreadInfo
36447@itemx qsThreadInfo
36448@cindex list active threads, remote request
36449@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36450@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36451Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS).  Since there
36452may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36453works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36454obtain the entire list of threads.  The first query of the sequence will
36455be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36456sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36457
36458NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36459
36460Reply:
36461@table @samp
36462@item m @var{thread-id}
36463A single thread ID
36464@item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36465a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36466@item l
36467(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36468@end table
36469
36470In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36471more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36472@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36473ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36474with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36475Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36476fields.
36477
36478@emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36479initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36480mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36481message.  Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36482the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36483
36484@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36485@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36486@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36487Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36488by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36489
36490@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36491thread for which to fetch the TLS address.  @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36492
36493@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36494thread local variable.  (This offset is obtained from the debug
36495information associated with the variable.)
36496
36497@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36498load module associated with the thread local storage.  For example,
36499a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36500object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36501Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36502differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36503
36504Reply:
36505@table @samp
36506@item @var{XX}@dots{}
36507Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36508local storage requested.
36509
36510@item E @var{nn}
36511An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36512
36513@item @w{}
36514An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36515@end table
36516
36517@item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36518@cindex get thread information block address
36519@cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36520Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36521
36522@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36523
36524Reply:
36525@table @samp
36526@item @var{XX}@dots{}
36527Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36528thread information block.
36529
36530@item E @var{nn}
36531An error occured.  This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36532address could not be retrieved.
36533
36534@item @w{}
36535An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36536@end table
36537
36538@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36539Obtain thread information from RTOS.  Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36540digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36541subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36542number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36543(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36544returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36545
36546Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36547
36548Reply:
36549@table @samp
36550@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36551Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36552returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36553and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36554digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36555is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36556digits), from the target.  See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36557@end table
36558
36559@item qOffsets
36560@cindex section offsets, remote request
36561@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36562Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36563image.
36564
36565Reply:
36566@table @samp
36567@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36568Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36569Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36570If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36571@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36572segments by the supplied offsets.
36573
36574@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36575@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36576to the @code{Bss} section.}
36577
36578@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36579Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36580contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}.  If
36581@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36582conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36583@var{yyy}.  @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36584does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36585as many segments as mentioned in the reply.  Extra segments are
36586kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36587@end table
36588
36589@item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36590@cindex thread information, remote request
36591@cindex @samp{qP} packet
36592Returns information on @var{thread-id}.  Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36593encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36594(@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36595
36596Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36597(see below).
36598
36599Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36600
36601@item QNonStop:1
36602@itemx QNonStop:0
36603@cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36604@cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36605@anchor{QNonStop}
36606Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36607@xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36608
36609Reply:
36610@table @samp
36611@item OK
36612The request succeeded.
36613
36614@item E @var{nn}
36615An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36616
36617@item @w{}
36618An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36619the stub.
36620@end table
36621
36622This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36623by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36624Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36625@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36626
36627@item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36628@itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36629@cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36630@cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36631@anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36632Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36633catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36634
36635For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36636in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}.  If no syscall @var{sysno}
36637is listed, every system call should be reported.
36638
36639Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36640still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36641@code{catch syscall} commands.  However, it is more efficient to only
36642report the requested syscalls.
36643
36644Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36645@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36646
36647If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36648kept for the new process too.  On targets where exec may affect syscall
36649numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36650client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36651
36652Reply:
36653@table @samp
36654@item OK
36655The request succeeded.
36656
36657@item E @var{nn}
36658An error occurred.  @var{nn} are hex digits.
36659
36660@item @w{}
36661An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36662the stub.
36663@end table
36664
36665Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36666command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36667This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36668by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36669
36670@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36671@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36672@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36673@anchor{QPassSignals}
36674Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36675Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36676(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}).  Each @var{signal} list item should be
36677strictly greater than the previous item.  These signals do not need to stop
36678the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}.  All other signals should be
36679reported to @value{GDBN}.  Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36680combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36681new list.  This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36682@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36683
36684Reply:
36685@table @samp
36686@item OK
36687The request succeeded.
36688
36689@item E @var{nn}
36690An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36691
36692@item @w{}
36693An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36694the stub.
36695@end table
36696
36697Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36698command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36699This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36700by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36701
36702@item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36703@cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36704@cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36705@anchor{QProgramSignals}
36706Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36707Others should be silently discarded.
36708
36709In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36710signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement.  One
36711example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36712stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36713@value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36714by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36715signals.
36716
36717This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36718resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36719
36720Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36721(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}).  Each @var{signal} list item should be
36722strictly greater than the previous item.  Multiple
36723@samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36724@samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36725
36726Reply:
36727@table @samp
36728@item OK
36729The request succeeded.
36730
36731@item E @var{nn}
36732An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36733
36734@item @w{}
36735An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36736by the stub.
36737@end table
36738
36739Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36740command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36741This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36742by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36743
36744@anchor{QThreadEvents}
36745@item QThreadEvents:1
36746@itemx QThreadEvents:0
36747@cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36748@cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36749
36750Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36751reporting of thread create and exit events.  @xref{thread create
36752event}, for the reply specifications.  For example, this is used in
36753non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36754synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies.  Without
36755exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36756forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36757same thread.  @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36758stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36759its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36760
36761Reply:
36762@table @samp
36763@item OK
36764The request succeeded.
36765
36766@item E @var{nn}
36767An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36768
36769@item @w{}
36770An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36771the stub.
36772@end table
36773
36774Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36775command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36776
36777@item qRcmd,@var{command}
36778@cindex execute remote command, remote request
36779@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36780@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36781execution.  Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36782string.  Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36783with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36784packets.  @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36785stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36786
36787Reply:
36788@table @samp
36789@item OK
36790A command response with no output.
36791@item @var{OUTPUT}
36792A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36793@item E @var{NN}
36794Indicate a badly formed request.
36795@item @w{}
36796An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36797@end table
36798
36799(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36800command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36801conventions above.  Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36802packets.)
36803
36804@item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36805@cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36806@ifnotinfo
36807@cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36808@end ifnotinfo
36809@cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36810@anchor{qSearch memory}
36811Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36812Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36813@var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36814
36815Reply:
36816@table @samp
36817@item 0
36818The pattern was not found.
36819@item 1,address
36820The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36821@item E @var{NN}
36822A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36823@item @w{}
36824An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36825@end table
36826
36827@item QStartNoAckMode
36828@cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36829@anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36830Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36831protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36832
36833Reply:
36834@table @samp
36835@item OK
36836The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36837@value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36838but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36839@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36840@item @w{}
36841An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36842@end table
36843
36844@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36845@cindex supported packets, remote query
36846@cindex features of the remote protocol
36847@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36848@anchor{qSupported}
36849Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36850query the stub for features it supports.  This packet allows
36851@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36852features.  @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36853at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36854packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36855high-latency links.  Some features may enable behavior which must not
36856be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36857stubs.  Other features may describe packets which could be
36858automatically probed for, but are not.  These features must be
36859reported before @value{GDBN} will use them.  This ``default
36860unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36861helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36862versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36863
36864Reply:
36865@table @samp
36866@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36867The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36868depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36869possible forms).
36870@item @w{}
36871An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36872or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36873@end table
36874
36875The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36876@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36877are:
36878
36879@table @samp
36880@item @var{name}=@var{value}
36881The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36882with the specified @var{value}.  The format of @var{value} depends
36883on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36884@item @var{name}+
36885The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36886need an associated value.
36887@item @var{name}-
36888The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36889@item @var{name}?
36890The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36891@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36892needed.  This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36893but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36894@end table
36895
36896Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36897supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36898request.  This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36899state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36900a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36901
36902The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36903are defined:
36904
36905@table @samp
36906@item multiprocess
36907This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36908extensions to the remote protocol.  @value{GDBN} does not use such
36909extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36910including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36911@xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36912
36913@item xmlRegisters
36914This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36915description.  If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36916specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36917description.
36918
36919@item qRelocInsn
36920This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36921@samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36922instruction reply packet}).
36923
36924@item swbreak
36925This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36926reason in stop replies.  @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36927
36928@item hwbreak
36929This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36930reason in stop replies.  @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36931
36932@item fork-events
36933This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36934extensions to the remote protocol.  @value{GDBN} does not use such
36935extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36936including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36937
36938@item vfork-events
36939This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36940extensions to the remote protocol.  @value{GDBN} does not use such
36941extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36942including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36943
36944@item exec-events
36945This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36946extensions to the remote protocol.  @value{GDBN} does not use such
36947extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36948including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36949
36950@item vContSupported
36951This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36952supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36953@end table
36954
36955Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36956@var{gdbfeature}.  Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36957packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36958versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses).  Additional values
36959for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36960advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36961improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36962an example of such a feature.  The stub's reply should be independent
36963of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36964describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36965all the features it supports.
36966
36967Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36968responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36969
36970Some features are flags.  A stub which supports a flag feature
36971should respond with a @samp{+} form response.  Other features
36972require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36973form response.
36974
36975Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36976@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36977in the @samp{qSupported} response.  The default values are fixed; a
36978stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36979
36980Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36981mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36982architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36983about the underlying target in advance.  This is especially common in
36984stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36985
36986These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36987
36988@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36989@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36990@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36991@item Feature Name
36992@tab Value Required
36993@tab Default
36994@tab Probe Allowed
36995
36996@item @samp{PacketSize}
36997@tab Yes
36998@tab @samp{-}
36999@tab No
37000
37001@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37002@tab No
37003@tab @samp{-}
37004@tab Yes
37005
37006@item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37007@tab No
37008@tab @samp{-}
37009@tab Yes
37010
37011@item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37012@tab No
37013@tab @samp{-}
37014@tab Yes
37015
37016@item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37017@tab No
37018@tab @samp{-}
37019@tab Yes
37020
37021@item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37022@tab No
37023@tab @samp{-}
37024@tab Yes
37025
37026@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37027@tab No
37028@tab @samp{-}
37029@tab Yes
37030
37031@item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37032@tab No
37033@tab @samp{-}
37034@tab Yes
37035
37036@item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37037@tab No
37038@tab @samp{-}
37039@tab No
37040
37041@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37042@tab No
37043@tab @samp{-}
37044@tab Yes
37045
37046@item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37047@tab No
37048@tab @samp{-}
37049@tab Yes
37050
37051@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37052@tab No
37053@tab @samp{-}
37054@tab Yes
37055
37056@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37057@tab No
37058@tab @samp{-}
37059@tab Yes
37060
37061@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37062@tab No
37063@tab @samp{-}
37064@tab Yes
37065
37066@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37067@tab No
37068@tab @samp{-}
37069@tab Yes
37070
37071@item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37072@tab No
37073@tab @samp{-}
37074@tab Yes
37075
37076@item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37077@tab No
37078@tab @samp{-}
37079@tab Yes
37080
37081@item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37082@tab No
37083@tab @samp{-}
37084@tab Yes
37085
37086@item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37087@tab No
37088@tab @samp{-}
37089@tab Yes
37090
37091@item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37092@tab Yes
37093@tab @samp{-}
37094@tab Yes
37095
37096@item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37097@tab Yes
37098@tab @samp{-}
37099@tab Yes
37100
37101@item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37102@tab Yes
37103@tab @samp{-}
37104@tab Yes
37105
37106@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37107@tab Yes
37108@tab @samp{-}
37109@tab Yes
37110
37111@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37112@tab Yes
37113@tab @samp{-}
37114@tab Yes
37115
37116@item @samp{QNonStop}
37117@tab No
37118@tab @samp{-}
37119@tab Yes
37120
37121@item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37122@tab No
37123@tab @samp{-}
37124@tab Yes
37125
37126@item @samp{QPassSignals}
37127@tab No
37128@tab @samp{-}
37129@tab Yes
37130
37131@item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37132@tab No
37133@tab @samp{-}
37134@tab Yes
37135
37136@item @samp{multiprocess}
37137@tab No
37138@tab @samp{-}
37139@tab No
37140
37141@item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37142@tab No
37143@tab @samp{-}
37144@tab No
37145
37146@item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37147@tab No
37148@tab @samp{-}
37149@tab No
37150
37151@item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37152@tab No
37153@tab @samp{-}
37154@tab No
37155
37156@item @samp{ReverseStep}
37157@tab No
37158@tab @samp{-}
37159@tab No
37160
37161@item @samp{TracepointSource}
37162@tab No
37163@tab @samp{-}
37164@tab No
37165
37166@item @samp{QAgent}
37167@tab No
37168@tab @samp{-}
37169@tab No
37170
37171@item @samp{QAllow}
37172@tab No
37173@tab @samp{-}
37174@tab No
37175
37176@item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37177@tab No
37178@tab @samp{-}
37179@tab No
37180
37181@item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37182@tab No
37183@tab @samp{-}
37184@tab No
37185
37186@item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37187@tab No
37188@tab @samp{-}
37189@tab No
37190
37191@item @samp{tracenz}
37192@tab No
37193@tab @samp{-}
37194@tab No
37195
37196@item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37197@tab No
37198@tab @samp{-}
37199@tab No
37200
37201@item @samp{swbreak}
37202@tab No
37203@tab @samp{-}
37204@tab No
37205
37206@item @samp{hwbreak}
37207@tab No
37208@tab @samp{-}
37209@tab No
37210
37211@item @samp{fork-events}
37212@tab No
37213@tab @samp{-}
37214@tab No
37215
37216@item @samp{vfork-events}
37217@tab No
37218@tab @samp{-}
37219@tab No
37220
37221@item @samp{exec-events}
37222@tab No
37223@tab @samp{-}
37224@tab No
37225
37226@item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37227@tab No
37228@tab @samp{-}
37229@tab No
37230
37231@item @samp{no-resumed}
37232@tab No
37233@tab @samp{-}
37234@tab No
37235
37236@end multitable
37237
37238These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37239
37240@table @samp
37241@cindex packet size, remote protocol
37242@item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37243The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37244length.  @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37245transfers, and will never send larger packets.  This is a limit on the
37246data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37247There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37248stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37249byte in its buffer for the NUL.  If this stub feature is not supported,
37250@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37251
37252@item qXfer:auxv:read
37253The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37254(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37255
37256@item qXfer:btrace:read
37257The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37258packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37259
37260@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37261The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37262packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37263
37264@item qXfer:exec-file:read
37265The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37266(@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37267
37268@item qXfer:features:read
37269The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37270(@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37271
37272@item qXfer:libraries:read
37273The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37274(@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37275
37276@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37277The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37278(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37279
37280@item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37281The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37282@samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37283(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37284
37285@item qXfer:memory-map:read
37286The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37287(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37288
37289@item qXfer:sdata:read
37290The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37291(@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37292
37293@item qXfer:spu:read
37294The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37295(@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37296
37297@item qXfer:spu:write
37298The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37299(@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37300
37301@item qXfer:siginfo:read
37302The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37303(@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37304
37305@item qXfer:siginfo:write
37306The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37307(@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37308
37309@item qXfer:threads:read
37310The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37311(@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37312
37313@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37314The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37315packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37316
37317@item qXfer:uib:read
37318The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37319packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37320
37321@item qXfer:fdpic:read
37322The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37323packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37324
37325@item QNonStop
37326The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37327(@pxref{QNonStop}).
37328
37329@item QCatchSyscalls
37330The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37331(@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37332
37333@item QPassSignals
37334The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37335(@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37336
37337@item QStartNoAckMode
37338The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37339prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode.  @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37340
37341@item multiprocess
37342@anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37343@cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37344The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37345protocol syntax.  The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37346thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37347add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37348replies.  Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37349syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37350debugging of more than one process at a time.  The stub must not use
37351multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37352indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37353
37354@item qXfer:osdata:read
37355The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37356((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37357
37358@item ConditionalBreakpoints
37359The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37360defined for breakpoints.  The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37361when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37362
37363@item ConditionalTracepoints
37364The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37365for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37366
37367@item ReverseContinue
37368The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37369(@pxref{bc}).
37370
37371@item ReverseStep
37372The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37373(@pxref{bs}).
37374
37375@item TracepointSource
37376The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37377the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37378
37379@item QAgent
37380The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37381
37382@item QAllow
37383The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37384
37385@item QDisableRandomization
37386The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37387
37388@item StaticTracepoint
37389@cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37390The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37391
37392@item InstallInTrace
37393@anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37394The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37395
37396@item EnableDisableTracepoints
37397The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37398@samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37399to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37400
37401@item QTBuffer:size
37402The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37403packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37404
37405@item tracenz
37406@cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37407The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37408See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37409
37410@item BreakpointCommands
37411@cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37412The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37413rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37414
37415@item Qbtrace:off
37416The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37417
37418@item Qbtrace:bts
37419The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37420
37421@item Qbtrace:pt
37422The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37423
37424@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37425The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37426
37427@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37428The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37429
37430@item swbreak
37431The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37432breakpoints.
37433
37434@item hwbreak
37435The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37436breakpoints.
37437
37438@item fork-events
37439The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37440
37441@item vfork-events
37442The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37443and vforkdone events.
37444
37445@item exec-events
37446The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37447
37448@item vContSupported
37449The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37450@samp{vCont?} packet.
37451
37452@item QThreadEvents
37453The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37454
37455@item no-resumed
37456The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37457
37458@end table
37459
37460@item qSymbol::
37461@cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37462@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37463Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37464requests.  Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37465
37466Reply:
37467@table @samp
37468@item OK
37469The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37470@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37471The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37472@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37473@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37474below.
37475@end table
37476
37477@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37478Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37479
37480@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37481target has previously requested.
37482
37483@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.  If
37484@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37485will be empty.
37486
37487Reply:
37488@table @samp
37489@item OK
37490The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37491@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37492The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37493encoded).  @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37494(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37495@end table
37496
37497@item qTBuffer
37498@itemx QTBuffer
37499@itemx QTDisconnected
37500@itemx QTDP
37501@itemx QTDPsrc
37502@itemx QTDV
37503@itemx qTfP
37504@itemx qTfV
37505@itemx QTFrame
37506@itemx qTMinFTPILen
37507
37508@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37509
37510@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37511@cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37512@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37513Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37514attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37515for the forms of @var{thread-id}.  This
37516string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37517for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.  The string is
37518displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display.  Some
37519examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37520@samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37521
37522Reply:
37523@table @samp
37524@item @var{XX}@dots{}
37525Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37526comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37527the thread's attributes.
37528@end table
37529
37530(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37531the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37532conventions above.  Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37533packets.)
37534
37535@item QTNotes
37536@itemx qTP
37537@itemx QTSave
37538@itemx qTsP
37539@itemx qTsV
37540@itemx QTStart
37541@itemx QTStop
37542@itemx QTEnable
37543@itemx QTDisable
37544@itemx QTinit
37545@itemx QTro
37546@itemx qTStatus
37547@itemx qTV
37548@itemx qTfSTM
37549@itemx qTsSTM
37550@itemx qTSTMat
37551@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37552
37553@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37554@cindex read special object, remote request
37555@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37556@anchor{qXfer read}
37557Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37558identified by the keyword @var{object}.  Request @var{length} bytes
37559starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data.  The content and
37560encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37561additional details about what data to access.
37562
37563Reply:
37564@table @samp
37565@item m @var{data}
37566Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37567target.  There may be more data at a higher address (although
37568it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37569block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37570It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37571request.
37572
37573@item l @var{data}
37574Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37575There is no more data to be read.  It is possible for @var{data} to
37576have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37577
37578@item l
37579The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37580There is no more data to be read.
37581
37582@item E00
37583The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37584
37585@item E @var{nn}
37586The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37587The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37588
37589@item @w{}
37590An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37591the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37592@end table
37593
37594Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far.  All the
37595@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37596formats, listed above.
37597
37598@table @samp
37599@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37600@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37601Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}.  @xref{OS Information,
37602auxiliary vector}.  Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37603
37604This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37605by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37606
37607@item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37608@anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37609
37610Return a description of the current branch trace.
37611@xref{Branch Trace Format}.  The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37612packet may have one of the following values:
37613
37614@table @code
37615@item all
37616Returns all available branch trace.
37617
37618@item new
37619Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37620the last read request.
37621
37622@item delta
37623Returns the new branch trace since the last read request.  Adds a new
37624block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37625location of the first branch in the trace buffer.  This extra block is
37626used to stitch traces together.
37627
37628If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37629@end table
37630
37631This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37632by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37633
37634@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37635@anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37636
37637Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37638@xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37639
37640This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37641by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37642
37643@item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37644@anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37645Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37646a process running on the remote system.  The annex specifies the
37647numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37648number.  If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37649filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37650
37651This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37652by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37653
37654@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37655@anchor{qXfer target description read}
37656Access the @dfn{target description}.  @xref{Target Descriptions}.  The
37657annex specifies which XML document to access.  The main description is
37658always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37659
37660This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37661by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37662
37663@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37664@anchor{qXfer library list read}
37665Access the target's list of loaded libraries.  @xref{Library List Format}.
37666The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37667(@pxref{qXfer read}).
37668
37669Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37670not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37671the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37672
37673This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37674by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37675
37676@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37677@anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37678Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37679platform.  @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}.  The annex part
37680of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37681stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37682by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37683(@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37684
37685This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37686@value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37687
37688This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37689by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37690
37691If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37692packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37693contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37694arguments.  The currently supported arguments are:
37695
37696@table @code
37697@item start=@var{address}
37698A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37699link_map} to start reading the library list from.  If unset or zero
37700then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37701chosen as the starting point.
37702
37703@item prev=@var{address}
37704A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37705link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37706specified by the @samp{start} argument.  If unset or zero then
37707the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37708exists prior to the starting point.
37709
37710@end table
37711
37712Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37713ignored.
37714
37715@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37716@anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37717Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}.  @xref{Memory Map Format}.  The
37718annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37719(@pxref{qXfer read}).
37720
37721This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37722by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37723
37724@item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37725@anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37726
37727Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37728information.  The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37729be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).  @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37730Action Lists}.
37731
37732This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37733by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37734(@pxref{qSupported}).
37735
37736@item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37737@anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37738Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37739system.  The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37740empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37741
37742This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37743by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37744(@pxref{qSupported}).
37745
37746@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37747@anchor{qXfer spu read}
37748Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system.  The
37749annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37750@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37751in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37752in that context to be accessed.
37753
37754This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37755by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37756(@pxref{qSupported}).
37757
37758@item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37759@anchor{qXfer threads read}
37760Access the list of threads on target.  @xref{Thread List Format}.  The
37761annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37762(@pxref{qXfer read}).
37763
37764This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37765by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37766
37767@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37768@anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37769
37770Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37771@xref{Traceframe Info Format}.  The annex part of the generic
37772@samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37773
37774This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37775by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37776
37777@item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37778@anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37779
37780Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}.  This packet is used
37781on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37782
37783This packet is not probed by default.
37784
37785@item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37786@anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37787Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system.  The
37788annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37789executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37790
37791This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37792by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37793
37794@item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37795@anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37796Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37797@xref{Operating System Information}.
37798
37799@end table
37800
37801@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37802@cindex write data into object, remote request
37803@anchor{qXfer write}
37804Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37805identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37806into the data.  The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37807written is given by @var{data}@dots{}.  The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37808is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37809to access.
37810
37811Reply:
37812@table @samp
37813@item @var{nn}
37814@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37815This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37816
37817@item E00
37818The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37819
37820@item E @var{nn}
37821The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37822The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37823
37824@item @w{}
37825An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37826recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37827@end table
37828
37829Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far.  All the
37830@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37831formats, listed above.
37832
37833@table @samp
37834@item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37835@anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37836Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37837The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37838empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37839
37840This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37841by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37842(@pxref{qSupported}).
37843
37844@item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37845@anchor{qXfer spu write}
37846Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system.  The
37847annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37848@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37849in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37850in that context to be accessed.
37851
37852This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37853by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37854@end table
37855
37856@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37857Requests of this form may be added in the future.  When a stub does
37858not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37859@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37860must respond with an empty packet.
37861
37862@item qAttached:@var{pid}
37863@cindex query attached, remote request
37864@cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37865Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37866existing process or created a new process.  When the multiprocess
37867protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37868@var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37869process.  Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37870the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37871
37872This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37873should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37874the @code{quit} command.
37875
37876Reply:
37877@table @samp
37878@item 1
37879The remote server attached to an existing process.
37880@item 0
37881The remote server created a new process.
37882@item E @var{NN}
37883A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37884@end table
37885
37886@item Qbtrace:bts
37887Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37888
37889Reply:
37890@table @samp
37891@item OK
37892Branch tracing has been enabled.
37893@item E.errtext
37894A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37895@end table
37896
37897@item Qbtrace:pt
37898Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37899
37900Reply:
37901@table @samp
37902@item OK
37903Branch tracing has been enabled.
37904@item E.errtext
37905A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37906@end table
37907
37908@item Qbtrace:off
37909Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37910
37911Reply:
37912@table @samp
37913@item OK
37914Branch tracing has been disabled.
37915@item E.errtext
37916A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37917@end table
37918
37919@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37920Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37921btrace recording method in bts format.
37922
37923Reply:
37924@table @samp
37925@item OK
37926The ring buffer size has been set.
37927@item E.errtext
37928A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37929@end table
37930
37931@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37932Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37933btrace recording method in pt format.
37934
37935Reply:
37936@table @samp
37937@item OK
37938The ring buffer size has been set.
37939@item E.errtext
37940A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37941@end table
37942
37943@end table
37944
37945@node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37946@section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37947
37948This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37949target architectures.  Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37950details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37951
37952@menu
37953* ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37954* MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37955@end menu
37956
37957@node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37958@subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37959
37960@menu
37961* ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37962@end menu
37963
37964@node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37965@subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37966@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37967
37968These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37969
37970@table @r
37971
37972@item 2
3797316-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37974
37975@item 3
3797632-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37977
37978@item 4
3797932-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37980
37981@end table
37982
37983@node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37984@subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37985
37986@menu
37987* MIPS Register packet Format::
37988* MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37989@end menu
37990
37991@node MIPS Register packet Format
37992@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37993@cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37994
37995The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37996In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37997sixty-four bits.  Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37998to fill the space allocated.  Register bytes are transferred in target
37999byte order.  The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38000most-significant -- least-significant.
38001
38002@table @r
38003
38004@item MIPS32
38005All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
3800632 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38007registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38008
38009@item MIPS64
38010All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38011thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}).  The ordering is the same
38012as @code{MIPS32}.
38013
38014@end table
38015
38016@node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38017@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38018@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38019
38020These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38021
38022@table @r
38023
38024@item 2
3802516-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38026
38027@item 3
3802816-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38029
38030@item 4
3803132-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38032
38033@item 5
3803432-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38035
38036@end table
38037
38038@node Tracepoint Packets
38039@section Tracepoint Packets
38040@cindex tracepoint packets
38041@cindex packets, tracepoint
38042
38043Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38044tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38045
38046@table @samp
38047
38048@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38049@cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38050Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}.  If @var{ena}
38051is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38052the tracepoint is disabled.  The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38053count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count.  If an @samp{F} is present,
38054then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38055the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38056for the tracepoint.  If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38057tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38058by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38059encodings as described below.  If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38060further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38061actions.
38062
38063Replies:
38064@table @samp
38065@item OK
38066The packet was understood and carried out.
38067@item qRelocInsn
38068@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38069@item  @w{}
38070The packet was not recognized.
38071@end table
38072
38073@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38074Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit.  The @var{n} and
38075@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38076this tracepoint.  This packet may only be sent immediately after
38077another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}.  If the
38078trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38079specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38080
38081In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38082can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}.  If such a packet
38083is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38084actions.  Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38085taken when the tracepoint is first hit.  If no action packet has an
38086@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38087tracepoint actions.
38088
38089The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38090actions, concatenated without separators.  Each action has one of the
38091following forms:
38092
38093@table @samp
38094
38095@item R @var{mask}
38096Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38097a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38098@var{i} should be collected.  (The least significant bit is numbered
38099zero.)  Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38100not fit in a 32-bit word.
38101
38102@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38103Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38104number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}.  If @var{basereg} is
38105@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38106address of the lowest byte to collect.  The @var{basereg},
38107@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38108values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38109
38110@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38111Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38112it directs.  The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38113@ref{Agent Expressions}.  Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38114two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38115in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38116packet).
38117
38118@end table
38119
38120Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38121packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38122length (400 bytes, for many stubs).  There may be only one @samp{R}
38123action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38124actions.  Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38125must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action.  (The
38126``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38127separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38128
38129Replies:
38130@table @samp
38131@item OK
38132The packet was understood and carried out.
38133@item qRelocInsn
38134@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38135@item  @w{}
38136The packet was not recognized.
38137@end table
38138
38139@item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38140@cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38141Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38142This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38143originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run.  The @var{type}
38144is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38145tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38146@var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38147
38148@var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38149string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38150This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38151fit in a single packet.
38152@c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38153@c tracepoint descriptions section.
38154
38155The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38156@samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38157@value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38158list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38159
38160The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38161report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38162query packets.
38163
38164Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38165if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38166Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38167much easier to use.  Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38168tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38169the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38170could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38171be found.
38172
38173@item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38174@cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38175@cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38176Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38177value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer.  Both @var{n}
38178and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38179the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38180target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38181mentioned in expressions.  The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38182if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38183@value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38184@samp{qTsV} packet had it set.  The contents of @var{name} is the
38185hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38186variable.
38187
38188@item QTFrame:@var{n}
38189@cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38190Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38191register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38192request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38193
38194A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38195requested frame.  The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38196without separators, describing the frame we selected.  Each part has
38197one of the following forms:
38198
38199@table @samp
38200@item F @var{f}
38201The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38202@var{f} is a hexadecimal number.  If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38203was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38204
38205@item T @var{t}
38206The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38207@var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38208
38209@end table
38210
38211@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38212Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38213currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38214@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38215
38216@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38217Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38218currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38219is a hexadecimal number.
38220
38221@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38222Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38223currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38224and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38225numbers.
38226
38227@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38228Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38229frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38230
38231@item qTMinFTPILen
38232@cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38233This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38234tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed.  For instance, on
38235the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38236it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38237the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38238system.  So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38239arrange for that.
38240
38241Replies:
38242
38243@table @samp
38244@item 0
38245The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38246@item @var{length}
38247The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38248is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1.  A reply
38249of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38250regardless of size.
38251@item E
38252An error has occurred.
38253@item @w{}
38254An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38255@end table
38256
38257@item QTStart
38258@cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38259Begin the tracepoint experiment.  Begin collecting data from
38260tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer.  This packet supports the
38261@samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38262instruction reply packet}).
38263
38264@item QTStop
38265@cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38266End the tracepoint experiment.  Stop collecting trace frames.
38267
38268@item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38269@anchor{QTEnable}
38270@cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38271Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38272experiment.  If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38273of data from it will resume.
38274
38275@item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38276@anchor{QTDisable}
38277@cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38278Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38279experiment.  No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38280@samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38281
38282@item QTinit
38283@cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38284Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38285
38286@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38287@cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38288Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''.  The stub
38289will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38290if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38291
38292@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38293containing program code.  Since these areas never change, they should
38294still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38295there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38296
38297@item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38298@cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38299Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38300disconnects from the target.  A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38301continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38302@value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38303
38304@item qTStatus
38305@cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38306Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38307
38308The reply has the form:
38309
38310@table @samp
38311
38312@item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38313@var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38314running, or @code{0} if not.  It is followed by semicolon-separated
38315optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38316
38317@end table
38318
38319If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38320explanations as one of the optional fields:
38321
38322@table @samp
38323
38324@item tnotrun:0
38325No trace has been run yet.
38326
38327@item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38328The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.  The optional
38329@var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38330stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38331stopped manually).  It is hex-encoded.
38332
38333@item tfull:0
38334The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38335
38336@item tdisconnected:0
38337The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38338
38339@item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38340The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38341
38342@item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38343The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error.  The
38344string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38345(for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38346is hex encoded.
38347
38348@item tunknown:0
38349The trace stopped for some other reason.
38350
38351@end table
38352
38353Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38354Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38355the progress of a trace run.  If a trace has stopped, and these
38356numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38357trace.
38358
38359@table @samp
38360
38361@item tframes:@var{n}
38362The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38363
38364@item tcreated:@var{n}
38365The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38366be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38367
38368@item tsize:@var{n}
38369The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38370
38371@item tfree:@var{n}
38372The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38373
38374@item circular:@var{n}
38375The value of the circular trace buffer flag.  @code{1} means that the
38376trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38377necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38378and may fill up.
38379
38380@item disconn:@var{n}
38381The value of the disconnected tracing flag.  @code{1} means that
38382tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38383that the trace run will stop.
38384
38385@end table
38386
38387@item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38388@cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38389@cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38390Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38391address @var{addr}.
38392
38393Replies:
38394@table @samp
38395@item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38396The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38397run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer.  Note that
38398@code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38399steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38400
38401@end table
38402
38403@item qTV:@var{var}
38404@cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38405@cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38406Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38407
38408Replies:
38409@table @samp
38410@item V@var{value}
38411The value of the variable is @var{value}.  This will be the current
38412value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38413saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38414user is looking at.  Note that multiple requests may result in
38415different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38416program is running.
38417
38418@item U
38419The value of the variable is unknown.  This would occur, for example,
38420if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38421was not collected.
38422@end table
38423
38424@item qTfP
38425@cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38426@itemx qTsP
38427@cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38428These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38429the target.  @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38430of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces.  Replies
38431to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38432that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38433
38434@item qTfV
38435@cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38436@itemx qTsV
38437@cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38438These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38439target.  @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38440and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables.  Replies to
38441these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38442trace state variables.
38443
38444@item qTfSTM
38445@itemx qTsSTM
38446@anchor{qTfSTM}
38447@anchor{qTsSTM}
38448@cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38449@cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38450These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38451in the target program.  @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38452first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38453pieces.  Replies to these packets take the following form:
38454
38455Reply:
38456@table @samp
38457@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38458A single marker
38459@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38460a comma-separated list of markers
38461@item l
38462(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38463@item E @var{nn}
38464An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38465@item @w{}
38466An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38467stub.
38468@end table
38469
38470The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38471@var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38472
38473In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38474more markers, separated by commas.  @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38475reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38476query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38477@dfn{last}).
38478
38479@item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38480@anchor{qTSTMat}
38481@cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38482This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38483target program at @var{address}.  Replies to this packet follow the
38484syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38485tracepoint markers.
38486
38487@item QTSave:@var{filename}
38488@cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38489This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38490@var{filename} in the target's filesystem.  The @var{filename} is encoded
38491as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38492absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38493
38494@item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38495@cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38496Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38497starting at @var{offset}.  The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38498a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38499The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38500in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38501A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38502available.
38503
38504@item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38505This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38506@var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38507
38508@item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38509@anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38510@cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38511This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38512@var{size} if possible.  A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38513use whatever size it prefers.
38514
38515@item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38516@cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38517This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run.  Allowable
38518types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38519@var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38520
38521@end table
38522
38523@subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38524When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38525relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38526different address in memory.  For most instructions, a simple copy is
38527enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38528return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38529PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38530of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38531it had executed in the original location.
38532
38533In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38534respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38535packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38536this relocation operation.  If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38537documentation will explicitly say so.  See for example the above
38538descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets.  The
38539format of the request is:
38540
38541@table @samp
38542@item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38543
38544This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38545to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38546instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38547@var{from}.  @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38548memory starting at @var{to}.
38549@end table
38550
38551Replies:
38552@table @samp
38553@item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38554Informs the stub the relocation is complete.  The @var{adjusted_size} is
38555the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38556@item E @var{NN}
38557A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38558relocating the instruction.
38559@end table
38560
38561@node Host I/O Packets
38562@section Host I/O Packets
38563@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38564@cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38565
38566The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38567operations on the far side of a remote link.  For example, Host I/O is
38568used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38569filesystem.  Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38570layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol.  However, the
38571Host I/O packets are structured differently.  The target-initiated
38572protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38573Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38574target's memory is not involved.  @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38575Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38576
38577The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38578its arguments.  They have this format:
38579
38580@table @samp
38581
38582@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38583@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38584should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38585for a supported operation.  The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38586the operation.  Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal.  Negative
38587numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38588used).  Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38589hexadecimal bytes.  The last argument to a system call may be a
38590buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38591
38592@end table
38593
38594The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38595
38596@table @samp
38597
38598@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38599@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38600non-negative for success and -1 for errors.  If an error has occured,
38601@var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38602value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}).  For
38603operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38604binary buffer.  Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38605normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}).  See the individual packet
38606documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38607@var{attachment}.
38608
38609@item @w{}
38610An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38611
38612@end table
38613
38614These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38615
38616@table @samp
38617@item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38618Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38619return -1 if an error occurs.  The @var{filename} is a string,
38620@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38621(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38622of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38623@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38624
38625@item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38626Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38627-1 if an error occurs.
38628
38629@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38630Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.  Up to
38631@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38632relative to the start of the file.  The target may read fewer bytes;
38633common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38634condition.  The number of bytes read is returned.  Zero should only be
38635returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38636@var{count} was zero.
38637
38638The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38639If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38640attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon).  The return value is the
38641number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38642some characters were escaped.
38643
38644@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38645Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38646to @var{fd}.  Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38647file.  Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38648separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38649packet is used.  @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38650which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38651error occurred.
38652
38653@item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38654Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38655On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38656and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38657If an error occurs the return value is -1.  The format of the
38658returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38659
38660@item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38661Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target.  Return 0,
38662or -1 if an error occurs.  The @var{filename} is a string.
38663
38664@item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38665Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target.  Return
38666the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38667
38668The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38669If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38670attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon).  The return value is the
38671number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38672some characters were escaped.
38673
38674@item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38675Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38676@var{filename} arguments will operate.  This is required for
38677@value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38678the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38679inferior(s).
38680
38681If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38682@var{pid}.  If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38683the remote stub.  Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38684If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38685remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38686operation.
38687
38688@end table
38689
38690@node Interrupts
38691@section Interrupts
38692@cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38693@anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38694
38695In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38696@value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38697@code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38698is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38699
38700The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38701mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined.  @value{GDBN} does not
38702currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38703interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38704@code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38705
38706@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38707transport mechanisms.  It is represented by sending the single byte
38708@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38709the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}).  When a @code{0x03} byte is
38710transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38711and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt.  E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38712(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38713@code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38714
38715@code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38716When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38717it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38718
38719In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38720(@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38721command to the remote stub, even when the target is running.  For that
38722reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38723packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38724@code{0x03}.
38725
38726Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38727precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38728implementation defined.  If the target supports debugging of multiple
38729threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38730currently-executing threads and processes.
38731If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38732running program, it should send one of the stop
38733reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38734of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38735for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38736Interrupts received while the
38737program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38738it is resumed next time.
38739
38740@node Notification Packets
38741@section Notification Packets
38742@cindex notification packets
38743@cindex packets, notification
38744
38745The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38746packets that require no acknowledgment.  Both the GDB and the stub
38747may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38748present are sent by the stub).  Notifications carry information
38749without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38750are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38751is not a problem.
38752
38753A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38754@var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38755and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38756as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets.  A notification's @var{data}
38757never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters.  Upon
38758receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38759to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38760
38761Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38762colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38763
38764Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38765notifications they do not understand.  Recipients should restart
38766timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38767not they understand it.
38768
38769Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38770protocol description specifies that they are permitted.  In the
38771future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38772new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38773recipients.
38774
38775(Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38776the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38777transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients.  There
38778are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38779assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38780
38781Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38782@table @samp
38783@item @var{name}:@var{event}
38784The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38785exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38786carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38787@var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38788@item @var{ack}
38789The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38790acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38791@end table
38792
38793The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38794@value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38795
38796The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38797at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38798appropriate.  The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38799acknowledges.  Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38800additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38801previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38802synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38803@value{GDBN}.  Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38804the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38805@value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38806
38807Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38808otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38809expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38810@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38811Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38812the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38813
38814After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38815sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38816stub.  Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38817@value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38818stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38819
38820Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38821events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38822normal @var{event}.  @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38823packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38824other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38825normally.
38826
38827If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38828@var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38829At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38830and the stub has completed sending any queued events.  @value{GDBN}
38831won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38832received .  If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38833a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38834the process shall be repeated.
38835
38836The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38837following example:
38838@smallexample
38839<- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38840@code{...}
38841-> @code{vStopped}
38842<- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38843-> @code{vStopped}
38844<- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38845-> @code{vStopped}
38846<- @code{OK}
38847@end smallexample
38848
38849The following notifications are defined:
38850@multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38851
38852@item Notification
38853@tab Ack
38854@tab Event
38855@tab Description
38856
38857@item Stop
38858@tab vStopped
38859@tab @var{reply}.  The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38860described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}.  Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38861for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38862@value{GDBN}.
38863@tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38864
38865@end multitable
38866
38867@node Remote Non-Stop
38868@section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38869
38870@value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38871multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.  If the stub
38872supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38873@samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38874
38875@value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38876establishing a new connection with the stub.  Entering non-stop mode
38877does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38878must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38879all-stop mode.  @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38880probe the target state after a mode change.
38881
38882In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38883would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38884asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38885inform @value{GDBN}.  In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38886in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38887mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped.  That is,
38888when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38889of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38890affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38891to run.  When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38892threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38893
38894In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38895follows.  First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38896sequence in progress is abandoned.  The target must begin a new
38897sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38898it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}.  The first
38899stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38900subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38901using the mechanism described above.  The target must not send
38902asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38903If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38904or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38905@samp{OK}.
38906
38907If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38908@samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38909the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38910(@pxref{swbreak stop reason}).  This is because given the asynchronous
38911nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38912and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38913breakpoint may have already been removed from the target.  Due to
38914this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38915caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38916opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38917Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38918for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38919necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38920
38921@node Packet Acknowledgment
38922@section Packet Acknowledgment
38923
38924@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38925@cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38926By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38927the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38928the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38929This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38930unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38931
38932In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38933TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38934It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38935overhead, or for other reasons.  This can be accomplished by means of the
38936@samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38937
38938When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38939expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments.  The packet
38940and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38941@ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38942
38943If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38944no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38945by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38946@pxref{qSupported}.
38947If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38948disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38949(@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38950@value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38951Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38952@value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38953response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38954
38955Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38956between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38957it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38958connection.
38959Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38960new connection is established,
38961there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38962for the current connection, once disabled.
38963
38964@node Examples
38965@section Examples
38966
38967Example sequence of a target being re-started.  Notice how the restart
38968does not get any direct output:
38969
38970@smallexample
38971-> @code{R00}
38972<- @code{+}
38973@emph{target restarts}
38974-> @code{?}
38975<- @code{+}
38976<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38977-> @code{+}
38978@end smallexample
38979
38980Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38981
38982@smallexample
38983-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38984<- @code{+}
38985-> @code{s}
38986<- @code{+}
38987@emph{time passes}
38988<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38989-> @code{+}
38990-> @code{g}
38991<- @code{+}
38992<- @code{1455@dots{}}
38993-> @code{+}
38994@end smallexample
38995
38996@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38997@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38998@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38999
39000@menu
39001* File-I/O Overview::
39002* Protocol Basics::
39003* The F Request Packet::
39004* The F Reply Packet::
39005* The Ctrl-C Message::
39006* Console I/O::
39007* List of Supported Calls::
39008* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39009* Constants::
39010* File-I/O Examples::
39011@end menu
39012
39013@node File-I/O Overview
39014@subsection File-I/O Overview
39015@cindex file-i/o overview
39016
39017The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39018target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39019system calls.  System calls on the target system are translated into a
39020remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39021actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39022This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39023
39024The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39025It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values.  Both
39026@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39027translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39028protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39029
39030The communication is synchronous.  A system call is possible only when
39031@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39032or @samp{s} packets.  While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39033the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39034memory.  Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals.  On
39035the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39036(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39037
39038The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39039the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action.  That means,
39040after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39041previous activity (continue, step).  No additional continue or step
39042request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39043
39044@smallexample
39045(@value{GDBP}) continue
39046  <- target requests 'system call X'
39047  target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39048  -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39049  ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39050  <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39051@end smallexample
39052
39053The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39054the host file system.  Character or block special devices, pipes,
39055named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39056system are not supported by this protocol.
39057
39058File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39059
39060@node Protocol Basics
39061@subsection Protocol Basics
39062@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39063
39064The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39065as reply packet.  Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39066@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39067the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39068of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39069This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39070to call the appropriate host system call:
39071
39072@itemize @bullet
39073@item
39074A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39075
39076@item
39077All parameters to the system call.  Pointers are given as addresses
39078in the target memory address space.  Pointers to strings are given as
39079pointer/length pair.  Numerical values are given as they are.
39080Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39081
39082@end itemize
39083
39084At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39085
39086@itemize @bullet
39087@item
39088If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39089system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39090standard @code{m} packet request.  This additional communication has to be
39091expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39092packet.
39093
39094@item
39095@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39096representation as needed.  Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39097
39098@item
39099@value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39100
39101@item
39102It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39103
39104@item
39105If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39106by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39107target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet.  This packet has to be expected
39108by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39109packet.
39110
39111@end itemize
39112
39113Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39114necessary information for the target to continue.  This at least contains
39115
39116@itemize @bullet
39117@item
39118Return value.
39119
39120@item
39121@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39122
39123@item
39124``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39125
39126@end itemize
39127
39128After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39129the latest continue or step action.
39130
39131@node The F Request Packet
39132@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39133@cindex file-i/o request packet
39134@cindex @code{F} request packet
39135
39136The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39137
39138@table @samp
39139@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39140
39141@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39142This is just the name of the function.
39143
39144@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39145Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39146of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39147datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39148of string parameters.  These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39149comma-delimited list.  All values are transmitted in ASCII
39150string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39151
39152@end table
39153
39154
39155
39156@node The F Reply Packet
39157@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39158@cindex file-i/o reply packet
39159@cindex @code{F} reply packet
39160
39161The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39162
39163@table @samp
39164
39165@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39166
39167@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39168
39169@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39170representation.
39171This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39172
39173@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break.  In this
39174case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39175The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39176
39177@smallexample
39178F0,0,C
39179@end smallexample
39180
39181@noindent
39182or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39183
39184@smallexample
39185F-1,4,C
39186@end smallexample
39187
39188@noindent
39189assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39190
39191@end table
39192
39193
39194@node The Ctrl-C Message
39195@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39196@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39197
39198If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39199reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39200the target should behave as if it had
39201gotten a break message.  The meaning for the target is ``system call
39202interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''.  Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39203(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39204packet.
39205
39206It's important for the target to know in which
39207state the system call was interrupted.  There are two possible cases:
39208
39209@itemize @bullet
39210@item
39211The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39212
39213@item
39214The system call on the host has been finished.
39215
39216@end itemize
39217
39218These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39219returned @code{errno}.  If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39220call hasn't been performed.  This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39221on POSIX systems.  In any other case, the target may presume that the
39222system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39223as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39224
39225@value{GDBN} must behave reliably.  If the system call has not been called
39226yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39227@code{errno} in the packet.  If the system call on the host has been finished
39228before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39229@value{GDBN}.  This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39230The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39231or the full action has been completed.
39232
39233@node Console I/O
39234@subsection Console I/O
39235@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39236
39237By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39238descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console.  Output
39239on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39240(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}).  Console input is handled
39241by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
392420 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39243conditions is met:
39244
39245@itemize @bullet
39246@item
39247The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}.  The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39248@code{read}
39249system call is treated as finished.
39250
39251@item
39252The user presses @key{RET}.  This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39253newline.
39254
39255@item
39256The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}.  This is treated as end of input.  No trailing
39257character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39258
39259@end itemize
39260
39261If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39262the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39263either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39264is stopped at the user's request.
39265
39266
39267@node List of Supported Calls
39268@subsection List of Supported Calls
39269@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39270
39271@menu
39272* open::
39273* close::
39274* read::
39275* write::
39276* lseek::
39277* rename::
39278* unlink::
39279* stat/fstat::
39280* gettimeofday::
39281* isatty::
39282* system::
39283@end menu
39284
39285@node open
39286@unnumberedsubsubsec open
39287@cindex open, file-i/o system call
39288
39289@table @asis
39290@item Synopsis:
39291@smallexample
39292int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39293int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39294@end smallexample
39295
39296@item Request:
39297@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39298
39299@noindent
39300@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39301
39302@table @code
39303@item O_CREAT
39304If the file does not exist it will be created.  The host
39305rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39306are concerned.
39307
39308@item O_EXCL
39309When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39310an error and open() fails.
39311
39312@item O_TRUNC
39313If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39314writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39315truncated to zero length.
39316
39317@item O_APPEND
39318The file is opened in append mode.
39319
39320@item O_RDONLY
39321The file is opened for reading only.
39322
39323@item O_WRONLY
39324The file is opened for writing only.
39325
39326@item O_RDWR
39327The file is opened for reading and writing.
39328@end table
39329
39330@noindent
39331Other bits are silently ignored.
39332
39333
39334@noindent
39335@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39336
39337@table @code
39338@item S_IRUSR
39339User has read permission.
39340
39341@item S_IWUSR
39342User has write permission.
39343
39344@item S_IRGRP
39345Group has read permission.
39346
39347@item S_IWGRP
39348Group has write permission.
39349
39350@item S_IROTH
39351Others have read permission.
39352
39353@item S_IWOTH
39354Others have write permission.
39355@end table
39356
39357@noindent
39358Other bits are silently ignored.
39359
39360
39361@item Return value:
39362@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39363occurred.
39364
39365@item Errors:
39366
39367@table @code
39368@item EEXIST
39369@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39370
39371@item EISDIR
39372@var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39373
39374@item EACCES
39375The requested access is not allowed.
39376
39377@item ENAMETOOLONG
39378@var{pathname} was too long.
39379
39380@item ENOENT
39381A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39382
39383@item ENODEV
39384@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39385
39386@item EROFS
39387@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39388write access was requested.
39389
39390@item EFAULT
39391@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39392
39393@item ENOSPC
39394No space on device to create the file.
39395
39396@item EMFILE
39397The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39398
39399@item ENFILE
39400The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39401has been reached.
39402
39403@item EINTR
39404The call was interrupted by the user.
39405@end table
39406
39407@end table
39408
39409@node close
39410@unnumberedsubsubsec close
39411@cindex close, file-i/o system call
39412
39413@table @asis
39414@item Synopsis:
39415@smallexample
39416int close(int fd);
39417@end smallexample
39418
39419@item Request:
39420@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39421
39422@item Return value:
39423@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39424
39425@item Errors:
39426
39427@table @code
39428@item EBADF
39429@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39430
39431@item EINTR
39432The call was interrupted by the user.
39433@end table
39434
39435@end table
39436
39437@node read
39438@unnumberedsubsubsec read
39439@cindex read, file-i/o system call
39440
39441@table @asis
39442@item Synopsis:
39443@smallexample
39444int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39445@end smallexample
39446
39447@item Request:
39448@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39449
39450@item Return value:
39451On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39452Zero indicates end of file.  If count is zero, read
39453returns zero as well.  On error, -1 is returned.
39454
39455@item Errors:
39456
39457@table @code
39458@item EBADF
39459@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39460reading.
39461
39462@item EFAULT
39463@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39464
39465@item EINTR
39466The call was interrupted by the user.
39467@end table
39468
39469@end table
39470
39471@node write
39472@unnumberedsubsubsec write
39473@cindex write, file-i/o system call
39474
39475@table @asis
39476@item Synopsis:
39477@smallexample
39478int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39479@end smallexample
39480
39481@item Request:
39482@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39483
39484@item Return value:
39485On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39486Zero indicates nothing was written.  On error, -1
39487is returned.
39488
39489@item Errors:
39490
39491@table @code
39492@item EBADF
39493@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39494writing.
39495
39496@item EFAULT
39497@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39498
39499@item EFBIG
39500An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39501host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39502
39503@item ENOSPC
39504No space on device to write the data.
39505
39506@item EINTR
39507The call was interrupted by the user.
39508@end table
39509
39510@end table
39511
39512@node lseek
39513@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39514@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39515
39516@table @asis
39517@item Synopsis:
39518@smallexample
39519long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39520@end smallexample
39521
39522@item Request:
39523@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39524
39525@var{flag} is one of:
39526
39527@table @code
39528@item SEEK_SET
39529The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39530
39531@item SEEK_CUR
39532The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39533bytes.
39534
39535@item SEEK_END
39536The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39537bytes.
39538@end table
39539
39540@item Return value:
39541On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39542the beginning of the file is returned.  Otherwise, a
39543value of -1 is returned.
39544
39545@item Errors:
39546
39547@table @code
39548@item EBADF
39549@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39550
39551@item ESPIPE
39552@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39553
39554@item EINVAL
39555@var{flag} is not a proper value.
39556
39557@item EINTR
39558The call was interrupted by the user.
39559@end table
39560
39561@end table
39562
39563@node rename
39564@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39565@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39566
39567@table @asis
39568@item Synopsis:
39569@smallexample
39570int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39571@end smallexample
39572
39573@item Request:
39574@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39575
39576@item Return value:
39577On success, zero is returned.  On error, -1 is returned.
39578
39579@item Errors:
39580
39581@table @code
39582@item EISDIR
39583@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39584directory.
39585
39586@item EEXIST
39587@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39588
39589@item EBUSY
39590@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39591process.
39592
39593@item EINVAL
39594An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39595of itself.
39596
39597@item ENOTDIR
39598A  component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39599path is not a directory.  Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39600and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39601
39602@item EFAULT
39603@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39604
39605@item EACCES
39606No access to the file or the path of the file.
39607
39608@item ENAMETOOLONG
39609
39610@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39611
39612@item ENOENT
39613A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39614
39615@item EROFS
39616The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39617
39618@item ENOSPC
39619The device containing the file has no room for the new
39620directory entry.
39621
39622@item EINTR
39623The call was interrupted by the user.
39624@end table
39625
39626@end table
39627
39628@node unlink
39629@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39630@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39631
39632@table @asis
39633@item Synopsis:
39634@smallexample
39635int unlink(const char *pathname);
39636@end smallexample
39637
39638@item Request:
39639@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39640
39641@item Return value:
39642On success, zero is returned.  On error, -1 is returned.
39643
39644@item Errors:
39645
39646@table @code
39647@item EACCES
39648No access to the file or the path of the file.
39649
39650@item EPERM
39651The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39652
39653@item EBUSY
39654The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39655being used by another process.
39656
39657@item EFAULT
39658@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39659
39660@item ENAMETOOLONG
39661@var{pathname} was too long.
39662
39663@item ENOENT
39664A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39665
39666@item ENOTDIR
39667A component of the path is not a directory.
39668
39669@item EROFS
39670The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39671
39672@item EINTR
39673The call was interrupted by the user.
39674@end table
39675
39676@end table
39677
39678@node stat/fstat
39679@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39680@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39681@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39682
39683@table @asis
39684@item Synopsis:
39685@smallexample
39686int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39687int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39688@end smallexample
39689
39690@item Request:
39691@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39692@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39693
39694@item Return value:
39695On success, zero is returned.  On error, -1 is returned.
39696
39697@item Errors:
39698
39699@table @code
39700@item EBADF
39701@var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39702
39703@item ENOENT
39704A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39705path is an empty string.
39706
39707@item ENOTDIR
39708A component of the path is not a directory.
39709
39710@item EFAULT
39711@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39712
39713@item EACCES
39714No access to the file or the path of the file.
39715
39716@item ENAMETOOLONG
39717@var{pathname} was too long.
39718
39719@item EINTR
39720The call was interrupted by the user.
39721@end table
39722
39723@end table
39724
39725@node gettimeofday
39726@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39727@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39728
39729@table @asis
39730@item Synopsis:
39731@smallexample
39732int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39733@end smallexample
39734
39735@item Request:
39736@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39737
39738@item Return value:
39739On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39740
39741@item Errors:
39742
39743@table @code
39744@item EINVAL
39745@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39746
39747@item EFAULT
39748@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39749@end table
39750
39751@end table
39752
39753@node isatty
39754@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39755@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39756
39757@table @asis
39758@item Synopsis:
39759@smallexample
39760int isatty(int fd);
39761@end smallexample
39762
39763@item Request:
39764@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39765
39766@item Return value:
39767Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39768
39769@item Errors:
39770
39771@table @code
39772@item EINTR
39773The call was interrupted by the user.
39774@end table
39775
39776@end table
39777
39778Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
397791 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39780to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.  Implementing through system calls
39781would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39782needed.
39783
39784
39785@node system
39786@unnumberedsubsubsec system
39787@cindex system, file-i/o system call
39788
39789@table @asis
39790@item Synopsis:
39791@smallexample
39792int system(const char *command);
39793@end smallexample
39794
39795@item Request:
39796@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39797
39798@item Return value:
39799If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39800available.  A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39801For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39802return status of the command otherwise.  Only the exit status of the
39803command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39804return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}.  In case
39805@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39806
39807@item Errors:
39808
39809@table @code
39810@item EINTR
39811The call was interrupted by the user.
39812@end table
39813
39814@end table
39815
39816@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39817to perform the @code{system} call.  The return value of @code{system} on
39818the host is simplified before it's returned
39819to the target.  Any termination signal information from the child process
39820is discarded, and the return value consists
39821entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39822
39823Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39824by @value{GDBN}.  The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39825@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39826
39827@table @code
39828@item set remote system-call-allowed
39829@kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39830Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39831protocol for the remote target.  The default is zero (disabled).
39832
39833@item show remote system-call-allowed
39834@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39835Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39836protocol.
39837@end table
39838
39839@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39840@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39841@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39842
39843@menu
39844* Integral Datatypes::
39845* Pointer Values::
39846* Memory Transfer::
39847* struct stat::
39848* struct timeval::
39849@end menu
39850
39851@node Integral Datatypes
39852@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39853@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39854
39855The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39856@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39857@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39858
39859@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39860implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39861
39862@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39863
39864@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39865in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39866
39867@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39868
39869All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39870structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39871byte order.
39872
39873@node Pointer Values
39874@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39875@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39876
39877Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are.  An exception
39878is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39879transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings.  Strings
39880are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39881
39882@smallexample
39883@code{1aaf/12}
39884@end smallexample
39885
39886@noindent
39887which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39888The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39889the trailing null byte.  For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39890at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39891
39892@smallexample
39893@code{123456/d}
39894@end smallexample
39895
39896@node Memory Transfer
39897@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39898@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39899
39900Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39901example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39902with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian.  Translation to
39903this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39904packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39905it transfers memory to the target.  Transferred pointers to structured
39906data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39907
39908
39909@node struct stat
39910@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39911@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39912
39913The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39914is defined as follows:
39915
39916@smallexample
39917struct stat @{
39918    unsigned int  st_dev;      /* device */
39919    unsigned int  st_ino;      /* inode */
39920    mode_t        st_mode;     /* protection */
39921    unsigned int  st_nlink;    /* number of hard links */
39922    unsigned int  st_uid;      /* user ID of owner */
39923    unsigned int  st_gid;      /* group ID of owner */
39924    unsigned int  st_rdev;     /* device type (if inode device) */
39925    unsigned long st_size;     /* total size, in bytes */
39926    unsigned long st_blksize;  /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39927    unsigned long st_blocks;   /* number of blocks allocated */
39928    time_t        st_atime;    /* time of last access */
39929    time_t        st_mtime;    /* time of last modification */
39930    time_t        st_ctime;    /* time of last change */
39931@};
39932@end smallexample
39933
39934The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39935appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39936structure is of size 64 bytes.
39937
39938The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39939range of values.
39940
39941@table @code
39942
39943@item st_dev
39944A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39945
39946@item st_ino
39947No valid meaning for the target.  Transmitted unchanged.
39948
39949@item st_mode
39950Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}.  Any other
39951bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39952
39953@item st_uid
39954@itemx st_gid
39955@itemx st_rdev
39956No valid meaning for the target.  Transmitted unchanged.
39957
39958@item st_atime
39959@itemx st_mtime
39960@itemx st_ctime
39961These values have a host and file system dependent
39962accuracy.  Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39963support exact timing values.
39964@end table
39965
39966The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39967responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39968continuing.
39969
39970Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39971representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39972get truncated on the target.
39973
39974@node struct timeval
39975@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39976@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39977
39978The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39979is defined as follows:
39980
39981@smallexample
39982struct timeval @{
39983    time_t tv_sec;  /* second */
39984    long   tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39985@};
39986@end smallexample
39987
39988The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39989appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39990structure is of size 8 bytes.
39991
39992@node Constants
39993@subsection Constants
39994@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39995
39996The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39997protocol.  @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39998values before and after the call as needed.
39999
40000@menu
40001* Open Flags::
40002* mode_t Values::
40003* Errno Values::
40004* Lseek Flags::
40005* Limits::
40006@end menu
40007
40008@node Open Flags
40009@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40010@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40011
40012All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40013
40014@smallexample
40015  O_RDONLY        0x0
40016  O_WRONLY        0x1
40017  O_RDWR          0x2
40018  O_APPEND        0x8
40019  O_CREAT       0x200
40020  O_TRUNC       0x400
40021  O_EXCL        0x800
40022@end smallexample
40023
40024@node mode_t Values
40025@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40026@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40027
40028All values are given in octal representation.
40029
40030@smallexample
40031  S_IFREG       0100000
40032  S_IFDIR        040000
40033  S_IRUSR          0400
40034  S_IWUSR          0200
40035  S_IXUSR          0100
40036  S_IRGRP           040
40037  S_IWGRP           020
40038  S_IXGRP           010
40039  S_IROTH            04
40040  S_IWOTH            02
40041  S_IXOTH            01
40042@end smallexample
40043
40044@node Errno Values
40045@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40046@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40047
40048All values are given in decimal representation.
40049
40050@smallexample
40051  EPERM           1
40052  ENOENT          2
40053  EINTR           4
40054  EBADF           9
40055  EACCES         13
40056  EFAULT         14
40057  EBUSY          16
40058  EEXIST         17
40059  ENODEV         19
40060  ENOTDIR        20
40061  EISDIR         21
40062  EINVAL         22
40063  ENFILE         23
40064  EMFILE         24
40065  EFBIG          27
40066  ENOSPC         28
40067  ESPIPE         29
40068  EROFS          30
40069  ENAMETOOLONG   91
40070  EUNKNOWN       9999
40071@end smallexample
40072
40073  @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40074  any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40075
40076@node Lseek Flags
40077@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40078@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40079
40080@smallexample
40081  SEEK_SET      0
40082  SEEK_CUR      1
40083  SEEK_END      2
40084@end smallexample
40085
40086@node Limits
40087@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40088@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40089
40090All values are given in decimal representation.
40091
40092@smallexample
40093  INT_MIN       -2147483648
40094  INT_MAX        2147483647
40095  UINT_MAX       4294967295
40096  LONG_MIN      -9223372036854775808
40097  LONG_MAX       9223372036854775807
40098  ULONG_MAX      18446744073709551615
40099@end smallexample
40100
40101@node File-I/O Examples
40102@subsection File-I/O Examples
40103@cindex file-i/o examples
40104
40105Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40106address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40107
40108@smallexample
40109<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40110@emph{request memory read from target}
40111-> @code{m1234,6}
40112<- XXXXXX
40113@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40114-> @code{F6}
40115@end smallexample
40116
40117Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40118address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40119
40120@smallexample
40121<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40122@emph{request memory write to target}
40123-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40124@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40125-> @code{F6}
40126@end smallexample
40127
40128Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40129file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40130
40131@smallexample
40132<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40133-> @code{F-1,9}
40134@end smallexample
40135
40136Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40137host is called:
40138
40139@smallexample
40140<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40141-> @code{F-1,4,C}
40142<- @code{T02}
40143@end smallexample
40144
40145Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40146host is called:
40147
40148@smallexample
40149<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40150-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40151<- @code{T02}
40152@end smallexample
40153
40154@node Library List Format
40155@section Library List Format
40156@cindex library list format, remote protocol
40157
40158On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40159same process as your application to manage libraries.  In this case,
40160@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40161operations to maintain a list of shared libraries.  On other
40162platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40163@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40164through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40165packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead.  The remote stub
40166queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40167are loaded.
40168
40169The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40170lists loaded libraries and their offsets.  Each library has an
40171associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40172which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40173
40174For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40175library should have a list of segments.  If the target supports
40176dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40177should instead include a list of allocated sections.  The segment or
40178section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40179depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40180
40181@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40182library lists.  @xref{Expat}.
40183
40184A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40185offset, looks like this:
40186
40187@smallexample
40188<library-list>
40189  <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40190    <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40191  </library>
40192</library-list>
40193@end smallexample
40194
40195Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40196allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40197
40198@smallexample
40199<library-list>
40200  <library name="sharedlib.o">
40201    <section address="0x10000000"/>
40202    <section address="0x20000000"/>
40203    <section address="0x30000000"/>
40204  </library>
40205</library-list>
40206@end smallexample
40207
40208The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40209
40210@smallexample
40211<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40212<!ELEMENT library-list  (library)*>
40213<!ATTLIST library-list  version CDATA   #FIXED  "1.0">
40214<!ELEMENT library       (segment*, section*)>
40215<!ATTLIST library       name    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40216<!ELEMENT segment       EMPTY>
40217<!ATTLIST segment       address CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40218<!ELEMENT section       EMPTY>
40219<!ATTLIST section       address CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40220@end smallexample
40221
40222In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40223single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40224section for each library.
40225
40226@node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40227@section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40228@cindex library list format, remote protocol
40229
40230On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40231(e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40232shared libraries.  Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40233more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40234
40235The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40236loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters.  For each library on SVR4
40237target, the following parameters are reported:
40238
40239@itemize @minus
40240@item
40241@code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40242@code{struct link_map}.
40243@item
40244@code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40245(Thread Local Storage) access.
40246@item
40247@code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40248@code{struct link_map}.  For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40249memory address.  It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40250address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40251@item
40252@code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40253@end itemize
40254
40255Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40256@code{struct link_map} used for the main executable.  This parameter is used
40257for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40258
40259@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40260SVR4 library lists.  @xref{Expat}.
40261
40262A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40263looks like this:
40264
40265@smallexample
40266<library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40267  <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40268           l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40269  <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40270           l_ld="0x152350"/>
40271</library-list-svr>
40272@end smallexample
40273
40274The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40275
40276@smallexample
40277<!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40278<!ELEMENT library-list-svr4  (library)*>
40279<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4  version CDATA   #FIXED  "1.0">
40280<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4  main-lm CDATA   #IMPLIED>
40281<!ELEMENT library            EMPTY>
40282<!ATTLIST library            name    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40283<!ATTLIST library            lm      CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40284<!ATTLIST library            l_addr  CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40285<!ATTLIST library            l_ld    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40286@end smallexample
40287
40288@node Memory Map Format
40289@section Memory Map Format
40290@cindex memory map format
40291
40292To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40293memory map from the target.  This section describes the format of the
40294memory map.
40295
40296The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40297(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40298lists memory regions.
40299
40300@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40301memory maps.  @xref{Expat}.
40302
40303The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40304
40305@smallexample
40306<?xml version="1.0"?>
40307<!DOCTYPE memory-map
40308          PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40309                 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40310<memory-map>
40311    region...
40312</memory-map>
40313@end smallexample
40314
40315Each region can be either:
40316
40317@itemize
40318
40319@item
40320A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40321bytes from there:
40322
40323@smallexample
40324<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40325@end smallexample
40326
40327
40328@item
40329A region of read-only memory:
40330
40331@smallexample
40332<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40333@end smallexample
40334
40335
40336@item
40337A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40338bytes in length:
40339
40340@smallexample
40341<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40342  <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40343</memory>
40344@end smallexample
40345
40346@end itemize
40347
40348Regions must not overlap.  @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40349by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40350packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40351
40352The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40353
40354@smallexample
40355<!-- ................................................... -->
40356<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40357<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40358<!-- .................................... .............. -->
40359<!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40360<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40361<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40362<!ATTLIST memory-map    version CDATA   #FIXED  "1.0.0">
40363<!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40364<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40365             and its type, or device. -->
40366<!ATTLIST memory        type    CDATA   #REQUIRED
40367                        start   CDATA   #REQUIRED
40368                        length  CDATA   #REQUIRED
40369                        device  CDATA   #IMPLIED>
40370<!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40371<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40372<!ATTLIST property      name    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40373@end smallexample
40374
40375@node Thread List Format
40376@section Thread List Format
40377@cindex thread list format
40378
40379To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40380@value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40381(@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40382the following structure:
40383
40384@smallexample
40385<?xml version="1.0"?>
40386<threads>
40387    <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40388    ... description ...
40389    </thread>
40390</threads>
40391@end smallexample
40392
40393Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40394identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).  The
40395@samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40396the thread was last executing on.  The @samp{name} attribute, if
40397present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread.  The content
40398of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40399auxiliary information.
40400
40401@node Traceframe Info Format
40402@section Traceframe Info Format
40403@cindex traceframe info format
40404
40405To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40406inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40407memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40408collected in a traceframe.
40409
40410This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40411(@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40412
40413@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40414traceframe info discovery.  @xref{Expat}.
40415
40416The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40417
40418@smallexample
40419<?xml version="1.0"?>
40420<!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40421          PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40422                 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40423<traceframe-info>
40424   block...
40425</traceframe-info>
40426@end smallexample
40427
40428Each traceframe block can be either:
40429
40430@itemize
40431
40432@item
40433A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40434@var{length} bytes from there:
40435
40436@smallexample
40437<memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40438@end smallexample
40439
40440@item
40441A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40442collected:
40443
40444@smallexample
40445<tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40446@end smallexample
40447
40448@end itemize
40449
40450The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40451
40452@smallexample
40453<!ELEMENT traceframe-info  (memory | tvar)* >
40454<!ATTLIST traceframe-info  version CDATA   #FIXED  "1.0">
40455
40456<!ELEMENT memory        EMPTY>
40457<!ATTLIST memory        start   CDATA   #REQUIRED
40458                        length  CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40459<!ELEMENT tvar>
40460<!ATTLIST tvar          id      CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40461@end smallexample
40462
40463@node Branch Trace Format
40464@section Branch Trace Format
40465@cindex branch trace format
40466
40467In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40468@value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches.  This list is
40469represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40470branches.  The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40471
40472This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40473(@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40474
40475@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40476traceframe info discovery.  @xref{Expat}.
40477
40478The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40479
40480@smallexample
40481<?xml version="1.0"?>
40482<!DOCTYPE btrace
40483          PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40484                 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40485<btrace>
40486   block...
40487</btrace>
40488@end smallexample
40489
40490@itemize
40491
40492@item
40493A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40494and ending at @var{end}:
40495
40496@smallexample
40497<block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40498@end smallexample
40499
40500@end itemize
40501
40502The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40503
40504@smallexample
40505<!ELEMENT btrace  (block* | pt) >
40506<!ATTLIST btrace  version CDATA   #FIXED "1.0">
40507
40508<!ELEMENT block        EMPTY>
40509<!ATTLIST block        begin  CDATA   #REQUIRED
40510                       end    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40511
40512<!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40513
40514<!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40515
40516<!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40517<!ATTLIST cpu vendor   CDATA #REQUIRED
40518              family   CDATA #REQUIRED
40519              model    CDATA #REQUIRED
40520              stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40521
40522<!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40523@end smallexample
40524
40525@node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40526@section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40527@cindex branch trace configuration format
40528
40529For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40530configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40531(@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40532
40533The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40534settings for that format.  The following information is described:
40535
40536@table @code
40537@item bts
40538This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40539@table @code
40540@item size
40541The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40542@end table
40543@item pt
40544This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40545PT}) format.
40546@table @code
40547@item size
40548The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40549@end table
40550@end table
40551
40552@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40553branch trace configuration discovery.  @xref{Expat}.
40554
40555The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40556
40557@smallexample
40558<!ELEMENT btrace-conf	(bts?, pt?)>
40559<!ATTLIST btrace-conf	version	CDATA	#FIXED "1.0">
40560
40561<!ELEMENT bts	EMPTY>
40562<!ATTLIST bts	size	CDATA	#IMPLIED>
40563
40564<!ELEMENT pt	EMPTY>
40565<!ATTLIST pt	size	CDATA	#IMPLIED>
40566@end smallexample
40567
40568@include agentexpr.texi
40569
40570@node Target Descriptions
40571@appendix Target Descriptions
40572@cindex target descriptions
40573
40574One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40575is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40576architecture in use.  It is common practice for vendors to start with
40577a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40578and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche.  Some
40579architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40580vendors.  This leads to a number of problems:
40581
40582@itemize @bullet
40583@item
40584With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40585the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40586@item
40587Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40588audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40589variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40590@item
40591When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40592at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40593@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40594@end itemize
40595
40596To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40597target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40598actually describe its own features.  This lets @value{GDBN} support
40599processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40600descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40601
40602@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40603target descriptions.  @xref{Expat}.
40604
40605@menu
40606* Retrieving Descriptions::         How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40607* Target Description Format::       The contents of a target description.
40608* Predefined Target Types::         Standard types available for target
40609                                    descriptions.
40610* Enum Target Types::               How to define enum target types.
40611* Standard Target Features::        Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40612@end menu
40613
40614@node Retrieving Descriptions
40615@section Retrieving Descriptions
40616
40617Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40618specified by the user manually.  The default behavior is to read the
40619description from the target.  @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40620protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40621qXfer}).  The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40622@samp{target.xml}.  The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40623XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40624Format}.
40625
40626Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40627If a file is set, the target will not be queried.  The commands to
40628specify a file are:
40629
40630@table @code
40631@cindex set tdesc filename
40632@item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40633Read the target description from @var{path}.
40634
40635@cindex unset tdesc filename
40636@item unset tdesc filename
40637Do not read the XML target description from a file.  @value{GDBN}
40638will use the description supplied by the current target.
40639
40640@cindex show tdesc filename
40641@item show tdesc filename
40642Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40643@end table
40644
40645
40646@node Target Description Format
40647@section Target Description Format
40648@cindex target descriptions, XML format
40649
40650A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40651document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40652the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}.  This
40653means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40654check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40655However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40656their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40657
40658Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40659and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40660sets.  They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40661@value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40662target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40663
40664Here is a simple target description:
40665
40666@smallexample
40667<target version="1.0">
40668  <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40669</target>
40670@end smallexample
40671
40672@noindent
40673This minimal description only says that the target uses
40674the x86-64 architecture.
40675
40676A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40677optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements.  The elements
40678are explained further below.
40679
40680@smallexample
40681<?xml version="1.0"?>
40682<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40683<target version="1.0">
40684  @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40685  @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40686  @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40687  @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40688</target>
40689@end smallexample
40690
40691@noindent
40692The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40693breaks, under the usual common-sense rules.  The XML version
40694declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40695(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40696useful for XML validation tools.  The @samp{version} attribute for
40697@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40698including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40699revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40700the version mismatch.
40701
40702@subsection Inclusion
40703@cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40704@cindex XInclude
40705@ifnotinfo
40706@cindex <xi:include>
40707@end ifnotinfo
40708
40709It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40710several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40711share files between different possible target descriptions.  You can
40712divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40713the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40714
40715@smallexample
40716<xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40717@end smallexample
40718
40719@noindent
40720When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40721the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40722the contents of that document.  If the current description was read
40723using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40724@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex.  If the
40725current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40726@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40727original description.
40728
40729@subsection Architecture
40730@cindex <architecture>
40731
40732An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40733
40734@smallexample
40735  <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40736@end smallexample
40737
40738@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40739@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40740
40741@subsection OS ABI
40742@cindex @code{<osabi>}
40743
40744This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40745Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40746
40747An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40748
40749@smallexample
40750  <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40751@end smallexample
40752
40753@var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40754@w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40755
40756@subsection Compatible Architecture
40757@cindex @code{<compatible>}
40758
40759This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40760Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40761
40762A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40763
40764@smallexample
40765  <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40766@end smallexample
40767
40768@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40769@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40770
40771A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40772is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40773given by the @samp{<architecture>} element.  For example, on the
40774Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40775or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40776in the @code{spu} architecture as well.  The way to describe this
40777capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40778
40779@smallexample
40780  <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40781  <compatible>spu</compatible>
40782@end smallexample
40783
40784@subsection Features
40785@cindex <feature>
40786
40787Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40788system.  Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40789registers and the types of their contents.  A @samp{<feature>} element
40790has this form:
40791
40792@smallexample
40793<feature name="@var{name}">
40794  @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40795  @var{reg}@dots{}
40796</feature>
40797@end smallexample
40798
40799@noindent
40800Each feature's name should be unique within the description.  The name
40801of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40802knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40803should have its standard name.  @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40804
40805@subsection Types
40806
40807Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40808interpret.  The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40809but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40810Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40811Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40812and enum types.
40813
40814Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40815a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40816Types must be defined before they are used.
40817
40818@cindex <vector>
40819Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40820of scalar elements.  These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40821specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40822@var{count}:
40823
40824@smallexample
40825<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40826@end smallexample
40827
40828@cindex <union>
40829If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40830with a union type containing the useful representations.  The
40831@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40832each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40833
40834@smallexample
40835<union id="@var{id}">
40836  <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40837  @dots{}
40838</union>
40839@end smallexample
40840
40841@cindex <struct>
40842@cindex <flags>
40843If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40844it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40845A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40846A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40847If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40848specified.
40849
40850Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40851
40852@smallexample
40853<struct id="@var{id}">
40854  <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40855  @dots{}
40856</struct>
40857@end smallexample
40858
40859Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40860No implicit padding is added.
40861
40862Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
40863
40864@smallexample
40865<struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40866  <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40867  @dots{}
40868</struct>
40869@end smallexample
40870
40871@smallexample
40872<flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40873  <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40874  @dots{}
40875</flags>
40876@end smallexample
40877
40878The @var{name} value is required.
40879Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
40880in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
40881Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
40882
40883The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
40884is optional.
40885The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
40886and zero represents the least significant bit.
40887
40888The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
40889and an unsigned integer otherwise.
40890
40891Which to choose?  Structures or flags?
40892
40893Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
40894defining them with @samp{struct}:
40895
40896@itemize @bullet
40897@item
40898Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
40899@item
40900They are printed in a more readable fashion.
40901@end itemize
40902
40903Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
40904defining them with @samp{flags}:
40905
40906@itemize @bullet
40907@item
40908One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
40909
40910@smallexample
40911(gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
40912$1 = 42
40913@end smallexample
40914
40915@end itemize
40916
40917@subsection Registers
40918@cindex <reg>
40919
40920Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40921
40922@smallexample
40923<reg name="@var{name}"
40924     bitsize="@var{size}"
40925     @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40926     @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40927     @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40928     @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40929@end smallexample
40930
40931@noindent
40932The components are as follows:
40933
40934@table @var
40935
40936@item name
40937The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40938
40939@item bitsize
40940The register's size, in bits.
40941
40942@item regnum
40943The register's number.  If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40944than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40945a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40946defaults to zero.  This register number is used to read or write
40947the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40948packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40949in order of increasing register number.
40950
40951@item save-restore
40952Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40953calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}.  The default is
40954@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40955some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40956ABI.
40957
40958@item type
40959The type of the register.  It may be a predefined type, a type
40960defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40961and @code{float}.  @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40962for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40963architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40964@var{bitsize}.  The default is @code{int}.
40965
40966@item group
40967The register group to which this register belongs.  It must
40968be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}.  If no
40969@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40970in @code{info registers}.
40971
40972@end table
40973
40974@node Predefined Target Types
40975@section Predefined Target Types
40976@cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40977
40978Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40979from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types.  Instead,
40980standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40981types.  The currently supported types are:
40982
40983@table @code
40984
40985@item bool
40986Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
40987
40988@item int8
40989@itemx int16
40990@itemx int32
40991@itemx int64
40992@itemx int128
40993Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40994
40995@item uint8
40996@itemx uint16
40997@itemx uint32
40998@itemx uint64
40999@itemx uint128
41000Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41001
41002@item code_ptr
41003@itemx data_ptr
41004Pointers to unspecified code and data.  The program counter and
41005any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41006pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41007address.  The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41008may be marked as data pointers.
41009
41010@item ieee_single
41011Single precision IEEE floating point.
41012
41013@item ieee_double
41014Double precision IEEE floating point.
41015
41016@item arm_fpa_ext
41017The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41018
41019@item i387_ext
41020The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41021
41022@item i386_eflags
4102332bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41024
41025@item i386_mxcsr
4102632bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41027
41028@end table
41029
41030@node Enum Target Types
41031@section Enum Target Types
41032@cindex target descriptions, enum types
41033
41034Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41035register descriptions.  @xref{Target Description Format}.
41036
41037Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41038
41039@smallexample
41040<enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41041  <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41042  @dots{}
41043</enum>
41044@end smallexample
41045
41046Enums must be defined before they are used.
41047
41048@smallexample
41049<enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41050  <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41051  <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41052</enum>
41053<flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41054  <field name="X" start="0"/>
41055  <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41056</flags>
41057<reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41058@end smallexample
41059
41060Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41061would be printed as:
41062
41063@smallexample
41064(gdb) info register flags
41065flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41066@end smallexample
41067
41068@node Standard Target Features
41069@section Standard Target Features
41070@cindex target descriptions, standard features
41071
41072A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41073target's registers.  If the description contains no registers, then
41074@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41075the architecture.  If the description contains any registers, the
41076default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41077described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41078can recognize them.
41079
41080This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41081which contain standard registers.  @value{GDBN} will look for features
41082with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41083if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41084feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41085description.  You can add additional registers to any of the
41086standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41087they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41088
41089This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41090Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41091@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41092
41093Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41094company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41095architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41096containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41097
41098The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41099of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41100registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41101
41102@menu
41103* AArch64 Features::
41104* ARC Features::
41105* ARM Features::
41106* i386 Features::
41107* MicroBlaze Features::
41108* MIPS Features::
41109* M68K Features::
41110* NDS32 Features::
41111* Nios II Features::
41112* PowerPC Features::
41113* S/390 and System z Features::
41114* Sparc Features::
41115* TIC6x Features::
41116@end menu
41117
41118
41119@node AArch64 Features
41120@subsection AArch64 Features
41121@cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41122
41123The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41124targets.  It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41125@samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41126
41127The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional.  If present,
41128it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41129and @samp{fpcr}.
41130
41131@node ARC Features
41132@subsection ARC Features
41133@cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41134
41135ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41136are not completely predetermined.  In addition flags and PC registers which are
41137important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC.  It is required
41138that one of the core registers features is present.
41139@samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41140
41141The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41142targets with a normal register file.  It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41143through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41144@samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.  This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41145and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41146@samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41147debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41148
41149The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41150ARC HS targets with a reduced register file.  It should contain registers
41151@samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41152@samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41153This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41154registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41155
41156The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41157targets with a normal register file.  It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41158through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41159@samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.  This feature may contain registers
41160@samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41161through @samp{r59/acch}.  @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41162registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications.  The only
41163difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41164@samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41165ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41166
41167The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41168targets.  It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41169
41170@node ARM Features
41171@subsection ARM Features
41172@cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41173
41174The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41175ARM targets.
41176It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41177@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41178
41179For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41180feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}.  It should contain
41181registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41182and @samp{xpsr}.
41183
41184The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional.  If present, it
41185should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41186
41187The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional.  If present,
41188it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41189@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}.  The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41190@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41191
41192The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional.  If present, it
41193should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}.  If
41194they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41195@value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41196halves of the double-precision registers.
41197
41198The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional.  It does not
41199need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41200VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41201quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41202If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41203be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41204
41205@node i386 Features
41206@subsection i386 Features
41207@cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41208
41209The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41210targets.  It should describe the following registers:
41211
41212@itemize @minus
41213@item
41214@samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41215@item
41216@samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41217@item
41218@samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41219@samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41220@item
41221@samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41222@item
41223@samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41224@samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41225@end itemize
41226
41227The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41228
41229The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional.  It should
41230describe registers:
41231
41232@itemize @minus
41233@item
41234@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41235@item
41236@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41237@item
41238@samp{mxcsr}
41239@end itemize
41240
41241The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41242@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature.  It should
41243describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41244
41245@itemize @minus
41246@item
41247@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41248@item
41249@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41250@end itemize
41251
41252The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41253Memory Protection Extension (MPX).  It should describe the following registers:
41254
41255@itemize @minus
41256@item
41257@samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41258@item
41259@samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41260@end itemize
41261
41262The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional.  It should
41263describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41264
41265The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional.  It should
41266describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41267
41268The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41269@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature.  It should
41270describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41271
41272@itemize @minus
41273@item
41274@samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41275@end itemize
41276
41277It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41278
41279@itemize @minus
41280@item
41281@samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41282@end itemize
41283
41284It should
41285describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41286
41287@itemize @minus
41288@item
41289@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41290@item
41291@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41292@end itemize
41293
41294It should
41295describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41296
41297@itemize @minus
41298@item
41299@samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41300@end itemize
41301
41302The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional.  It should
41303describe a single register, @samp{pkru}.  It is a 32-bit register
41304valid for i386 and amd64.
41305
41306@node MicroBlaze Features
41307@subsection MicroBlaze Features
41308@cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41309
41310The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41311targets.  It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41312@samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41313@samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41314@samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41315
41316The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41317If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41318
41319@node MIPS Features
41320@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41321@cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41322
41323The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41324It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41325@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}.  They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41326on the target.
41327
41328The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required.  It should
41329contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41330registers.  They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41331
41332The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41333it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}.  It should
41334contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41335@samp{fir}.  They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41336
41337The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional.  It should
41338contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41339@samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}.  The @samp{dspctl} register should
41340be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41341
41342The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional.  It should
41343contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41344Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41345
41346@node M68K Features
41347@subsection M68K Features
41348@cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41349
41350@table @code
41351@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41352@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41353@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41354One of those features must be always present.
41355The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41356used.  The feature that is present should contain registers
41357@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41358@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41359
41360@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41361This feature is optional.  If present, it should contain registers
41362@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41363@samp{fpiaddr}.
41364@end table
41365
41366@node NDS32 Features
41367@subsection NDS32 Features
41368@cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41369
41370The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41371targets.  It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41372@samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41373and @samp{pc}.
41374
41375The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional.  If present,
41376it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41377@samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41378@samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41379
41380@emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41381registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41382floating-point registers.  The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41383not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41384overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers.  Listing 32-bit
41385single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41386support to it could be totally removed some day.
41387
41388@node Nios II Features
41389@subsection Nios II Features
41390@cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41391
41392The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41393targets.  It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41394@samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41395@samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41396@samp{mpuacc}).
41397
41398@node PowerPC Features
41399@subsection PowerPC Features
41400@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41401
41402The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41403targets.  It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41404@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41405@samp{xer}.  They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41406
41407The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional.  It should
41408contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41409
41410The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional.  It should
41411contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41412and @samp{vrsave}.
41413
41414The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional.  It should
41415contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}.  @value{GDBN}
41416will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41417(@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41418through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41419through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41420
41421The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional.  It should
41422contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41423@samp{spefscr}.  SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41424@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41425@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}.  @value{GDBN} will combine
41426these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41427user.
41428
41429@node S/390 and System z Features
41430@subsection S/390 and System z Features
41431@cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41432@cindex target descriptions, System z features
41433
41434The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41435System z targets.  It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41436registers.  In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41437registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41438S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41439A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
4144032-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41441register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41442lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41443
41444The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required.  It should
41445contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41446@samp{fpc}.
41447
41448The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required.  It should
41449contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41450
41451The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional.  It should
41452contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41453targets and 32-bit otherwise.  In addition, the feature may contain
41454the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41455mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
4145632-bit wide.
41457
41458The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional.  It should
41459contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41460@samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41461
41462The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional.  It should contain
4146364-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41464combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41465through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41466@samp{v0} through @samp{v15}.  In addition, this feature should
41467contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41468@samp{v31}.
41469
41470@node Sparc Features
41471@subsection Sparc Features
41472@cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
41473@cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
41474The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41475targets.  It should describe the following registers:
41476
41477@itemize @minus
41478@item
41479@samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
41480@item
41481@samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
41482@item
41483@samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
41484@item
41485@samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
41486@end itemize
41487
41488They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41489
41490Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41491targets.  It should describe the following registers:
41492
41493@itemize @minus
41494@item
41495@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
41496@item
41497@samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
41498@end itemize
41499
41500The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41501targets.  It should describe the following registers:
41502
41503@itemize @minus
41504@item
41505@samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
41506@samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
41507@item
41508@samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
41509for sparc64
41510@end itemize
41511
41512@node TIC6x Features
41513@subsection TMS320C6x Features
41514@cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41515@cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41516The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41517targets.  It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41518registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41519
41520The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional.  It should
41521contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41522through @samp{B31}.
41523
41524The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional.  It should
41525contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41526
41527@node Operating System Information
41528@appendix Operating System Information
41529@cindex operating system information
41530
41531@menu
41532* Process list::
41533@end menu
41534
41535Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41536the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41537processes, or the list of open files.  This section describes the
41538mechanism that makes it possible.  This mechanism is similar to the
41539target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41540on a different aspect of target.
41541
41542Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41543remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41544read}).  The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41545the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41546
41547@node Process list
41548@appendixsection Process list
41549@cindex operating system information, process list
41550
41551When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41552@samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}.  The returned data is
41553an XML document.  The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41554@file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41555
41556An example document is:
41557
41558@smallexample
41559<?xml version="1.0"?>
41560<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41561<osdata type="processes">
41562  <item>
41563    <column name="pid">1</column>
41564    <column name="user">root</column>
41565    <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41566    <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41567  </item>
41568</osdata>
41569@end smallexample
41570
41571Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}.  The value
41572of that column should identify the process on the target.  The
41573@samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41574displayed by @value{GDBN}.  The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41575should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41576is running on.  Target may provide additional columns,
41577which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41578
41579@node Trace File Format
41580@appendix Trace File Format
41581@cindex trace file format
41582
41583The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41584section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41585
41586The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}.  The first byte is
41587@code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41588while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41589in the future.
41590
41591The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41592separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}).  The lines may include a
41593variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41594as tracepoint definitions or register set size.  @value{GDBN} will
41595ignore any line that it does not recognize.  An empty line marks the end
41596of this section.
41597
41598@table @code
41599@item R @var{size}
41600Specifies the size of a register block in bytes.  This is equal to the
41601size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol.  @var{size}
41602is an ascii decimal number.  There should be only one such line in
41603a single trace file.
41604
41605@item status @var{status}
41606Trace status.  @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41607remote packet reply.  There should be only one such line in a single trace
41608file.
41609
41610@item tp @var{payload}
41611Tracepoint definition.  The @var{payload} has the same format as
41612@code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload.  A single tracepoint
41613may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41614reply packets.
41615
41616@item tsv @var{payload}
41617Trace state variable definition.  The @var{payload} has the same format as
41618@code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload.  A single variable
41619may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41620reply packets.
41621
41622@item tdesc @var{payload}
41623Target description in XML format.  The @var{payload} is a single line of
41624the XML file.  All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41625the original XML file.  This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41626@code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41627file.  Includes are not allowed.
41628
41629@end table
41630
41631The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41632Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41633four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame.  The data in
41634the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41635character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41636state variable).  The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41637hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41638endianness.
41639
41640@c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41641
41642@table @code
41643@item R @var{bytes}
41644Register block.  The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41645@code{g} packet in the remote protocol.  Note that these are the
41646actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41647
41648@item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41649Memory block.  This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41650address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41651@var{length} bytes.
41652
41653@item V @var{number} @var{value}
41654Trace state variable block.  This records the 8-byte signed value
41655@var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41656
41657@end table
41658
41659Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41660of blocks.
41661
41662@node Index Section Format
41663@appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41664@cindex .gdb_index section format
41665@cindex index section format
41666
41667This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41668gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}).  The index section is
41669DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41670description.
41671
41672The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41673@code{mmap}able on any architecture.  In most cases, a datum is
41674represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41675@code{offset_type}.  Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41676before using them.  Exceptions to this rule are noted.  The data is
41677laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41678
41679A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41680
41681@enumerate
41682@item
41683The file header.  This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41684unless otherwise noted:
41685
41686@enumerate
41687@item
41688The version number, currently 8.  Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41689Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41690Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41691and 5 do not.  Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41692symbol table.  Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41693(@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41694compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41695
41696@value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41697by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41698GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41699currently not flagged as deprecated.
41700
41701@item
41702The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41703
41704@item
41705The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list.  Note
41706that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41707to the next offset.
41708
41709@item
41710The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41711
41712@item
41713The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41714
41715@item
41716The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41717@end enumerate
41718
41719@item
41720The CU list.  This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41721values, sorted by the CU offset.  The first element in each pair is
41722the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section.  The second
41723element in each pair is the length of that CU.  References to a CU
41724elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
417250-based index into this table.  Note that if there are type CUs, then
41726conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41727CU indices.
41728
41729@item
41730The types CU list.  This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41731little-endian values.  In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41732the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41733the type signature.  The types CU list is not sorted.
41734
41735@item
41736The address area.  The address area consists of a sequence of address
41737entries.  Each address entry has three elements:
41738
41739@enumerate
41740@item
41741The low address.  This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41742
41743@item
41744The high address.  This is a 64-bit little-endian value.  Like
41745@code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41746
41747@item
41748The CU index.  This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41749@end enumerate
41750
41751@item
41752The symbol table.  This is an open-addressed hash table.  The size of
41753the hash table is always a power of 2.
41754
41755Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41756values.  The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41757constant pool.  The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41758constant pool.
41759
41760If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty.  This
41761is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41762valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41763
41764The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41765iterative hash function to the symbol's name.  Starting with an
41766initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41767the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41768index version:
41769
41770@table @asis
41771@item Version 4
41772The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41773
41774@item Versions 5 to 7
41775The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41776@end table
41777
41778The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41779
41780The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41781@code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41782value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table.  The step size
41783is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41784collision.
41785
41786The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized.  We
41787don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41788algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41789the code.
41790
41791@item
41792The constant pool.  This is simply a bunch of bytes.  It is organized
41793so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41794strings.
41795
41796A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41797values.  The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41798Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41799the CU list.  This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41800CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41801See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41802
41803A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41804@end enumerate
41805
41806Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41807If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41808CU index+attributes value for each use.
41809
41810The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41811(bit 0 = LSB):
41812
41813@table @asis
41814
41815@item Bits 0-23
41816This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41817@item Bits 24-27
41818These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41819@item Bits 28-30
41820The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41821
41822@table @asis
41823@item 0
41824This value is reserved and should not be used.
41825By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41826with previous versions of the index.
41827@item 1
41828The symbol is a type.
41829@item 2
41830The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41831@item 3
41832The symbol is a function.
41833@item 4
41834Any other kind of symbol.
41835@item 5,6,7
41836These values are reserved.
41837@end table
41838
41839@item Bit 31
41840This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41841
41842The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41843The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41844@value{GDBN} sources.
41845
41846@end table
41847
41848This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41849global/static attributes in the index.
41850
41851@smallexample
41852is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41853language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41854switch (die->tag)
41855  @{
41856  case DW_TAG_typedef:
41857  case DW_TAG_base_type:
41858  case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41859    kind = TYPE;
41860    is_static = 1;
41861    break;
41862  case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41863    kind = VARIABLE;
41864    is_static = language != CPLUS;
41865    break;
41866  case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41867    kind = FUNCTION;
41868    is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41869    break;
41870  case DW_TAG_constant:
41871    kind = VARIABLE;
41872    is_static = ! is_external;
41873    break;
41874  case DW_TAG_variable:
41875    kind = VARIABLE;
41876    is_static = ! is_external;
41877    break;
41878  case DW_TAG_namespace:
41879    kind = TYPE;
41880    is_static = 0;
41881    break;
41882  case DW_TAG_class_type:
41883  case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41884  case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41885  case DW_TAG_union_type:
41886  case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41887    kind = TYPE;
41888    is_static = language != CPLUS;
41889    break;
41890  default:
41891    assert (0);
41892  @}
41893@end smallexample
41894
41895@node Man Pages
41896@appendix Manual pages
41897@cindex Man pages
41898
41899@menu
41900* gdb man::                     The GNU Debugger man page
41901* gdbserver man::               Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41902* gcore man::                   Generate a core file of a running program
41903* gdbinit man::                 gdbinit scripts
41904@end menu
41905
41906@node gdb man
41907@heading gdb man
41908
41909@c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41910
41911@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41912gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41913[@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41914[@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41915    [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41916[@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41917[@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41918    [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41919[@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41920@c man end
41921
41922@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41923The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41924going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41925program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41926
41927@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41928these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41929
41930@itemize @bullet
41931@item
41932Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41933
41934@item
41935Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41936
41937@item
41938Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41939
41940@item
41941Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41942effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41943@end itemize
41944
41945You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41946Modula-2.
41947
41948@value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}.  Once started, it reads
41949commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41950command @code{quit}.  You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41951by using the command @code{help}.
41952
41953You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41954usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41955executable program as the argument:
41956
41957@smallexample
41958gdb program
41959@end smallexample
41960
41961You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41962
41963@smallexample
41964gdb program core
41965@end smallexample
41966
41967You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41968to debug a running process:
41969
41970@smallexample
41971gdb program 1234
41972gdb -p 1234
41973@end smallexample
41974
41975@noindent
41976would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41977named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41978With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41979
41980Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41981
41982@c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41983@table @env
41984@item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41985Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41986
41987@item run [@var{arglist}]
41988Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41989
41990@item bt
41991Backtrace: display the program stack.
41992
41993@item print @var{expr}
41994Display the value of an expression.
41995
41996@item c
41997Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41998
41999@item next
42000Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42001function calls in the line.
42002
42003@item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42004look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42005
42006@item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42007type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42008
42009@item step
42010Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42011function calls in the line.
42012
42013@item help [@var{name}]
42014Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42015about using @value{GDBN}.
42016
42017@item quit
42018Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42019@end table
42020
42021@ifset man
42022For full details on @value{GDBN},
42023see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42024by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch.  The same text is available online
42025as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42026@end ifset
42027@c man end
42028
42029@c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42030Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42031file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42032encountered with no
42033associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42034if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42035Many options have
42036both long and short forms; both are shown here.  The long forms are also
42037recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42038present to be unambiguous.  (If you prefer, you can flag option
42039arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42040more usual convention.)
42041
42042All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42043in sequential order.  The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42044option is used.
42045
42046@table @env
42047@item -help
42048@itemx -h
42049List all options, with brief explanations.
42050
42051@item -symbols=@var{file}
42052@itemx -s @var{file}
42053Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42054
42055@item -write
42056Enable writing into executable and core files.
42057
42058@item -exec=@var{file}
42059@itemx -e @var{file}
42060Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42061appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42062dump.
42063
42064@item -se=@var{file}
42065Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42066file.
42067
42068@item -core=@var{file}
42069@itemx -c @var{file}
42070Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42071
42072@item -command=@var{file}
42073@itemx -x @var{file}
42074Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42075
42076@item -ex @var{command}
42077Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42078
42079@item -directory=@var{directory}
42080@itemx -d @var{directory}
42081Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42082
42083@item -nh
42084Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42085
42086@item -nx
42087@itemx -n
42088Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42089
42090@item -quiet
42091@itemx -q
42092``Quiet''.  Do not print the introductory and copyright messages.  These
42093messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42094
42095@item -batch
42096Run in batch mode.  Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42097files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42098Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42099commands in the command files.
42100
42101Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42102download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42103more useful, the message
42104
42105@smallexample
42106Program exited normally.
42107@end smallexample
42108
42109@noindent
42110(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42111terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42112
42113@item -cd=@var{directory}
42114Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42115instead of the current directory.
42116
42117@item -fullname
42118@itemx -f
42119Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess.  It tells
42120@value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42121recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42122includes each time the program stops).  This recognizable format looks
42123like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42124and character position separated by colons, and a newline.  The
42125Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42126characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42127
42128@item -b @var{bps}
42129Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42130interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42131
42132@item -tty=@var{device}
42133Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42134@end table
42135@c man end
42136
42137@c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42138@ifset man
42139The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42140If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42141documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42142
42143@smallexample
42144info gdb
42145@end smallexample
42146
42147@noindent
42148should give you access to the complete manual.
42149
42150@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42151Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42152@end ifset
42153@c man end
42154
42155@node gdbserver man
42156@heading gdbserver man
42157
42158@c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42159@format
42160@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42161gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42162
42163gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42164
42165gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42166@c man end
42167@end format
42168
42169@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42170@command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42171than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42172
42173@ifclear man
42174@subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42175@end ifclear
42176@ifset man
42177Usage (server (target) side):
42178@end ifset
42179
42180First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42181the target system.  The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42182@command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols.  All symbol handling is taken care of by
42183the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42184
42185To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42186program.  You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42187your program, and (c) its arguments.  The general syntax is:
42188
42189@smallexample
42190target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42191@end smallexample
42192
42193For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42194
42195@smallexample
42196@ifset man
42197@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42198target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42199@end ifset
42200@ifclear man
42201target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42202@end ifclear
42203@end smallexample
42204
42205This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42206to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}.  @command{gdbserver} now
42207waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42208
42209To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42210
42211@smallexample
42212target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42213@end smallexample
42214
42215This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42216going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP.  The @code{host:2345} argument means
42217that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
422182345.  (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.)  You can choose any number you
42219want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42220ports on the target system.  This same port number must be used in the host
42221@value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly.  Note that if
42222you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42223print an error message and exit.
42224
42225@command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42226This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument.  The syntax is:
42227
42228@smallexample
42229target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42230@end smallexample
42231
42232@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.  It isn't
42233necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42234
42235To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42236or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42237In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42238the program you want to debug.
42239
42240@smallexample
42241target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42242@end smallexample
42243
42244@ifclear man
42245@subheading Usage (host side)
42246@end ifclear
42247@ifset man
42248Usage (host side):
42249@end ifset
42250
42251You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42252@value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such.  Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42253would, with the target program as the first argument.  (You may need to use the
42254@option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42255That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}.  After that, the only
42256new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42257(or @code{target extended-remote}).  Its argument is either
42258a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42259descriptor.  For example:
42260
42261@smallexample
42262@ifset man
42263@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42264(gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42265@end ifset
42266@ifclear man
42267(gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42268@end ifclear
42269@end smallexample
42270
42271@noindent
42272communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42273
42274@smallexample
42275(gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42276@end smallexample
42277
42278@noindent
42279communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42280you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number.  Note that for
42281TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42282command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42283`Connection refused'.
42284
42285@command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42286described in
42287@ifset man
42288the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42289-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42290@end ifset
42291@ifclear man
42292@ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42293@end ifclear
42294In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42295
42296@smallexample
42297(gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42298@end smallexample
42299
42300The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42301case.
42302@c man end
42303
42304@c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42305There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42306
42307@itemize @bullet
42308
42309@item
42310Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42311
42312@smallexample
42313gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42314@end smallexample
42315
42316The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42317with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42318a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42319stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.  Specify the name of the program to
42320debug in @var{prog}.  Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42321program verbatim.  When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42322connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42323
42324@item
42325Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42326program:
42327
42328@smallexample
42329gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42330@end smallexample
42331
42332The @var{comm} parameter is as described above.  Supply the process ID
42333of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42334else.  Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42335@value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42336
42337@item
42338Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42339
42340@smallexample
42341gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42342@end smallexample
42343
42344In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42345command(s) to run.  Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42346close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42347debug several processes in the same session.
42348@end itemize
42349
42350In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42351
42352@table @env
42353
42354@item --help
42355List all options, with brief explanations.
42356
42357@item --version
42358This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42359
42360@item --attach
42361@command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program.  The syntax is:
42362
42363@smallexample
42364target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42365@end smallexample
42366
42367@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.  It isn't
42368necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42369
42370@item --multi
42371To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42372or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42373Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42374the program you want to debug.  The syntax is:
42375
42376@smallexample
42377target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42378@end smallexample
42379
42380@item --debug
42381Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42382process.
42383This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42384the developers.
42385
42386@item --remote-debug
42387Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42388This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42389the developers.
42390
42391@item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42392Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42393of debugging output.
42394@xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42395
42396@item --wrapper
42397Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42398for debugging.  The option should be followed by the name of the
42399wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42400@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42401
42402@item --once
42403By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42404additional connections are possible.  However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42405with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42406connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42407
42408@c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42409
42410@c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42411@c QDisableRandomization.
42412
42413@end table
42414@c man end
42415
42416@c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42417@ifset man
42418The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42419If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42420documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42421
42422@smallexample
42423info gdb
42424@end smallexample
42425
42426should give you access to the complete manual.
42427
42428@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42429Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42430@end ifset
42431@c man end
42432
42433@node gcore man
42434@heading gcore
42435
42436@c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42437
42438@format
42439@c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42440gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42441@c man end
42442@end format
42443
42444@c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42445Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42446Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42447crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42448limit).  Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42449running without any change.
42450@c man end
42451
42452@c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42453@table @env
42454@item -o @var{filename}
42455The optional argument
42456@var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42457If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42458where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42459@end table
42460@c man end
42461
42462@c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42463@ifset man
42464The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42465If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42466documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42467
42468@smallexample
42469info gdb
42470@end smallexample
42471
42472@noindent
42473should give you access to the complete manual.
42474
42475@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42476Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42477@end ifset
42478@c man end
42479
42480@node gdbinit man
42481@heading gdbinit
42482
42483@c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42484
42485@format
42486@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42487@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42488@value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42489@end ifset
42490
42491~/.gdbinit
42492
42493./.gdbinit
42494@c man end
42495@end format
42496
42497@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42498These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42499@value{GDBN} startup.  The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42500described in
42501@ifset man
42502the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42503-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42504@end ifset
42505@ifclear man
42506@ref{Sequences}.
42507@end ifclear
42508
42509Please read more in
42510@ifset man
42511the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42512-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42513@end ifset
42514@ifclear man
42515@ref{Startup}.
42516@end ifclear
42517
42518@table @env
42519@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42520@item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42521@end ifset
42522@ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42523@item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42524@end ifclear
42525System-wide initialization file.  It is executed unless user specified
42526@value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42527See more in
42528@ifset man
42529the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42530-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42531@end ifset
42532@ifclear man
42533@ref{System-wide configuration}.
42534@end ifclear
42535
42536@item ~/.gdbinit
42537User initialization file.  It is executed unless user specified
42538@value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42539
42540@item ./.gdbinit
42541Initialization file for current directory.  It may need to be enabled with
42542@value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42543See more in
42544@ifset man
42545the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42546-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42547@end ifset
42548@ifclear man
42549@ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42550@end ifclear
42551@end table
42552@c man end
42553
42554@c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42555@ifset man
42556gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42557
42558The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42559If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42560documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42561
42562@smallexample
42563info gdb
42564@end smallexample
42565
42566should give you access to the complete manual.
42567
42568@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42569Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42570@end ifset
42571@c man end
42572
42573@include gpl.texi
42574
42575@node GNU Free Documentation License
42576@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42577@include fdl.texi
42578
42579@node Concept Index
42580@unnumbered Concept Index
42581
42582@printindex cp
42583
42584@node Command and Variable Index
42585@unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42586
42587@printindex fn
42588
42589@tex
42590% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo.  In the
42591% meantime:
42592\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42593\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42594\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42595\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42596\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42597\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42598\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42599\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42600\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42601\page\colophon
42602% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42603@end tex
42604
42605@bye
42606